Home
        Manual
         Contents
1.                                Beat Subdivision Boar Subdivision Tick Value  Moment   Quarter note 1st 0  1st 0   8th note  2nd 480  1st 0   8th note triplet 2nd 320  3rd 640  1st 0  2nd 240   16th note  3rd 480  4th 720  ist 0  2nd 192   16th note quintuplet 3rd 384  4th 576  5th 768  1st 0  2nd 160     3rd 320   16th note triplet  sextuplets   4th 480  5th 640  6th 800          Table 7 2 Subdivision Values    Stop    Use the Stop parameter to specify the riff stop point  Like the Start parameter  the time format  for Stop is Bar   Beat   Tick  Bar can be set to any bar in the sequence  and Beat can be set to any       7 52    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    beat in that bar  beat range is dependent on time signature   Tick can be set from 0 to 959  Refer  to Table 7 2 for Tick values     The PC3LE restricts the selectable values for the Stop parameter such that the current riff is at  least one beat long     Transpose Root Note    With the Transpose parameter set to On  the riff will transpose to the value set in the Root Note  parameter  So  if you have a riff whose root note is C4  you can set a new root note in the setup so  that the riff will play in the correct range  In this scenario  if you want to trigger your riff from  C1 but it was recorded at C4  you would set Transpose to On and Root Note to C1  Your riff will  now play in the desired range when triggered from the C1 key  which now corresponds to the  note C4     SrcTrack  Source Track     The SrcTrack par
2.              DestTuPe cel  duclume    CH   Fr    Knob 1  labeled Timbre on the front panel  should now control the volume of the bass  which is  on the lower half of the keyboard  if not  review the previous steps   All other settings on the  Controllers page for Zone 1  Knob 1  should be left at their default values  see above      8  Next  lets repeat the steps above for Zone 2  using Knob 2  On the Controllers page  use the Chan   Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2  You can view the number of the selected  Zone in the top right corner of screen  see below         9  On the Controllers page  use the cursor buttons to select the Controller field  Make sure the LED to  the left of Timbre Knob is lit  if it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that  LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled Mod   This will select Knob 2 for the Controller field  see below   You can also set the desired controller  in the Controller field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons            Param    TELS S PANWOL JREYWEL    Test Tyre          13 15    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Different Zones    10  With Knob 2 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below      ERAS                 ontr  Scale  CUL  Offset   Test Tyre       PANWOL JKEYWEL    1
3.         13 26    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones    7  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field             COn  ntrallalue  amp  More  ExitWalue                  DestTur T  es   CE ume    CH Fru    Knob 1  labeled Timbre on the front panel  should now control the volume of the pad on Zone 2   222 Class Pad  if not  review the previous steps      8  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the Curve field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Compress  see below   This makes Zone 2  louder when Knob 1 is half way up than it would be with the standard Linear curve  This allows for  the pad sound to be closer to its full volume when Knob 1 is half way up  which will give us an  equal blend of both pad sounds when we are done        Ore             Offset    DestTupe Ctrl    TRUS  PANWOL STA   more s       9  Next  lets repeat the steps above for Zone 3  except this time we will set an Offset and a negative  Scale value to get a crossfading effect  On the Controllers page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the  left of the display to select Zone 3  see below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in  the
4.         Parameter Range of Values Default   Scale  300  100    Curve Linear  Compress  Expand Linear   Offset  128 to  127 0   DestType  Destination Type  Ctrl  Param Dependent on controller  Destination  Dest  Control Destination List Dependent on controller  Entry Value None  0 to 127 None   Exit Value None  0 to 127 None    A word about pressure  Key Range in a zone does not define which notes will generate pressure  in that zone  If pressure is enabled in a zone  playing with aftertouch anywhere on the keyboard  will produce data  For example  if Zone 1   s Key Range is C3 C5 and you play C2 and push  down on the note  pressure messages will be sent from Zone 1  As with any other physical  controller  however  you can disable pressure in any zone  or scale it or offset it differently in the  various zones  It might help to think of pressure as an extra wheel    wheels operate in a zone  regardless of Key Range  and so does pressure     i Note  Aside from the Pressure settings on the Controllers page  MIDI pressure values can be affected by   LS TF settings you make on other pages  See Pressure Map  Press Map   Master  on page 9 5 for an overall  setting that affects all MIDI pressure values input to the PC3LE  and all MIDI pressure values sent to the  internal sound engine and USB or MIDI out ports  except for pressure values output when in Song  Mode   See Pressure Map  Transmit  on page 9 14 for settings that affect only those MIDI pressure  values sent to the USB or MI
5.        Any Editor Left Right cursor buttons Display Tap Tempo page    Up Down cursor buttons Toggle between Play and Stop of current song    Shift Enter Panic  sends all notes controllers off message on all 16 channels    Save Dialog Plus Minus buttons Toggle between next free ID and original ID        Rename Dialog    Plus Minus buttons    Moves cursor to the end of the name           Left Right cursor buttons       Moves cursor to the end of the name        3 11    User Interface Basics       Intuitive Controller Selection Data Entry    Intuitive Controller Selection Data Entry    Search    For certain parameters you can select values    intuitively     rather than having to scroll through a  list  Do this by selecting the desired parameter  then holding the Enter button while moving the  desired physical control     For example  on the Program Mode PARAMETERS page  see page 6 11  you can assign a  physical controller for a parameter by selecting the Control Source column for a parameter   holding the Enter button and moving the desired controller     On the Setup Mode Controllers page  see page 7 9   you can choose the controller that you wish  to make an assignment for by selecting the Controller field  holding the Enter button and  moving the desired controller     A similar technique can be used when setting key ranges  For example  on the KEY VEL page in  the Setup Editor  you can set the range of the currently selected zone as follows  use the cursor  buttons to move 
6.       hal DI MIDI LOCAL  cama E BankHode   Ctl B32  HidiFrog  S  EnteyProgChd 1 Or  Status  Active Arreaaiator   Or    more  CH PRGICTRLS JPANWOL JKEVWEL   more d             13 8    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using Setup Mode To Play Layers Of Instruments    5  Press the more soft button  see A below  on the bottom left of the display twice to scroll left two  pages of soft buttons and find the DupZn  duplicate Zone  button  Press the DupZn button to  duplicate Zone 2 and create Zone 3  see B below   You will see the message    Zone duplicated     and  you will be brought to the CH PROG page for Zone 3  see C below      ERE           Programe  Channel  al Ton  USE_MIDI MID01 LOCAL  MidiBank  El BankMode   Ctl Ar  HidiFrog  S  EntruProstha 1 On  AMIA    ewe ArPedaiator   Or    Delen   fore d      Oren      MIDI hNIDI LOCAL  BankMode   Ctl 6 32  EntryProgChd 1 On  Status  Active ArPedSisator   Orn    pare Newer  Durer  meen  Del  n   more d    6  On the CH PROG page for Zone 3  select the Program field  Select the program 198 Studio  Strings by entering 198 and pressing the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad  see below            ELO Mens      Studio   E pa i EEN   Pal   OI hMIDI LOCAL  MidiBank  1 BankMode   Ctl Ar  HidiFrog  ra EntruProstha 1 On  Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    porte Newer  Durer  meen  Del  n   more d    Now playing the upper half of the keyboard will produce piano and strings  To finish  press the  Exit button to the right of the display to exit the
7.      Control Setup   Setup Mode  ID  126  Internal Voices     Setup Editor Zone 1 Parameters Affecting Program Mode  Page    Controllers Page  CTRLS  All Parameters Except  Entry Value  Exit Value   On Value  Off Value  All Parameters for Drum  Pad Pages   CH PROG Destination  BankMode   KEY VEL All       Aside from assigning MIDI CC destinations for the PC3LE s physical controllers  the Control  Setup allows you to set other available parameters for each physical controller  such as Scale   Curve  and Offset  and Switch Type  see Controllers  CTRLS  Page on page 7 9      On the CH PROG page of the Control Setup  you can set a MIDI Destination for the currently  selected channel in Program Mode  as well as the Bank Mode which determines how Program  Mode will send MIDI bank messages  see The Channel Program  CH PROG  Page on page 7 6      On the KEY   VEL page of the Control Setup  you can set parameters that determine the usable  key and velocity ranges  transposition  and velocity options  though these are best left at their  defaults  For program mode  it is best to set transposition settings with Xpose or Octav soft  buttons on the Program Mode main page  see The Program Mode Page on page 6 2   An overall  velocity response adjustment is best made with the VelMap setting on the Master Mode 1 page   see Velocity Map  Vel Map   Master  on page 9 3      Control Setup Default Assignments                                                 PC3LE Physical Controller Controllers Pag
8.     5  On the CH PROG page for Zone 1  select the Program field  Select the program 105 P Bass by  entering 105 and pressing the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad  see below   You can also set  the desired program in the Program field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons       Ores               Pal Tr SE ULI OI LOCAL  MidiBank  El BankMode   Ctl Ase  HidiFros  143 EntruProstha 1 On  Status  Active Arreaaiator   Or    e more  CH APRG ICTELS JPANUOLJEEYUEL   more d    6  Next  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2        7  On the CH PROG page for Zone 2  select the Program field  Select the program 22 Sweet Loretta  EP by entering 22 and pressing the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad  see below   You can  also set the desired program in the Program field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons         Pal TT OE Ut OI LOCAL  MidiBank  El BankMode   Ctl Ase  HidiFrog  22 EntruProstha 1 Or  Status  Active Arreaaiator   Or    more  CH PEG PANYOL IKEYWEL   more     Now the playing the lower half of the keyboard will produce electric bass  and playing the  upper half of the keyboard will produce electric piano  To finish  press the Exit button to the right  of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup    Editor section at the beginning of this chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup  Editor              13 7    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using Setup Mode To Play
9.     Real time Controls in KB3 Mode    You have real time control over many components of KB3 programs directly from the front  panel  The knobs emulate the drawbars that are so essential to the tone wheel sound  while the  assignable switches above them can control the KB3 effects  Leslie  vibrato  chorus  and  percussion  Use the Shift button next to each set of controls in order to access all of the available  parameters     When using a KB3 program in Program mode  the assignable knobs and switches always control  KB3 effects  In Setup mode the assignable switches mute and unmute zones by default  If you  want the assignable switches to control the functions of a KB3 program in a setup  you can edit  the setup and automatically assign the KB3 controls using the KB3CTL soft button in the Setup  Editor  See Set Controls KB3  KB3CTL  on page 7 65     Drawbars In KB3 Mode    One of the standard performance features of many tone wheel organs is the set of drawbars for  emulating the stops on a pipe organ  Moving the drawbars controls the amplitude of either the  fundamentals or the harmonics of the notes  out to increase amplitude  in to decrease it      The PC3LE s knobs serve as the nine drawbars found on most tone wheel organs  Turning the  knobs down is the equivalent of pushing the drawbars in  removing fundamentals or  harmonics   The table below shows how the PC3LE s knobs relate to standard drawbar  functions           Subharmonics Fundamental Harmonics   16  5 1 3  8  
10.     Soft buttons    On most PC3LE screens  the bottom line of the display identifies the function of each of the  buttons beneath the display  We call these buttons soft buttons  because they do different things  depending on what s currently showing in the display     In Program and Quick Access modes  you can change octaves with the Octav  and Octav   buttons under the display  The Info soft button shows you relevant details about the current  item  The Xpose  Xpose  buttons are a shortcut for quick transposition in semitone  half   step  increments  You can use them to transpose the entire PC3LE as much as three octaves up or  down  The top line of the display shows the current amount of transposition  Xpose   Press both  Xpose buttons simultaneously to return transposition to zero     The Panic button  or a double press of Shift and Enter at the bottom of the alphanumeric  keypad  sends an All Notes Off message and an All Controllers Off message   both to the PC3LE  and over all 16 MIDI channels  You won t need it often  but it s nice to have     V A S T  Programs    Most of the included factory programs use V A S T  synthesis  which play up to 32 layers of  samples  routed through digital signal processing     KB3 Programs    KB3  organ  programs differ from V A S T  programs in that they don t play samples  Instead  they rely on oscillators that mimic the tone wheels used in many popular organs  Because of  their architecture  KB3 programs require different processing w
11.     The Setup Editor    The FX Page    Use the FX Page to distribute processing power  DSP units  for the effects of the zone s   or  track s  in Song Mode  assigned to each MIDI channel   See Channel on page 7 6 and Track  Channels on page 10 7 for details on setting the MIDI channel for each zone   track in Setup  Song  mode respectively   Each Effect Chain is composed of an effect box or a series of effect boxes   Each effect box uses a certain amount of the PC3LE   s effects processing power  The amount of  processing power used by an effect box or Chain reflects how complex the effect   s algorithm  is   more complex effects require more processing power  Accordingly  each Chain and effect   box uses a certain number of    DSP units      you can have up to 10 DSP units used at a time in the  current setup or song  The number of DSP units required to load effects for the cursor   highlighted channel is shown at the top of the page  followed by the number of total DSP units  required to load all effects for the setup or song  If you attempt to use more than 10 DSP units   the PC3LE will indicate that you have gone over the limit by displaying  Max 10  on the top line  of the page     Effects are loaded for as many channels as is possible  until all of the DSP units are used up  In  Setup and Song Mode  the MIDI channel of the lowest used zone  track will have priority for  using DSP units  This zone track will use as many DSP units as it need for its effects  then the  MID
12.     The pedals are independently assignable within each zone of every setup  Here are the default  settings for the three pedals you can use with the PC3LE     Switch Pedal 1 Controller 64  Sustain   Switch Pedal 2 Controller 66  Sostenuto   Continuous Control Pedal 1 Controller 11  Expression   Volume        2 3    Startup       Startup   the Details    AN    Switching On the Power  The PC3LE s power switch is on the rear panel  adjacent to the power cable connection   When you power up  the display briefly shows some startup information  The Program mode    display then appears  It looks like the diagram below  though your PC3LE may be different from  the example     PoSr arm         E Nv Jazz Grand  Octau  Panic Tinto TePose      The first time you power up  or after a reset   your instrument will be set to operate on MIDI  Channel 1  as shown at the far right of the top line above           gtan          Set the volume at a comfortable level  You ll get the best signal to noise ratio if you keep the  PC3LE at full volume  and adjust the level from your mixing board  You may also want to adjust  the display contrast by using the small contrast knob on the rear panel of the PC3LE     USB Storage Port    You can plug a USB mass storage device such as a    thumb drive    into the PC3LE for backing up   archiving  sharing your work  and updating your software  Any size USB mass storage device  will work  though thumb drives are recommended for their portability  durability  an
13.     gt     followed by the note name  The     gt     is effectively the  event type for notes  and to change the event type  highlight the     gt      To change the note     highlight the note name     Table 10 1 lists the ranges of the editable event values                    Event Type Values  Program Change  PCHG  0 to 127  Pitch Bend  BEND   8192 to 8191  Mono Pressure  MPRS  0 to 127  Poly Pressure  PPRS  0 to 127 C 1toG9    Table 10 1  MIDI event Value Ranges       10 32    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The EVENT Page    Note events have four editable values  Note Name  Attack    Velocity  indicated by a    v      Release Velocity  indicated by  a           and Note Duration                 MIDI Note Events   gt   Note Number C 1toG9  Attack Velocity v1 to v127  Release Velocity M to 4127  Note Duration Bar   Beats   Ticks          Controller events have two editable values  Controller Type  and Controller Value  Defined controllers are referred to by  their names  See the table Continuous Controller Number  And Name on page 7 69 for the names that represent  MIDI Controller Events  CTRL  Controller Events sent by each of the PC3LE   s physical  controllers when using the default Control Setup                    Controller Type Control Source List  0 to 127   Controller Value 0 to 127  Tempo Change 20 00 BPM to 400 00 BPM    Table 10 1 MIDI event Value Ranges  Continued     Soft Buttons on the EVENT Page    Cut  Removes the currently selected event fr
14.    223 2 135 113 T   Knob 1 Knob 2 Knob 3 Knob 4 Knob 5 Knob 6 Knob 7 Knob 8 Knob 9  Row 2 Row 2 Row 2 Row 2                            Table 6 1 Standard Drawbar Settings for the Hammond B3    Assignable Switches In KB3 Mode    When the assignable switches are enabled for KB3 control  their LEDs indicate the status of the  various effects for the current KB3 program  This status is saved as part of each KB3 program   You can change the effects in real time by pressing the buttons  or by sending the appropriate  MIDI Controller values from your MIDI controller      In normal operational modes  on off settings of the assignable switches for a KB3 program are  not automatically saved  the switches return to their programmed on or off state the next time  you select the program  If you   ve made changes to their state that differ from those saved with  the program  the Save button will light  Press the Save button to save changes to the current  program  or to rename the program and save it under a new ID  When choosing an ID   press  the   and   buttons simultaneously  below the Alpha Wheel  to jump to the original ID  if you  would like to replace the original program  The state of the assignable switches will also be  saved if you change their state while in the Program Editor  If you don t like the changes  you  can exit without saving  and the program will revert to its previous settings     The assignable switches also send MIDI Controller information to the PC3LE   s MIDI
15.    Initial Volume Settings    Each song file does not automatically save your volume setting for each track  To make a song  save your volume settings for each track  you must write an initial volume for each track  Initial  volume is the volume setting that will be used when your song is played back from the start of  bar 1  An initial volume setting is essentially a volume automation message that is written  before the first tick of a track  Initial volume settings are not automatically written during  recording because they make it harder to try out different volume settings for a track  For  example  an initial volume will reset any volume adjustments that you make during playback  each time the song is stopped and played from the start of bar 1  or if the song is stopped and  played from any point if the Control Chase parameter set to On on the Song MISC page  see  Song Mode  The MISC Page on page 10 17   If you plan to try out different volume settings  it is  easier if you write an initial volume after you have found the desired setting     Setting Initial Volume Per Track    Follow these steps to change the current RecTrk   s initial volume  While the sequencer is  stopped  press Record  change the value of Vol  press Stop  and save the song  follow the same  method to quickly set initial program or pan settings   Initial program  volume  and pan can also  be set at the top of each track   s event list  see Song Editor  The EVENT Page on page 10 31      Setting Initia
16.    Save changes to  this song     dialog  described below   and provides you with the opportunity to listen to the new  song and compare it with the old  previously saved  song before answering Yes or No     The PC3LE also has dedicated front panel buttons for Record  Play Pause  and Stop  You ll find  them just below the six mode buttons  Additionally you can control these functions from any  external sequencer that sends MIDI Machine Control  MMC  messages  The PC3LE will  automatically listen to any MMC messages received at the USB or MIDI in port  The PC3LE will  also automatically send its own MMC messages from the USB and MIDI out port  enabling the  PC3LE s transport to control an external sequencer  This works from any mode  though in  Program mode you will want to make sure that the Demo Button function is set to off  You can  do this from Master Mode  Page 2  When Demo Button is set to off  you can still hear Program  demos by pressing the cursor up and down buttons simultaneously     Important Note About External Sequencers     If using the PC3LE transport controls to record to an external sequencer  you must be in Song  mode with the RecTrk set to None  If this is not done  you will simultaneously record to the  external sequencer and the selected RecTrk if in Song Mode  or activate the Quick Song  Recording function from other modes  This will cause unwanted sequences to be recorded in the  PC3LE   s sequencer     If you are also triggering PC3LE sounds from the 
17.    T Oetau     Play a note on the left hand end of the keyboard to hear the electric bass riff that is loaded with  this setup  If you let the bass riff play without pressing any other keys  you will hear that the riff  is a four bar loop  When you press another key on the left hand end of the keyboard  the bass riff  waits until its next downbeat and then transposes the riff and restarts the loop  To stop the riff   press the Stop button to the left of the display     3  Next  lets edit this setup to see how this riff is being transposed and triggered  With the setup 64  Old School Jam selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will bring you to the CH   PROG page of the setup editor  see below               Program  pa    Channel  tion  JSE MIDI MIDI LOCAL  HidiBank  1 BankMode   Ctl O a  MidiProa1 115 EntriProStha   Orn    Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    more  CH PRG  ICTELS JPANWOL JKEVWEL Y more A          13 43    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    4  From the CH PROG page of the setup editor  press the top Chan Zone button to the left of the  display to move up one zone to zone 2  The currently selected zone number can be viewed in the  top right corner of the display  On the CH PROG page for zone 2  we can see the program used for  the electric bass riff is 236 Motown Bass  see below             Pal STD I4  MIDI   LOCAL  bank 1 ADE   Ctl O a  HidiFrog  145 EntruProstha 1 On  Status  Active Arreaaiator   Or    AAA AAA   more 4       
18.    f       17  Next  use the cursor buttons to select the field below SyncZone  SyncType  Use the       buttons or  the Alpha Wheel to select DownBeatWait for the SyncType field  see below   Now if you press  pad 2  the PC3LE will wait until you press pad 1 to start both the horn and drum riffs        7 foe         C i SYncTyPe  Relsundn   OFF RelSunTue   Hone   Forever Dur  laas Welt 16007    f  E            ate 7  4         Why did we choose these settings  We have selected Riff 4 for SyncZone  because we want the  horn riff to sync with the drum riff  Riff 4  which is on zone 4   We chose DownBeatWait as the  SyncType  which makes the horn riff  riff 6  wait to start until there is a downbeat of riff 4  You  could also choose the same settings for RelSynZn and RelSynTyp to make the horn riff wait to  stop playing until the drum riff plays a downbeat  See The RIFF2 Page on page 7 54 for more on  the numerous settings available on this page        13 41    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    18  Lastly  lets change the Stop point for the horn riff so that it loops with no gaps  Press the RIFF1  soft button at the bottom of the page to move to the RIFF1 page for zone 6  On the RIFF  page  use  the cursor buttons to select the left most Stop field  The Stop field sets the bar number  within the  riff   s original sequence  that the riff should stop at  The Stop field also sets the loop point when  Loop parameter is set to Forever on the RIFF2 page  Our horn ri
19.   1 EntruProschs  On    Status  Active ArPeddiator   Orn    e more  CH   PRGICTRLS JPANWOL IKEYUEL   more 4    4  On the CH PROG page  select the Program field  see above   Select a program for Zone   using  the Category buttons        buttons  the Alpha Wheel or the alphanumeric pad        13 33    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Creating A New Setup    5  If you would like to add a new Zone  use the more soft button on the bottom left of the display to  scroll to the next page of soft buttons and find the NewZn  new Zone  button  Press the NewZn  button to create a new Zone  see below   You will see the message    New Zone created     and you  will be brought to the CH PROG page for the new Zone  You can view the number of the selected  Zone in the top right corner of screen           Programe  Channel  Ji i   MidiBank  E Eun E   CIl PES  HidiFros  1 EntruProstha 1 On  Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    more  Newer Duena  meen  Delf  n   more d       6  On the CH PROG page for the new Zone  select the Program field  see below   Select a program  for the new Zone using the Category buttons        buttons  the Alpha Wheel or the alphanumeric  pad        A  EA           Programe  Channels a HIDI AHIDI LOCAL  HidiBank   amp  BankMode PCT  B732  MidiProg  1 EntruProschs  Orn    Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    ore  Hewszn  Dureza  meen  Delf  n   more d    Repeat steps 5 and 6 to create up to 16 Zones  each of which can have its own instrument  program and keyrange  as well as m
20.   172 ShiftPBank Each increment of 7  0 6  7 13   112 127  selects one of  the 17 ShiftPatt Banks for the ARPEGGIATOR page of a  controller   s zone    173 VelPatt Selects one of the 128 patterns in the VelPatt Bank for  the ARPEGGIATOR page of a controller s zone    174 VelPBank Each range of seven values  0 6  7 13   112 127   selects one of the 17 VelPatt Banks for the  ARPEGGIATOR page of a controller   s zone    175 VelFixed Set s arpeggiator velocity when velocity is set to Fixed          for the ARPEGGIATOR page of a controller s zone        7 48    Setup Mode       The COMMON Page    The Setup Editor    The COMMON page contains parameters that affect every zone in the current setup        Tempo   ESA  Clock source  Interna Aux FH channel    ArPGlobal   Off  Aresunc    Not in anc KES channel  1    1    ore  Hame  Save  Delete  COMMON   more d                      Parameter Range of Values Default  Tempo 20 to 300 120   Clock source Internal  External Internal  ArpGlobal  Arpeggiator Global  Off  Arp 1 to 16 Off  ArpSync  Arpeggiator Sync  Not in Sync  Sync Mode Not in Sync  Aux FX channel 1 to 16 1   KB3 Channel 1 to 16 1          Tempo    When Clock Source is set to Internal  the Tempo parameter sets the PC3LE   s system tempo  The  Tempo parameter values are in units of BPM  beats per minute   This controls the tempo of any  arpeggiators used in the current setup  any riffs that have their BPM parameter set to Setup  any  tempo based effects  and the currently select
21.   4 1  Selecting parameters 3 6  Selecting programs and setups 2 6  Sequencer  tutorial 10 1  sequencer 12 1  Setup  Compare Editor 7 5  Setup Editor 7 5  13 3  Control Setup 7 68  Delete Soft Button 7 64  Delete Zone  DelZn  Soft Button 7 65  Duplicate Zone  DupZn  Soft Button 7 65  Import Zone  ImpZn  Soft Button 7 65  Local Program  LocalPrg  7 6  Name Soft Button 7 64  New Zone  NewZn  Soft Button 7 64  Soft buttons 7 64  Setup Mode 13 1  Channel   Program  CH PROG  Page 7 68  Creating A New Setup 13 13  13 17  Layers Of Instruments 13 8  Saving 13 3  Split Program Setup 13 4  Volume And Pan Of Zones 13 11  Setup mode 4 2  7 1       Setups 2 8  Aux Bend 1 7 35  Aux Bend 2 7 35  BEND Page 7 34  Bend Range 7 34  COMMON Page 7 49  Curve  Curv  7 11  Destination 7 8  Destination  Dest  7 11  Entry  Ent  and Exit States 7 14  7 16  Entry Pan  Exit Pan 7 25  Entry values 7 12  Entry Volume  Exit Volume 7 25  Low and high key 7 26  Low Velocity  LoVel   HighVelocity  HiVel  7 33  MIDI Bank 7 7  MIDI Bank Mode 7 8  MIDI channel 7 6  MIDI Controller Destination List 7 17  Note Maps 7 27  Off Value 7 14  On Value 7 14  Pan   Volume  PAN  VOL  Page 7 25  Save Soft Button 7 64  Scale 7 11  selecting 2 6  Status 7 8  Transpose 7 27  Transposing 7 1  Velocity Curve 7 31  Velocity Offset 7 29  Velocity Scale  VelScale  7 28  Shift  Song Mode TRACK Page 10 28  Shift Key Number  Shift Key  ShKeyNum  ShiftKey  7 22  Shift Pattern  ShiftPatt  7 41  Shifting notes  in the Arpeggiator 7 40  S
22.   Ctl 6732  HidiFrog  187 EntriProStha   Orn            Status  Active ArPedSistor  Orn  more  CH PRGICTRLS JPANWOL  KEYWEL more    Step 3    A    2  On the CH PROG page use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 1   see above   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen  In the  Program field you can view the instrument Program for the current Zone  We can see that the  program for Zone 1 of this setup is 235 AC Buzzer Bass     3  From the CH PROG page  press the KEY VEL soft button on the bottom of the screen  see above    This brings you to the KEY VEL page where you can view the key range for the current Zone  On  the KEY VEL page we will adjust the key range for Zone 1  You can see that Zone 1 is still  selected  displayed in the top right corner of screen  see below           Linear  WelScale   1007  Lolle  11 Weloffset   i  Hilel   12T WelCuryve Linear       FANUOL JEEYUEL Y more d    4  On the KEY VEL page for Zone 1  use the cursor buttons to highlight the HiKey field  This field  sets the upper limit of the key range for Zone 1  which contains the bass program  Let s make the  upper range of this Zone end an octave higher by changing the HiKey field from D 3 to D 4  To  do this  select the HiKey field  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and play D 4          13 5    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using And Editing A Split Program Setup     three half steps above middle C  which is C4  on the PC3LE 
23.   Ctl Ar  MidiProg  111 Ba ode ng  On  Status  Active ArPedSisator   Orn    more  CH   PRGICTRLS JPANWOL JKEVWEL              13 36    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    4  From the CH PROG page of the setup editor  press the left hand more soft button to cycle through  the soft buttons at the bottom of the display and find the NewZn soft button  Press the NewZn soft  button  This will create a new zone  zone 6  and bring you to the CH PROG page for the new zone   see below   You can see the number of the currently selected zone in the top right corner of the    display   If needed  change the selected zone by using the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the  display      7 foe       Programe  Channel  estination USb_MIDIFNIDI LOCAL  MidiBank  4 EsikMode   Ctl Arz    MidiProg  1 EntruProschs  On  Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    more MAMI   more d          5  We will use the new zone  zone 6  to play a horn riff  On the CH PROG page for zone 6  choose  program 59 BigBand A Mradio for the zone   s program  see below   To do this  enter 59 into the  Program field by pressing and lighting the Category Shift button  then use the alphanumeric pad to  enter 59 followed by the Enter button  You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select  the program   You can always go back and change the program later           Setup ATTE   OMe B  Progr ant EEF  and AMradio  Channels E ahr  OS EMO I MIDI  LOCAL  MidiBank  El BankMode   Ctl 32  HidiFrog  59 EntruProst
24.   F   e   F   F   F   F   e     dio a Ao    If Override is set to No  the top line of the page displays the Aux Chain that is loaded due to the  Aux FX Channel parameter  see page 7 50   On the example screen below  the Aux Chain of the  zone   track selected for the Aux FX Channel parameter is 904 Sax Chamber2     SAS PA loaded  cE 21 904 Sax Chamber  err ie     pi           Send Levels and Pre Post ma    1 2 4 56 rt 8 amp 8 9 Ibilli i   2   F   F   F  El  2   F   F   F   e   e  S fe  fe  le    RUSE ALA                   Parameter Range of Values Default   Override No  Yes No   Chain Chain List 0 None   Send Level  p    96 to 24 dB  p    Pre  Post  Insert  p   pst  pre  p   Override    This parameter switches on or off the Aux override  Set Override to Yes to select an override  Aux Chain on this page  Set Override to No to allow Aux FX chain of the program for the  current zone  or track in Song Mode      Normally  the Aux Effects Chains are specified by the program on the specified Aux Effects  channel  see Aux FX Channel on page 7 50 for Setup mode  or FX Track on page 10 20 for Song  mode   When Override is set to Yes  the Chain parameter appears  allowing you to choose a  different Aux effect  which also applies different send levels and other parameters   See   Dest on page 7 12 for details on controlling parameters of Aux Override effects     Chain    When Override is set to Yes  you can select an override Aux Chain for the page   s corresponding  Aux Effect  This par
25.   For controller messages sent to external equipment via the MIDI or USB out ports  destinations  0 127 will only perform their named function if the external equipment has the capability to do  so  Most of these named functions correspond to the MIDI standard for continuous controller  destinations     Controller Destination numbers which are greater than 127 are sent as a PC3LE specific  protocol  and are thus not sent as MIDI data through MIDI or USB out ports  Most PC3LE  programs respond to the controller destinations above 127  though some like 163 RiffOn or 176  ShKeyNum require additional circumstances or setup                                   Corresponding  Controller Agee po  Destination Description  Number  Name  0 OFF Bank By default  when you enter 0 or Clear for the Destination  parameter  the destination will be assigned to OFF  To select  Bank as the destination  use the Alpha Wheel or     buttons   1 MWheel Default assignment for Mod Wheel  2 Breath Default assignment for breath controller in compatible synths   3 MIDI 03 MIDI Controller 3  4 Foot Default assignment for continuous foot controller in  compatible synths   5 PortTim Monophonic PC3LE programs respond to this Controller if  portamento is turned on  6 Data Almost all PC3LE programs have this Controller assigned to  filter frequency or brightness  Volume MIDI Volume  Balance MIDI Balance  MIDI 09 MIDI Controller 9  10 Pan MIDI Pan   programs which use PANNER their effect chain  will respond to real
26.   Function  Erase        Events Hi i ers  Controllers Uolume  Lollal   Hi  12T    8  Press the Go soft button to delete the selected volume automation  A screen will appear reading     Erase Operation Completed     Press the OK soft button to return to the EditSong  TRACK page   see below          Erase Operation Completed        9  Once back on the EditSong TRACK page  press the Play Pause button to hear the result  Next   press the Exit button twice to return to the Song mode MAIN page  You will be presented with the  Song  Save Changes page  where you can decide whether or not to save the changes you have  made     10  To re record volume automation  follow the steps in Part 6 b  above        12 14    Tutorial  Song Mode       Part 7  Learning More About Song Mode    Factory ROM Songs    The PC3LE includes a number of pre recorded songs stored in the factory ROM  Investigate  these songs to see the possibilities of Song mode  Feel free to edit or add to any of these songs in  order to learn more about song mode  You can save the demo songs you ve experimented with  under new ID numbers so that you can compare between your version and the original  Also  if  you replace a factory ROM song  you can revert to the original song by deleting the song using  the Object soft button in Master Mode  see the Master Mode chapter      Quantizing    Quantizing is a method of adjusting the timing of notes recorded into a sequence  It can be used  to adjust note timing in order to fix mis
27.   HidiFros  1  EntridProstha   On  Status  Active Hrressiator   On  LAA EATA ARAS    Step 3 A       3  From the CH PROG page  press the CTRLS soft button on the bottom of the screen  see above    This brings you to the Controllers page where you can view and assign physical controllers to  destinations for the current Zone        13 25    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones    4  On the Controllers page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2  see  below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen             E FP     pate  Scale   a  MES   Linear  Offset  H  Test Tyre   Par am    TELS S PARLOLTEEYLEL       5  On the Controllers page for Zone 2  the Controller field will be highlighted  if not  select the  Controller field with the cursor buttons   Make sure the LED to the left of the Timbre Knob is lit  if  it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter  button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for  the Controller field  see below   You can also set the desired controller in the Controller field by  using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons           DestTuPe Par am    6  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below    
28.   If you edit the parameters of a program and suddenly can t produce any sound  from the program  this may be the cause  In this case  either set the MIDI Value for Expression  to something other than None  or use the Control Source that you set for Expression to increase  the MIDI Value     The BASIC Page    On the BASIC page you can adjust basic settings for the currently selected program  see below          aim   Ber Le   Bernd Down  saat  Categor  1 Piano            THAE    OutGain  Adjust the output level of the currently selected program by up to  96 dB or  20 dB        SLO FX i more d    Bend Up  Bend Down    Use these parameters to define how much the pitch will change when you move your Pitch  Wheel  You can set either Bend parameter to bend by up to 72 half steps up or down  Pitch  values are set in cents  where 100 cents   1 half step  For both Bend parameters  positive values  will cause the pitch to bend up  while negative values will cause the pitch to bend down  Large  positive values can cause samples to bend to their maximum upward pitch shift before the Pitch  Wheel is fully up  or down   This will not happen when bending pitch down     Category    This parameter sets the category that the program will be program will be grouped with when  you press one of the Category buttons from the Program mode main page  For example  if you  were to edit a program in the Leads category that you want to use primarily as a Synth Bass  you  could make it appear in the Syn 
29.   Quant  Off  1 to 100     The Quantize parameter determines how much the selected Note events are moved towards  grid locations  If set to Off  no aligning of previously recorded notes to grid locations will occur   If set to 100   every recorded Note event will be aligned to the closest grid location  defined by  the Grid setting  Notes will be moved to a position half way between the grid location and the  original Note event location if Quant is set to 50      Grid  1 1 to 1 480    This setting determines the size of the Quantize grid  expressed as a fraction of a Bar with a 4 4  meter  Set Grid to 1 1 for whole note grid  1 16 for sixteenth notes  All of the standard note  durations and all fractional Bar divisions in between are available as the size of the Input  Quantize grid     Swing   100 to 125     The Swing percentage is applied to the quantize grid  0  swing is straight time  100  produces  a swing feel  triplet feel   A positive Swing value determines how close every other grid location  is moved to a point 1 3 of the way towards the next grid point  Negative Swing moves every  other grid location closer to a point 1 3 of the way towards the previous grid point     Release  Yes No    Set the Release parameter to Yes if you would like each quantized Note event   s Note Off  message to be aligned to the grid location nearest to the time the key was originally released        10 27    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  Track Functions    Shift    The
30.   Riff 1 16  Main Seq  Arp 1 16  FirstRiff Av   First First Avail   Arp Av  Sync Type None  DownBeat  AnyBeat  DownBeatWait  AnyBeatWait  None  Loop  Stop  StartWait  LoopWait  StopWait  Release Sync Zone  RelSynZn  First Avail   Riff 1 16  Main Seq  Arp 1 16  FirstRiff Av   First First Avail   Arp Av  Release Sync Type  RelSynTyp  None  DownBeat  AnyBeat  DownBeatWait  AnyBeatWait  None  Loop  Stop  StartWait  LoopWait  StopWait  Duration 1 to 1000  100   Velocity 0 to 255  100   Offset  32768 to 32767 0  Trigger    There are a few ways to trigger riffs in setup mode  On the Riff2 page you can use the Trigger  field to set a keyboard key to trigger the Riff  Also  any physical controller can be assigned to  controller destination 163 RiffOn  Lastly  see Controllers  CTRLS  Page on page 7 9  Pad section  to trigger and release a Riff from a pad     To set the key range to trigger your riff  use the cursor buttons to select the left value in the  Trigger field  this will be the low end of the trigger key range   Now you can select the key  number by scrolling the Alpha Wheel  or you can use intuitive entry by pressing and holding the  Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and pressing the desired key on your keyboard  You will  see this value change as you press a key     Next  move your cursor to the right to highlight the second value of the Trigger field  this will be  the high end of the trigger key range   Use one of the methods described above to select a key  value for t
31.   The Setup Editor    The BEND Page    The parameters on the BEND page define the bend ranges for each of the three types of pitch  bend messages the PC3LE can respond to        BendRandelecsT gt  a AuxBendiUie  125T   BendRangelPtcts   9c HuxBendd Dwrn   12571  HusxBend2Rra   25T   EesndRansellouniSsT 2 2ST   BendRansdellounict   ct    p more  BENT AUF al AUSE aS                         Parameter Range of Values Default  Bend Range Up  semitones  Prog  0 to 127 semitones 2   Bend Range Up  cents  Prog  100 cents 0   Bend Range Down  semitones  Prog  0 to 127 semitones 2   Bend Range Down  cents  Prog  100 cents 0   Aux Bend 1 Up 0 to 60 semitones 12   Aux Bend 1 Down 0 to 60 semitones 12   Aux Bend 2 Range 0 to 60 semitones 2          Bend Range  Semitones  and Bend Range  Cents   Up and Down    BendRangeUp ST  and BendRangeDown ST  sends a bend range message to an internal  program or a MIDI device  telling it how to define subsequent pitch bend messages  Some  programs may behave strangely when you change the Bend Range value  because they use DSP  Functions to affect the pitch wheel  In that case  you should either set the value of Bend Range to  Prog  or edit the program itself     L NOTE  The settings for BendRangeUp and Down are only reflected in Setup mode  Even if you specify   LYS BendRangeUp and Down values for the control setup  the setup 126 Internal Voices  which defines  controller assignments that are used in Program mode   bend range values will not be reflec
32.   Use the Chan Zone buttons  or the cursor buttons to change the currently selected track  To get to other pages of tracks   continue scrolling past the first or last track on the page  The bottom part of the screen displays  current settings for the selected track including program number and name  panning  and  volume     Changing the settings for a track s program  volume  or panning while the sequencer is  recording will record these changes  viewable in the corresponding track s EVENT page  Upon  playback  these automated mixer parameters will display their changing values in real time on  the MIXER page  Below is an example MIXER page         Hill race do   Z 3 4 J   T o  64 64 64 Ed 64 6d     22  1688 113 92 Sb ley 5  Pra  293 3le 167 232 55 561 355 1819    4  3  E                         Parameter Range of Values Default  Current Pan 0 to 127 None  Current Volume 0 to 127 None  Current Program Program List None  Selected Track  Trk  1 to 16 1  Current Program   Program List  Current Program   For Selected Track Current Volume   0 to 127 127  Current Pan   0 to 127 64              Uneditable  these values are an expanded view of the mixer values for the currently selected track  which  can be edited in the first three rows of the MIXER page     The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons  These soft buttons function as described in The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons on page 10 7     The Keep Soft Button    Pressing the Keep soft button captures the current settings for each
33.   Use the cursor buttons to select the Type field and use the      buttons to select Switch  With  Switch selected for the Type field  set the DestType field to Ctrl and the SW Type field to  Momentary  Finally  use the cursor buttons to select the OnControl field  then use the  alphanumeric pad to enter 164 followed by the category Enter button to select RiffOff for the  OnControl field  Do the same to select RiffOff for the OffControl field  The other fields should  be left at their default values  OnValue  0  OffValue  0  EntryState  Off  ExitState  Off  Now   when you trigger the bass riff from the keyboard  you can stop the riff by pressing pad 3  though  it will still follow any RelSynZn and RelSynTyp settings made on the RIFF2 page      9  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID  if desired  See The Setup Editor section at the beginning  of this chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor        13 46    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    Using A Single Song For Multiple Riffs    As discussed in the previous riff tutorials  riffs get their sequence information  which notes to  play  velocity  etc   from songs recorded in the PC3LE   s Song mode  A single riff can play back a  single track of a song on one zone  or multiple tracks of a song on multiple zones  In this tutorial   we will look at a setup that uses a single song for multiple r
34.   assignments     Set Controls Zone Mutes  MUTES     Press this button if you want to assign the setup   s switches to control zone muting  Switches 1  through 10 will mute zones 1 through 10 respectively  A switch with a lit LED means it  respective zone is active  a switch with an unlit LED means it respective zone is muted  When  you press the MUTES soft button  you will be prompted to continue by pressing OK  or to cancel  and return to the previous screen by pressing CANCEL  Caution  This will clear any existing  switch assignments        7 65    Setup Mode       Recording A Setup To Song Mode    Recording A Setup To Song Mode    Le    The MIDI output of a setup can be recorded to a song in Song mode  Each MIDI channel that is  output from a setup is recorded into each track of a song  if the tracks have corresponding MIDI  channels   Programs from each zone of your setup are automatically assigned to tracks in Song  mode  Follow these steps for proper recording of a new song from a setup     1  Enter Song mode by pressing the Song Mode button     2  On the Song mode MAIN page  select 0 New Song  in the CurSng field by entering 0 on  the alphanumeric pad and pressing the Enter button  This loads a default empty song file     3  On the Song mode MAIN page  select Mult in the RecTrk field   4  Press the Setup Mode button to enter Setup Mode and choose the desired setup     5  Press the Tap Tempo button  below the MODE buttons  to reach the Tap Tempo Page   Enter a tempo by
35.   banks from the list of factory  preset or user programmed banks  Use the Chan Zone buttons to scroll through the QA banks   You can also use the bank selection shortcut  press the     or Clear button on the alphanumeric  pad  and you ll be prompted to enter a bank number  Type the desired number on the  alphanumeric pad  then press Enter  The bank is selected  and you return to the Quick Access  mode page     Each bank contains ten memory slots  or entries  where you can store programs or setups in any  combination  Any program or setup in the currently selected bank can be selected with the  numeric buttons 0 through 9     If the highlighted entry contains a program  the bottom right hand field of the page displays the  channel on which the program entries are transmitted  this channel is the current channel in  Program mode   If the highlighted entry contains a setup  the bottom right hand field of the page  displays the word    Setup        The MIDI Program Change commands that the PC3LE receives when in Quick Access mode can  differ from those in Program or Setup mode  This depends on the setting you have for the  PrgChgMode parameter on MIDI Receive page in Master mode  If PrgChgMode is set to  Extended or K2600  the PC3LE responds to Program Change commands as it would in Program  or Setup mode  If PrgChgMode is set to QAccess  the PC3LE responds to Program Change  commands by calling up the corresponding entry in the current QA bank  not the actual  program number of
36.   but we   ll setup our assignment so that Zone 3 is always quieter than Zone 2   There are two methods of achieving this relative volume assignment  each sounds and behaves differently   Try both methods because one may sound better than the other depending on the situation  Let s go over  both methods and look at the advantages of each     Offset Method    Using the Offset method allows you to set an exact value that the volume of your Zones will be  changed by  Since MIDI controller values only range from 0 127  volumes that are changed by an  offset get truncated to 0 or 127 if the addition of the offset to your current volume results in a  value below 0 or above 127  Using an offset gives you the advantage of being able to set an exact  difference in volume  but can be troublesome in certain situations if you don t want your values  to be truncated     1  If you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Next  press 58 and then Enter on the alphanumeric  pad to select the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  see below   You can also select setups by using the        buttons or eat Wheel        S   Techno substance    Pad 2 Then Pad 1    a Pia    E  a Black Co    lit  Dolau we aaa ae            Oe Su          2  Next  with the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad selected in setup mode  press the Edit butto
37.   by ID      Keep in mind that you can have both setups and programs in the same QA bank     Naming And Saving A Quick Access Bank    When you ve filled each entry with the object you want  press the Name soft button if you want  to rename the bank  or press the Save soft button to begin the save procedure  Or  press the Exit  button to exit the QA editor  and the    Save Changes     dialog comes up        8 3    Quick Access Mode       The QA Editor       8 4    Master Mode  Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1        Chapter 9  Master Mode    Press the Master mode button to enter Master mode  which contains parameters affecting the  PC3LE s overall performance and system setup  You can access master tuning  transposition   and audio output options  You can also access settings for transmitting and receiving MIDI   setting velocity and pressure maps  and program change options  You can use the Reset function  to delete all user objects and restore the PC3LE s memory to its original factory settings  or the  Delete function to delete the Master Table  which resets Master Mode to its original factory  settings     When you exit Master Mode the PC3LE saves a Master Table  The Master Table remembers  the settings of the Master pages  as well as the state of the PC3LE  such as which programs  are assigned to each channel     Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1     On Master Mode page 1 you ll find parameters for setting the overall tuning  transposition and  intonation of the PC3LE  as well as velo
38.   can be divided into three primary operations  mode selection  navigation  and data entry  There  is also an assignable control section                                                                                               co KURZWEIL  lt A        5  ua   ta                                                      il             mi          ih             Ll                            Mode Selection    The PC3LE is always in one of six primary operating modes  Select a mode by pressing one of  the mode buttons     they re to the left of the display  Each mode button has an LED that lights to  indicate the current mode  Only one mode can be selected at a time     Program mode    Setup mode    Quick Access mode    Master mode    Song mode    Storage mode    Select and play programs  and modify them with the Program Editor     Select and play setups  16 keyboard zones with independent MIDI  channel  program and control assignments   and modify them with the  Setup Editor     Select from a list of preset banks  each containing a list of ten programs  and or setups that can be viewed in the display for easy selection   Modify the preset banks and create your own with the Quick Access  Editor     Define performance and control characteristics for the entire PC3LE  and  how your PC3LE sends and receives MIDI information     Use the PC3LE   s sequencer to record and play back your keyboard  performance  play Type 0 and Type 1 MIDI sequences  and record multi   timbral sequences r
39.   does not fit on the ARPEGGIATOR page  Each pattern can have up to 48 steps  and each step can  shift velocities by   127 steps  You can insert a step with a value of    none    by entering  127 and  then shifting down one more step  A step with the value    none    causes the arpeggiator to play  nothing for that step  allowing you to create rhythmic patterns by using    none    to leave spaces   Pressing Step  removes the last step in the list  pressing Step  inserts a new velocity step at the  end of the list  the pattern editor remembers the values of removed steps until you save or exit    Use the cursor to move between pattern steps  use the alpha wheel  alphanumeric pad  or plus   minus buttons to enter the velocity shift amount for each step  Press More to see a second page  for patterns with more than 24 steps     Press Delete to delete the pattern from memory  Press Rename to rename the pattern and save   Pressing Save gives you the option to save the pattern or rename and save  To create a new  VelPatt  edit an existing pattern and choose Rename when saving  Press Exit to return to the  ARPEGGIATOR page  When exiting the editor  it will automatically give you the option to save  the pattern if changes have been made  For more detailed instructions on these functions  see  Saving and Naming on page 5 3           TETTI  AA A          Oo  woh at tt    j  i          7 38    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The Human1 through Humans settings randomly change played 
40.   literature accompanying the product     IMPORTANT SAFETY  amp  INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS    INSTRUCTIONS PERTAINING TO THE RISK OF FIRE  ELECTRIC SHOCK  OR INJURY TO PERSONS    WARNING  When using electric products  basic precautions should  always be followed  including the following     1  Read all of the Safety and Installation Instructions and Explanation  of Graphic Symbols before using the product     2  This product must be grounded  If it should malfunction or break  down  grounding provides a path of least resistance for electric  current to reduce the risk of electric shock  This product is equipped  with a power supply cord having an equipment grounding  conductor and a grounding plug  The plug must be plugged into an  appropriate outlet which is properly installed and grounded in  accordance with all local codes and ordinances     DANGER  Improper connection of the equipment grounding  conductor can result in a risk of electric shock  Do not modify the  plug provided with the product   if it will not fit the outlet  have a  proper outlet installed by a qualified electrician  Do not use an  adaptor which defeats the function of the equipment grounding  conductor  If you are in doubt as to whether the product is properly  grounded  check with a qualified serviceman or electrician     3  WARNING  This product is equipped with an AC input voltage  selector  The voltage selector has been factory set for the mains  supply voltage in the country where this unit was sol
41.   s keyboard  see below   You  can also set the desired key name in the HiKey field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons        ransPose  12571  otemar Linear  elscale 1411   Lolle  11 Weloffset     12T WelCurve Linear    PANLOLIKEEVYUEL   more d    5  Next  use the Chan Zone buttons to select Zone 2  viewable in the top right corner of screen   This will bring you to the KEY VEL page for Zone 2  see below             A g iLa         TransPose AST  Hike e t Linear  Melscale    Lollel s  WelOffset a    121 WelCurwe Linear  PANWOL JREYWEL    6  On the KEY VEL page for Zone 2  use the cursor buttons to highlight the LoKey field  This field  sets the lower limit of the key range for Zone 2  which contains the piano program  Let   s make the  lower end of this Zone end an octave higher by changing the LoKey field from E3 to E4  To do  this  select the LoKey field  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and play E4  the E  two whole steps above middle C  on the PC3LE   s keyboard  see below   You can also set the  desired key name in the LoKey field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons  Using the piano  keyboard to set high and low note ranges is an example of intuitive entry  You can read  more about intuitive entry in Chapter 3  User Interface Basics              ERE       ransPose  BST  olemae 1   WelScale     Lolle  11 Weloffset 16    12T WelCuryve Linear    PANWOL JKEYWEL    Use the same methods to set the key range for any Zone  To finish  press the Exit butt
42.   select that string for a search  When the string appears  you can change it  or just press Enter to  find that string        3 12    User Interface Basics       Quick Song Recording and Playback    Quick Song Recording and Playback    There are three buttons   labeled Record  Play Pause  and Stop   below the mode selection  buttons  They control the recording and playback of songs from any mode  you don t have to be  in Song mode to record or play back  However  you ll need to make sure that the Demo Button  parameter on Master Mode Page 2 is set to    Off     Otherwise these buttons are used for Easy  Audition  see page 2 6   Master Mode is described in Chapter 9     Record Play Pause Stop    Using these buttons affects the current track of the current song   that is  the song and track that  were selected the last time you were in Song mode  When you record  the recording track and  recording mode are determined by the current settings in Song mode  likewise for the playback  mode when you re playing a song     When the sequencer status is STOPPED  neither the Record button LED nor the Play Pause   button LED is lit or flashing   press Record to put the sequencer in REC READY status  The  Record button LED lights  red   Then press Play Pause to start recording  The Play Pause   button flashes  green  to indicate the tempo  Any countoff is determined by the current Song   mode setting for the CountOff parameter  Press Play Pause or Stop to end recording and go to  the Save
43.   to start and stop recording  and review     save or discard your performance  When saving the song with your new tracks recorded  press the    Save soft button on the SongMode save as page in order to replace the currently saved song with  your new version     4  Repeat the steps above with different track and program numbers to add additional instrument parts  to your song        12 7    Tutorial  Song Mode       Part 5  Fixing Mistakes    For each track in Song mode  you can fix mistakes in your performance without re recording the  entire performance  Here we will describe the method that is easiest for fixing specific passages  in a track   See the Song mode chapter  The Event Page for a way to fix single notes      1     On the Song mode MAIN page  use the Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to Set    the RecTrk parameter to the track that you want to fix  For example  let s fix track 1  see  below           adri ete  CurSras nu Son TemPor 166 4   RecTrk al  pas Panied Mode  Merde  Prod dard Grand    Locat  1 il          Track 7     libs dia is    2  Set the Mode parameter to Erase  see below   This causes previously recorded notes to be erased  when a track is being recorded into            CN EA E E O ll   IS  curse 14625   NY Sond Temes    RecTrki 1 Wolti v r Pant 64 Mode         Prods Pees Grand Locate   Track 215 ee ee ee  Road  Save  Export   more   3     Press the BIG soft button to go to the Big Time page     4  On the Big Time page  set the Punch pa
44.  1 value  or  to whatever location you defined in the Locate field        12 5    Tutorial  Song Mode       S    Pressing Retry restarts recording from the same point you last started recording from     Yes saves the song with the performance you just recorded  Whatever was played back when  you pressed PlayNew will be the version of the song saved when you press Yes  The    save as     dialog will be displayed      gt  on al       Save New Sons az MIE       Fename  Save  Cancel    Use the Alpha Wheel      buttons  or Alphanumeric Pad to choose a free ID  location to save the  song  or choose a used ID  location to overwrite a previously saved song with your new  version  For this example we will save the song under ID  1025  see above   When overwriting a  song file  the    save as    dialog displays    Replace    followed by the name of the file being  replaced  Press Save to save the song with the current name  or Cancel to return to the previous  screen        Press Rename if you would like to change the song   s name  This brings you to the  SongMode name page  For this example we will rename the song My Song  see below   For more  detailed instructions  see the Editing Conventions chapter     Saving and Naming    section     ors   Name a CET    Sond Name   Mu Sorg       Delete Trsert  ise EA TOK  Cancel    If you decide not to save or rename on the Song  Save Changes page  pressing the No soft button  returns you to the Song mode page in which you were last recording  C
45.  3          When you save objects that you ve edited  the PC3LE will ask you to assign an ID  If the original  object was a ROM object  factory preset   the PC3LE will suggest the first available ID in the  User category  starting at 1025   If the original object was a memory object  user created   you ll  have the option of saving to an unused ID  or replacing the original object  Double press the    and   buttons  beneath the Alpha Wheel  to select the next available user location     Objects of different types can have the same ID  but objects of the same type must have different  IDs to be kept separate  When you re saving an object that you ve edited  you can replace an  existing object of the same type by giving it the same ID  The object you are replacing will be  deleted permanently  There is one exception to this  If you write over a ROM object  factory  preset   you can always revert to the original factory ROM object by deleting you new object that  uses the ID  The object that you had replaced the ROM object with will be permanently deleted   and the original ROM object will appear in its place     Many parameters have objects as their values   the ShiftPattrn parameter on the  ARPEGGIATOR page  for example  In this case  the object s ID appears in the value field along  with the object s name  You can enter objects as values by entering their IDs with the  alphanumeric pad  This is especially convenient for programs  since their ID numbers are  usually the same a
46.  Autohold  except only the last note played is latched  even if previously  played notes are still being held   1NoteAuto is specifically designed for use with Shift Patterns   see above   because Shift Patterns are designed to be played from one note at a time  though  you can use 1NoteAuto without a Shift Pattern as well   Using 1NoteAuto for zones that use a  Shift Pattern ensures that Shift Patterns will sound correct by only allowing one note at a time to  trigger the pattern  You can use the Panic soft button to stop arpeggiation at any time   1NoteAutoLow and 1NoteAutoHi are also designed for use with Shift Patterns  They work  similarly to 1NoteAuto  except INoteAutoLow always latches the lowest note when holding  multiple notes  and 1NoteAutoHi always latches the highest note when holding multiple notes   You can also use these latch types without a Shift Pattern if desired     Low Key  LoKey  and High Key  HiKey     The Arpeggiator processes notes within the range of these parameters  Notes outside the  specified range play normally  and do not become part of the arpeggiation sequence  Set the  LoKey and HiKey parameters using the data entry wheel or buttons     Glissando    When the Glissando parameter is On  the Arpeggiator chromatically fills between latched notes   When Glissando is on  the Arpeggiator ignores the Note Shift  Shift Limit  and Limit Option  parameters     You must latch at least two notes to get a result  When Glissando is on  all notes played in
47.  Aux chain is shown only  if the specified Aux Effects channel is selected      Alternatively  if you don t want to disable effects for any channels in order to free up DSP units   you may want to edit some programs to use different effects that use fewer DSP units  see The  EFFECTS  FX  Page on page 6 13   You can enter the Program Editor for a zone s program from  within the Setup Editor  To do this  select the Program field on the CH PROG page of the Setup  Editor and press the Edit button to the left of the display  When finished  exit the Program Editor  to return to the Setup Editor of the current setup  In song mode  you may wish to allocate only  one channel at a time when recording tracks one at a time to an external multi track recorder  By  recording each channel separately  each channel will be able to use 10 DSP units for its effects        7 62    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The AUXFX1 and AUXFX2 Pages    Pressing the AUXFX1 soft button or the AUXFX2 soft button calls up  respectively  the AUXFX1  page or the AUXFX2 page  Use these pages to provide overrides for Aux Chain selection and  other Aux Effects parameters  which allows you to change an Aux Effect and its parameters  without editing the program of a zone  track  see Override below   Each AUXEX page appears as  shown below  the page shown below is the AUXFX1 page         Her rides 3 DPera House    Send Levels and Pre Post Ins      123456 rt 8 9 161112131415 16   2   10 F   F   F   F   F   F   F 
48.  Dur     Duration changes the duration of each MIDI note  The original durations of the notes in the  sequence are multiplied by the selected percentage  100  will cause no change  values smaller       7 58    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    than 100  will result in shorter durations  values larger than 100  will result in longer  durations     Velocity    Velocity changes the velocity of each MIDI note  The original velocities of the notes in the  sequence are multiplied by the selected percentage  100  will cause no change  values smaller  than 100  will result in lower velocities  values larger than 100  will result in higher velocities     Offset    You can fine tune the start time of your riff in ticks by using the Offset parameter  A positive  value will delay the start time  while a negative value will speed up the start time     Real time Control of Riff Parameters    You can have real time control over several Riff parameters  by assigning physical controllers to  special Riff Controller Destinations  Any input  or entry value  from a physical controller  assigned to a Riff Controller Destination overrides the programmed values for the parameters of  the riff on that controller   s zone  The override remains in effect until you select a different setup   Remember  each of the following Controller Destinations affects only the riff for the zone which  your controller is assigned to     Controller Corresponding             Number Riff Parameter Operation  163 Riff
49.  Layers Of Instruments    Using Setup Mode To Play Layers Of Instruments    In a setup you can set Zone key ranges that overlap  This creates layers of instrument programs  that are played from the same key range  As an example  let s use the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano  a  split setup of bass and piano  and add a layer of strings to the piano section     1  Press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page  Next  press the Setup mode button   located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This will bring you to the Setup mode main  page     2  Use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to select the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano or use the  alphanumeric pad to enter 38 and press Enter  see below         E  40 Ze dE a  Octau T00t 31 1  TUE   se     Er    3  With the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will  bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below           Program Zi   Channel  Tore a   M     HidiBank  1 BankHode   Ctl Ae 32  HidiFrog  18r EntruProstha 1 Or  Status  Active Arresaiator   Or    more  CH    PRGICTRLS JPANWOL JKEVWEL   more d          4  On the CH PROG page use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen  In the Program  field you can view the instrument Program for the current Zone  We can see that the program for  Zone 2 of this setup is the piano program 8 Grand    Evans     see below   
50.  MIDI  Transmit page are in effect except for Channel and ProgChang  see below for details      When sending MIDI to the USB or MIDI out port from Song mode  Song mode ignores all of the  settings on the MIDI Transmit page     Destination ies ee AL       Channel ds ap   Linear  TransPose 10ST allele   Linear  ProgChange orn Chaseturs tIimmediate    MAST 1  HAST 2  HIT                               Parameter Range of Values Default   Destination USB_MIDI  MIDI  Local USB_MIDI MIDI Local   Channel 1to16 1   Transposition   60 semitones 0   Velocity Map Velocity Map List 1 Linear   Pressure Map Pressure Map List 1 Linear   Program Change Off  On On   Change Setups Immediate  KeyUp Immediate  Destination    The Destination parameter tells the PC3LE which ports will carry MIDI information  and  determines if the PC3LE   s sound engine will receive MIDI data  Select the desired destination or  any combination of destinations depending on your needs  For example  a value of Local  disables the USB and MIDI Out ports  Use this setting when you want to play the PC3LE  but  not to send any MIDI information to other MIDI instruments  local control only   Alternatively   you would set this parameter to MIDI or USB_MIDTif you only wanted to send MIDI data to  other MIDI instruments from the MIDI port or USB port  and no MIDI data would be sent  locally to the PC3LE s sound engine  A value of MIDI Local would send MIDI data only to the  MIDI out port and the PC3LE   s sound engine     For 
51.  Mode  Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones       5  On the Controllers page for Zone 2  the Controller field will be highlighted  if not  select the  Controller field with the cursor buttons   Make sure the LED to the left of the Timbre Knob is lit  if  it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter  button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for  the Controller field  see below   You can also set the desired controller in the Controller field by  using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons        6  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below               ontr  Scale  CUL  Offset  Test Tyre        7  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field              RG       Knob 1  labeled Timbre on the front panel  should now control the volume of the pad on Zone 2   222 Class Pad  if not  review the previous steps      8  Next  lets repeat the steps above for Zone 3  except this time we will set a Scale value so that Zone  3 is always quieter than Zone 2  On the Controllers page  use 
52.  OS pus tt aah condoned noire dh estas dE 7 63  The Setup Editor Utility Soft BUtONS at ae 7 64  Recording A Setup To Song  Mod  s ti iea a dees Rds shea dabas coreano Sa cion diate oana e ae dor 7 66  The Control SU di 7 68    Chapter8 Quick Access Mode    Soft Buttons In Quick Access Mode      cccsccssessecsscssecsscessssscessecssessssessseeseessecseecssessecsecssecseceasceesssseseseseseeseeeeeneeseenes 8 2  The OA Edito aia ise suite tacks e ia Dus hes le ees Ms a hs oS bees Es 8 2    Chapter9 Master Mode    Master Mode Page ISAS Is DEA A AS 9 1  TUN A oia 9 2  NN 9 2  TOO PO ita EA at di EIA AO AAA AAA A AIR A Ai 9 2  Velo Mel IMA E ae 9 3  Fads Velocity Map  Pad Vs IMaprosii sai RA ai 9 4  Pressure Map  Press Mp o ARTE 9 5  O boresaahes 9 6  at AAA A A ales son eel Cena 9 7   Master Mode P  ge2  MAST  2  nidad li iio dt ita 9 8  ELSA tds e oa Oe S 9 8  Digital Output Volume  Dig Out Vol  criar ani ai add a Caspio 9 8  A A O 9 8  OS   Object Ver  Operating System  Object Version           cscscessessesseesessscssessessessseseesssssessessessseseessseseessasessessease 9 9  SAA A A ONE 9 9  Output Clorinda ERA 9 9  DTU AE a a rn A a A ia an 9 9  General MID Deiren ie a A E a A a it tala 9 9  DEMO BURON LA Edd OS AEAEE SESSA EnS 9 10   MIDI TESEO MID EE E acc ORE I Soca eas a Te SE tes 9 11             DESDE AAA ETT AAA E 9 11  Chameleon 9 12  Transposed er E e E aa E aces E Oe E E EE E ERS 9 12  Velocity  Map  Transmit  tt dd ii At 9 13  Pressure Map Cas ri ia aaa 9 14  Prog
53.  Out port   See Column 2 of Table 6 2  below  to see which Controller numbers the buttons send        6 6    Program Mode       V A S T  and KB3 Programs    You can also change the programmed settings for the KB3 mode buttons to perform non KB3  functions  such as controlling an Aux effect  by changing the settings on the Program Editor  Parameters page                                   Switch   cd Button Name ds Comments  1 Rotary Slow Fast Rotary Slow Fast  2 Rotary Brake Rotary Brake  3 On   Off Chorus Vibrato On Off  4 Vibrato Chorus   Vibrato Chorus Vibrato Select Disabled if Switch 3 is off  5 Depth 1 3 Chorus Vibrato Depth Disabled if Switch 3 is off  6  row 2  On   Off Percussion On Off  7  row 2    Volume Loud   Soft Percussion Level Disabled if Switch 6 is off  8  row 2  Un Decay Fast   Slow Percussion Decay Disabled if Switch 6 is off  9  row 2  Pitch High   Low Percussion Pitch Disabled if Switch 6 is off  10  row 2  Click On   Off KeyClick On Off                Additional Controller Assignments In KB3 Mode  Other default assignments for factory KB3 programs include     Knob 10 and CC Pedal 1 control the Swell  volume pedal  parameter     Knob 11 controls the Leakage parameter  which controls the level of simulated signal    bleed    of  adjacent tone wheels  Generally  turning up the leakage parameter creates a    dirtier    organ  sound  This can be used for emulating different aged organs  as an older organ will have more  leakage as it ages and its capacitors 
54.  Receive Page  PRESS page for current Control Setup  in Program Mode  or current Zone  in Setup Mode        PressMap Settings on Master Mode Page 1 b  PressureMap Settings on MIDI Transmit Page                          PC3LE Song Mode       Destinations    PC3LE Sound Engine MIDI Out via MIDI Out port or USB Computer port  to    PC3LE audio outputs    The Master Press Map is an overall control for MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values used in the  PC3LE  MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values are created for each note depending on how hard you  press on a key that is being held down  The Master Press Map affects MIDI pressure  aftertouch   values for all MIDI sources and destinations used in the PC3LE  see the circled box above for its  location in the MIDI signal flow   Different maps used for the Master Press Map generate  different MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values for the same physical key press value  Each map  applies a different curve to received MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values and remaps them to new  values before letting them pass  The default map provides the widest range of pressure   aftertouch  expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit  your playing style  See the diagram above for the other pages that affect MIDI pressure   aftertouch  values before and after reaching the Master Press Map     The default map  Linear  allows MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values to pass unchanged  Maps 2 4  make it increasingly easier to produce MID
55.  Setup Editor and save your changes to this setup under a  new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this chapter for details on saving when  you exit the Setup Editor        Alternatively you can create a layer by adjusting the key range of existing Zones to match  another Zone  You can also create a partial layer by adjusting a Zone   s key range to only  coincide with some of another Zone   s key range  There are many advanced uses of Setup mode  to manipulate layered Zones  You can make a Zone only respond to certain velocity ranges  so  that for example a layered Zone is only heard when playing loudly  see page 13 30   You can       13 9    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using Setup Mode To Play Layers Of Instruments    also adjust the volume of a layered Zone with a Knob or expression pedal  see page 13 13   or  mute and unmute a layered Zone with a assignable switch or footswitch  See SW Pedal 1  amp  2   Arp  switch  Arp  latch sw  Switch 1 10 on page 7 13 and 149 on The Controller Destination    List on page 7 17         13 10    Tutorials  Setup Mode  Adjusting The Volume And Pan Of Zones       Adjusting The Volume And Pan Of Zones    You will likely want to adjust the volume of Zones in a setup  You can also adjust the pan  left    right speaker position  of each Zone  Each setting is easily controlled in the setup editor  For  more details of the settings on this page see the Setup Mode Chapter  The Pan  Volume  PAN    VOL  Page     Let s look at the 
56.  Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The ARPEGGIATOR 2 Page                               Latch   CCPM nc To   First Avail   Lokes  C     Sri TYR   Hone  Hikes iG 9 Num Beats  4  Gliss   Off  TES AA A AA more d  Parameter Range of Values Default  Latch Keys  Overplay  Arpeg  Add  Auto  Keys  Pedals  Autohold  1NoteAuto  Low Key C  1 to G9 C 1  High Key C  1 to G9 G9  Glissando Off  On Off  SyncTo First Avail   Riff1 16  Main Seq   Arp1 16  First Avail   FirstRiff Av   FirstArp Av    SyncType None  DownBeat  AnyBeat  None  DownBeatWait  AnyBeatWait  Num Beats 1 32 4  Latch    Latch determines how the Arpeggiator responds to notes when they are triggered     Keys means that the Arpeggiator plays only while you are holding one or more keys down  or  note triggers on   As you play different notes  they get added to the Arpeggiator  and as you  release notes  they get taken out  If you play notes faster than the Arpeggiator s current tempo   each subsequent note will be added to the arpeggiation at the next division of a beat  This can  cause a lag between the time you play the note and the time you hear it in the arpeggiation     In the next three modes  the Arpeggiator latches notes only when MIDI Controller 157  Latch   sends a value of On  64 or higher   An easy way to experiment with these modes is to assign the  Mod Wheel to send MIDI 157     In Overplay mode  the Arpeggiator latches any notes that are being held when Latch turns on   and continues playing them  even after 
57.  Shift function allows you to offset the existing MIDI events forward or backward in time  any number of ticks  1 480th of a Beat  and beats  This function only affects the End point if any  of the shifted events are after the End point of the song     Events can not be shifted beyond the End point or before Bar 1   Beat 1   Tick 0  The events can be  shifted only as far as these temporal boundaries  All events that can t be shifted the full Ticks  amount will be placed at the boundary location          Events  Hotes  Lokes 2E 1H1 5   Lollel   Hi 11271    Amount  Bars   Beats   Ticks    The Ticks parameter specifies the number of bars  beats  and ticks that the MIDI events  from  within the selected region  are moved forward  for positive values  or backward  for negative  values  in time relative to their original locations     Mode  Merge   Erase  The Mode setting determines whether the shifted events merge with  or erase existing events on    the destination track from the location point to the end of the shifted region     Transpose    Use the Transpose function to change the MIDI Note numbers of the selected Note events           HLF   Function    IGELA aA  Semitone      Semitone   128 to 127 semitones    An increment of one semitone represents a change of one MIDI Note number  You can transpose  Note events only within the range of MIDI Note numbers 0 to 127        10 28    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  Track Functions    Grab    Grab is similar to th
58.  ShiftAmount  BST Play Order  Played  Welt Plaved Duration 1146    TAI AA A AA More d                Parameter Range of Values Default   Active On Off Off   Beats 1 1  Whole Notes  to 1 384  96 notes per 1 16  16th Notes   beat    Play Order Played  Upwards  Downwards  UpDown  Played    UpDown Repeat  Random  Shuffle   Walking  Simultaneous    Duration 1  to 100  100     Velocity First  Played  Last  Aftertouch  MIDI 109  Played  Fixed  Pattern  1 74 factory patterns   user created patterns   Human1 4   Chimp1 4  MissNotes1 9                            ShiftAmount   88 Semitones 0  ShiftLimit 0 60 24  Limit Option Stop  Reset  Unipolar  Bipolar  Float Res  Unipolar  Float Uni  Float Bip  ShftPattrn  Shift Pattern  Off   1 69 factory patterns  user created Off  patterns   Active    The first parameter on the Arpeggiator menu is Active  which specifies whether or not the  Arpeggiator is on for the current zone  This parameter can be switched from the  ARPEGGIATOR page  or for real time control  it can be switched on using Controller number       7 36    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    147  ArpOn  and switched off using Controller number 148  ArpOff   these Controllers can  of  course  be assigned as the destination of a PC3LE physical controller     Turning Active on affects zones whose ZoneArpeg values are also set to On  By setting the  ZoneArpeg parameter  on the CH PRG page  to Off or On in the individual zones of a setup   you can choose which zones will be controlled
59.  Song Mode TRACK Page 10 26  Intonation key 9 7  Intonation tables 9 6  9 7  Introduction to editing 5 1  Intuitive data entry 3 12  14 4  intuitive entry 13 6    K    K2600  bank mode 7 8  KB3 channel 6 5  KB3 programs 2 7  Key Range 13 5  Key   Velocity  KEY   VEL  Page 7 26  Keyboard naming 5 5  Knobs  In Setup Mode 7 10    L    Layers Of Instruments 13 8    LCD 3 6   Line cord 2 2   Loading files 5 6   Loading Individual Objects 11 6  Loops 12 15    Master files 11 6  Master mode 4 3  Master mode page 9 1  Master Transpose 9 2  Memory objects 5 4  metronome 12 3  count off options 12 5  MID extension 11 8  MIDI  About MIDI 12 1  All Notes Off 9 19  Basic channel 9 16  Program change formats 9 21  Receive mode 9 16  Transmit parameters 9 11  MIDI channel 9 12  MIDI connections 2 3  MIDI disconnected 11 1  MIDI Implementation Chart A 1  MIDI Machine Control 10 8  MIDI program changes 9 15  MIDI Receive page 9 19  MIDI sequence Load  Save  Export 10 8  MIDI Time Clock 10 2  MMC 10 8  Mod Wheel 3 5  Mode buttons 3 2  Mode selection 3 1  4 1  Modes 4 1  Program 6 1  Modes  using 4 2  Mono sound systems 2 2  MTC 10 2  MuteZn 7 20          N    Naming 12 6   Naming objects using the keyboard 5 5  Navigation 3 6   Numeric entry 3 9    O    Object type and ID 5 2  Objects 5 1  Deleting 5 6  loading individually 11 6  Naming 5 3  RAM 5 2  5 4  Renaming 5 3  ROM 5 2  5 4  Octav 6 3  8 2       Overwrt soft button 11 7    P    Pads  In Setup Mode 7 15  Program Mode 6 12  Pads Color  b
60.  Tempo    When the Clock Source parameter is set to Internal  the Tempo parameter sets the PC3LE s  system tempo  The system tempo sets the tempo for all modes except Setup Mode  which has its  own tempo settings  Also  in Song mode  changing to a new song will override the system  tempo  The Tempo parameter values are in units of BPM  beats per minute   You can also use the  Tap Tempo button to set the system tempo from other modes  see Tap Tempo Button on page 6 4         9 2    Master Mode       Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1     Velocity Map  Vel Map   Master     Change the Master Velocity Map setting if you find that the PC3LE is not producing the desired  velocities  too loud or too quiet  based on your playing style  how light or heavy that you play  the keys   The default map provides the widest range of velocity expression  but you may want  to choose a different map if the default does not suit your playing style     MIDI In via MIDI In port or USB Computer port    VelMap Settings on MIDI Receive Page  KEY VEL page for current Control Setup  in Program Mode  or current Zone  in Setup Mode   q VelMap Settings on Master Mode Page 1      PC3LE Song Mode VelMap Settings on MIDI Transmit Page    MIDI  Destinations    PC3LE Sound Engine MIDI Out via MIDI Out port or USB Computer port    MIDI  Sources       PC3LE Keyboard                       to  PC3LE audio outputs    The Master Velocity Map is an overall control for MIDI velocities used in the PC3LE  MIDI  velocities are va
61.  a normal data entry method or via MIDI program change commands  Choose  KeyUp to indicate that you want setup changes to take place only when you ve released all  currently held notes  Choose Immediate to indicate that you want such changes to happen  immediately when you select the setup        9 15    Master Mode       MIDI Receive  RECV     MIDI Receive  RECV            Basic Chan O ae   Linear  HIDI Mode Multi Presshar o near  PraChdMNodetExtended SusExID    BankSelect Ctl 6 32 AllHotesO  f  Normal  LocalkbdCh Hone    MAST 1  HAST 2  HIT Re     The MIDI Receive page is where you define the PC3LE   s response to incoming MIDI signals   with one exception pertaining to Quick Access mode  which we ll explain later         i                               Parameter Range of Values Default     Basic Channel T rirre o e Nnn  MIDI Mode Omni  Poly  Multi Multi  Velocity Map Velocity Map List 1 Linear  Pressure Map Pressure Map List 1 Linear  Program Change Mode  PrgChgMode  Program Change Type List Extended  System Exclusive ID  SysExID  0 to 127 0  Bank Select Ctl O  Ctl 32  Ctl 0 32 Ctl 0 32  All Notes Off Normal  Ignore Normal  Local Keyboard Channel  LocalKbdCh  None  1 to 16 None       Basic Channel    The basic channel determines which channel will always be available to receive MIDI  information  Depending on the MIDI receive mode  below   the Basic channel may be the only  receiving channel  or one of several     MIDI Receive Mode  MIDI Mode     The MIDI Mode parameter de
62.  accompany your playing like a backing track  but riffs give you  more options such as endless looping  stopping or starting different instrument parts  the ability  to transpose instruments or change tempo during playback  and many other options     Read this section to learn the basic concepts and settings needed for using riffs  Here we will  look at some of the factory setups that use riffs in common ways     Adding A Riff  Sync Riffs    The easiest way to add a riff to a setup is to create a new zone which will be dedicated to playing  a riff  For this tutorial  we will look at a setup that contains a drum riff  and add a horn riff that  will play in sync with the drums     1  Press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page  Next  press the Setup mode button   located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This will bring you to the Setup mode main  page     2  Use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to select the setup 54 Acoustic Split or use the alphanumeric  pad to enter 54 and press Enter  see below   This setup splits the keyboard between an upright bass  program on the lower notes of the keyboard and piano layered with strings on the higher notes of  the keyboard  There is also a drum riff the plays from pad 1     S   Techno O ES    IHE tHE       3  With the setup 54 Acoustic Split selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will bring  you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below         Programe  Channel   MidiBank  4 E 
63.  always be 14 MIDI volume steps below  Zone 2 because of the Offset parameter        13  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this  chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor     In setup example above  if we turn Knob 1 so that it is sending a MIDI controller value of 10  the  MIDI volume of Zone 2 would be set to 10  and the offset on Zone 3 would mean that Zone 3 s   volume is supposed to be  4  Since MIDI controller values don t go below 0  the MIDI volume of  Zone 3 would be set to 0  and the Zone would not be heard  In this case  Zone 3 s volume would  be set to 0 for any Knob 1 value of 14 or less  This is a disadvantage of using the Offset method     but it can also be used creatively as a way to    mute     set volume to 0  a Zone below a certain  volume        13 20    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    Scale Method    The Scale method multiplies the volume of one your Zones by a percentage  This means that the  scaled Zone s volume will always be a certain percent different than the non scaled Zone  Unlike  the Offset method which always sets a specific value of volume difference  the Scale method   changes the volume difference between Zones for each new volume setting  Using a scale value  of more than  100 can result in values tru
64.  and MacOS computers support USB devices in a very straightforward  way  You should be able to drag and drop the PC3LE files right onto the USB device directory   After the files are copied  remove the device from the computer and place it in the USB storage  port on the rear panel of the PC3LE  A USB connector will only fit into the port if oriented  properly  so don t force it into the port  as this may damage your PC3LE or USB device  If you  are having trouble inserting your USB connector into the port  try flipping the connector over     To transfer files without a USB device  plug a USB cable into the PC3LE Computer port and the  computer  After you enter the bootloader menu  the computer should recognize that a new  device is available having the name    KurzweilPC3LE     Files can be dragged and dropped  directly to this device icon and will be immediately available on the PC3LE     The UPDATE IMAGE menu looks like this     Main  Object       Use the soft buttons below the display to choose the appropriate module to update  Most of the  time you ll want to choose    MAIN IMAGE    or    MAIN OBJECT     The executable image file will  be a file with a name like  PC3LESY150 BIN  The object library file will have a name like   OBJ120 PLE     After choosing a module type to load  the PC3LE will offer you a choice for which storage type  to load your files from  see below   Make sure your USB device is connected and choose the  appropriate type to see a list of files  or pr
65.  and press one of the       buttons   below the Alpha Wheel  to move to the next higher or lower numbered object that contains the  string of characters     The string you search for remains in memory until the PC3LE is turned off  You can store and  select a string of characters with each of the numeric buttons  Hold Enter and press one of the  numeric buttons at any time to select that string for a search  When the string appears  you can  change it  or just press Enter to find that string        14 4    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips    Quick Song Recording And Playback  Record An Idea From Any Mode     There are three buttons   labeled Record  Play Pause  and Stop   below the mode selection  buttons  They control the recording and playback of songs from any mode  you don t have to be  in Song mode to record or play back  However  you ll need to make sure that the Demo Button  parameter on Master Mode Page 2 is set to    Off     Otherwise these buttons are used for Easy  Audition  see Easy Audition  above on page 3   See Demo Button on page 9 10 for details     Record Play Pause Stop    Using these buttons affects the current track of the current song   that is  the song and track that  were selected the last time you were in Song mode  When you record  the recording track and  recording mode are determined by the current settings in Song mode  likewise for the playback  mode when you re playing a song     When the sequencer status is STOPPED  neither the Record butto
66.  and will remain selected when accessing the Tap Tempo screen from other modes   but the selection will return to OFF the next time the PC3LE is turned on     You can also assign a controller  such as a footswitch  to controller destination 168  Tap Tempo   to be used as a tap tempo button when not viewing the Tap Tempo page  This can be done in the  Control Setup  see The Control Setup on page 7 68   Any MIDI values received by destination 168  send a tap signal to the tap tempo function  This would be best used with a assignable switch  or  footswitch   Configure the selected switch so that it is Toggled  has it s On and Off Controls set  to destination 168  Tap Tempo   and set the On and Off Values to any value other than None   Entry and Exit State should be set to None     V A S T  and KB3 Programs    It is important to understand the difference between V A S T  programs and KB3 programs     V A S T  programs contain up to 32 layers  Each layer contains either samples  most often used  to recreate conventional instrument sounds   or KVA oscillators  used for virtual analog  synthesis   Each layer is preset to be triggered by the keyboard in specific ranges and velocity  levels  The ability to trigger so many layers results in detailed and more realistic programs  Each  layer is also routed through sophisticated digital signal processing  DSP  algorithms which  shape the tone and other behaviors of the sounds     KB3 programs use a much different architecture  There are n
67.  are set to their defaults  scale   100   curve   linear  min   1  max   127      127    Velocity Offset   64    low velocity keystrikes produce  medium MIDI velocity and greater    E Velocity Offset   64    s low velocity keystrikes result in MIDI velocity of 1   maximum MIDI velocity reduced    MIDI Velocity  O  IS       64 127    Strike Velocity       7 29    Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       Offset and Scale work together  If scaling takes the velocity out of the ballpark     for example   you want to set it to 300  but that puts all of your notes at maximum velocity     using a  negative offset  say around  60  can make it possible to still play at different volumes  although  your curve will still be a lot steeper than normal  If you use a negative scaling  then you must  use an offset  otherwise all of your velocities will end up as zeroes  well  ones actually  since a  MIDI note on with velocity zero is something else   So to get true inverse scaling  that is  minus  100     you must set an offset of 127 to get the full range of velocities  Setting the offset to 127  and the scale to  100  produces a slope like this  which is the same as the reverse linear curve      127    MIDI Velocity  O  IS    0  64 127    Strike Velocity    Note that Offset and Scale affect only MIDI velocities  that is  these parameters don t change  Velocity Tracking in the programs themselves  Therefore  some programs  such as organ sounds   which often have low VelTrk values  may respond onl
68.  aux effect  parameters with FXAux1   Program specific synth parameters will have no prefix     If the setup has an aux1 or aux2 Override loaded  see page 7 63   the parameters for the override  aux effects will not appear in the Dest parameters list  Aux Override effect parameters cannot be  assigned to controllers  Only a non override aux  effect can be assigned to controllers  If you  need to control an aux1 or aux2 Override effect parameter  edit one of the setup   s programs to  use the desired chain as the program   s aux effect  see The EFFECTS  FX  Page on page 6 13    Then  set the setup s Aux FX channel  see Aux FX Channel on page 7 50  to the channel of the  zone that contains your newly edited program  Now you will be using the same effects chain  that had been your aux Override  but you can assign controllers to its parameters since it is now  a regular  non override aux     Note  When DestType is set to Param  the parameters in the Dest field are sending MIDI  continuous controller values to control each parameter  It can be useful to know the CC number  or name used for each parameter  because this is how the controller movements will be labeled  when recorded to the PC3LE s Song mode  see Song Editor  The EVENT Page on page 10 31  or to  an external sequencer  To see the CC number being used for a parameter  you can temporarily  change the DestType parameter to Ctrl to see the CC number in the Dest field  Some CC  numbers show a name instead of their number on
69.  based effects  and the  currently selected song in Song mode  Setups revert to their saved tempo when selected  saved  setup tempo is set in the Setup Editor with the Tempo parameter on The COMMON Page  see  page 7 49  You can set this parameter using the Tap Tempo button   For more on operating the  Tap tempo button and the Tap Tempo page  see Tap Tempo Button on page 6 4         7 4    Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       The Setup Editor    From Setup mode  press the Edit button to enter the Setup Editor  where you can make changes  to the currently selected setup  Use the soft buttons to select the various Setup Editor pages  The  upper line of each page displays the usual mode reminder  as well as the current Setup Editor  page  and the current zone  Use the Chan Zone buttons to select one of up to sixteen different  zones  each having its own set of Setup Editor pages     The parameters on the Setup Editor pages define what each of a setup s zones sends   both to  internal programs and to the MIDI Out port  They also determine how the PC3LE responds to  MIDI signals received from a MIDI controller connected to the PC3LE   s MIDI In port  when the  Local Keyboard Channel matches the transmit channel of your MIDI controller      The Control Setup    The Setup stored at ID  126  Internal Voices has a special function in the PC3LE  and is referred  to as the Control Setup  Don t edit the Control Setup unless you know what you re doing   see  The Control Setup on page 7 68 fo
70.  by the Arpeggiator when it is on     Beats    The Beats parameter sets the number of notes per beat  The tempo is based on quarter notes   Therefore  if you set it to 1 4  you will get one note per beat of the clock  At 1 16  you will get   4 notes per beat  and so forth  You can go all the way to 96 notes per beat  1 384   but at most  tempos  divisions smaller than 1 64 will sound pretty much the same  To find a Beats value   multiply the notes you want per beat by 4  For example  4 notes per beat  16th notes  would be  4 4 16  a Beats value of 1 16  Three notes per beat  8th note triplets  would be 3 4 12  a Beats  value of 1 12  Six notes per beat  16th note triplets  would be 6 4 24  a Beats value of 1 24  Note  that when recording arpeggiations to a PC3LE MIDI track  you must turn on real time  quantization and set it to the same Grid value in order for the selected Beats value to sync  properly with the tempo grid  see Quant and Grid on page 10 18      Play Order    This parameter determines the order in which the PC3LE plays arpeggiated notes  Played  causes them to play back in the chronological order in which you played and latched them   Upwards means that notes play in ascending pitch order  regardless of their chronological order   Downwards means descending pitch order  UpDown causes notes to play from lowest pitch to  highest  then from highest pitch to lowest  repeating the cycle until you stop the arpeggiation   The notes at the very top and very bottom only
71.  calls up the    Save Changes    dialog        10 14    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The Filter Pages  RECFLT and PLYFLT     Song Mode  The Filter Pages  RECFLT and PLYFLT     On the RECFLT and PLYFLT pages you can specify what events are ignored during   respectively  recording and playback  Both pages have the same parameters with the same  ranges of values  but you would use the RECFLT page to configure recording event filtering   and the PLYFLT page to configure playback event filtering     Below is the RECFLT page     San  J    oles       Controllers   On  PitchBend   On           ECO Aa  F    DREH    Lollel            Lollal        Controller    HonoFress  PolyPress                                                 Parameter Range of Values Default  Notes On  Off On  Low Key C 1toG9 C 1  Note Filter Hi Key C 1toG9 G9  Low Velocity 0 to 127 0  Hi Velocity 0 to 127 127  Controllers On  Off On  a Controller ALL  MIDI Control Source List ALL  Low Value 0 to 127 0  Hi Value 0 to 127 127  Pitch Bend On  Off On  Program Change On  Off On  Mono Pressure On  Off On  Poly Pressure On  Off On    Notes    With Notes set to Off  all notes are ignored during recording  playback  With Notes set to On   only the notes within the specified note range with velocities within specified velocity range are  recorded   played     LoKey    LoKey determines the lowest key that is recorded   played back when Notes is set to On     Hi    The Hi to the right of LoKey determines the
72.  calls up the Utilities page  where the PC3LE displays the  contents of the current directory  in an alphabetized scrolling list  Use the Utilities page to create   directories  and delete  rename or copy directories and files     On the Utilities page  the path field and a directory is shown and the display shows the 3   character extension of all files in the directory  except directories themselves   Extensions are  created when the file is saved by the PC3LE  You cannot modify the extensions on the PC3LE   This is because the PC3LE uses the extensions to tell it what kind of data the files contain     Directories created by the PC3LE have up to 8 character names  with no extension     The  MID extension is used by the PC3LE for MIDI Type 0 or Type 1 sequence files     Soft Buttons on the Utilities Page    Format    A    NewDir Create a new directory    Delete Delete files from the current device    Rename Change the filename of a file    Copy Single or multiple file copy between devices   Open Opens the highlighted directory     Parent Moves you up one level in the directory hierarchy  If the display is already at the  root directory  this button has no effect     When you first open a directory for viewing  the index is 1  the first file in the list   The PC3LE  remembers the index of the previous directory you were in before you pressed Open  so if you  return to that directory by pressing Parent  the index changes accordingly  This index is  remembered for one level do
73.  controller values  so that O   1  and 127   100     See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    157 Latch For Arpeggiator Latch Pedals mode  0 63   off  64 127   on    See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    158 Latch2 For Arpeggiator Latch Pedals mode  0 63   off  64 127   on    See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    159 ArpGliss Arpeggiator Gliss  0 63   off  64 127   on   See The  ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    160 SusLatch For Arpeggiator Latch Pedals mode  0 63   off  64 127   on    See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    161 Panic Panic   162 SoloZn Solo Zone   163 RiffOn Riff On  See Riffs on page 7 51    164 RiffOff Riff Off  See Riffs on page 7 51    165 RiffDur Riff Duration  See Riffs on page 7 51    Table 7 1 Controller Destination List  Continued        7 20    Setup Mode       Corresponding    The Setup Editor                                              pentreller Destination Description  Number  Name   166 RiffVel Riff Velocity  See Riffs on page 7 51    167 RiffDly Riff Delay  See Riffs on page 7 51    168 Tap Tempo Tap Tempo  See Tap Tempo Button on page 7 4    169 KB3Mutes KB3 Mutes    in Setup Mode  values of 63 and below set the  switches to KB3 controls in that setup  and a values of 64 and  above set switches to mute zones  see Set Controls KB3   KB3CTL  on page 7 65     170  Arp Shift Sets ARPEGGIATOR values for Shift to negative  0 63   off   64 127   on   See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    171 ShiftPatt Selects one of the 128 patterns in th
74.  dialog  where you can save the song  or discard it     When the sequencer status is STOPPED  press Play Pause to begin playing the current song   Press Play Pause again to pause playback  and again to resume  Press Stop to end playback     See Chapter 12 for more information on Song Mode        3 13    User Interface Basics       Quick Song Recording and Playback       3 14    The Operating Modes  What the Modes Are       Chapter 4  The Operating Modes    In this chapter we ll discuss the theory behind the mode concept  and we ll describe the basic  operating features of each mode     What the Modes Are    The modes exist to make the PC3LE logical to work with  With as many performance and  programming features as the PC3LE has  it s helpful to break them into groups  These groups  are called modes  There are six primary modes  they re described briefly in the section called  Using the Modes on page 4 2  then the rest of the manual is dedicated to explaining each primary  mode in turn     Each mode is named for the kind of operations you perform while in that mode  and each  mode   s editor  if any  contains all of the parameters related to editing the type of object found in  that mode  In Setup mode  for example  you select setups  and only setups  for performance or  editing  All of the setup editing parameters are grouped together on the Setup Editor page   which is accessible through Setup mode     Selecting Modes    When the PC3LE is on  it s always operating in one of
75.  display to see a list of controls and assigned  parameters for the current program   You can use the program editor to change parameter  controller assignments  For example  you could assign three parameters that you often use to be  controlled from one row of knobs  or assign a previously unused effect parameter to a be  controlled by a knob  To edit the controller assignments for a program  follow these steps     1  In Program mode  choose the program you would like to edit  then press the Edit button to the left  of the display  This will bring you to the EditProg PARAMETERS page     2  On the EditProg PARAMETERS page  there is a list of all the available parameters that you can  assign to controllers such as knobs and switches  With the left column highlighted  you can scroll  through the list with the Alpha Wheel  cursor up down buttons or       buttons  As you scroll  through the list  the top right corner of the display will show each parameters    type  Prog indicates  that it   s either one of the 5 parameters common to all programs  Pan  Expression  program  volume   Aux FX1 Wet Dry  Sustain  and Sostenuto   or a program specific parameter   FXInsert1 indicates that it is a parameter from the current insert effects chain  while  FXAux1 indicates that it is a parameter from the current aux effects chain  Select the  parameter for which you would like to add or change a controller assignment     3  With the desired parameter selected  use the cursor buttons to select
76.  easier to play  but it allows more sensitive control  over playing high velocities by not boosting the MIDI velocity for fast strike velocities as much  as it does for medium strike velocities  GM Receive mimics the velocity map commonly used  by keyboards that use the General MIDI  GM  sound set  The GM Receive map makes medium       9 3    Master Mode  Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1        strike velocities produce higher MIDI velocities compared to the Linear map  GM Receive  effects notes from the PC3LE s keyboard as well as the MIDI in port  This map is automatically  used when the PC3LE is in GM mode  see General MIDI on page 9 9   though users may want to  use the GM Receive map when generating MIDI outside of GM mode which will later be played  back by a GM system     Pads Velocity Map  PadVelMap     Change the Pads Velocity Map setting if you find that the Pads of the PC3LE are not producing  the desired velocities  too loud or too quiet  based on your playing style  how light or heavy  that you play the pads   The default map provides the widest range of velocity expression  but  you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit your playing style     MIDI  Source          PC3LE Pads    KEY VEL page for current Control Setup  in Program Mode  or current Zone  in Setup Mode       E _SOEOESOQ gt _U   UUYQ    _AIG_QOGOAOOAOOAAAAA  VelMap Settings on MIDI Transmit Page    MIDI  Destinations         PC3LE Song Mode       PC3LE Sound Engine    MIDI Out via 
77.  field  the addition or subtraction of the number of steps in  your current shift pattern will raise or lower the starting octave in relationship to the default  starting octave  For example  in a shift pattern with 3 steps  an Offset value of 9 would cause a  controller value of 0 to make Shift Key Number trigger notes in octave C3 C 4  3 octaves above  the default CO C1  Offset values that are not multiples of the number of current shift pattern  steps will change which step the pattern begins on at controller value 0  thus offsetting the  relationship between all of the controller   s values and current shift pattern s steps     Adjusting Controller Range     When using Shift Key Number  the number of steps in the Shift Pattern also affects the range of  values that will cause a controller to trigger a shift pattern step  and in turn affect the useful  range of the physical controller  With a shift pattern of 12 notes  the 128 different notes that the  PC3LE can trigger are evenly spaced over the range of the controller  Patterns with less than 12  steps will trigger notes in every octave over a shorter range of the controller  For example  in a  shift pattern with 3 steps  by default the controller values 0 to 2 will trigger notes starting in the  lowest possible octave  and controller values 27 to 30 will trigger notes in the highest possible  full octave  Using a knob for this controller  only about 1 4th a turn of the knob would be  triggering notes  This decreased use
78.  following section  and complete the storing process     The File Name New Directory Rename Dialog    When you create a new file in Storage mode  create a new directory  or rename a file or directory   the PC3LE prompts you to enter the object s name  This File Name dialog appears as shown  below  both the New Directory and Rename screens appear and function similarly to the File  Name dialog         Lorades  File hame Eodhamin  L 1rn    Save selected objects to the file     Path  File Name   GTLENANE   ShifFto    Delete Trsert  ese tere TOK  Cancel    New file names will default to either FILENAME  after a powerup   or the name will be that of  the most recent file saved or loaded  New directory names will default to either DIRNAME   after a powerup   or the name will be that of the most recent file saved or loaded  Once you  choose a name to start with  or the default   you can edit the name using the Left and Right  cursor buttons  the Delete and Insert soft buttons  and the  lt  lt  and  gt  gt  soft buttons  See Keyboard  Naming on page 5 5 for another way to enter file names        Pressed OK soft button saves the object in the current directory     The display shows that the PC3LE has created or renamed the object  then the Storage mode  page reappears        11 4    Storage Mode  The STORE Page       The STORE Page    Pressing the STORE soft button calls up the Store page  where you can select user objects from  RAM to store in the current storage device  The page app
79.  highest key that is recorded   played back when  Notes is set to On        10 15    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The Filter Pages  RECFLT and PLYFLT     LoVel    LoVel determines the lowest note on   off velocity that is recorded   played back when Notes is  set to On     Hi    The Hi to the right of LoVel determines the highest note on   off velocity that is recorded   played  back when Notes is set to On     Controllers    With Controllers set to Off  all controllers are ignored during recording   playback  With  Controllers set to On  controller data only of the specified controller and only within the  specified value range are recorded   played     Controller    The Controller parameter determines which controller s  is are recorded   played back when  Controllers is set to On     LoVal    LoVal determines the lowest value for the specified controller that is recorded   played back  when Controllers is set to On     Hi  The Hi to the right of LoVal determines the highest value for that specified controller that is  recorded   played back when Controllers is set to On   PitchBend  This parameter enables   disables pitch bend events to be recorded   played back   ProgChange  This parameter enables   disables program changes to be recorded   played back   this includes  Controllers 0 and 32  bank change    MonoPress  This parameter enables   disables monophonic key pressure events to be recorded   played back   PolyPress    This parameter enables   disabl
80.  in your song will use the  volume setting of those channels set in Program or Quick Access mode     You can set an initial pan position  the balance between the Left and Right audio channels  for  the playback and recording of each track as a value between 0 and 127  A value of 64 is center  If  the channel of the RecTrk or the control channel contains any panning data  controller 10   the  change will be reflected as the Pan parameter   s value in real time  as well as on the MIXER page   Also  changing the Pan value while recording will write Pan automation  controller 10  messages  to the current RecTrk s event list     Initial Pan Settings    Each song file does not automatically save your Pan setting for each track  To make a song save  your Pan settings for each track  you must write an initial Pan value for each track  Initial Pan is  the Pan setting that will be used when your song is played back from the start of bar 1  An initial  Pan setting is essentially a Pan automation message that is written before the first tick of a track   Initial Pan settings are not automatically written during recording because they make it harder  to try out different Pan settings for a track  For example  an initial Pan setting will reset any Pan  adjustments that you make during playback each time the song is stopped and played from the  start of bar 1  or if the song is stopped and played from any point if the Control Chase  parameter set to On on the Song MISC page  see Song Mode  
81.  ina aapilisp alitas 6 2  Easy    AUG Onis aiii aii a caros 6 2  Picking Favorite AA eee E acct adh gut coat EEE a E acd cie e R I ER 6 2  Saving Controller Settings          cccccccsesssssseseseeseseseececesesescssensneseseseesesescececesesssesuaneseseseesesesescecesesssesnansneseseesseneseseaney 6 3  Arpeggiator Settings  Arp Settings BU COM  pisa td 6 4  Split Layer Duo dba 6 4  Tap Tempo Button       ccccccssseseesesssssneneseseeeneensseenesesesecesessseeseseseseesesesesessseseeesessseseseesssesesesesessseseseseseseneneneneses 6 4   NA NO 6 5  Realk   me Controls KBS Modessa eree ea e n dente sugadte cogs antpadauer and a iarae RS 6 6   The ProgramrEditors A A E E 6 9  The PARAMETERS Pare id NS Ad A A 6 9  The BASIC Pa An San 6 11  The PADS Pass A A A a 6 12  TRhEEFREGIS  PX  ii dd 6 13  The  ARPEGGIATOR 1  amp  2 Pages  ARP 1  ARP Di li 6 15  The Program Editor Utility Soft DUNAS a aaa 6 15    Chapter 7 Setup Mode    Split Layer BOO ii 7 2  Tap lempo BUHO cid Aa A RA AAA EA Rd 7 4  A in i Prov SST N A ARES a aT EN Ea nT ETT a aE a SPEE R 7 5  The Channel  Program  CH PROG  Page ssis hiesari ana a a E 7 6  Controllers  CIRLS  Pase ds idas 7 9  Knobs  CC Pedal  Modwheel  Pitchbend up  dn  Pitch Wheel   Pressure    oocionioninninconnnioninnincnnncn ran concnncnecnns 7 10  SW Pedal 1  amp  2  Arp  switch  Arp  latch sw  Switch 1 10  tenrinl tonic iia tanta airada 7 13  A ects Birches eee bos oe a SG i GG oa eho a ese eel BU Be ee 7 15  The Controller Destination List  dede i
82.  is a setup which defines the controller assignments for all programs in  Program mode  these assignments are the MIDI CC numbers that the PC3LE   s physical  controllers send while in Program mode  not their destinations  Available destinations for each  program are listed in the Program Editor Parameters page   The control setup is stored in setup  mode at ID  126 and is named Internal Voices  See the diagram below for a visual depiction of  of the Control Setup   s role while in Program Mode  Don   t edit the Control Setup unless you are  an advanced MIDI user and know what you re doing  read below for details     Examples Of How The Control Setup Defines The PC3LE   s Physical Controller  Assignments While In Program Mode     Control Setup      Knob 5               9   Controller  Knob 5                             Knob 5  Reverb  2 2 3        Dest  Ctrl C  MIDI CC 18          Sends MIDI CC 18           tO control the      4 selected parameter   Pedal SW1             gt  gt    Controller  SW Pedal 1                 gt   Pedal 1     Dest  Sustain  MIDI CC 64            gt    Sends MIDI CC 64            to control the  ro    selected parameter      Continues for    all controllers  except Pads         All factory ROM programs  and any user programs made before editing the control setup  use  the controller assignments of the default settings for the control setup  Because of this  editing  the control setup can    break    the Control Source assignments made for programs on
83.  is referred to as a    Chain     A Chain is a sequence of  up to 8 effect boxes cascaded in series  Each program can have one main Insert Chain and each  Setup  or song in Song mode  can use up to two Aux Chains at one time  which are available to  all programs in the setup or song      The PC3LE   s chains contain a variety of effects including different types of reverb  chorus  delay   flanger  phaser  tremolo  panner  leslie  distortion  EQ  compression  filter  envelope following  filter  frequency stimulator  ring modulator  frequency offset  pitch LFO  and stereoizer  Chains 1  through 81 contain many configurations of these effects  which are useful for quickly finding a  suitable effect  The remaining chains are used by the PC3LE   s factory programs  setups  and  songs  though they can be used for any user program  setup  or song as well  If you discover a  factory program  setup  or song that uses an effect that you like  look at the chain number in the  program  setup or song editor so that you can use it later in your own program  setup  or song   A complete list of the PC3LE s effects chains can be found at www kurzweil com     Each program on a zone  or on a track in Song Mode  is stored with settings for an Aux Effect  chain  as well as an Insert effect chain  each can be changed by editing the program   Use the  Aux FX Channel parameter  see page 7 50  on the Setup Editor COMMON page to set which  channels Aux effects settings will be used for the entire setu
84.  it will stop when you press and release AO     Note  the LoKey and HiKey values on the KEYVEL page do affect the riff  If your riff s trigger and release  notes are not within the LoKey and HiKey range on the KEY VEL page  your riff will not be able to be  triggered from the keyboard     Conditional Release  CondRel     The CondRel parameter allows you to have a riff play only while a key is pressed and held  and  nothing will stop or restart that riff until the key is released  To use conditional release  set the  same range for the Trigger and Release ranges on the RIFF2 page  Any key that is pressed and  held within this range will play the selected riff  Release the key and the riff will stop  Playing  any other key in this zone while triggering a riff with CondRel even if they are within the  Trigger and Release ranges will not retrigger or stop the zone   s riff     Local    If you want to trigger your riff without playing the current zone s program  set Local to Off   Local is set to Off by default since most users wont want to play the program in the zone they  are using for a riff  but only wish hear that zone   s program as a backing track  With Local set to  On  you will play the current zones program any time a key is pressed  This could create  undesired    grace notes    if you trigger a riff that has a downbeat at the same time you are  playing a note     Loop    If you want your riff to loop indefinitely  set this parameter to Forever  If you want to have it 
85.  keystrike  This means that if you hold a  note and change the pan  the current note will stay at its current position until you strike it  again  However  a PC3LE program that uses the PANNER effect in a effects Chain will respond  to real time pan adjustments as well        7 25    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The Key Velocity  KEY VEL  Page    A    The Key   Velocity page allows you to set key range  velocity range  transposition  and Note  Maps for each zone     Note  Aside from the settings on this page  MIDI velocities can be affected by settings you make on other  pages  See Velocity Map  Vel Map   Master  on page 9 3 for an overall setting that affects all MIDI  velocities input to the PC3LE  and all MIDI velocities sent to the internal sound engine and USB or  MIDI out ports  except for velocities output when in Song Mode   See Velocity Map    Transmit  on page 9 13 for settings that affect only those MIDI velocities sent to the USB or MIDI out  ports  except for velocities output when in Song Mode   See Velocity Map  Receive  on page 9 17 for  settings that affect only those MIDI velocities received by the USB or MIDI in ports  On each of the pages  mentioned above  look at the MIDI signal flow chart to see which velocity maps can affect your velocities  depending on which MIDI Sources  MIDI Destinations and operating mode that you are using        Loke A anseose  HST  Hik e a   MotemarP   Linear    WelScale 1411   Weldffsetl  o    1  121 WelCurwe Linear  PA
86.  memory  and provides  a fully featured sequencer that you can use to record songs  You can also record multi timbrally  via MIDI  or load standard MIDI files  Type 0 or 1   The Song Editor also enables you to modify  existing sequences stored in memory  See Chapter 10     Storage Mode    Storage mode lets you load and save programs and other objects using a USB device  See  Chapter 11        4 3    The Operating Modes       Using the Modes       4 4    Editing Conventions       Introduction to Editing    Chapter 5  Editing Conventions    Introduction to Editing    Editing programs  setups and songs on the PC3LE always involves three basic operations  mode  selection  navigation  and data entry     First  select the mode that relates to the object you want to edit   a program  a setup  etc  Then  select the object you want to edit  and press the Edit button to enter the editor within that mode   For programs  setups  songs  and quick access banks  these objects are    selected    when you are  on the main page of their corresponding mode  In these cases you can press the Edit button with  anything selected on their main page to access their editor  Often their will be more objects  inside of these    main page    editors  such as shift patterns and velocity patterns  and they can be  edited by selecting their parameter with the cursor and pressing the Edit button  An editor  contains all the parameters that define the object you re programming     Next  navigate around the ed
87.  mode main page shows your mode location  the present MIDI  transposition  and the current MIDI channel            TA       The info box at the left of the Program mode page gives you information about the current  program   s controller assignments  Changing the value of a control  moving a knob or pressing a  switch  will display the name of the last moved controller along with its parameter assignment     Selecting Programs    When you are in Program mode  there are two basic ways to select a PC3LE program     e Press a Category button to list all programs in that category  then use the Alpha Wheel       buttons  or cursor up   down buttons to scroll through the list  The Category buttons are on  the front panel  to the right of the display  Press the All category to list programs in all  categories     e Press the Shift category button and use the numbered category buttons to enter a specific  program ID number  then press the Enter category button  Press the Shift category button  again to return the category buttons to their primary function     A list of PC3LE factory programs and other objects  as well as their ID s  can be found at  kurzweil com  When not in General MIDI mode  default programs used for GM mode can be  accessed starting at ID  4096  see General MIDI on page 9 9 for details      The PC3LE has various settings for responding to MIDI Program Change commands from  external sources  These are explained in Chapter 9  so we won t go into them here  You shoul
88.  not all MIDI devices respond to Bend Range messages  With many older  MIDI instruments  you must set bend ranges on the devices themselves     Changing programs sends a Bend Range message with the current programs values  So does  pressing Panic  which is a quick way to reset your PC3LE or MIDI slaves if you ve used a  controller to modulate the bend range     Aux Bend 1 Up and Aux Bend 1 Down    Like BendRangeUp  Down  Aux Bend 1 defines the range for Pitch Bend messages  but does so  for those physical controllers assigned to controller destination 21  MIDI 21  There are two  parameters related to AuxBend 1  an upward value  AuxBend1Up  and a downward value   AuxBend1Dwn   This means that you can set different values for upward and downward pitch   shifting  For example  you could get the Pitch Wheel to give you both vibrato and whammy bar  effects for the guitar program in a setup  In the zone that contains the guitar program  set  AuxBend1Up to 2ST and AuxBend1Dwn to 12ST  then assign the Pitchbend up and Pitchbend  dn parameters  for the Pitch Wheel  on the Controllers page to a value of MIDI21  Now moving  the Pitch Wheel up gives you a whole tone of upward bend  while moving it down gives you a  full octave of downward bend     Aux Bend 2 Range    The PC3LE allows you to specify a third pitch bend range  this is called AuxBend 2  and it  defines the range for controllers set to controller destination 15  MIDI 15  For AuxBend 2  you  can set only one range for both upw
89.  numbers generated by the keys in the zone  without physically shifting the zone  The  range is  128 to 127 semitones  Since there are 12 semitones  or half steps  to an octave  you can  transpose up or down over ten octaves  If you transpose out of the range of the active voice   however  no notes will sound  MIDI note numbers will transmit  but notes will not     Note Map    Note Map lets you change the way notes are sent from the PC3LE  The default setting is Linear   all notes go out as played  Pressing the Minus button takes you to Off  no notes are sent  but  controllers and other non note data are     Setting Note Map to Inverse effectively turns the keyboard upside down  with the highest key  being A 0 and the lowest C 9  If you set Note Map to Constant  all of the keys on the keyboard  will play the same note  The note defaults to C4  but you can change this with the Transpose  parameter  This works well when you want the sound from a particular key to play with every  note of another zone   for example  playing a ride cymbal with every note in a bass line     Next are the alternating note maps  which let you divide the keyboard in some unique ways  If  you are using two or more MIDI devices  including the PC3LE   you can expand polyphony by  assigning each zone to a different alternating note map  For example  if you have two PC3LEs    you can assign two zones to each play the same program on a different PC3LE  thereby doubling    polyphony   To split a zone into on
90.  of the display   the currently selected zone number can be viewed in the top right corner of the display   To set  a pad to toggle a zone   s arpeggiator  the arpeggiator   s Active parameter must be set to On on  the ARPEGGIATOR page for that zone  Next  press the CTRLS soft buttons to move to the  Controllers page for the same zone  and choose the desired pad in the Controller field  To do  this  select the Controller field with the cursor buttons  hold the Enter button  located with the  Category buttons  and press the desired pad  You can also select the desired pad in the  Controller field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons  With the desired pad selected  use  the cursor buttons to select the Type field  then use the       buttons to select Switch  Next  use  the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and set it to Ctrl by using the       buttons   Finally  use the cursor buttons to select the OnControl field and set it to ArpOn by pressing 147  on the alphanumeric pad  followed by the Enter button  Use the cursor buttons to select the  OffControl field and set it to ArpOff by pressing 148 on the alphanumeric pad  followed by the  Enter button  The other parameters should stay at their defaults  SW Type  Toggled  On Value   0  OffValue  0  EntryState  Off  ExitState  Off   Now pressing and lighting the current pad will  enable the arpeggiator for the current zone  Unlighting the current pad will disable the  arpeggiator for the current zone  Repeat these ste
91.  of values to edit by setting a high and low value   LoVal will define the lowest modifiable value in the selected controller   s recorded data  Value  ranges are not definable when Ctl is set to All  Available Values are 0 127     High Value  Hi     Hi defines the highest modifiable value in the selected controller   s recorded data  Value  ranges are not definable when Ctl is set to All  Available Values are 0 127     Soft Buttons on the TRACK Page    FromTo is a quick way to define the region of time you intend to edit  There are a couple of ways  to use this feature when the sequence is playing back in real time  and both ways will set the  temporal boundaries of the region     One way is to first position the cursor over the From parameter in the Region   Criteria box and  then press the Play soft button  During playback  every time you press FromTo  the PC3LE  updates the value of From to match the current playback location  Position the cursor over the  To parameter to change the value of To in a similar fashion     If you haven t selected either the From or To parameter  pressing FromTo during playback  updates From or To   or both   depending on the current playback location  the value of the  Locate parameter  at the time you press FromTo  If you press it while the Locate value is earlier  in the song than the current To value  the PC3LE updates the From value  If you press FromTo  again  without stopping playback  while the Locate value is later than the current Fr
92.  one of the LEDs of the three rows of labels below the  Assignable Controls  This lets you know which set of controls you are using  either controls 1 5   Timbre Reverb   CTL 6 10  or CTL 11 15   Each knob can be used to control a program specific  parameter  or to send MIDI continuous controller values to external equipment  Press the Info    soft button from the Program  Setup or QA mode main pages to see the assignments set for each  control        3 2    User Interface Basics  Pads       When using a KB3 organ program  the blue KB3 LED will light  above the Shift button at the left  of the Assignable Controls   and the Assignable Controls will control the KB3 organ functions  labeled below the control names  For example  the control labeled Timbre emulates an organ s  16    drawbar  as is labeled below Timbre   Use the Assignable Controls Shift button to access  more organ controls     Pads    The PC3LE s eight pads are located below the display  The pads can be assigned to trigger notes  or control other functions  When you select a PC3LE program in Program mode  the PC3LE will  also select an associated Drum program to be triggered by the Pads  The program for the Pads is  assigned to MIDI channel 10     Assignable Switches    The Assignable Switches  see below  are located in the upper left of the panel  Use these to  switch FX on and off  mute layers of sound  or control other functions  Each of the 5 switches can  control two separate functions independently  effecti
93.  original  values determined by the Scale parameter  A setting of 100  has no affect  Values are scaled  lower with a Scale percentage set from 0  to 99   Low values can be set higher using a Scale  percentage above 100  on up to 20 000   although the maximum value of 127 can not be  exceeded for any velocity or controller type     Offset   128 to 127    Offset can be used alone or in conjunction with Scale to add or subtract a set amount to or from  the original  or scaled  values  Values for velocities can not be less than 1 or greater than 127   Values for controllers can not be less than 0 or greater than 127     As an example  to set all Velocities to a value of 55  you would set Scale to 0   multiplies all  original values by zero  and set Offset to 55  adds 55 to the product of the Scale parameter      Mode  Constant PosRamp  NegRamp    Set Mode to Constant to have values modified in a uniform fashion  as determined by the Scale  and Offset settings  for the entire selected region of time and range of values     When the Change function is applied with Mode set to PosRamp  the selected velocity or  controller values will gradually change over the region of time  defined by the locations set for  the From and To parameters  from the original value to the new value determined by the Scale  and Offset settings  The first events being modified within the region will have little or no  change from their original values  The amount of Scale and Offset applied will increase a
94.  page  vs  when using the Program Editor     On the Program mode main page  if you change the settings of any controls  knob position   assignable switch on off  Mod Wheel position  as well as Arp Settings   the LED on the Save  button will light  Press the Save button to bring up the save dialog and save your edited  program  If you switch to a different program  the alterations that you made to the previous  program will be lost without warning     When using the Program Editor  the LED on the Save button will light when you have altered  the current program  and the PC3LE will ask if you would like to save the current program if  you exit the Program Editor     Saving A Newly Edited Program    If you are saving changes to a program that you have not previously edited  the save dialog will  choose the first available user ID  as a save location  so that you don t replace the original   program   You can also choose a different ID  to save the program to and rename the program if  desired  If you have edited a factory ROM program and wish to save over the original program       6 3    Program Mode       The Program Mode Page    at the original ID   simultaneously press the     buttons to jump between selecting the  program   s original ID  and the first available User category ID   Saving at the program   s  original factory ID  will replace the factory program  but you can always return a factory ROM  program to it   s original settings by deleting the program at that ID   
95.  play once  UpDown Repeat is similar to  UpDown  except that the notes at the top and bottom play twice  repeat  when the Arpeggiator  reverses direction     Random plays the currently latched notes in completely random order  Shuffle plays them at  random  but keeps track of the notes so that no note repeats until all of the others have played   Walk is a    random walk    order  each successive note is either the next or previous note  in  chronological order   For example  suppose you ve latched four notes   G 4  B 4  D 5  and F 5     in that order  The first note the Arpeggiator plays is the G 4  The second note will be either B 4   the next note chronologically   or F 5  the    previous    note chronologically   that is  the last  latched note   If the second note is B 4  the third note will be either D 5 or G 4  If the second note  is F 5  the third note will be either G 4 or D 5     Simultaneous makes the Arpeggiator latch each note you play and repeat it in time with the  Tempo value  sort of like a digital delay with no decay  If you play a C and hold it while you  play an E and aG  the Arpeggiator will play all three notes at the same time and at the same  tempo  Simultaneous also works well with Shift and Limit  allowing you to shift multiple notes  simultaneously     Duration    Duration determines how long each arpeggiated note plays  100  means that a note sustains  until the next one sounds   very legato  50  means that the note fills half the space between  it
96.  play once and then stop until you retrigger it  set this parameter to Once     BPM    There are four choices here that will determine what controls the tempo of your riff  With BPM  set to Sequence  the original tempo in which the riff was recorded will be used  With BPM set to  Setup  the tempo set on the COMMON or Tap Tempo pages will be used  When syncing  multiple riffs it is convenient to set each riffs    BPM parameter to Setup  Doing this  you can  change the tempo of all riffs at once with the Tap Tempo button or on the Tap Tempo page  see  Tap Tempo Button on page 7 4   A value of Setup is also useful for syncing riffs to a zone s       7 55    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    arpeggiator  With Tempo BPM set to External  the riff will sync to external MIDI clock  You can  also manually choose a tempo by selecting a value from 20 to 400 for BPM  Use the Alpha Wheel  or      buttons to choose between the options or set a tempo  You can also use the alphanumeric  pad followed by pressing the Enter button to enter a tempo     SyncZone    2    The SyncZone parameter determines which zone a riff will sync to  You can choose to sync to a  riff or arpeggio in a specific zone by setting SyncZone to Riff 1 16 or Arp1 16  and the current  riff will always sync to the riff or arpeggio in the set zone  For example  if you have a drum riff  in zone 1 and a bass riff in zone 2  you may always want the bass riff in zone 2 to sync to the  drum riff in zone 1  In this case you wo
97.  played song  Volume settings are  tied to MIDI channels  so the volume of each track will be dependent on which MIDI channel is  assigned to each track in each song  If you are in Song mode and you load a song that does not  have initial volumes without playing another song first  the volume of the MIDI channel for  each track is set depending on which mode you enter Song mode from  If you enter Song mode  from Program mode or Quick Access mode  the volume of each track is set based on the volume  for each MIDI channel set in those modes  If you enter Song mode from Setup mode  the volume       10 4    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Pan    Song Mode  The MAIN Page    of each MIDI channel is set by the volume of each zone  if a zone uses the same MIDI channel on  the SetupMode CH PROG page  set with the Channel parameter   If a zone does use a MIDI  channel that one of the tracks in your song uses  the volume of that track will be set by the  ExitVolume parameter of that zone  on the SetupMode PAN VOL page   If multiple zones use  the same MIDI channel  the ExitVolume of the highest numbered zone that uses that channel  will set the volume for tracks that use that channel  If ExitVolume is set to NONE  the value for  EntryVolume is used  If Entry Volume and ExitVolume are set to NONE  then the track for that  channel uses the volume set for that channel in Program or Quick Access mode  If there is no  zone that uses certain channels used by your song  then those channels
98.  program   s  effects chain  or a parameter for a DSP function such as a filter or LFO used by the program  The  parameters listed depend on what parameters exist for the current zone s program and effects  chain  Choose Ctrl if you would like to control a MIDI continuous controller number  By default  this MIDI continuous controller value is sent internally to the program on the controller   s zone   as well as to the USB and MIDI out ports  To change this from the default  see   Destination on page 7 8        7 13    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    On Control  OnControl     OnControl determines what parameter control or MIDI Control message will be sent when the  switch is on   that is  either pressed and held or toggled on from the off position  The list of  available destinations is dependent on the setting for the DestType field  see above   For more  information on MIDI controllers  see the MIDI Controller Destination list on page 7 17     OnValue    The OnValue parameter sets the parameter or MIDI controller value that is sent when the  switch sends an on value  In the case of conventionally switched functions  such as sustain  the  OnValue should be set to 127 in order to have an affect     Off Control  OffControl     OffControl determines what parameter control or MIDI Control message will be sent when the  switch is off   that is  either released or toggled off from the on position  The list of available  destinations is dependent on the setting for the DestTyp
99.  sequences   but you can also edit or exchange these programs to suit your taste  The PC3LE provides you  with a GM sound set editor which allows you to replace the PC3LE   s default GM programs with  any other PC3LE factory or user created program  For example  you could choose a different  factory or user created piano program to replace the default GM program 1  Ac Grand Piano   This way  any GM sequence that uses GM program 1 would now use the new piano program  that you selected  Alternatively  you could even choose a different instrument to replace the  default GM program 1  such as PC3LE program 47 Harpsichord  This way  any GM sequence  that uses GM program 1 would now use the new harpsichord program that you selected  Using  a PC3LE program that does not resemble the instrument named in the current GM program  would technically make the PC3LE incompatible with GM  but some users may want to do this  as a way to    remix    GM sequences     It is easy to replace default GM programs in order to make a custom GM sound set  Once in GM  mode  the right side of Program Mode screen displays a list of the GM programs with their  standard GM names  The left side of the screen shows you what PC3LE program is being used  for the selected GM program  Pressing left on the cursor moves you to this field  Use the cursor   s  up down buttons  the alphanumeric pad  the plus minus buttons  or the alpha wheel if you  wish to select a different PC3LE program for the current GM program  
100.  setting will be  There are  three choices  None  no setting is sent when you leave the setup   Off  the Riff is stopped when  you leave the setup   and On  the Riff is started when you leave the setup         7 16    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The Controller Destination List    The table below contains the available values for the MIDI CC  continuous controller   destinations  Physical controllers can send MIDI values to these destinations in order to control  the parameters of PC3LE programs or external MIDI equipment  In Setup mode  these  destinations can be assigned for each controller on the Setup Editor Controllers page with the  Dest parameter  if the DestType parameter is set to Ctrl  By default  MIDI CCs sent from  physical controllers are sent to their zone s program internally  and to the MIDI and USB outs on  their zone s MIDI channel  to change these settings see Destination on page 7 8 and   Channel on page 7 6      In the PC3LE  MIDI CC destinations are best used to control external MIDI equipment  If you  want to control a program parameter  set the DestType parameter to Param on the Setup Editor  Controllers page  This has the same result as sending a MIDI CC to control a program  parameter  but saves you a lot of setup steps  Parameters also send their own CC numbers to the  MIDI and USB out ports by default   If MIDI CC messages for destinations 0 127 are sent to  programs internally  programs will only respond to some of these CC destinations   
101.  tapping the Tap Tempo button or enter a tempo in the Tempo field   When you are finished  press the Done soft button to return to the Setup mode main page     6  Press the Record button and then the Play Pause button to begin recording  The  metronome will count off 1 bar and then recording will begin  you can set metronome and  other recording settings in Song mode      7  Press the Stop button to stop recording  You will see the usual Song mode save changes  dialog where you can review  retry  or save your song  see The Save Changes  Dialog on page 10 9      8  After saving your song  you will be returned to the Song mode MAIN page  where your  saved song will be loaded  You can continue to record or edit the song in Song mode just  as you would with any other song  see Song Mode and the Song Editor on page 10 1   Each  program from each zone in your setup is automatically assigned to a track  change the  RecTrk parameter in order to record to a single track   You can also continue to record  from Setup mode by going back to step 3  above  Remember to set the tempo  step 5  above  before recording  as the song tempo will change if your setup is saved with a  different tempo     Notes About Recording A Setup To Song Mode    Tempo  The tempo of a setup is set on the SetupMode COMMON page  see on page 7 47   If you  plan to record a song from the same setup several times  it is convenient to set your desired  tempo on the SetupMode COMMON page and save it with your setup  By 
102.  tempo during playback  and many other options     To create your own riffs  first record and save a sequence in Song mode  A riff can play single or  multiple tracks of a song at once  To get started with Song mode  see Chapter 12  Tutorial  Song  Mode  If you have a setup that you want to add newly recorded riffs to  it may be easier to record  the setup into Song mode  To do this  see Recording A Setup To Song Mode on page 7 66  Lastly   see Basics Of Using Riffs on page 13 36 for tutorials on using and adding riffs to setups        14 10    Specifications       Appendix A  Specifications    MIDI Implementation Chart  Model  PC3LE    MIDI Implementation Chart                                                                                        Manufacturer  Date  12 01 07  Young Chang Version 1 0  Digital Synthesizers  Function Transmitted Recognized Remarks  Default 1 1 Memorized  Basic Channel  Changed 1 16 1 16  Default Mode 3 Mode 3 Use Multi mode for multi   Mode Messages timbral applications  Altered  0 127  Note Number  True Voice 0 127 0 127    Note ON O O  Velocity  Note OFF O O  Keys Xx O  After Touch  Channels O O  Pitch Bender O O  O 0 31 0 31 Controller assignments are  Control Change 32   63  LSB  32   63  LSB  programmable  64   127 64   127  b   r O 1 999 1 999 Standard and custom  rogram Change  J True   0 127 0 127   formats  System Exclusive O o   Song Pos  O O  System Common Song Sel  O O  Tune x x    Clock O O  System Real Time  Messages O O  Local Co
103.  tempo to be controlled by an external sequencer  Use the Alphanumeric Pad  to enter    0    in the tempo field  and press enter     EXT    will appear in the tempo field  Any MIDI  Time Clock  MTC  signal received at the PC3LE s USB or MIDI in port will now set the Song  playback tempo        10 2    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page    Recording Track  RecTrk     The RecTrk parameter determines which track is record enabled  Set the record enabled track to  Mult to record more than one channel simultaneously     When RecTrk is set to a single track  1 16   Record  R  is displayed for that track in the Track  Status Indicator region  above the Track and Channels region   Conversely  with one exception   when any track   s Status Indicator is changed to Record  R   that track is shown as the value for  the RecTrk parameter     The exception is when RecTrk is already set to Mult  you can select the record enabled tracks by  toggling the Track Status Indicator to Record  R   and the RecTrk will remain set to Mult     When Mult is initially selected  all of the empty tracks will be record enabled  Tracks containing  data will remain set to play  P   but you can manually set them to record  R      The parameter s  below RecTrk change according to the value of RecTrk  If RecTrk is set to a  single track  1 16   Prog is displayed and you can select the program to be assigned to that track   If you switch through the channels  the program also changes  sho
104.  the  Program Editor Parameters page  Since the PC3LE s physical controllers will not be sending  their default MIDI CC   s  the program parameters that have their Control Source set as one of the  default MIDI CC s will no longer be controlled by the PC3LE s physical controllers  These  programs could be    fixed    by re assigning the Control Source for each parameter so that they  are controlled by the new CC numbers set for the control setup     Don t edit the control setup unless you are an advanced MIDI user who needs to send specific  MIDI CC   s to external equipment  You can save multiple versions of a control setup by saving a  copy of an edited control setup to an available user ID   and then copying the desired setup to  ID  126 by saving the setup at ID  126  and overwriting the existing setup saved at ID 126  You  can always recall the original control setup by deleting the setup stored at ID  126  You can  delete a setup from within the Setup Editor by using the Delete soft button  see   Delete on page 7 64        7 68    Setup Mode       The Control Setup    When editing the control setup  only zone 1 has an effect on program mode   Zones 2 16 are not  relevant in Program Mode  because the PC3LE s physical controllers can only control one MIDI  channel at a time in Program Mode  A control setup should have only 1 zone   See the table  below for which pages and parameters in the Setup Editor of the Control Setup have an affect on  Programs in Program Mode      
105.  the  arpeggiation range get latched  although you won t necessarily get meaningful results from all  latched notes  In general  try to get each subsequent note you latch to be a change in direction   For example  try latching the following sequence of notes  C4  C5  G4  G5  C5  C6  G4  G5  The     glissando    changes direction around each change in direction of the latched notes        7 44    Setup Mode       2    The Setup Editor    SyncTo    The SyncTo parameter determines what an arpeggiator will sync to  An arpeggiator can sync to  another arpeggiator  a riff  or a song playing from Song mode  You can choose a specific  arpeggiator or riff to sync to by setting SyncTo to Arp 1 16 or Riff 1 16  and the current  arpeggiator will always sync to that arpeggiator or riff  For example  if you have an arpeggiator  on a bass sound in zone 1 and an arpeggiator on a lead sound in zone 2  you may always want  the lead arpeggiation in zone 2 to sync to the bass arpeggiation in zone 1  In this case you would  set the SyncTo parameter in zone 2 to Arp 1     You may want to have a little more freedom and not be tied to the bass arpeggiation in zone 1 as  the main    timekeeper     Maybe you want to start with the lead arpeggiation in zone 2 and have  the bass arpeggiation in zone 1 start later  In this case you would set the SyncTo parameter for  zone 2 to FirstArp Av  With this setting  the arpeggiator will look for the first available  arpeggiator to sync to  So if both the bass ar
106.  the PC3LE  You can find a CC name   s  corresponding number in The Controller Destination List on page 7 17  See page 7 66 for details  on recording a setup to Song mode     Entry and Exit Values    Entry value allows you to specify an initial value for a controller in a setup that will be sent  whenever you select that setup  For example  if you want to make sure that all of the modulation  in a zone is turned off when you select a setup  assign a physical controller to a destination of  MIDI 01  MWheel  and set Entry Value to 0     Entry values ignore the current position of the physical controller when the setup is selected  In  fact  if the physical controller is above or below the entry value when the setup is selected   which it often is   moving the controller will have no effect until it is past its entry value  In the  modulation example above  moving the assigned controller won t turn on any modulation until  it   s pushed all the way down  and then up again     An entry value of None is quite different from a value of 0  None means that there will be no  initial controller command when the setup is selected  and any subsequent movement of the  physical controller will be effective     Exit Value tells the PC3LE to send a value for that controller whenever you leave the setup   either by selecting another setup or by selecting a different mode altogether  It can be very  useful when a controller is doing something to the sound  and you don   t want that effect to  
107.  the entry        8 1    Quick Access Mode       The QA Editor    Soft Buttons In Quick Access Mode    Use the Octav  and Octav  soft buttons to transpose up or down by a full octave  Pressing both  Octav buttons simultaneously returns the transposition to its original setting     Press the Info soft button to see all of the controller assignments of the current program  Scroll  down the page using the Alpha Wheel  cursor or the     buttons     The Xpose  Xpose  buttons are a shortcut for quick transposition in semitone  half step   increments  You can use them to transpose the entire PC3LE as much as three octaves up or  down  The bottom line of the display shows the current amount of transposition  Xpose    Pressing both Xpose buttons simultaneously returns the transposition to zero  The Xpose  buttons transpose the PC3LE  as well as any MIDI devices connected to the PC3LE s MIDI Out  port  Changing the transposition with the soft buttons also changes the Transpose setting on the  Master mode MIDI Transmit page     The QA Editor    Use the QA Editor to customize existing QA banks  Enter the QA editor from QA mode by  pressing the Edit button        1 Standard Grand    3 Rubens teinshcone TYPe  Program  Horowitz Grand Chan 1  o HYC Jazz Grand    Hame  Save  Delete  Tre    The top line gives you the usual mode reminder  the current QA bank  and the current entry   corresponding numeric button for the highlighted object   The cursor highlights the object   program or setup  th
108.  the inputted velocities in a range of   5  with the  purpose of simulating a more human played sound     Note  Missed Notes are actually output as notes with a velocity of zero                             Velocity Setting ne  MissNotes1   10  MissNotes2   20  MissNotes3   30  MissNotes4   40  MissNotes5   50  MissNotes6   60  MissNotes7   70  MissNotes8   80  MissNotes9   90          7 39    Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       Shift Amount    You can tell the Arpeggiator to transpose all of the currently latched notes each time it plays  through them  Shift determines how much transposition will occur for each cycle of notes  For  example  if you have latched C4 and F4  and you assign a Note Shift of 2  the Arpeggiator will  play C4  F4  D4  G4  E4  A4  and so on until it reaches the Limit value  The Shift values can range  from  88 to 88  with 0  the default  being no transposition     Shift Limit  Limit determines how far up or down the Arpeggiator shifts from the original note  The    minimum value is 0  and the maximum is 60  When the Arpeggiator reaches the limit  the  Arpeggiator responds according to the setting for the Limit Option parameter     Limit Option  This parameter determines what the Arpeggiator does when it has shifted the currently latched  notes up  or down  to the shift limit  Stop causes the Arpeggiator to stop when it reaches the  shift limit  Reset causes the Arpeggiator to return to its original pitch and repeat the latched  cycle of notes  transposi
109.  the right column in the row of  the desired parameter  The right column is the control source column  where you choose a  controller to assign to the parameter for that row  With the right column selected  hold the Enter  button  at the bottom right of the Category buttons  and move the controller  knob  switch  pedal   etc    that you wish to assign to the parameter  pads can   t control parameters in Program mode  only  in Setup mode   The name of the moved controller will appear in the right column  indicating that it  now controls the parameter for that row     4  Controllers can be assigned to multiple parameters at once  so you will probably want make sure  that the controller you just assigned is not assigned to another parameter  To do this  use the up   down cursor buttons to scroll through the parameters list  while remaining in the control source  column   If you see the controller that you just assigned in the control source column of another  parameter  you can change the assignment to None by entering  1  To do this  use the alphanumeric  pad to press      1  and Enter     5  The center column in each row on the PARAMETERS page sets a default MIDI value for the  parameter   s controller  See The PARAMETERS Page on page 6 9 for more about setting a MIDI  value on the PARAMETERS page  Read the notes in this section to understand the behavior of  parameters when their MIDI values are set to None  and how to solve issues that may arise when  making controller assig
110.  the six primary modes represented by the  LED highlighted buttons to the left of the display   or in one of the editors corresponding to the  current operating mode  Pressing one of the mode buttons selects the corresponding mode  This  is the mode   s entry level  At the entry level  the LED of the selected mode is lit  Only one mode  can be selected at a time     From any primary mode  you can get to any other primary mode simply by pressing one of the  mode buttons  If you re in an editor  however  you must press Exit to return to the mode s entry  level before selecting another mode     All of the modes except Master and Storage mode give you access to one or more editors for  changing the values of the parameters within that mode  Press the Edit button to enter the editor  of the currently selected mode  When you do this  the mode LED goes out     It s possible to enter another mode s editor without leaving the currently selected mode  For  example  if you press Edit while in Setup mode  you ll enter the Setup Editor  The Setup Editor  page will appear  and the Program parameter will be highlighted by the cursor  If you press Edit  again  you ll enter the Program Editor  where you can edit the currently selected program  While  you can edit and save programs as you normally would  you re still in Setup mode  and you  can t select another mode at this point  When you exit the Program Editor  you ll return to the  Setup Editor page  and be prompted to save any changes mad
111.  time pan adjustments  all other programs  will respond on the next note start  see The Pan Volume   PAN VOL  Page on page 7 25           Table 7 1 Controller Destination List       7 17    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Corresponding                                                                                                 Controller PA es  Number Destination Description  Name  11 Express MIDI Expression    Default assignment for CC Pedal 1  In  most programs it acts as an volume control  It scales  between minimum  0  and the current value of Volume   12 MIDI 12 MIDI Controller 12  13 MIDI 13  14 MIDI 14 Default destination for Knob 1  Timbre   15 MIDI 15 Default destination for Knob 2  Mod   16 Ctl A Default destination for Knob 3  Envelope   17 Ctl B Default destination for Knob 4  Effect   18 Ctl C Default destination for Knob 5  Reverb   19 Ctl D Default destination for Knob 6  CTL6   20 28 MIDI 20 28 Default destination for Knobs 7 15  CTL7 CTL15   29 31 MIDI 29 31 MIDI Controllers 29 31  32 Bank  33 63 MIDI 33 63 MIDI Controllers 33 63  64 Sustain Default destination for Footswitch 1 see SW Pedal 1  amp  2  Arp   switch  Arp  latch sw  Switch 1 10 on page 7 13   65 MIDI 65  66 Sostenut Default destination for Footswitch 2   holds notes that are  currently down  but not notes played subsequently  67 Soft Lowers the volume by a preset amount and may soften the  timbre as well  see SW Pedal 1  amp  2  Arp  switch  Arp  latch  sw  Switch 1 10 on page 7 13   68 
112.  to its default state  This is especially  helpful if you re having problems getting sound programs or setups to work properly  or think  there may be some kind of underlying hardware problem   Remember to first save your work  in the Storage menu  Once deleted  the files are completely removed from the PC3LE and  there is no way to retrieve them   To clear all user objects and restore the factory default state   press the soft button labeled System Reset on the Bootloader menu  The PC3LE will ask you to  confirm this action  Press OK to complete the clear function  or CANCEL to stop without  altering anything     File Utilities    Use this menu to format the PC3LE s internal flash memory  which deletes all of the PC3LE s  internally stored objects and the OS  In rare cases Kurzweil support may instruct you to format  the internal flash if you are having issues that cannot be solved otherwise  Itis possible  though  not likely  that the PC3LE file system can become corrupted due to hardware failure or power  outage during certain operations  This will result in the Bootloader being unable to bring up the  synthesizer system correctly  In such a circumstance  the Bootloader will take over control and  present its usual menu  If the file system is completely corrupted  it will not be possible to  reconfigure without first formatting the internal flash memory      If possible  remember to first save your work in the Storage menu  Once deleted  the files are  completely removed f
113.  to restart its loop  if it is looped  before starting   see Loop on page 7 55 for looping riffs  and Loop on page 10 11 for looping songs   This way you  can trigger the arpeggiator to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the start of the  playing riff or song   s loop  provided that it is set to sync to a riff  song  or the first available      With SyncType set to Stop  if there is already something playing to sync to  the current  arpeggiator will wait for what is playing to stop before starting  This way you can trigger the  arpeggiator to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the release  stopping  of the riff   arpeggiator  or song that you are syncing to     With SyncType set to StartWait  if there is nothing playing to sync to  the current arpeggiator  will wait for something it can sync to to begin playing first before starting  This is similar to  DownBeatWait  but it will only trigger the arpeggiator the first time that whatever it is syncing  to starts  This way you can trigger the arpeggiator to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync  at the start of the riff  arpeggiator  or song that you are syncing to  If you stop the arpeggiator  and try to start it again while the thing you are syncing to is already playing  StartWait will not  start the arpeggiator     With SyncType set to LoopWait  if there is already a riff or song playing to sync to  the current  arpeggiator will wait for the playing riff or song to restart its loop  if 
114.  to select the various Setup Editor pages  Use the more  soft buttons on the bottom of the display to scroll through pages of soft buttons  The top line of the  display says    SetupMode     with the name of the current Setup Editor page as well as the  number of the current Zone  Use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select the  current Zone  The current and total number of Zones can be viewed in the upper right corner of  each screen in the Setup Editor        Progr ari P   Channel  ae ination  a    MidiBank  1 Banktode   Ctl Ar  HidiFrog  18r EntruProstha 1 On  Status  Active Arreaaiator   On    more  CH   PRG PANYOL ANA  gt     Press the Exit button on the front panel to exit the Setup Editor and return to the Setup mode main page   If you have made any changes to the setup  you will be presented with the message    This setup has been  edited        see below   You are given a choice of soft buttons  Press Rename to rename the setup before  saving  press No to return to the Setup mode main page without saving  press Yes to choose an  ID  and save the setup  press Cancel to return to the Setup Editor              About ID s    When saving  you must choose an ID   An ID  gives you a way to locate a setup aside from its  name  you can store up to 2 560 unique ID s for each object type  setups  programs  songs  etc    though many ID s are already used for factory ROM objects   ID s also allow you to save  setups with the same name under different ID s  and 
115.  top right corner of screen               B OE    Hone  CUL  Offset  Test Tyre        Param    MEA PANYOL IKEYWEL    more     10  On the Controllers page for Zone 3  Knob 1 will still be selected in the Controller field  If not   follow these steps  Use the cursor buttons to select the Controller field  Make sure the LED to the  left of the Timbre Knob is lit  if it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that  LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled          13 27    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones    Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for the Controller field  You can also set the desired controller in  the Controller field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons     11  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below           Ores              ontr  Scale Hone  CUL   Offset    Test Tyre    12  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field       foresee  ntrallslue      ExifWalue 1       13  Now we will set an Offset value for Zone 3  On the Controllers page for Knob 1  Z
116.  track   s program  panning   and volume as the initial settings  Remember to save if you want these change to be permanent        10 12    Song Mode and the Song Editor  Song Mode  The METRO Page       The Done Soft Button    If no changes were made in the MIXER page  pressing the Done soft button calls up the MAIN  page  If changes were made  pressing the Done soft button calls up the    Save Changes    dialog     Song Mode  The METRO Page    All of the parameters affecting the sequencer metronome are on the METRO page  Like the other  pages in the Song Editor  you can save changes made in this page        Son Serie  ROA   Metronome   CountOff  Program rack  Channel    Soft Hote      16  Strong Hote  1602  127 Soft Wel    Strona Wel    104  100                                  Parameter Range of Values Default   Metronome Off  Rec  Always Rec   Count Off Off  1  2  3  4  StartOnly  1  StartOnly    Always    Program Program List 998 Click Track   Channel 1to16 16   Strong Note 0 to 127 102   Strong Velocity 0 to 127 127   Soft Note 0 to 127 104   Soft Velocity 0 to 127 100  Metronome    This parameter determines the recording modes in which the metronome plays  With  Metronome set to Off  the metronome never plays  With Metronome set to Rec  the metronome  only plays during recording  With Metronome set to Always  the metronome plays during  playback and recording     CountOff    This parameter determines the number of measures the PC3LE will count off before recording   Wit
117.  trigger only zone 6  and later we will make the riff trigger only from  a pad  Use the cursor buttons to select the SreTrack field  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons  to select 2 for the source track  see below   Then set the Re Channel parameter to On  Now playing  any key should trigger a horn riff     7 foe       s  G SrcTrack    Stop  So El Re Channel    Tran Po se   OFF    DEA RIFFi IRIFFZ   more d    Why did we set the source track to track 2  If you were to look at the song 115 Jazz in the  PC3LE s Song mode  you would see a two track song that has drums on channel 1  and bass on  channel 2  For this tutorial  we are using the MIDI data from track 2 of that song to play the  notes of our horn riff  When adding riffs to your own setups later  you can use any song  factory  or user created  and any track from that song to use as a riff  though usually it works best if the  track in your song originally used the same or similar instrument program as the one you will  use for the riff  For more on the Re Channel parameter  see Re Channel on page 7 53        13 38    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    10  Next  we will stop the riff from being triggered by the keyboard  so that we can play the setup again  as it originally was  Press the RIFF2 soft button at the bottom of the page to move to the RIFF2    page     11  On the RIFF2 page for zone 6 we will change key ranges for the Trigger and Release fields  By  default when you create a new zone it
118.  very simple example  Suppose that the only note in the Arpeggiator cycle is C4  Note  Shift is 4  a third   and Shift Limit is 7  so notes won t get shifted above G4   The Arpeggiator  plays C4  then E4  The next note should be G 4  but that s above the shift limit   so the PC3LE  calculates the difference between that G 4 and the shift limit  G4   one semitone  It adds that  difference to the original starting note  C4  and plays that note next   C 4  The next note  F4  is  within the shift limit  but the next note  A4  isn t  so it gets translated into D4   and so on     Float Uni uses the same concept and applies it to Unipolar mode  when the Arpeggiator reaches  the shift limit  it calculates the difference between the next note and the limit  and transposes the  next cycle of notes down by that interval  then shifts each subsequent cycle down until it reaches  the original pitch  Float Bip is similar to Float Uni  but the downward shift limit isn t the  original pitch  it s the negative of the Shift Limit value     The Arpeggiator can be a lot of fun  even if you don t always understand exactly what it s doing   Keep in mind that the stranger the algorithm you set up  the more unlikely the notes will stay  close to one key  so if you want to create something that s going to sound at all diatonic  keep it  simple     Shift Pattern  ShiftPatt     ShiftPatt engages a step sequencer for arpeggiator note patterns  The inputted note number of  each played key is shifted accor
119.  with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Use the alphanumeric pad to enter 253 and press the  Enter button to select the setup 253 4 Zone Riff Pno  or use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to  select the setup  see below   This setup has five zones  The first four zones play riffs triggered from  pads 1 4  while zone 5 contains a piano program playable from the keyboard     Ritts  255 6 Zone Ar  Oetau    ethauw       APOze        The riffs on pads 2 4 are all set to sync to the down beat of the riff on pad 1  see the previous riff  tutorials for more on syncing riffs   To start all the riffs at once  press and light pads 2 4  then press  and light pad 1  When you press pad 1  all of the riffs will start playing in sync     4  Next  lets edit this setup to see the settings for these riffs  With the setup 253 4 Zone Riff Pno    selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will bring you to the CH PROG page of the  setup editor  see below         Channel  estinalion     MIODI MI01 LOCAL    MidiBank  5 BankNode   Ctl ES  MidiPro3  9 EntruProschs  On  Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    F more  CH PEGICTELS IPANWVOLIKEYUEL   more 3          13 48    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    5  From the CH PROG page  press the right hand more soft button at the bottom of the display to find  the RIFF1 soft button  then press the RIFF1 soft button  This brings you to the RIFF1 page for  zone 1  The cur
120. 1  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field         ERAS             Knob 2  labeled Mod on the front panel  should now control the volume of the piano  which is  on the upper half of the keyboard  if not  review the previous steps   All other settings on the  Controllers page for Zone 2  Knob 2  should be left at their default values     12  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this  chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor     If you have a setup with more Zones  you can repeat the same steps for each additional Zone   using additional Knobs        13 16    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In  Different Zones    You can assign a single Knob to adjust the relative volume of multiple Zones in a Setup  For  example  let s edit the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  The setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad is a layered setup that uses  piano on Zone 1 and    pad    type synth sounds on Zones 2 and 3  Let s assign a single Knob to control the  volumes of Zones 2 and 3
121. 10 8    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page    The Save Changes Dialog    The following dialog appears after you have recorded a track and pressed Stop  or if you have    entered the Song Editor and made changes  then pressed Exit  or if you press Save in the Song  Editor               The PlyNew soft button allows you to play the song with your last recorded performance  You  will likely want to hear this first     Pressing PlyOld will play the current song  minus the performance that you just recorded  You  can toggle between Play Old and Play New without restarting the song by pressing either  button while the song is playing  This is useful to check if your last performance was better or  worse than what was previously saved  if anything was previously saved      The Locate field allows you choose a start time for the old or new playback  This is useful when  you just want to hear a certain part of the song without listening to the whole thing  The Playing  field displays whether to NEW or OLD data is playing     Stop halts the playback of either the Old or the New version of the song you are currently  auditioning  This also resets the song   s start location to either the default Bar 1  Beat 1 value  or  to whatever location you defined in the Locate field     Pressing Retry restarts recording from the same point you last started recording at   Yes saves the song with the performance you just recorded  Whatever was played back when    you presse
122. 3LE  you can quickly select sounds  customize them with the turn of a knob  and save the result with  two button presses  We hope that the PC3LE will become a valuable musical tool that you will  use for years to come     Read this guide to learn how to get the most out of your PC3LE  This chapter will give you an  overview of the PC3LE s capabilities  Read chapters 2 and 3  Startup and User Interface Basics to  start using the PC3LE right away  Experienced users may wish to browse the topics in   Chapter 14  Power User Tips  Once you get familiar with using the PC3LE you will be able to take  control of your sound and quickly transition from inspiration to performance     Sounds and Features      Over 1000 preset sounds  play real sampled instruments sounds  simulated tonewheel  organs  or virtual analog synthesis sounds        8 assignable pads  velocity sensitive  use these to play drums or other sounds  trigger note  sequences with riffs  or control other functions      e Assignable knobs  use the shift button to access 3 different functions for each knob to  control up to 15 parameters      e Convenient knob presets  each preset has its own knob assignments for effects and other  parameters so you can easily adjust the settings of any sound  View the assignment of the  last moved knob on the left of the program window  or press the Info soft button to see  destinations for all controls that are assigned        Assignable switches  use the shift button to access 2 differe
123. 3LE receives on the local keyboard channel gets  remapped to the channels and control destinations used by the zones in the setup     The PC3LE also remaps certain MIDI Controller messages that it receives on the local keyboard  channel  so that they correspond  in most cases  to the default assignments for the PC3LE s  physical controllers  Mod Wheel  knobs  etc    While this ensures that the physical controllers  work in a consistent and relatively standard fashion for most setups and V A S T  programs  it  necessitates a few adjustments to make incoming MIDI Controller messages control the KB3  features listed in Table 6 2 on page 6 8  Without these adjustments  some of the KB3 features  won t respond to MIDI Controller messages   this is true when you re playing programs as well  as when you re playing setups     To make everything work properly  you need to make sure that all the appropriate physical  controllers are assigned for KB3 control  Physical controller assignments are handled by setups   and are defined by parameters for each controller on the Controllers page in the Setup Editor   Each zone of a setup has its own controller assignments  Programs don t have controller  assignments  so they    borrow    them from the Control Setup  You can read about the Control  Setup in detail on page 7 68     When you re playing a setup on the local keyboard channel that uses a KB3 program  each zone  must have the appropriate physical controller assignments in order to contr
124. 43 21 65               5  On the Song MIXER page  press the Done soft button or the front panel Exit button  You will be  asked to save changes to your song  just as in Part 3  step 4 of this guide  see above   Saving your  song completes the process of storing initial volume settings with your song     Pressing the Keep soft button on the Song MIXER page stores initial values of volume  pan  and  program number for each track  Initial values are the settings that will be used when your song  is played back from the beginning  Volume  pan  and program settings can change automatically  over the course of the song if you change them while recording  but pressing the Keep button  stores the current value for each setting to be recalled at the song   s beginning     6  Follow the above procedure in steps 4 and 5 to store current values as initial values after changing  any volume  pan  or program parameters     Note  Most users will want to store initial values as described above  Advanced users may not want to  store initial values for every track  See the Song Mode chapter The MAIN Page  Program  Volume  and  Pan sections for details on saving an initial value for a single track only     Part 6 b  Recording Volume Automation   You can also record volume automation  Volume automation is the method of recording a series  of volume event messages that change a track   s Vol parameter over the course of the song  This  is useful for fading instruments in or out of a song  or adjus
125. 5  Press the right hand more soft button at the bottom of the display to find the RIFF1 soft button   then press the RIFF1 soft button  This brings you to the RIFF1 page for zone 2  Here we can see  that a riff is turned on for zone two  Zone 2   s riff is using track 2 of the song 95 Old School Jam as  the source track for this setup   s bass riff  see below    See the previous tutorial Adding A Riff  Sync  Riffs on page 13 36 for details on these settings             Far a me    COR             d School Jam  1   Src track 12  1 26 Re Channel   On  n    EA RIFFi RIFF    more      TransPose  0    6  Next  press the RIFF2 soft button at the bottom of the display to move to the RIFF2 page  On the  RIFF2 page  we can see in the Trigger field that the riff is set to be triggered by the keys C  1  through C 3  see below            OP     13 Walle         GENG g i ay ANE ONE 1    Release r  SuncTuPe   Downbeat  CondrRel   off Relsun  n   First Avail   Local   Off RPelSyn Tye   Downbeat          Logt Forever ee lags lel  166   more a       13 44    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    7  Press the RIFF1 soft button at the bottom of the display to move to the RIFF1 page once again  On  the RIFF1 page  the Transpose parameter is set to on  This is what makes the riff transpose  If you  set the Transpose parameter to Off  any key played between C  1 and C 3 will trigger the riff to play  at its original pitch  When the Transpose parameter is set to On  the riff will tra
126. 6  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below            13 18    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    7  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field             Ores                in    ontr  Scale  Curse  Offset  Test Tyre    Knob 1  labeled Timbre on the front panel  should now control the volume of the pad on Zone 2   222 Class Pad  if not  review the previous steps      8  Next  lets repeat the steps above for Zone 3  except this time we will set an offset so that Zone 3 is  always quieter than Zone 2  On the Controllers page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the  display to select Zone 3  see below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right  corner of screen           ontr  Scale  CUL  Offset   Test Tyre    9  On the Controllers page for Zone 3  Knob 1 will still be selected in the Controller field  If not   follow these steps  Use the cursor buttons to select the Controller field  Make sure the LED to the  left of Timbre Knob is lit  if it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that  L
127. 6  see below                    alle    T  ExiTllalue    Par am    TELS S PARLOLTEEYLIEL          13 39    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    13  On the controllers page  make sure you are still on zone 6  the currently selected zone is shown in  the top right corner of the display   If you are not on zone 6  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left  of the display to select zone 6  Next  with the Controller field selected on the Controllers page   hold the Enter button  located with the Category buttons  and press pad 2  below the display   This  will select Drum Pad 2 for the Controller field  see below             hited te  ExitState   Test Tyre  OF fWalue             Ts  OFF  HE PANWOL IKEYUEL   more 4    14  With Drum Pad 2 selected for the Controller field on the Controllers page  use the cursor buttons to  select the Type field  With the Type field selected  press the   button  below the Alpha Wheel  to  select Riff  see below   Now pressing pad 2 should play the horn riff on zone 6              n Control    7 foe       more  CH PRGICTRELS JPANUOL JKEYUEL    15  If you press pads 1 and two at the same time  you will notice that the horn riff on pad 2 does not  play at the same tempo as the drum riff on pad 1  The drum riff is playing at the tempo of the setup   while the horn riff is playing at the tempo of its original sequence  the song 115 Jazz  Lets make the  horn riff play at the tempo of the setup as well  To do this  press the more soft button in 
128. 7 54  55 72   73 90  91 108  109 127 32nd triplets     152 ArpShift The 88 Arpeggiator Shift steps are scaled over the 128  MIDI controller values  so that O   O steps and 127   88  steps    153 ArpLimit The 60 Arpeggiator Shift Limit steps are scaled over the  128 MIDI controller values  so that O   0 steps and 127    60 steps    154 ArpLmtOp Arpeggiator Shift Limit Option  each range of values  selects one of seven options in order on parameters list   0 18  Stop   19 36  Reset  etc    37 54  55 72  73 90   91 108  109 127  FloatBip     155 ArpVel Arpeggiator Velocity  each range of values selects one of  twenty three options in order on parameters list  0 5  First   6 10  Played  etc    11 15   101 105  106 110   111 127  MissNotes9     156 ArpDur The Arpeggiator Duration   values are scaled over the  128 MIDI controller values  so that 0   1  and 127    100     157 Latch For Arpeggiator Latch Pedals mode  0 63   off  64 127    on    158 Latch2 For Arpeggiator Latch Pedals mode  0 63   off  64 127    on    159 ArpGliss Arpeggiator Gliss  0 63   off  64 127   on    160 SusLatch For Arpeggiator Latch Pedals mode  0 63   off  64 127    on    170  Arp Shift Sets ARPEGGIATOR values for Shift to negative  0 63    off  64 127   on              Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Corresponding                Controller   ARPEGGIATOR Operation  Number  Parameter   171 ShiftPatt Selects one of the 128 patterns in the ShiftPatt Bank for  the ARPEGGIATOR page of a controller s zone  
129. All Notes Off and Reset All Controllers messages to all zones  and  stops all arpeggiators and riffs     When you select a setup in Setup mode  the PC3LE sends a number of MIDI messages  on each  of the MIDI channels used by the setup  Some of these include  Program Change commands        7 1    Setup Mode       Split Layer Button    MIDI Bank Select messages  Pan and Volume messages  and entry values for physical controllers   entry values are the values that take effect as soon as you select the setup  there are also  controller exit values  which are the values of the controllers when you leave the setup   either  by selecting another setup or by exiting Setup mode   The values of all these messages depend  on the parameters you define in the Setup Editor for each setup     In addition to zone splitting and layering  Setup mode is a powerful way to take advantage of  the PC3LE   s assignable knobs  switches  pads  and other controllers     Split Layer Button    Press the Split Layer button  on the front panel  below the Mode buttons  to add a split or layer  zone to the currently selected setup  You will be brought to the Split Layer page        A Laer  Current Sound  1 Standard Grand    LoSPlt   Create a new sound below the sP1it   HiSFIT 3  Create a new sound above the selit  Later Create an additional sound    Lose1t   Hise1t Cancel    Press the LoSplt or UpSplt soft button to add a new zone to the lower or upper half of the  keyboard  or press the Layer soft button to 
130. Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones             13 25  Switch Between Zones Based On Played Keyboard Velocity          0 00606 c cece e nee 13 30  Creating A New Setup iss sion ASS EI nach ite Sia hu te naz ANA E yeaa 13 33  Basics Of USING RISA A Sogn Pie Side Ss A heey eer aie oleate 13 36      Adding A Riff  Sync Riffs    nnn 13 36   eTransposing A Riff As It Is Triggered 0 0 0    ccc cc ccc cence es 13 43   eUsing A Single Song For Multiple Riffs    0 0 0 0 13 47   RIF Troubleshooting ise  A A het hat ee A E NS 13 53    Use Setup mode to select  play  edit  and save setups  To enter Setup mode press the Setup mode  button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This brings you to the Setup mode main    page           IEN GHE    2 Thumper Best Set    4   pa as    5 Dance Club            13 1    Tutorials  Setup Mode       A setup is made up of 1 to 16 Zones  each of which uses a program  instrument sound  from  Program mode  With a setup you can play up to 16 different instrument sounds at once  either as  separate instruments from different key ranges  known as split setups   as layers of instruments  from the same keys  known as layered setups   or using a mix of both methods  Each zone can  also trigger a riff  which is sequence that can be synced with other riffs or transposed as it is  triggered     The following examples will explain how to use and edit each type of setup  These examples  include instructions 
131. Bass Piano or use the  alphanumeric pad to enter 38 and press Enter  see below      This setup contains a piano program on the upper octaves of the keyboard  and an upright bass  program on the lower octaves of the keyboard            hi  40 Ze ada tae  Dotav  Panio Tinta Te TE    2 Note  The pre set    split    setups included with the PC3LE all include the word    Split    or a slash     in  LT their names  such as 39 Fretless Bass Split  and 40 Zep KB3 Pianet          gtan             13 4    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using And Editing A Split Program Setup    Part 2  Changing The Split Point  Setting Zone Key Range     You can use the Setup Editor to change the    split    point on the keyboard  the point where one  Zone stops and the other begins  For example  let s change the split point of the setup 38 Jazz  Bass Piano  38 Jazz Bass Piano has 2 Zones  which we will see upon entering the Setup Editor    Each Zone in a setup contains an instrument program  The programs in this setup are AC  Buzzer Bass and Grand  Evans   Let s change the split point of this setup to happen an octave  higher  We will have an octave more of high bass notes and an octave less of low piano notes   This is done by adjusting the key range for each Zone     1  With the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will  bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below          Progr ari Ped  Channel  ion  USE DI MIDI LOCAL  MidiBank  1 BankMode 
132. Bass category by changing this parameter to SynBass  While  this parameter is selected  you can choose a category by pressing the corresponding Category  button on the front panel  You can also set a category by using the Alpha Wheel or     buttons   In addition to the category set here  all edited programs can be viewed by pressing the User  Category button        6 11    Program Mode       The Program Editor    The PADS Page    Use the PADS page to assign notes or controllers to the PC3LE s eight pads  see below   When  you select a PC3LE program  the PC3LE will also select an associated Drum program to be  triggered by the pads  The program for the pads is assigned to MIDI channel 10  Also  any  factory program in the Drums category is playable from the pads        ALIS    Po Sram  PA AS  Pad Assignments    i 2 3 4 5 6 T 8          Drum Pad Program    Use this field to select the PC3LE program that will be played by the pads  To select a program   press one of the Category buttons  then scroll through the list of programs by using the Alpha  Wheel or     buttons  You can also enter a program ID  number by pressing the Shift category  button so that its LED is lit  and using the alphanumeric pad to enter and ID  and pressing  Enter  You can also set this parameter to Self by entering  1 on the alphanumeric pad and  pressing Enter or scrolling to the bottom of the program list  Setting this parameter to Self  assigns the pads to trigger notes on the current MIDI channel  Thi
133. Cancel to resume editing  No to exit the editor without saving  or Yes to save  your edits and move to the Save page     The Rename soft button on the Save page takes you immediately to the naming dialog  where  you assign a name to the object you re saving  You haven t saved yet  but you ll be able to after  you ve named the program     The cursor underlines the currently selected character  Press the  lt  lt  lt  or  gt  gt  gt  soft buttons to move  the cursor without changing characters  Press an alphanumeric button one or more times to  enter a character above the cursor  The characters that correspond to the alphanumeric buttons  are labeled under each button  If the character that appears is not the one you want  press the  button again  Press the     button on the alphanumeric pad to switch between upper and lower  case characters     Use the numbered buttons to enter the numerals 0 through 9  Press Clear  on the alphanumeric  pad  to erase the selected character without moving any other characters  Press the Delete soft  button to erase the selected character  All characters to the right of the cursor will move one  space left  Press the Insert soft button to insert a space above the cursor  moving all characters to  the right of the cursor one space to the right     Press the Cancel soft button if you decide not to name the object  Press OK when the name is set  the way you want to save it     In addition to the letters and numerals  there are three sets of punctuat
134. Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to Set the RecTrk parameter to 1  This sets  the track that you will be recording to  see below      cona  AI Events  Ea A A    Cursna  Son TemPo  126 4  RecTrk al  127 Pan  6 4 Mode  Merde   Frog  gard Grand Locat  1 il            Track      sien m amt    4  Use the cursor buttons to navigate to the Prog field and choose a program with the plus minus  buttons  alpha wheel  or by entering the desired program number with the alphanumeric pad  This  sets the instrument sound for the current track  For example  choose program 1 Standard Grand to          12 2    Tutorial  Song Mode       make the first track contain the piano part for this song  see below   You can do this quickly by  entering 1 on the alphanumeric pad and pressing Enter          SE E E LAEE EG    Curr  pa TemPo  178  Hodes Merce    ar Locat  1 11        Part 2  Set The Tempo    For this example  we will leave the song at its default time signature  4 4  see the Song mode  chapter for details on setting the time signature   Follow the steps below to set a tempo for your  song  It is easiest to choose your tempo before recording any tracks  but the tempo can be  adjusted after recording as well  see the Song mode chapter for details on changing the tempo after  recording      1  On the Song mode MAIN page  use the cursor buttons to navigate to the Tempo field and enter a  tempo  Entering the tempo with the alphanumeric pad is the easiest method 1f you know your  desi
135. DI channels  If you plan on syncing riffs with a  song  it may be easier to start by creating a setup  then recording the setup into a song  See Recording A  Setup To Song Mode on page 7 66 for details   A setting of First Avail  will sync the riff to the first  available riff  arpeggiator  or song from Song mode     Note  If you have multiple riffs or arpeggiators already playing when using FirstRiff Av   FirstArp Av    or First Avail  for the current riff  the current riff will sync to the riff or arpeggiator of the lowest  numbered zone that has a riff or arpeggiator playing     SyncType    The SyncType parameter allows you to choose how your riff will sync to other riffs   arpeggiators  and Songs  depending on your settings made for the SyncZone parameter   With  SyncType set to None  your riff will start playing as soon as it is triggered  It will not sync to  anything  With SyncType set to DownBeat  if there is already something playing to sync to  the  current riff will wait for the downbeat of the next measure before starting  so  you can trigger the  riff to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the downbeat of the next measure  If  Syncing to an arpeggiator  see Num Beats on page 7 46 for details on changing when an arpeggiator s  downbeat will occur  With SyncType set to AnyBeat  if there is already a something playing to  sync to  the riff will wait only until the next beat  Depending on when you trigger the riff  it will  sync up  but it may be on an 
136. DI channels  showing  the program assigned to each channel  This changes the MIDI channel the PC3LE uses  internally  as well as the channel you re using to send information to other synths connected to  the PC3LE   s MIDI Out or USB port  MIDI slaves   Changing the current MIDI channel also  changes the corresponding setting on the Master Mode MIDI Transmit page  When you press  both Chan Zone buttons at the same time on the Program mode main page you will be returned  to Channel 1  Check out the chart on page 3 11 for more shortcuts you can make with double  button presses     In the Setup Editor  the Chan Zone buttons scroll through the zones in the current setup  In  Quick Access mode  they scroll through the Quick Access banks  and in Song mode they scroll  through recording tracks     We ll let you know  when applicable  what the Chan Zone buttons do     The Edit Button    The Edit button  located to the left of the display  activates each of the PC3LE   s editors  Pressing  the Edit button tells the PC3LE that you want to change some aspect of the object marked by the  cursor  For example  when a program is selected and you press Edit  you enter the Program  Editor  If a setup is selected  you enter the Setup Editor     There are editors accessible from every mode except Master and Storage mode  To enter an  editor  choose one of the modes  mode selection   and press Edit  An editing page for that mode  will appear  You can then select parameters  navigation  and chang
137. DI out ports  except for pressure values output when in Song Mode   See  Pressure Map  Receive  on page 9 18 for settings that affect only those MIDI pressure values received by  the USB or MIDI in ports  On each of the pages mentioned above  look at the MIDI signal flow chart to  see which pressure maps can affect your velocities depending on which MIDI Sources  MIDI Destinations  and operating mode that you are using        7 10    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Scale    After you ve selected a continuous physical controller  you can modify the controller   s response  similarly to the ways you can modify velocity response  Refer to the graphs beginning on  page 7 28 for illustrations of the velocity scaling parameters     Scale lets you amplify or diminish the action of the controller  Full scale is 100   Higher values  will make the controller more sensitive  and lower values will make it less so  Setting the scale to  a negative number makes the controller action work in reverse  As with velocity  you can use a  controller to crossfade between two zones by setting the scaling for one zone positive and the  other negative  Maximum scale values are  300  and  300      Curve    This lets you taper the controller response  The default setting is Linear  which means that the  response follows a straight line as you move the controller     Setting Curv to Expand produces a curve that is less steep than the linear curve at keystrike  velocities below 64  and steeper than 
138. Don   t use the program or  category buttons because these will change the currently selected GM program  The newly  selected PC3LE program will be used by the current GM program  though the name of the GM  program will not change  To save these settings you must enter and then exit Master Mode   Saved settings can be recalled after powering off or leaving GM mode  To restore GM mode   s  factory selected programs  press the Reset soft button  see below      Demo Button    The Demo Button parameter determines whether or not pressing the Play   Pause button plays a  demo song for the current program while in Program mode  Set this to off when using the  transport buttons to control an external sequencer while in Program mode        9 10    Master Mode  MIDI Transmit  XMIT        MIDI Transmit  XMIT     Use the parameters on the MIDI Transmit page to control how the PC3LE sends MIDI  information to its USB or MIDI Out port  These settings to some extent affect the PC3LE   s  response to its own keyboard and controllers  but they primarily affect the responses of other  MIDI devices that are receiving MIDI from the PC3LE on the channel specified with the Channel  parameter on this page     When a program is selected  either in Program mode or in Quick Access mode  all of the settings  of the MIDI Transmit page are in effect  except for ChgSetups  which only applies when loading  a setup     If a setup is selected  in Setup mode or in Quick Access mode  all of the settings of the
139. Double Button Presses    Pressing two or more related buttons simultaneously executes a number of special functions  depending on the currently selected mode  Make sure to press them at exactly the same time     In this mode  or editor       Program mode        pressing these  buttons  simultaneously       Octav   Octav     Data Entry       does this     Reset MIDI transposition to O semitones  Double press again to go  to previous transposition        Chan Zone    Set current MIDI channel to 1        Plus Minus    Step to next Program bank  increments of 128         Up Down cursor buttons    Starts playback of demo song for current Program  Stop with Stop  transport button        Left Right cursor buttons    Brings up Tap Tempo page                    Plus Minus Moves through list of Setups in increments of 128   Setup mode Chan Zone Set zone 1    Left Right cursor buttons Brings up Tap Tempo page    Up Down cursor buttons Toggle between Play and Stop   Song mode Chan Zone Select all tracks on any TRACK page in Song Editor        Left Right cursor buttons    Brings up Tap Tempo page        Storage mode    Left Right cursor buttons    Select all items in a list  Move cursor to end of name in naming  dialog        up down cursor buttons    Clear all selections in a list  Move cursor to beginning of name in  naming dialog        Plus Minus    Scroll through the currently selected parameter s list of values in  regular or logical increments  varies with each parameter           
140. E a OE bse sststhsasde des SESER ARNS EEE EEEE dies 14 3  o MDT o IEEE EE E E AT E E NO E 14 4  Intuitive Controller Selection   Data NON 14 4  Search Function  Find A Program Or Setup By Name  dl 14 4  Quick Song Recording And Playback  Record An Idea From Any Mode        sccscessessssseseesessessesseseeseeneeseseeses 14 5  Program Mod  er Eare casts A Eaei e EEEE TES esas a O EEEa ae aaaea ara AEE a E TAEAE R EARE RES 14 6  Set  p Mode A AA A AAA AAA AAA A R anne hotese Sandee 14 8  Appendix A Specifications  MIiDi Implementation COP AAA AAA A A AAA A AAA A 1  A EEC A 2  Appendix B PC3LE Bootloader  Using the Bootloader Mets il B 1  Updating PC3LE Software and Objects       cccccecccssesesssssssteseseseeesescscecesescsesnansnesesesesenescecesesesssnsnsnesesesceenesesans B 2  R  n A ON B 3  A O OR B 3  Ele vet ssa saben Sapna Danette vba ata a a vb aa aani B 3  Index          vi    Introduction       Sounds and Features    Chapter 1  Introduction    Thank you for purchasing the PC3LE  The PC3LE is a performance instrument designed for fun  and fast operation on stage  in the studio  and at home  The PC3LE is available in 61  76  and 88  key models known as the PC3LE6  PC3LE7  and PC3LE8 respectively  This guide can be used for  for any of these models  and refers to all models as the PC3LE     The PC3LE gives you access to many of the same realistic sounds and useful features that are  found in Kurzweil s powerful PC3  with the benefit of a streamlined interface  With the PC
141. E imports this zone from  Zone 1 of 128 Default Setup  If there are parameters or entire pages you use often  you can  create your own Default Setup and save it to location 128  pressing NewZn will then import  zones from your custom Default Setup        7 64    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Duplicate Zone  DupZn     This adds a new zone with the same parameters as the current zone     Import Zone  ImpZn     You can import  or    bring in     any zone from any setup in memory  Press ImpZn  and use any  data entry method to choose a setup to import from  Then use the Chan Zone buttons to select  one of that setup s zones  Now press Import  and the zone you selected will be added to the  current setup     Note  If you are using all 16 zones in a setup and you try to add  duplicate  or import a zone  a     No More Zones    message appears  You must delete an existing zone before you can add   duplicate  or import any new ones     Delete Zone  DelZn     This deletes the current zone from the setup  Use DelZn to free up zones so you can add or  import new ones     Set Controls KB3  KB3CTL     Press this button if you want to assign the setup s knobs and switches to control organ functions   if you have a KB3 organ program in the current setup   Organ functions for KB3 programs are  labeled on the front panel under the switches and knobs  When you press the KB3CTL soft  button  you will be prompted to continue by pressing OK  or to cancel and return to the  previous screen b
142. E will show up as a USB MIDI device  If you choose USB Temporary Drive from Storage  mode  the PC3LE will temporarily  while on that Storage mode page  become a    virtual storage  device    and USB MIDI will be disabled  Different host programs on your computer may  indicate various errors as the USB MIDI device is no longer present  Leaving Storage mode will  restore USB MIDI functionality     USB MIDI and 5 pin MIDI can be used at the same time  the MIDI signals will be combined into  a single 16 channel MIDI stream     Pedals    Plug your switch or continuous pedals into the corresponding jacks on the PC3LE   s rear panel   We recommend using the Kurzweil pedals described on page page 1 4  but you can use almost  any switch or continuous pedal  as long as it adheres to the following specifications  as most    pedals do    Switch pedals     inch tip sleeve plug  Continuous pedals 10 kOhm linear taper potentiometer        inch tip ring sleeve plug    with the wiper connected to the tip     If you use a third party  non Kurzweil  switch pedal  make sure it s connected before you turn  on your PC3LE  This ensures that the pedal will work properly  it might function backward   off  when it   s down and on when it s up   if you turn on your PC3LE before plugging in the pedal    Similarly  don t press any of your switch pedals while powering up  because the PC3LE verifies  each pedal s orientation during power up  If you re pressing a pedal  you might cause it to work  backward 
143. ED is lit  Next  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled  Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for the Controller field  You can also set the desired controller in  the Controller field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons     10  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below         ae  7  O         Hone    Hone           13 19    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    11  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  You can also  use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field             OMe    ntrallalue  ExiTlalue            ontr  Scale  Cure  Offset   Test Tyre          AAA DMT  TU OLL    AAA ee L    12  Now we will set an offset for Zone 3  On the Controllers page for Knob 1  Zone 3  use the cursor  buttons to select the Offset field  On the alphanumeric pad press the     button  then 14  then the  Enter button to enter  14 as an offset value        ELO FIA    nitrate  Exitlalue        Test Tyre    CA PROTCTRLS SPANUOLIKEVUELY more A    Knob 1  labeled Mod on the front panel  should now control the volume of the pads on Zones 2    and 3  if not  review the previous steps   Zone 3 will
144. EEOSE CEASA odas 3 4   Picking PaVvorites ii tdt td ELIO E EE E AAA 3 4  A RR 3 6  Data Et  52  cas 15s sata 164 cascada tad ba ive    OIEA Endesa Laas ard E End sista 3 9   MA St oe AA A A A A e SEPT RTS 3 9  Intuitive Controller Selection  Data A NO 3 12  A i O O A A Se kie as te 3 12  Quick Song Recording and Playback         ccccccscccsesesesseesessesesescecesesescsnansneseseseesesesescecesescsesaneneseseeesesesescenesesesnananeneass 3 13       Chapter 4 The Operating Modes    Selecti  g Modeste miniserie sern ineen taste the eSEE spat td cad EEn Pa AE EEE EE E EAE E lee aS EEE e AERE TeSa Feie SREE sa Dende EERSTE ROS 4 1  Pin ding Square  One  eoe NN 4 2  Using th   Modest IE E ced aes on Sees adele gcd AAA NR OR Sooty 4 2    Chapter 5 Editing Conventions    Introduction to Editing A O es rE Eea Ee ra SE EEE Ee ES Ea chs Wes TaS Eai Eea Tae aTi TE n SESSE REEE SES EOR EE SEERE 5 1  Object Ty pear  lO EEEE Dioni E E N E ET 5 2  Savingand Naming ar tt iii debida Aia a AT S S E EE E EEEE RE ETER 5 3  ROMODjecis semestre A RE 5 4  Memory Oberon salas E e eat A tai 5 4  A eetan erea ae eara E anara ETER Singeess eeraa aee Aasaa erene EA REAR ar EEAS  5 5  Deletin Det iraro e es EE E REEE A alge det beste E EAE ETETEA ETEY Ee A DA AAA A 5 6  Saving and Loading Files   Storage MOde        c ccccsssesessssesssesescecesessscsnsnsnesssescesesescecenesescsesaneneseseeesescecenanesesesnaneneneees 5 6    Chapter 6 Program Mode    The Program Node Pag A A A a A 6 2  Selecting Program
145. End point  a new End point is defined     Mode  Merge Erase Slide    The Mode setting determines whether the grabbed events merge with  or erase existing events  on the destination track from the location point to the end of the grabbed region  With Mode set  to Slide  the sequencer creates space for the new events  and slides the existing events to  uniformly later times in the song     Times  1 to 127    The value selected for the Times parameter determines how many copies of the selected region  are placed  one after another  in the destination track        10 29    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  Track Functions    Change    The Change function is used to modify either attack and release velocities  or the values of any  existing controller data on the current track  A static change of values can be made as well as  having the change take place over a region of time     Change can not modify or add data that doesn t exist on the current track  If you hear Note  events played back on a track  then you know there is an attack and release velocity value for  each one  and the effect of the Change function can usually be easily detected  Controller values  are sometimes more difficult to change since there can be inconsistent gaps of time between each  controller event           Events   Hotes  Lokes iC  15  Lollel   Hi      El  Constant           Scale  0  to 20000     The selected velocity or controller events    values can be changed to a percentage of the
146. ExitWalue   None  MS    Linear  Offset   E          13 23    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    12  Now we will set a Scale value for Zone 3  On the Controllers page for Knob 1  Zone 3  use the  cursor buttons to select the Scale field  On the alphanumeric pad press 90 and then the Enter button  to enter 90  as a Scale value  see below         Hone  Hone       E    ntrdldalue  ExiTlalue    TRUS A PANWOL IKEVUEL   more s    Knob 1  labeled Mod on the front panel  should now control the volume of the pads on Zones 2  and 3  if not  review the previous steps   Zone 3 will always be at 90  the volume of Zone 2  because of the Scale value set for Zone 3  For example  if Knob 1 is sending a value of 127  Zone  2 will be at MIDI volume 127  while Zone 3 will be at MIDI volume 114  The value 114 is a result  of the value sent by Knob 1  127  multiplied by the Scale value for Zone 3  90  or  90   This  equation  Knob 1 value x  90  is calculated for every new Knob 1 value received  Because MIDI  only sends integer values  numbers to the right of the decimal point are dropped  so even  though 127 x  90   114 3  only 114 is sent        13  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this  chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor        13 24    Tutorials  Setu
147. H PROG page for each zone that each zone uses its corresponding MIDI channel  number as well  Both of these conditions are important  because otherwise setting the SrcTrack  parameter on the RIFF1 page for each zone would not be as simple as setting it to correspond  with the zone number  See SrcTrack  Source Track  and Re Channel on page 7 53 for more details  on these settings     The MIDI channel settings discussed above are important in order to direct the sequence  information coming from the original song to each desired zone in setup mode  Once this is  done  you can select a program for each zone that is playing a riff  If you want each riff to sound  the same as each track of the original song  use the same program for each zone that each track  used  You can use different programs if you want the riffs to sound different from the original  song  In this setup  zones 1 4 use the same programs that the song 428 H Fact Sng uses for its tracks 1   4  You can view the program used for each zone in the Program field of each zones    CH PROG page        13 49    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    7  Next  lets change the setup to make riff 1 play not only track 1  but tracks 1 4 of the original song   Using this method  you could have riff 1 play all the instruments for one part of a song  such as a  verse section  and then use riff 2 to play all the instruments for another part of a song  such as a  chorus section  Use the Chan Zone button  to the left o
148. I channel of the next highest used zone   track will use DSP units to load its effects  and this  continues until all of the DSP units are used up     If you run out of available DSP units  there are a few methods you can use in order to manage  and free up additional DSP units  First  you can simply disable effects allocation for the MIDI  channels of less important zones   tracks  This is done on the FX page  in either Setup or Song  mode   which provides per channel control over effects allocation  see below            p more  BENT ALE 1 AUSF aS    Use the cursor buttons to select a channel number  only the channel numbers used in the current  setup   song are shown   The selected channel will have its Y or N highlighted  The channel  number with a box around it is the specified Aux Effect channel in Setup and Song mode  see  Aux FX Channel on page 7 50 for Setup mode and FX Track on page 10 20 for Song mode   Each  channel can be set to Y to allocate effects for the zone s    track s  assigned to that MIDI channel   or to N to not allocate effects for that channel  Use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to change  between Y and N  Some channels set to Y may be displayed as  Y   This means that there are not  enough effects resources available for that channel  and that channel s effects are not loaded  As  the cursor is moved from left to right  the ID  and name of the Insert and Aux Effects chains for  each selected channel are displayed on the bottom half of the page  the
149. I controller  0 or 32 message  with value 0 127  The next PCH in the range 0 127 will select the correspondingly numbered  program in the newly selected bank  The following table of examples should help make it clear           Bank Change   Program Change Result   Command Received Command Received   MC 0 or 32  value 0 PCH  value 99 Program 98  bank 1  98th program   MC 0 or 32  value 1 PCH  value 41 Program 168  bank 2  41st program   MC 0 or 32  value 2 PCH  value 56 Program 311  bank 3  56th program           Soft Buttons In Master Mode    Reset    Delete    Press the Reset soft button if you want to return your PC3LE   s memory to the state it was in  when you bought it     CAUTION  Resetting the PC3LE system causes ALL parameters to be restored to default values and  ALL user objects to be erased           Press the Delete soft button to delete the master table  which stores all settings on the Master  Mode pages  program settings for each MIDI channel and program category favorites for  Program Mode  and replacement General MIDI programs in Program Mode when the PC3LE is  in General MIDI Mode  Master Mode parameters will be returned to their factory default  settings        9 22    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Getting Started with the Sequencer    Chapter 10  Song Mode and the Song Editor    Getting Started with the Sequencer    The PC3LE s sequencer is a powerful and versatile tool for songwriters  composers  and anyone  else who wants to record and play back so
150. I pressure values for the same physical pressure  applied to a key  with 4    Easiest    being the easiest   Maps 4 7 make it increasingly harder to  produce MIDI pressure values for the same physical pressure applied to a key  with 7    Hardest     being the hardest         9 5    Master Mode       Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1     Intonation    Most modern western music uses what is known as equal temperament  This means that the  interval between each semitone of the 12 tone octave is precisely the same as every other  semitone  However  many different intonation intervals have evolved over the centuries and  across cultures and instruments  so equal temperament will not sound appropriate for certain  styles of music  The PC3LE supplies you with 17 different factory intonation maps which are  useful for a range of different styles  By changing the value for this parameter  you select from  among the intonation maps stored in the PC3LE s memory  Each of these maps defines different  intervals between each of the semitones in a single octave  used for all octaves  by setting pitch  offsets for each note in cents     Scroll through the list of Intonation maps  and listen for the differences between semitones   Some of the intervals between semitones may be quite different from equal temperament  but  you ll notice that all notes are precisely tuned with notes that are an octave apart  This is because  the intonation maps set the intervals within a single octave  and apply those 
151. IDI Out jack when you select setups  If it   s set to On  the program numbers  for the programs in the 16 zones will be sent via MIDI when a setup is selected  By setting this  parameter to Off  you can select a setup on the PC3LE without changing the internal programs  or those on MIDI devices receiving from the PC3LE  This is useful if you want to send only  controller data to the PC3LE or to MIDI devices  without changing program assignments        7 8    Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       Controllers  CTRLS  Page    Press the CTRLS soft button to display the Controllers page  The Controllers page allows you to  assign any of the PC3LE s physical controllers  knobs  pads  switches  mod and pitch wheels   foot switches and expression pedal  to control a program specific parameter or MIDI controller  number for the currently selected zone     First  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select the desired zone that you  wish to assign a controller for  Next  on the Controllers page  use the cursor buttons to select the  Control field  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and then move any of the PC3LE   s  physical controllers  This will select that controller and display its available parameters   You  can also scroll through the list of controllers in the Control field by selecting the Control field  with the cursor buttons and using the Alpha Wheel or the      buttons to scroll through the list      OO ASSIGNABLE SWITCHES TT    This is how each 
152. Kurzweil com    Table Of Contents    Kurzweil International Contacts a A E a iv    Chapter 1 Introduction    Sounds  and Feat  tes A A ad RT 1 1  A A A NI 1 2  Overview  of the  RES dial eae 1 2  How to Use This Mantal  a ica 1 3  Do TH EEE A AAA A AAA AA A AR IN AAA 1 3  Boot Loader aiii lidia E incaico SEEE EEE ASST 1 3  Options r   a IA A A adas 1 4   Pedal acotada lidia ias 1 4   USB Storage Device Dd ia a 1 4    Chapter 2 Startup    Make Connections int aadas 2 1  Make MUSIC  000 ada 2 1  Before YOU Mi A A aa nua A A al Rice  A deena 2 2  Connecting Audio O a ES a a r ara raer aaae a E e EOE EE E RAE OS AAE Eo EA Ee ASEE Aa ERE Ea ER 2 2  Pedals icons anal ii a idtrai ans 2 3  USB Storage Portaitosutana israelita iones aaa pies ares E AE A esas 2 4  USB Computer POrbos meere e e eo dico desa Sha tebe va hth A sy teen E acted dds cia E ni 2 4  CIA A ONO 2 6  Selecting Programs noes is a dl ii 2 6  Easy AudioNotes pe ano e OaE E E E ae E es e Ee a os 2 6  SetU PS ie e e A A R AA A E 2 8  Quick Access EOE T E OE TEN 2 8  The Other M  des msc AAA 2 9  sottware Upgrades arica a eaaa indiana crei sion E E 2 9    Chapter 3 User Interface Basics    Mode Selection iii A A A Sov T std E E ES 3 1  Assignable  Controls  E tasadnces eA nA ga taaasienes 3 2  DS A A A AA AA A AA AA AA a A AA Aa Aid 3 3  a O A ties oon sees Cudes 3 3  The Save DUO ii A ct sen ncn baka iaa 3 3  Category Buttons e  osio issnsns ds ceesoesstscascanensecsstes aeoea Sees Aeee eee aR aee ae EE ARo aA AEAT EA 
153. Legato Forces mono playback  69 Freeze Envelopes freeze at current state  70 79 MIDI 70 79 MIDI Controllers 70 79  80 83 MIDI 80 83 MIDI Controllers 80 83  Default destination for Switches 1 4   SW1 SW4   84 Portamen Standard MIDI controller for setting Portamento starting note   85 90 MIDI 85 90 MIDI Controllers 85   90  Default destination for Switches 5 10   SW5 SW10   91 GM Reverb With PC3LE in General MIDI mode  controls Reverb send  level  92 MIDI 92 MIDI Controller 92  93 GM Chorus With PC3LE in General MIDI mode  controls Chorus send  level  94 95 MIDI 94 95 MIDI Controllers 94 95  96 Data Inc Equivalent to pressing the plus button  97 Data Dec Equivalent to pressing the minus button  98 NRegParL Non Registered Parameter Least Significant Byte  Table 7 1 Controller Destination List  Continued        7 18    Setup Mode       Corresponding    The Setup Editor                                                                                                          ee Destination Description  Name   99 NRegParM Non Registered Parameter Most Significant Byte   100 RegParL Registered Parameter Least Significant Byte   101 RegParM Registered Parameter Most Significant Byte   102 108 MIDI 102 108 MIDI Controllers 102 108   109 MIDI 109 MIDI Controller 109  Set   s arpeggiator velocity when  ARPEGGIATOR velocity is set to MIDI 109 mode   110 119 MIDI 110 119 MIDI Controllers 110 119   120 Sound Off Stops all sound in the corresponding channel   121 RstCtls Reset Controllers to 
154. MIDI Out port or USB Computer port    to  PC3LE audio outputs    The Pads Velocity Map affects MIDI velocity values for all MIDI sources and destinations used  in the PC3LE  see the circled box above for its location in the MIDI signal flow   Different maps  used for the Pads Velocity Map generate different MIDI velocity values for the same physical  pad strike velocity  Each map applies a different curve to received MIDI attack velocities and  remaps them to new velocities before letting them pass  The default map provides the widest  range of velocity expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default does not  suit your playing style  See the diagram above for the other pages that affect the MIDI attack  velocity before and after reaching the Pads Velocity Map  See the last paragraph of Pressure Map   Press Map   Master  above for a description of Velocity Map types        9 4    Master Mode       Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1     Pressure Map  Press Map   Master     Change the Master Press Map setting if you find that the PC3LE is not producing the desired  MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values  too high or too low  based on your playing style  how soft or  hard that you press the keys   The default map provides the widest range of pressure  expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit your playing    style     MIDI  Sources    PC3LE Keyboard    MIDI In via MIDI In port or USB Computer port    PressureMap Settings on MIDI
155. MIDI data sent from Song mode        9 12    Master Mode       MIDI Transmit  XMIT     Velocity Map  Transmit     Change the MIDI Transmit Velocity Map setting if you are triggering external MIDI gear which  is producing notes that are too loud or too quiet based on your playing style  how light or heavy  that you play the keys   The default map provides the widest range of velocity expression  but  you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit your playing style     MIDI  MIDI In via MIDI In port or USB Computer port    Sources    MIDI  Destinations         PC3LE Keyboard                   PC3LE Sound Engine  to    MIDI Out via MIDI Out port or USB Computer port        PC3LE audio outputs    The transmit Velocity Map affects the way the PC3LE sends MIDI velocity values   to its USB or MIDI Out port  see the circled box above for its location in the MIDI signal flow    Different maps output different MIDI velocity values for the same received MIDI attack velocity   Each map applies a different curve to received MIDI attack velocities and remaps them to new  velocities before transmitting them to the USB or MIDI Out port  this parameter has no effect on  MIDI data sent from Song mode or to the PC3LE   s sound engine   The default map provides the  widest range of velocity expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default  does not suit your playing style  See the diagram above for the other pages that affect the MIDI  attack velocity b
156. Motemar   Linear    WelScale 1411   Lollel s  WelOffsetl  f    1zr WelCurwe Linear  PANWOL IKEYUEL   more 3    5  Onthe KEYVEL page for Zone 2  use the cursor buttons to select the LoVel field  Then press 80  on the alphanumeric pad and press the Enter button to enter 80 for the LoVel field  see below    This means that 80 is the lowest keyboard velocity that Zone 2 will respond to  anything lower will  not cause Zone 2 to be heard  Any velocity of 80 or more will cause Zone 2 to be heard because  Zone 2   s HiVel field is set to 127  which is the maximum MIDI velocity           TEE    1 TransPose  HST  MotemarP   Linear  elscale 1411   elOffset 16  elCurve   Linear    PANWOL IKEYUEL   more 3            Lollel  Hillel y    y more  CH PEG       6  Next  lets set the same velocity range for Zone 3  Use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the  display to select Zone 3  see below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right  corner of screen     Step 6               ores    1 TransPose  BST    Lokes C    Hikes   GA Motemar   Linear  elScale 1 1004   Lollel elOff etl  6   Hillel J elCurue   Linear       CH PRG       PANWOLIEEYUEL   more d    7  Onthe KEYVEL page for Zone 3  the LoVel field will still be selected if you haven   t moved the  cursor  If the LoVel field is not selected  use the cursor buttons to select the LoVel field  Then press  80 and press the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to enter 80 for the LoVel field  see above         Step 7    Now 
157. NWOL JREYWEL                               Parameter Range of Values Default  Low Key  LoKey  C  1 to G9 C 1  High Key  HiKey  C  1 to G9 G9  Low Velocity  LoVel  1 to 127 1  High Velocity  HiVel  1 to 127 127  Transpose  128 to  127 Semitones 0   Note Map Note Map List Linear  Velocity Scale  VelScale    300  100   Velocity Offset  VelOffset   128 to  127 0  Velocity Curve  VelCurve  Velocity Curve List  see Velocity Curve Linear   VelCurve  on page 7 31           Low Key  LoKey   High Key  HiKey     The LoKey and HiKey parameters define the note range of the currently selected zone  The  easiest way to change these values is to press and hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric  pad and press the key of the note you wish to enter  You can set these values with normal data  entry methods as well     You can create    negative    ranges as well  To do this  select the HiKey parameter and set its limit  lower than the LoKey limit  This results in the zone being active at the top and bottom of the  keyboard  but being silent in the range between the two limits  This lets you create a layer with a     hole    in the middle  which you can then fill with a different sound on another zone     The limits of MIDI are C 1 to G9  The untransposed 88 key range is AO to C8  The untransposed  76 key range is El to G7        7 26    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Transpose    This changes the pitch of the zone  without changing its position on the keyboard  It changes the  MIDI note
158. ON Page  Song Mode 10 19  Connecting MIDI 2 3  continuous pedals 1 4  Contrast 2 4  Control Setup  Setup Editor 7 68  Controllers  entry values in Program Mode 6 3  conventions for editing objects 5 1  Copy  Song Editor TRACK Page 10 24  Cursor buttons 3 7    D    Data entry 3 9  Deleting objects 5 6  Demo Songs 12 15  Destination  MIDI Transmit Page 9 11  Dialogs  Save 5 3  diamond icon 5 4  Digital audio output 2 2  Digital Output Volume 9 8  Directories 11 3  Disk format requirements 11 1  Display 3 6  Double button presses 3 11  Drum Pads  In Setup Mode 7 15  Program Mode 6 12  Drum Pads Color  blue 7 16  red 7 16  Drum Remap 9 9  Drum Tracks  Song mode 10 20    E    Easy Audition 2 6  6 2  14 3  EDIT button 3 8  Edit Song   COMMON Page 10 19   EVENT Page 10 31  Editing 5 1  editing conventions 5 1  Editing VAST programs 6 9  EditProg Exit page 5 3  EditProg Save page 5 3  Effects   Program Mode 6 13  Electrical grounding 2 2  Erase   Song Mode TRACK Page 10 24  EVENT Page       Song Mode 10 31  EXIT button 3 8  Exit values 7 12  External sequencer 10 2  External Tempo Source 7 49    F    Files  Everything 11 6  Loading 5 6  Master 11 6  Saving 5 6  Fill Mode 11 7  Finding objects 3 12  14 4  Formatting a USB Device 11 2  11 8  Front panel navigation 3 6  FX  Program Mode 6 13  FX Mode on Master page 9 8    G    General MIDI 9 9   Drum Remap 9 9  Grab   Song Mode TRACK Page 10 29  Grounding 2 2    H    Hard reset 9 22    ID s 12 6  Info soft button 2 7  6 3  8 2  Insert  
159. Off     Drum Remap    This parameter will remap all Drum programs to conform to the General MIDI  GM  drum map   a standard drum map used in many keyboards and synthesizers  The GM drum map isn t  optimally intuitive in terms of playability  so by default the PC3LE uses a unique keymap that is  more intuitive and lends better to performance  However  the GM drum map is so  commonplace that many players feel more comfortable playing drum programs with the GM  drum map  Because of this  the PC3LE is designed such that you can remap drum programs to  the GM drum map     When the Master Page Drum Remap is set to None  no remapping takes place in Program mode   When the Master Page Drum Remap is set to GM  the PC3LE remaps Drum programs to the GM  drum map     General MIDI    This parameter enables or disables General MIDI  GM  mode  You can not access Setup Mode or  Quick Access Mode while in GM mode  Aside from what is noted in this section  all other  PC3LE functions operate normally while in GM mode  In GM mode  the PC3LE complies  specifically with the General MIDI  GM1  specification     An Overview of General MIDI    General MIDI is a specification created by the MIDI Manufacturers Association which defines  specific features that a MIDI instrument must have  see the MMA website at www midi org for  more information   Among other things  the GM specification sets a standard bank of program  names and numbers  as well as a standard drum mapping layout  so that sequences crea
160. On Riff On  Any value triggers the zone   s Riff if Riff is set to On  on RIFF1 page   164 RiffOff Riff Off  Any value stops playback of zone s Riff   165 RiffDur Riff Duration  sets the Duration parameter  see above   The    Duration value is calculated by multiplying the received  controller value by 1000  and dividing the answer by 128  any  decimal points are taken off the final value   Here are some  example values  7   54   13   101  19   148   32   250    64   500   127   992     166 RiffVel Riff Velocity  sets the Velocity parameter  see above   The  Velocity value is calculated by multiplying the received  controller value by 2  For Example  25   50   50   100    100   200   127   254      167 RiffDly Riff Delay  Controls Offset parameter  see above   Controller  value 64   0 offset ticks  Each value away from 64   512  offset ticks  For example  63    512 offset ticks  65    512  offset ticks  O    32768 offset ticks  127    32256 offset ticks                    7 59    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The FX Pages  FX  AUXFX1  AUXFX2    The PC3LE contains a versatile effects processor  and when combined with Setup Mode it puts  the power of an entire studio of audio effects at your fingertips  This section contains everything  you ll need to know how to use the PC3LE s effects in Setup Mode  as well as Song Mode     Before getting started  read the Effects Overview section for a basic description of how effects  work in the PC3LE  Read the FX Page section to le
161. PC3LE comes with over 1000 instrument programs  all of which can be  edited or copied to a user program to customize your sound  In addition to sample based  programs  the PC3LE includes Kurzweil s KB3 organ simulator for realistic tonewheel organ  sounds as well as KVA oscillators for virtual analog synthesis     The PC3LE includes many hardware features designed for live performance  There are five  knobs  each of which can be assigned to 3 separate parameters  each parameter accessed  through use of a shift button   allowing for the control of a total of 15 parameters  There are eight  drum pads which are assignable to notes or control functions  The PC3LE also includes 12  assignable switches  mod and pitch wheels  as well as inputs for foot switches and an expression  pedal     Keeping Current    Check for new documentation and operating system upgrades before you start using your  instrument  When new software is available for the PC3LE  it will be posted at  www kurzweil com  You can use the PC3LE   s Boot Loader  described in this manual  to easily  upgrade your instrument with new software and sounds  which will be released periodically by  Kurzweil        Overview of the PC3LE    The PC3LE s 1000  programs include samples from our PC2 s Base ROM  Orchestral ROM   Classic Keys ROM  and a new String Sections ROM  as well as support for General MIDI  Multi   zone performance setups are also provided  many of these setups use note triggers to play  factory recorded riff
162. POS L      Musician s Guide     For PC3LE6  PC3LE7  and PC3LE8        KURZWEIL  PAZ gp PCI      2010 All rights reserved  Kurzweil    is a product line of Young Chang Co   Ltd  Young Chang    Kurzweil O  V  A  S  T  O  PC3LE    PC3     X Pro  KDFX    Pitcher    and LaserVerb    KSP8      K2661     K2600     K2500     and K2000    are trademarks of Young Chang Co   Ltd  All  other products and brand names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective companies  Product features and specifications  are subject to change without notice                 You may legally print up to two  2  copies of this document for personal use  Commercial use of any copies of this document  is prohibited  Young Chang Co  retains ownership of all intellectual property represented by this document     910520 003     May 2010    CAUTION    RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  DO NOT OPEN    CAUTION  TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK   DO NOT REMOVE THE COVER  NO USER SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE  REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL       The lightning flash with the arrowhead symbol   within an equilateral triangle  is intended to alert  the user to the presence of uninsulated   dangerous voltage  within the product s  enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude  to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons     The exclamation point within an equilateral  triangle is intended to alert the user to the  presence of important operating and  maintenance  servicing  instructions in the
163. Program Editor    MIDI Values    To change the MIDI value or controller for a parameter  press the right cursor button to highlight  the center or right column  In the MIDI value  center  column  use the Alpha Wheel or the      buttons to enter a MIDI value from 0 127  or a value of None by scrolling below 0  You can also  use the alphanumeric pad followed by the Enter button to enter a MIDI value  For parameters  that are using a Switch or Footswitch as a control source  the available MIDI values are None   Off  and On  You can enter these values with the alphanumeric pad  For a value of None  enter   1  negative 1  followed by the Enter button  For a value of Off  enter 0  or any number less than  64  followed by the Enter button  For a value of On  enter 127  or any number greater than 63   followed by the Enter button     Important Note About Values of None    For all factory ROM programs  four of the standard parameters  Pan  Expression  program  volume   Sustain  and Sostenuto  are always set to None by default  If you change one of these  values  either on the Parameters page in the Program Editor  or with a physical controller from  Program Mode  or the Program Editor   the same value will be used for any other program you  select  if you select another program that uses a value of None for the same parameter  These  values remain set even if you don t save the program  This can be useful  for example  when  using an expression pedal to control program volume  By defa
164. Setup mode  this parameter acts as a final filter for which ports will send MIDI information   For example  if this parameter is set to MIDI_USB MIDL  and a setup zone has its Destination  parameter set to MIDI Local on the SetupMode CH PRG page  MIDI data will be sent only       9 11    Master Mode       MIDI Transmit  XMIT     A    through the traditional MIDI port  Both parameters  MIDI Transmit Destination and the setup  Destination parameter in the SetupMode CH PRG page act as filters and both are active in  Setup mode     Note  This parameter has no effect on Song mode  In Song mode each track s destination ignores this  parameter     Channel    This defines which MIDI channel the PC3LE uses to transmit MIDI messages when not using a  setup or Song mode  each zone determines this in a setup  each track determines this in a song    The value for this parameter matches the current MIDI channel displayed on the top line of the  Program mode page  If you change the current MIDI channel while in Program mode  the  setting of this parameter changes accordingly  and vice versa     Transpose    This parameter affects the transposition that   s applied to the MIDI data stream  Adjusting this  parameter transposes the PC3LE   s notes  as well as notes on slaves receiving from the PC3LE   This transposition setting mirrors transposition settings from the Program and Setup main  pages  It   s value is added to transposition settings made elsewhere  This parameter has no effect  on 
165. Song Editor      Picking Favorite Programs For Each Category    You can select a favorite program within each category that will be automatically recalled when  you press that category   s Category button  Follow these steps to set a favorite program     1  First enter Program mode  if you are not in Program mode  press the Exit button to the right of the  display until you see ProgramMode in the top left of the display      2  In Program mode  select a category by pressing one of the Category buttons to the right of the  Alpha Wheel   First make sure the category Shift button is not lit  if it is  press it to unlight it before  selecting a category      3  Next  find your favorite program in the current category by using the Alpha wheel        buttons  or  up down cursor buttons   Alternatively  you can find the program by pressing the category Shift  button and using the numbered category buttons to enter the program   s ID number  then press the       14 2    Power User Tips       General Tips    category Enter button  If you use this method  make sure to unlight the category shift button by  pressing it again after making your selection      4  Lastly  hold the Category button that you wish to save a favorite for  the Category button that is  currently lit   The next time you choose that category  your favorite program will be selected     Easy Audition  Play A Demo Song For Each Program     Any time you want to hear what a program sounds like  highlight the program   s n
166. The MISC Page on page 10 17   If  you plan to try out different pan positions  it is easier if you write an initial Pan after you have  found the desired setting     Setting Initial Pan Per Track    Follow these steps to change the current RecTrk   s initial Pan  While the sequencer is stopped   press Record  change the value of Pan  press Stop  and save the song  follow the same method  to quickly set initial program or volume settings   Initial program  pan  and volume can also be  set at the top of each track s event list  see Song Editor  The EVENT Page on page 10 31      Setting Initial Values For All Tracks    An important last step before saving a finished song is to store initial values of Program  Volume  and Pan for all tracks  This can be done at any time  but is best done as a last step if you plan to  make a lot of adjustments to these settings  To write initial settings for all tracks  press the Keep  soft button on the Song MIXER page  see Song Mode  The MIXER Page on page 10 12   After  pressing the Keep soft button you must save your song to save these settings  you are  automatically prompted to save upon exiting the Song MIXER page   Pressing the Keep soft  button stores the current value of each track s Program  Volume and Pan settings as initial  settings  Be sure that these values on each track are set to the value that you wish to store  as the  settings may have changed if you have written any automation     Note  Don t use the Keep soft button if you 
167. The aux bus is an audio  channel with a shared effects Chain that can be used by programs on any of the PC3LE   s 16  MIDI channels  The aux effect is useful when you want to use the same type of effect for  multiple channels  You apply the aux effect to the program on a MIDI channel by    sending    the  audio from that channel to the aux bus     Every channel is connected to the aux bus  but the aux bus doesn   t receive the signal until you  turn up the aux    send    level for that channel  which controls a channel s input level to the aux  bus  On each MIDI channel you can control the aux send level for that channel s program  in  turn controlling how loudly you can hear the aux effect applied to that channel s program  The  aux send level is set by the Aux FX Wet Dry parameter on the PARAMETERS page for each  program  see The PARAMETERS Page on page 6 9   For each factory program  by default the  Aux FX Wet Dry parameter is assigned to be controlled by knob 5  labeled Reverb  located to the  left of the display   As you turn up an Aux send  the PC3LE automatically turns down that  channels unprocessed signal  this does not happen for Aux Effects in Setup and Song mode    With an Aux send turned half way up  a MIDI value of 64   you hear an equal amount of  processed and unprocessed signal  called wet and dry  respectively   With an Aux send turned  all the way up  a MIDI value of 127   you hear only the processed  wet  signal and none of the  original unprocessed  dry  
168. Trk settings do not have any effect on edits made on the TRACK page in the Song  Editor  Any tracks defined as Drum Tracks are transposed when a transposition is applied to  these tracks from the TRACK page     MIDI Destination  MidiDst     Midillst         L          U LM     U L U LAHU    The MIDI data on each track has a destination assignment selectable with the MidiDst  parameter  There are four possible indicators     L   Local  The track   s MIDI data will be transmitted locally only  to the PC3LE   s internal sound  generator  None of the track   s MIDI data will be sent to the USB or MIDI Out port     M   MIDI  The track   s MIDI data will be transmitted only to the MIDI Out   U   USB MIDI  The track s MIDI data will be transmitted only to the USB port         None     Pairs and groups of the above letters indicate that MIDI is being sent to each letter   s  corresponding destination        10 20    Song Mode and the Song Editor  Song Editor  The TRACK Page       Use the cursor buttons to select one of the MidiDst fields  You can access fields for 8 tracks at  once  either tracks 1 8 or 9 16  each of which correspond to the track numbers displayed in the  DrumTrk field  directly above the MidiDst fields  Use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the  display to select one of the tracks 1 8  viewed in the top right corner of the page  in order to  access tracks 1 8  or select one of the tracks 9 16 to access tracks 9 16  With the desired track  number field selected  u
169. a pair of headphones to the headphone out for private listening     Digital   For digital audio output from the PC3LE  connect a 75 Ohm coaxial cable from the PC3LE   s  RCA Digital Out jack to the AES or S PDIF input of the receiving device  You may need an  RCA to XLR adapter to connect with the receiving device  If the receiving device receives only  optical signals  you ll need a converter as well  The PC3LE   s S PDIF output sends digital audio  at a 48 kHz fixed sample rate        2 2    Startup       Startup   the Details    Connecting MIDI    The simplest MIDI configuration uses a single 5 pin MIDI cable  either from the MIDI Out port  of your PC3LE to the MIDI In port of another instrument  or from the MIDI Out port of another  MIDI controller to the MIDI In port of the PC3LE  There are all sorts of possible configurations   including additional synths  personal computers  MIDI effects processors  and MIDI patch bays   Depending on your system  you may want to use the PC3LE s MIDI Thru port to pass MIDI  information from a MIDI controller to the PC3LE and on to the next device in your system  You  can also connect MIDI devices to the PC3LE   s MIDI Out port  which can send channelized MIDI  information from the keyboard or through the PC3LE from your MIDI controller         lt  gt  USB MIDI  O Digital  Q      In Thru Out Contrast Out    Computer Storage         Jo          You can also use the PC3LE   s USB Computer port to send and receive MIDI  By default the  PC3L
170. able files with every sequence you create using an external sequencer   Then  when you load the Master Table file  you would have all the correct programs assigned to  the appropriate MIDI channels     The LOAD Page    Pressing the LOAD soft button calls up the LOAD page  where you can load  PLE files or  individual objects from the current storage device  Along the bottom of the Load page  there are  four soft buttons  Below are descriptions of their functions     Parent Moves you up one level in the directory hierarchy  If the display is already at the  root directory  this button has no effect     Open Open selected file or directory  See below for instructions on opening files to view  objects   OK Load selected file  See below for instructions on using the Load dialog     Cancel Exits the Load page and returns you to the Storage mode page     Loading Individual Objects    Since files can contain over 3000 objects  it is often useful to load only a subset of the information  contained in a  PLE file  Sometimes  this capability is necessary even to be able to load certain  files  if the size of the file   s data is greater than the PC3LE   s internal RAM size     You can select individual objects or groups of objects  programs  effects  songs  for loading from  within a single  PLE file  The Load Object feature is accessible from the LOAD page  To activate  it  scroll the file list until you have highlighted the file that you wish to load objects from     Press Open to beg
171. across zones boundaries  There are two  important points to keep in mind when using Sync Mode     e Make sure that the ARPEGGIATOR keyranges of each zone that you want to sync cover the  entire keyboard  rather than covering the range of the current zone  If the ARPEGGIATOR  keyranges do not coincide  then playing keys in separate zones will sound no different from  having ArpSync set to Not in Sync     e For    regular    arpeggios  make sure the Beats parameter settings on the ARPEGGIATOR page  of each zone that you want to sync are the same  Different Beats values result in irregular     but potentially very interesting   arpeggios     Aux FX Channel    The Aux FX Channel determines the FX channel through which the aux sends of all of the zones  in the current setup are sent  For example  if a zone 2 in a setup has a program with 25 Basic  Delay 1 8 as an Aux FX  and zone 2 is assigned to channel 5  then setting the Aux FX Channel to  5 sends the programs of all of the zones in the setup through zone 2 s Program   s Aux FX  i e    through 25 Basic Delay 1 8      KB3 Channel    With this parameter  you can specify the KB3 channel in the current setup  because KB3  programs can play on only one channel  zone at a time  See page 6 5 for more information on  KB3 mode         7 50    Setup Mode       Riffs    Ly    The Setup Editor    Riffs are full songs or individual tracks of a song created in the PC3LE   s Song mode that you can  trigger in setup mode  Standard MIDI files m
172. add a layered zone  Using the Split   Layer button  automatically creates and edits a new setup for you  which is convenient for making basic split  and layered programs  For more complex splits and layers  it may be necessary to use the setup  editor  see The Setup Editor on page 7 5  and Chapter 13  Tutorials  Setup Mode for details        Adding a Split Zone    On the Split Layer page  press the LoSplt or UpSplt soft button to add a new zone to the lower  or upper half of the keyboard  you will be brought to the Split Layer  LOWERSPLIT or  UPPERSPLIT page  Both pages have the same parameters to set  Play the keyboard as you  adjust these parameters to find the right settings  Below is the Split  Layer  LOWERSPLIT page     Main Sounds 1 tree ga  Lower SPLit Program   TransPose    SPlit Lowib 3    7B  Wolume  ler Pan  64             7 2    Setup Mode       Split Layer Button    Parameters on the Split Layer  LOWERSPLIT and UPPERSPLIT pages     Lower Split Program  Upper Split Program    Use this field to select a program that will become the lower or upper part of your split setup   Select a program from the program list by using the Category buttons  Alpha Wheel        buttons  You can also enter a program   s ID   To do this  press the Shift Category button  enter  the ID  with the alphanumeric pad  then press the Enter button     Transpose    Use the Transpose parameter to change the pitch of the zone you are creating  without changing  its position on the keyboard  Trans
173. all number of ticks away from the  beats   See Part 7  The Event List  below for a way to view note time position   Ticks allow for the  sequencer to record these tiny differences in timing  thus retaining the original timing nuances  of the performance  When locating note values smaller than 1 beat  divide the number of ticks in  a beat by the appropriate number  a quarter note is always worth 960 ticks  no matter the time  signature   For example  in a 4 4 time signature there are 960 ticks in a beat  since a beatis worth  a quarter note in 4 4   To find the value of an 8th note  divide 960 by 2  since there are two 8th  notes in a quarter note  Divide 960 by 4 for 16th notes  by 6 for 16th note triplets  by 8 for 32nd  notes  and so on  You can also use record quantization which automatically moves recorded  notes to the nearest set time division  such as 8th or 16th notes   See Part 7  Quantizing  below for  details      Part 1  Assign Instruments To Tracks    1  Press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page  Next  press the Song mode button   located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This will bring you to the Song mode  MAIN page  see below       gt  Step 2  below             STUFFED    TemPo  178  Hodes Merce  Locat  1 il       Frog     4 Standard Seong    Track if    dei er stor en ore    2  Onthe Song mode MAIN page choose 0 New Song  in the CurSng field  if not already selected    This loads an empty song file  see above      3  Use the 
174. ame  while in  Program mode  then press the Play Pause button to play a brief sample  The Demo Button  parameter on the Master Mode 2 page must be on for Easy Audition to work  the parameter is  on by default  See Demo Button on page 9 10 for details     Program Mode General Tips    Save The Current Knob And Switch Settings From The Program Mode Main Page    On the Program mode main page  if you change the settings of any controls  knob position   assignable switch on off  Mod Wheel position  as well as Arp Settings   the LED on the Save  button will light  When the LED on the Save button is lit  press the Save button to bring up the  save dialog and save your edits to the current program   If you switch to a different program   the alterations that you made to the previous program will be lost without warning      Saving A Newly Edited Program    If you are saving changes to a program that you have not previously edited  the save dialog will  choose the first available  lowest  user ID  as a save location  so that you don   t replace the  original program   You can also choose a different ID  to save the program to and rename the  program if desired  If you have edited a factory ROM program and wish to save over the  original program at the original ID   simultaneously press the       buttons  below the Alpha  Wheel  to jump between selecting the program   s original ID  and the first available User  category ID   Saving at the program   s original factory ID  will replace t
175. ameter determines the source track of the riff  from the riff   s original sequence  in Song mode   Along with the Start and Stop parameters  SrcTrack allows you to use a single  sequence as a riff for many zones  and to select a different source track and Start Stop parameter  setting for each zone to avoid having to create a special sequence for each riff     To create a setup with multiple riffs each playing a single instrument part  set a single track for  the SrcTrack parameter  and that track of the sequence will play with the program on the current  zone  Repeat the process on other zones using the same song for the riff  but using a different  SrcTrack for each zone     To create a setup with a single riff that plays multiple instrument parts  set SrcTrack to ALL   Each track of the sequence will play its track through the zones which have corresponding MIDI  channels  MIDI channels are set for each zone on The Channel Program  CH PROG  Page of the  Setup Editor  see page 7 6      Re Channel    Use the Re Channel parameter when the current zone   s MIDI channel and the channel that the  riff was recorded on are not the same  When Re Channel is set to On  the track selected for the  SrcTrack parameter will play through the MIDI channel of the current zone  For example  if you  want to use a riff on zone 2  MIDI channel 2 and the riff was recorded on track 4  MIDI channel  4  you will need to turn Re Channel on  If you were to do this and keep Re Channel set to Off   th
176. ameter is not visible when Override is set to No        7 63    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Send Levels and Pre Post Ins     There are two parameters for each of the setup or song s 16 available MIDI channels  Send Level   top row  and Pre  Post Insert  bottom row   The setting for the parameter Send Level determines  if the Aux Send Level for the selected zone   MIDI channel s program is overridden  and if so  by  what value  The default value of  p  means    no override     i e   use the values specified in the  program   To override the send level value  select the send level parameter  the top row  for the  desired channel  and enter a new value with the Alpha Wheel       buttons  or enter a value with  alphanumeric pad and press the Enter button     The setting for the parameter Pre  Post Insert determines if the current Aux routing for the  selected zone   MIDI channel s program is overridden  and if so  by what routing  The default  value of  p  means    no override     i e   use the values specified in the program   To override the  Pre  Post Insert parameter setting  select the Pre  Post Insert parameter  the bottom row  for the  desired zone  track  and change the value with the Alpha Wheel or     buttons  Pre means that  the Aux Send takes place before any Insert Effect is applied  whereas a setting of Pst means that  the Aux Send takes place post Insert Effect   Of course  if the program on the channel has no  Insert Effects loaded  then this parameter wi
177. any other options  For more information see the Setup  Mode chapter        13 34    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Creating A New Setup    7  Tf you would like to adjust the keyrange of each Zone  use the more soft buttons on the bottom of  the display to scroll to through pages of soft buttons and find and press the KEYVEL button  This  brings you to the KEY VEL page where you can view the key range for the current Zone  see  below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen  Use the  Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select the current Zone  On the KEY VEL  page  the LoKey and HiKey fields set the lowest and highest keys that will trigger the current Zone   All keys in between the LoKey and HiKey will trigger the current Zone  while those outside of this  range will not trigger the current Zone  To set a key value for the LoKey or HiKey field  select the  field  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and press the desired keyboard key        7 OMe       TransPose  BST  Motemar   Linear  WelScale Logz  LelOff et  Linear    127 We lCur ne  PANWOL IKEYUEL   more 3    m  m      EP  PR    y more  CH PEG    8  When you are finished creating your setup  press the Exit button on the front panel to exit the Setup  Editor and return to the Setup mode main page  You will be presented with the message    This setup  has been edited       Press Rename to save and name your setup  press No to return to the Setup  mode main page witho
178. apter for details on setting metronome count off  options         4  Play your part for the current track  when finished  press the Stop button on the front panel to stop  recording  The Save Changes screen will be displayed where you can retry the last performance of  recording  save the song with the last recorded performance  or compare your new performance  with the last saved version of the song  For this example we will name the song My Song under  ID  1025  See below for an explanation of this page        Soft Button Functions On the Save Changes Page     The PlyNew soft button allows you to play the song with your latest recorded performance   You will likely want to hear this first     Pressing PlyOld will play the current song  minus the performance that you just recorded  You  can toggle between Play Old and Play New without restarting the song by pressing either  button while the song is playing  This is useful to check if your last performance was better or  worse than what was previously saved  if anything was previously saved      The Locate field allows you choose a start time for the old or new playback  This is useful  when you just want to hear a certain part of the song without listening to the whole thing  The  Playing field displays whether to NEW or OLD data is playing     Stop halts the playback of either the Old or the New version of the song you are currently  auditioning  This also resets the song   s start location to either the default Bar 1  Beat
179. ard and downward pitch bending     2 A Note About Continuous Controllers and The BEND Page      _ Unlike the Pitch Wheel  other continuous controllers such as a knob will not automatically  return to the original center pitch  This can make it hard to accurately return the controller to it   s  center position by hand  In these cases  it is useful to use a separate controller for bending only  up or down  For example  to have a knob only bend up  use a knob with an Offset value of 64  and a Scale value of 50   and Curve set to Linear  The bottom of the knob range will now be the  center pitch  and the top of the knob range will be the top of your bend range  To have a knob  only bend down  use a knob with an Offset value of  127 and a Scale value of 150   and Curve  set to Linear  The top of the knob range will now be the center pitch  and the bottom of the knob  range will be the bottom of your bend range  See page 7 10 for more on setting knob controller  parameters     The ARPEGGIATOR  amp  ARPEGGIATOR 2  ARP1  ARP2  Pages    Each zone in a setup has its own Arpeggiator  When activated  each Arpeggiator takes MIDI  note input from the PC3LE keyboard  or via MIDI  and outputs a rhythmic pattern of MIDI  notes  You can control the speed and nature of the pattern in real time  Each Arpeggiator can  affect both the PC3LE and external MIDI instruments  The notes produced by the Arpeggiator in  a given zone go to all of that zone   s destinations  local  MIDI  or both  You can a
180. arn how to allocate processing power for  effects  and read that AUXFX Page sections to learn how to quickly change your Aux Effects  chains from the Setup Editor  or Song Mode      Effects Overview    This section gives a general     big picture    overview of the effects types in the PC3LE  as well as  descriptions of the fundamental concepts of effects stages and routing  Read the Insert Effects  and Auxiliary Effects sections to learn about the two types of effects that can be applied during  different stages in of program   s signal path  Read the Chains section to learn about where each  type of effect is chosen     Insert Effects    Insert Effects are placed directly in the signal path at the output of a single program  as  described in the Program mode chapter   Each program on a zone  track can have its own Insert  Effect  depending on available processing power  see The FX Page on page 7 62 for details      Aux Effects    Aux Effects  unlike Insert FX  are not applied to the whole output of a program  but are blended  in with the original unprocessed program sound  Each setup has two stereo Aux Sends that go  to the Aux 1 and Aux 2 Effects  The Aux Effects are global  available to all zones or tracks at the  same time   and there can be only one set of Aux effects  Aux 1 and Aux 2  loaded at a time  Each  Aux effect can be set to be applied either pre  or post Insert Effect  see Signal Flow below for  details      Chains    The object used for Insert and Aux Effects
181. asingly harder to  produce MIDI pressure values for the same physical pressure applied to a key  with 7    Hardest     being the hardest         9 14    Master Mode       aL    MIDI Transmit  XMIT     Program Change  ProgChange     When ProgChang is set to On  the PC3LE sends program change commands to its USB or MIDI  Out port when you select programs or setups from the front panel or from your MIDI controller   Select a value of Off when you want to change programs on the PC3LE but don   t want to send  program change commands to the USB or MIDI Out port  This parameter doesn   t affect the type  of program change command that s sent  it just determines whether any command is sent at all    The type of program change command is determined by the settings on the CH  PROG page in  the Setup Editor of your control setup  See The Setup Editor on page 7 5 for more details      Note  The ProgChang parameter applies to all modes except Song mode and Setup mode  or when a setup  is loaded from Quick Access mode   Setups disregard the ProgChang setting and instead use the  EntryProgChg parameter on the SetupMode CH PROG page  See The Channel Program  CH PROG   Page on page 7 6   Songs disregard this ProgChang setting and instead use the ProgChang parameter on  the Song Event Filter Playback page  accessed from the PLYFLT soft button in Song mode     Change Setups  ChgSetups     This parameter determines the exact timing of setup changes when you select a different  setup   either by
182. at   s stored in the current entry                Selecting A Quick Access Entry To Edit    Pressing the Chan Zone buttons scrolls through the ten entries   the number of the current entry  is displayed in the top right corner  As the entry number changes  the highlighted objects at the  center of the page change as well  showing you what s stored in each entry  On the page above   for example  entry 0 is the current entry     Selecting A Program For A Quick Access Entry    Above  the Type field tells you that the object stored at entry 0 is a program  The cursor  highlights the program   s ID and name  Use the Alpha Wheel or     buttons to scroll through the  list of programs  Press one of the Category buttons to see a list of programs in that category  or  press the All Category button to see a list of all programs        8 2    Quick Access Mode       The QA Editor    Selecting A Setup For A Quick Access Entry    If you want to store a setup in the current entry instead of a program  press the Type soft  button   when you do this  notice that the Type field change from Program to Setup  also notice  that the channel indicator disappears  since setups can transmit over several channels   The list  of objects changes from the program list to the setup list  Just as with programs  the cursor  highlights the setup s ID and name  Use the Alpha Wheel or     buttons to scroll through the  setups  You can also use the alphanumeric pad followed by the Enter button to choose a Setup
183. away from the root directory  To navigate out of subdirectories back towards the root directory   use the Parent soft button to move one level back from the current directory     Directories    A directory lets you group files together as you might separate documents using folders in a file  cabinet  When storing files you can create directories on USB devices  You can even create  subdirectories within directories  Directories appear in the normal file list with the indicator   lt DIR gt  to the right of the directory name     Directories are handy for organizing your songs  setups  and program files  The PC3LE provides  many operations for setting up and managing directories and the files within them        11 3    Storage Mode       Common Dialogs    Common Dialogs    These are dialogs that the PC3LE calls up when about to perform certain storage functions     The Select Directory Dialog    When storing an object   or group of objects   the PC3LE prompts you to select a directory in  which to save that object or group     There are three navigating soft buttons on the left side of the bottom of the page   NewDir Create new directory  Calls up the New Directory dialog  see the following section   Open Opens the highlighted directory     Parent Moves you up one level in the directory hierarchy  If the display is already at the  root directory  this button has no effect     When you have chosen your directory  press the OK soft button to call up the File Name dialog   see the
184. ay also be imported to Song mode and then used as  riffs in setups  Every zone in a setup can have it s own riff   a completely independent sequence   You can use a setup with many riffs to trigger and stop looped sequences of different instrument  parts  Alternatively  a single riff can play multiple instrument parts  Each riff could be used as a  different song section of a backing track  For tutorials on how to configure riffs for basic uses  see  Basics Of Using Riffs on page 13 36  Also  see Riff Troubleshooting on page 13 53 for solutions to  common problems     To use a riff  first go to Song mode and note the ID  of the song  section of song and track that  you will use for your riff  Next go to Setup mode and create a setup  On the CH PRG page of  the Setup Editor  choose the program that you want to use for the riff on the current zone   Program changes that are recorded in song mode will be ignored when using the song as a riff in  a setup  You can also set up the playback event filter in Song mode to ignore other types of  events as well  Once you have selected your program  press the more soft button until you get to  the RIFF1 and RIFF2 pages  The following sections describe the contents of these pages     Note  By default  setting a zone to trigger a riff will disable the ability to play notes of that zone   s  program from the keyboard  To re enable this ability  see Local on page 7 55     The RIFF1 Page    The first Riff page appears as shown below  and has t
185. aying fast arpeggiations   These destinations only work when combined with other destinations and features  so be sure to  read this whole section to gain a complete understanding     Shift Key Number  ShKeyNum  controller destination 176  works in a similar way to Key  Number  KeyNum  controller destination 134   Both controllers basically generate a  monophonic stream of notes  The difference is that Key Number plays through all notes  chromatically  while Shift Key Number only plays notes relative to a Shift Pattern     For example  when controlling Shift Key Number from a knob  notes are triggered from a Shift  Pattern in forwards order as you turn the knob up  and backwards order as you turn the knob  down  If in our zone we have selected the Shift Pattern 2  minor  the notes being played by the  knob will be only the root  the minor third and fifth in the chosen key  triggering notes in any  octave up and down the keyboard   See Shift Key below for details on selecting the root note and  octave      Selecting The Desired Notes     You must select a Shift Pattern for the desired zone in order for Shift Key Number to have an  effect  To select a Shift Pattern for the current zone in a setup  enter the setup editor and go to the  Arpeggiator page by pressing the ARP1 soft button  Select a Shift Pattern from the ShiftPatt  field  If using multiple zones  a different pattern can be selected for each  The ShiftPatt field is  usually used with the arpeggiator  but can also be 
186. begin to leak     The Mod Wheel controls Distortion Drive     Switch Pedal 1  the sustain pedal  controls the Rotary FootSw parameter  which toggles the  Rotary speed between slow or fast        Program Mode       V A S T  and KB3 Programs    MIDI Control of KB3 Programs    When you re playing a KB3 program from an external MIDI source  there are two things to keep  in mind     e Certain MIDI Controller numbers always control specific KB3 features  See Controller  Numbers below     e The value of the LocalKbdCh parameter affects how KB3 programs respond to MIDI  Controller messages  See Local Keyboard Channel  LocalKbdCh  on page 9 19     Controller Numbers    Table 6 2 lists the MIDI Controller numbers that control KB3 features  The PC3LE also sends  these Controller numbers to its MIDI Out port when you re using the local keyboard channel   see Local Keyboard Channel  LocalKbdCh  on page 9 19   The controller numbers below may not  apply if you have edited controller assignments for the Control Setup  see The Control   Setup on page 7 68                                                                        MIDI  KB3 Program Feature Controller  Number   Dist Drive 1  Swell 11  Drawbar1 14  Drawbar2 15  Drawbar3 16  Drawbar4 17  Drawbar5 18  Drawbar6 19  Drawbar7 20  Drawbar8 21  Drawbar9 22  Swell Ctl 23  Leak Level 24  Rotary Slow Fast 80  Rotary Brake 81  Chorus Vibrato On Off 82  Chorus Vibrato Select 83  Chorus Vibrato Depth 85  Percussion On Off 86  Percussion Level Lo
187. both Zones 2 and 3 will only respond to velocities of 80 or more  Try playing some soft  quiet notes  you should hear only piano  Next  play some hard loud notes  and you should hear  the piano and pads  if not  review the previous steps   Depending on your playing style  you  may wish to set the LoVel value for Zones 2 and 3 lower or higher so that Zones 2 and 3 can be  triggered by lower velocities or only very high velocities        13 31    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Switch Between Zones Based On Played Keyboard Velocity    8  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this  chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor     Velocity ranges can be used in different way depending on your needs and the sounds being  used  You could repeat the above tutorial  but instead make Zones 2 and 3 only be heard when  low velocities are played  for a more subtle effect  Or  you could repeat the above tutorial and  additionally change the velocity range of the piano on Zone 1 so that it is not heard for velocities  above 80  This way  you only hear one sound at a time  piano for low velocities  and pads for  high velocities  This technique is often referred to as velocity switching  Velocity switching can  be a used to switch between Zones of similar sounds in order to add a bit of extra  expressiveness  or to switch between d
188. burt 180  Wel  108        If you would rather not be tied to down beats for syncing this riff  you can set the SyncType to  None  With SyncType set to None  the riff will not sync to anything  which allows you to trigger  it more freely  This can be helpful if you need to transpose the riff more quickly to match chord  changes  If you would like to transpose the riff quickly  but still want it to be able to sync with  other things  a SyncType setting of AnyBeat will sync the riff at the next available beat  instead  of waiting for a down beat     Another sync option is to have the bass riff sync only when the drum riff on zone 1 is playing   For example  set the SyncType parameter for zone 2 to AnyBeat  and set the SyncZone  parameter to Riff 1  Press pad 1 to trigger the drum riff  and notice that the bass riff syncs with  the next beat of the drum riff when the drum riff is playing  If you press pad 1 again to stop the  drum riff  you will be able to trigger the bass riff out of sync once again     You may also want to assign a pad to stop the bass riff  instead of using the front panel Stop  button which stops all riffs  Press the CTRLS button to go to the Controllers page for zone 2   With the Controller field selected  hold the category Enter button and press pad 3 to select  Drum Pad 3 for the Controller field  This pad is already assigned to trigger the bass riff  but  since we can trigger it from the keyboard  lets change this pad   s assignment to stop the bass riff 
189. cification is a little ambiguous when it comes to Bank Select messages  as to  whether they should be only Controller 0  only Controller 32  or both Controllers sent as a pair   Different manufacturers design their instruments to respond to different schemes  and if you  send Bank Select in a form an instrument doesn t like  it may ignore it or interpret it incorrectly   The BankMode parameter is designed to allow the greatest flexibility in addressing other MIDI  instruments  Usually you can look on the MIDI Implementation chart in the user   s manual of an  instrument to determine how it   s designed to receive Bank Select messages  and then set  BankMode for each zone to suit the instrument that is receiving data from it  The default setting   which works with the largest number of other instruments  is Ctl 0 32     A BankMode value of K2600 is intended for use with the Kurzweil K2000  K2500  or K2600  The  Bank Select message is sent as Controller 32  with a value between 0 and 127  The K2000  K2500   and K2600 support only 10 banks  with 99 programs per bank  so Program Changes 100 or  higher are sent as Bank Select 1  followed by the last two digits as a Program Change  For  example  if Program 124 is assigned to the zone  this will be sent out the MIDI Out port as Bank  Select  Controller 32  1  and then Program Change 24     Entry Program Change  EntryProgChg     This parameter enables or disables bank and program change commands sent to internal  programs or to the M
190. city and pressure  aftertouch  response  You can also set  the master tempo           Tune gC WelMar Linear  TransPose  PadllelMar   Linear  TemPo 126 50 Press Mar Linear  Int ked C Intonation  1 Edual       i    HAST 1 MAST 2    HIT Re                            Parameter Range of Values Default  Tune   100 cents 0  Transpose  128 to 127 semitones 0  Tempo 20 00 to 300 00 BPM 120 00  Velocity Map  VelMap  Velocity Map List Linear  Pads Velocity Map  PadVelMap  Velocity Map List Linear  Pressure Map  Press Map  Pressure Map List Linear  Intonation Intonation Map List Equal  Intonation Key  Int Key  C  C   D  DA  E  F  FA  G  GH  A  A   C  B             Master Mode       Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1     Tune    Adjusting the value of this parameter tunes every program in the PC3LE by the amount you  specify  Tuning can be adjusted up or down 100 cents  one semitone  in one cent increments   This parameter is useful for getting in tune with recordings and acoustic instruments  Adjusting  the tuning in Master mode does not change the settings on the PITCH page of individual  programs  but will be added to any adjustments you make there  Master mode tuning  adjustments affect only the audio output of PC3LE program notes  and not notes sent via MIDI     Transpose    Like the Tune parameter above  Transpose affects every PC3LE program  but not those notes  sent to the MIDI Out port  You can adjust the MIDI transposition sent to the MIDI Out port on  the TRANSMIT page in MIDI mode    
191. ck s  you are editing  that occur in the  region of time between the From and To settings  will be affected by the edit function     When Events is set to Notes  note number and velocity ranges can be set for Note events     LoKey    Determines the lowest note in a range of notes to be affected  This can be set to any MIDI note  value  the default is C 1        10 22    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The TRACK Page    High Key  Hi   Determines the highest note in a range of notes to be affected  This can be set to any MIDI note  value  the default is G9     LoVel   An attack velocity range can be specified as criteria for selecting Note events for editing  The  LoVel parameter sets the lowest velocity a Note needs to have in order to be edited  Notes on  the selected track s  with a attack velocities lower than the LoVel will not be affected by the  edit  The available values are 1 127  the default is 1     High Velocity  Hi   The Hi parameter sets the highest attack velocity a Note needs to have in order to be edited     Notes on the selected track s  with attack velocities higher than the value of Hi are not  affected by the edit  The available values are 1 127  the default is 127     When Events is set to Controller  the Controller s  and a Controller value range can be set for  Controller events     Controller  The Controller parameter selects the Controller  if any  or all Controllers to be affected     LoVal   You may further specify a particular range
192. continue after you leave the setup  For example  if you want to make sure a zone   s pitch returns  to normal whenever you leave a setup  you would set Exit Value to 64 for any controller whose  Destination parameter is set to PitchUp  Again  None means no command is sent        7 12    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    SW Pedal 1  amp  2  Arp  switch  Arp  latch sw  Switch 1 10    The parameters for SW Pedal 1  amp  2  Arp  switch  Arp  latch sw  and Switch 1 10 are the same  See  and example of the Switch 1 page below     Use SW Pedal 1  amp  2 to assign parameters for footswitch pedals which can be connected to the  PC3LE via jacks in the pedals section on the rear panel labeled SW1 and SW2  The PC3LE comes  with one piano style sustain switch pedal  see Pedals on page 1 4 for information on compatible  pedals  SW Pedal 1  amp  2 are often used to control sustain and sostenuto  though they can be  assigned to any other on off switch function     The PC3LE has 12 switches that you can assign functions to  These switches include the Arp   switch and Arp  latch sw  located above the Pitch and Mod Wheels   as well as the five buttons  labeled Assignable Switches  located above the assignable knobs  Each of the five buttons above  the knobs can perform the function of two separate switches  access each function by using the  shift button  to the left of these switches   When the top switch button Shift LED is lit  the  switches access switch functions 1 5  When the bottom sw
193. correspondingly  If you want to transmit a MIDI Bank number different from the one  corresponding to the local program  select the local program first  then change the MIDI bank     If you select an empty bank  like Bank 53   the zone will still produce sound on the PC3LE   provided that Destination is set to a destination including Local  The Program parameter will  display whatever internal program you set  but the bank number transmitted over the MIDI Out  port will be different from the internal program s bank number     MIDI Program  MidiProg     MidiProg defines which program number is transmitted out the MIDI Out port on the current  zone s MIDI channel     When you change the value of the Program parameter  the value of MIDIProg automatically  changes correspondingly  If you want to transmit a MIDI program change number different  from the one corresponding to the local program  select the local program first  then change the  MIDI program     Different programs are accessible depending on the value of the BankMode parameter              Value of BankMode Available Programs  Ctl O or Ctl 32 O to 127  Ctl 0 32 O to 127  K2600 0 to 99  None None          7 7    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Status    Destin    MIDI B    This parameter determines what the current zone does when you select the setup in Setup  mode  Muted means that the zone sends and receives program changes and entry   exit  controller values  but doesn t play notes  If the value is Active  the zo
194. cts and a Chain of 8 aux effects     see note below for details on chain size limitations   Insert effects are applied only to the current  program  while aux effects receive signal from all active programs  aux sends        A Note About Processor Power Allocation    Each effects Chain is composed of an effect box or a series of effect boxes  Each effect box uses a  certain amount of the PC3LE   s effects processing power  The amount of processing power used  by a Chain reflects how complex the effect s algorithm is   more complex effects require more  processing power  The processing  DSP  power needed for each Chain is represented by a  number of    DSP units     All insert and aux effects for the currently selected mode share the  PC3LE s 10 available DSP units     At the top right of the EFFECTS page  you can see how many DSP units are being used by the  selected Chain  The left hand number is the DSP unit size of the selected Chain  and the right   hand number is the total number of DSP units being used by the program  If you exceed 10  DSP units when adding effects  no effects will be applied to the program  The top right of the  EFFECTS page will display  Max 10  when you have exceeded the maximum number of 10  available DSP units     The PC3LE   s 10 available DSP units are most often enough processing power for single  program  but if you use many programs with insert effects at once  you may have to remove  effects on one program in order to allocate more DSP units 
195. d  Changing  the voltage selector may require the use of a different power supply  cord or attachment plug  or both  To reduce the risk of fire or electric  shock  refer servicing to qualified maintenance personnel     4  Do not use this product near water   for example  near a bathtub   washbowl  kitchen sink  in a wet basement  or near a swimming  pool  or the like     5  This product should only be used with a stand or cart that is  recommended by the manufacturer     6  This product  either alone or in combination with an amplifier and  speakers or headphones  may be capable of producing sound  levels that could cause permanent hearing loss  Do not operate for  a long period of time at a high volume level or at a level that is  uncomfortable  If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the  ears  you should consult an audiologist     7  The product should be located so that its location or position does  not interfere with its proper ventilation    8  The product should be located away from heat sources such as  radiators  heat registers  or other products that produce heat     9  The product should be connected to a power supply only of the type  described in the operating instructions or as marked on the product     10  This product may be equipped with a polarized line plug  one blade  wider than the other   This is a safety feature  If you are unable to  insert the plug into the outlet  contact an electrician to replace your  obsolete outlet  Do not defeat the sa
196. d  be able to change programs by sending Program Change commands from your MIDI controller     Easy Audition    Any time you want to hear what a program sounds like  highlight the program s name  while in  Program mode  then press the Play Pause button to play a brief sample  The Demo Button  parameter on the Master Mode 2 page must be on for Easy Audition to work  the parameter is  on by default  Master mode is described in Chapter 9     Picking Favorite Programs    You can select a favorite program within each category that will be automatically recalled when  you choose that category  To do this  first select a category by pressing one of the Category  buttons while in Program mode  make sure the category Shift button is not lit   Next  find your  favorite program in that category by using the Alpha wheel       buttons  or up down cursor  buttons   Alternatively  you can find the program by pressing the category Shift button and  using the numbered category buttons to enter the program   s ID number  then press the category       6 2    Program Mode       The Program Mode Page    Enter button  If you use this method  make sure to unlight the category shift button by pressing   it again after making your selection   Lastly  hold the category button that you wish to save a  favorite for for a few seconds  The next time you choose that category  your favorite will be  selected     Startup Program    You can save the current settings for program mode  selected channel  selecte
197. d  holding the Enter button and  moving the desired controller     A similar technique can be used when setting key ranges  For example  on the KEY VEL page in  the Setup Editor  you can set the range of the currently selected zone as follows  use the cursor  buttons to move the cursor to the value for the LoKey parameter  press  and hold  the Enter  button  then press the note you wish to be the lowest note for the currently displayed zone  The  note you triggered will appear as the value for the LoKey parameter  Repeat the process for the  HiKey parameter     Search Function  Find A Program Or Setup By Name     You can find programs or setups by searching for a string of characters from the Program or  Setup mode main pages  or when selecting programs from with the Setup Editor   On these  pages  hold the Enter button and press any of the numeric Category buttons to display the  Search dialog     Type in the string of characters you want to find using the alphanumeric pad  For example  if  you re looking at the program list and you want to find all programs containing the word     Horn     you would type h o r n  This function is not case sensitive  it will find upper and lower  case characters regardless of what you type     When you ve typed the string of characters you want to find  press Enter  The PC3LE searches  through the current list of objects or values  finds all items that match the string of characters  you typed  and displays the first one it finds  Hold Enter
198. d PlayNew will be the version of the song saved when you press Yes  The    save as     dialog will be displayed     SI       Save Hen Sons as  MEA    Replace Hew Sons 3       Rename  Save  Cancel    Use the Alpha Wheel      buttons  or Alphanumeric Pad to choose a free ID  location to save the  song  or choose a used ID  location to overwrite a previously saved song with your new  version  When overwriting a song file  the    save as    dialog displays    Replace    followed by the  name of the file being replaced  Press Rename if you would like to change the song   s name   Press Save to save the song  or Cancel to return to the previous screen           10 9    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The BIG Page    If you decide not to save or rename  No returns you to the Song mode page in which you were  last recording  Changes to the current song are not saved  though the sequencer will remember  changes to certain settings from the MAIN and BIG pages  These settings are Tempo  Merge   Erase Mode  Locate  track mute status  Time In  Time Out  Song End  Loop  Punch  and Metron   To permanently save these changes with the song  make sure to choose Save from the soft  button menu before powering off or loading a new song  Alternatively  you will be prompted to  save these changes upon loading a new song if the MAIN page settings were changed while  recording or with recording armed  or if any of the BIG page settings were changed     For more detailed instructions  
199. d low  price  The USB Storage port is on the back panel of the PC3LE  but it is easily accessible from the  front of the instrument  A USB connector will only fit into the port if oriented properly  so don t  force it into the port  as this may damage your PC3LE or USB device  If you are having trouble  inserting your USB connector into the port  try flipping the connector over     Caution  Do not remove a USB device while the display says Loading    or Saving     Removing a USB  device during a file transfer can cause data corruption        lt  gt  USB  O      Computer Storage    USB Computer Port    Next to the USB Storage port on the back panel of the PC3LE is a USB Computer port  The USB  Computer port works for MIDI  transmit and receive  or to connect your PC3LE to a computer  for file transfer  By default  the USB port is set to MIDI mode  When selecting USB PC  connection in Storage mode  USB MIDI will temporarily be disabled        2 4    Startup       Startup   the Details    We recommend that you use the USB cable provided with your PC3LE and do not use extension  USB cables  The PC3LE   s USB Computer port is only intended for connection to a USB Type A  port        gt  USB  O      Computer Storage    In USB Storage mode  a  PC3LE  virtual drive will appear on your computer desktop  One  important thing to know here is that this is a virtual drive  You can save to this drive from the  PC3LE  but you must immediately transfer that file to your desktop  or other fol
200. d pan at the top of its  event list  You can also access the tempo track  instructions below      Location Bar Beat Tick Event Type and Value    Pogram EEES  AMET Pre de Hashi Uot    A    Volume   Pan       The top line of the page displays the current song position in the center  and the currently  selected track and corresponding channel on the right  Use the Chan Zone buttons to select an    active track to view and edit the MIDI events recorded on it        10 31    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The EVENT Page    To scroll through the events  make sure the location  Bar and Beat  in the first column  is  highlighted  Use the Alpha Wheel  the Up and Down cursor buttons  or the Plus Minus  buttons  As you scroll through the events  each event is executed by the sequencer  In the case of  Note events  you will hear the note played  although the duration will be short  If you have  scrolled through a Sustain  MIDI Controller 64  message with an On value then you will hear  the note sustain as if the sustain pedal was depressed  The note will continue to sustain until  you scroll through a Sustain message with a value of Off     You can also jump directly to a specific bar and beat by typing the bar number and beat number   then pressing Enter  Keep in mind if you have controller or program data previous to the point  that you jump to  those events may not have been executed and you may hear unexpected  results  For example  if you have program changes at ba
201. d pan settings  as  well as other useful items     THIN vente 109944 1      TemPo   126  al  an  Mode  Merde      de  All Out  Locat  1611    Track E            Z  Pros           Parameter Range of Values Default   Current Song Song List 0 New Song   Recording Track 1 to 16  None  Mult 1   Program Program List Current Program             10 1    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page                               Parameter Range of Values Default   Track Status      R  M  P       Channel 1to 16 1 to 16 left to right  Volume 0 to 127 127   Pan 0 to 127 64   Tempo 20 0 to 400 0 BPM  EXT 120 0 BPM   Mode Merge  Erase Merge   Location  9999 9 to 9999 9 1 1    The Events field on the top line displays the free RAM available for events in the selected song   The Song Status  also on the top line of the display  is always one of the following     STOPPED The default sequencer status  also appears when you press the Stop or Pause  button   PLAYING Appears when the Play button is pressed  but only if the following conditions    are true  the Record was not pressed prior to pressing Play     REC  READY Appears when the Record button is pressed while Song Status is STOPPED   REC  READY flashes  indicating that the sequencer is waiting to start  recording     Current Song  CurSong     This shows the ID and 16 character name of the song currently selected for recording  playback   or editing  When a song is selected  Program Change  Volume  and Pan information is sen
202. d program on each  channel  by entering and then exiting master mode  This saves a master table  see Chapter 9   Master Mode for details   By doing this  your selected channel and program will load the next  time you power on the PC3LE     The Soft Buttons in Program Mode    Use the Octav  and Octav  soft buttons to transpose up or down by a full octave  Pressing both  Octav buttons simultaneously returns the transposition to its original setting     Pressing the Panic soft button sends an All Notes Off message and an All Controllers Off  message on all 16 MIDI channels     Press the Info soft button to see all of the controller assignments of the current program  Scroll  down the page using the Alpha Wheel or the     buttons     The Xpose  Xpose  buttons are a shortcut for quick transposition in semitone  half step   increments  You can use them to transpose the entire PC3LE as much as three octaves up or  down  The top line of the display shows the current amount of transposition  Xpose   Pressing  both Xpose buttons simultaneously returns the transposition to zero  The Xpose buttons  transpose the PC3LE  as well as any MIDI devices connected to the PC3LE   s MIDI Out port   Changing the transposition with the soft buttons also changes the corresponding setting on the  Master mode MIDI Transmit page     Saving Controller Settings    Saving On Program Mode Main Page Vs  The Program Editor    It is important to keep in mind how programs are saved when on the Program mode main
203. defaults in the corresponding channel   122 Local   123 Notes Off Sends Note Off Message to all playing notes in the  corresponding channel   124 Poly   125 Omni   126 Mono On   127 Mono Off   128 Pitch Pitch   values above and below 64 bend the pitch up and  down  respectively   129 PitchRev Pitch   values above and below 64 bend the pitch down and  up  respectively   130 PitchUp Pitch   values above 0 bend the pitch up   131 PitchDwn Pitch   values above 0 bend the pitch down   132 Pressure Pressure   133 Tempo Tempo   134 KeyNum Triggers playback of notes by Key Number   e g   C4 is 60   Send a velocity first with Destination135  KeyVel    135 KeyVel Key Velocity   136 Proginc Program Increment   increments current program number   137 ProgDec Program Decrement   decrements current program number   138 ProgGoto Go to Program   selects program   139 SetuplInc Setup Increment   increments current setup number   140 SetupDec Setup Decrement   increments current setup number   141 SetpGoto Go to Setup   selects setup   142 Start Sequencer function   143 Stop Sequencer function   144 Continue Sequencer function   145 TransUp Transpose Up  ST    146 TransDown Transpose Down  ST    Table 7 1 Controller Destination List  Continued        7 19    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Corresponding                                                                SonpalleE Destination Description  Number  Name   147 ArpOn Any value turns Arpeggiator On   See The ARPEGGIATOR  Page on pag
204. dent objects   the dependent program would get deleted as well  If you press No at the Delete dependent  objects  prompt  the PC3LE deletes only the object  but keeps the dependent objects  In this  example  the setup would get deleted  but the dependent program would remain     When deleting objects and their dependents  the PC3LE deletes only those dependent objects  that aren t dependent on other objects that you re not deleting  For example  suppose you have  two setups that contain the same program  If you delete one of the setups  and delete dependent  objects with it  the setup gets deleted  but the program that s contained in the other setup  remains in memory     Saving and Loading Files    Storage Mode    Saving a file simply involves selecting single objects or all user objects to be stored as a single  file  When you load a file  the PC3LE asks you if you want to maintain the ID s that were saved  with the original objects  which will replace any objects on the PC3LE that share those ID s  or  if you would like to add them to the PC3LE   s existing objects  this will not replace any objects   the PC3LE will instead automatically reassign the object ID s if they are already being used      See Chapter 11 for more information on loading and saving files        5 6    Program Mode       Chapter 6  Program Mode    Programs are the PC3LE   s performance level sound objects  They re preset sounds equivalent to  the patches  presets  voices  or multis that you find on ot
205. der   You must  copy data from the PC3LE virtual drive to your computer s drive or else the data will be lost     When you leave Storage Mode  there will be a prompt telling you that the PC3LE is turning back  into a USB MIDI device   which you have to acknowledge  If you haven t copied the file s  to  your desktop  or other place on the computer  it won t be on the virtual disk when you leave  storage mode     Depending on your computer   s operating system  you may sometimes see a scary device  removal warning on your desktop  for example  when the PC3LE leaves the Boot Loader   You  may disregard such a message without worries of damage to your PC3LE or computer        2 5    Startup  PC3LE Programs    PC3LE Programs    The PC3LE powers up in Program mode  where you can select and play programs  called  patches  presets  or voices on other instruments   Programs are preset sounds composed of up to  32 layers of samples  waveforms  or oscillators  If you ve left Program mode  just press the  Program mode button or Exit button to return        Selecting Programs    When you are in Program mode  there are two basic ways to select a PC3LE program     e Press a Category button to list all programs in that category  then use the Alpha Wheel        buttons  or cursor up   down buttons to scroll through the list  The Category buttons are on  the front panel  to the right of the display  Press the All category to list programs in all  categories     e Press the Shift category butto
206. ding to a sequenced pattern  thus    Shift Pattern     There are 69  pre programed shift patterns including many useful chords  intervals  and rhythms  Each  pattern can have up to 48 steps  and each step can shift notes by   127 half steps or play nothing   Steps are played back at the rate set for Beats on the ARPEGGIATOR page  Keep in mind that  Shift Patterns are effected by every parameter on the ARPEGGIATOR page  which can be the  cause of unexpected variation  or a way to add interesting variation to a pattern     Shift Patterns are most easily used and understood when triggered by only one key at a time   One way to prevent triggering from multiple keys is to use one of the Latch types 1NoteAuto   1NoteAutoLow  or 1NoteAutoHi when using a shift pattern  see Latch on page 7 43  below    Triggering shift patterns from one key allows the pre programed patterns to sound like what  you would expect from their names  If no other keys are playing  patterns will start over each  time a key is pressed  there are some exceptions to this when using ARPEGGIATOR Latch parameters  other than    Keys     though a newly triggered pattern will always start at step 1   When triggering Shift  Patterns from more than one key at a time  each consecutive step of the pattern shifts the note  from a different inputted key  the order of which is decided by the order parameter on the  ARPEGGIATOR page  This means that each key will not be shifted by every step of the pattern   causing you to o
207. doing this  you will  not need to reset your setup tempo to the desired song tempo every time you load your setup   as in step 5  above      Riffs  If you are using Riffs in your setup  do the following to make each Riff play at your setup   s  tempo  which also becomes your song   s tempo   For each zone that has a riff  go to the  SetupMode RIFF2 page  see The RIFF2 Page on page 7 54  and set the BPM parameter to Setup   Remember to save changes to your setup when exiting the Setup Editor     Effects  When recording a setup into Song mode  the song will not retain the Aux effects settings  of your setup  If you would like your song to use the same effects as your setup  copy the  settings of your setup   s FX and AUXI pages to the FX and AUX1 pages in your song   Alternatively  playing your song from setup mode will allow you to hear the effects  To do this   load your song  press the Setup Mode button to enter Setup mode and choose your setup  then  press the Play Pause button  This will play your song from Setup mode  and the effects will be  intact        7 66    Setup Mode       Recording A Setup To Song Mode    Mono Pressure  When recording a setup to Song mode with Mult selected for RecTrk in Song  mode  you may notice that every track has recorded Mono Pressure messages  even if there is  nothing else recorded on a track  If this bothers you  you can set the MonoPress parameter to  Off on the Song Event Filter Recording page  see Song Mode  The Filter Pages  RECFLT a
208. e  and have it start in sync at the start of the playing riff or  song   s loop  The difference from Loop is that if there is nothing playing to sync to  the riff will  not start  If the riff or song that you are syncing to is already running  LoopWait behaves just  like Loop     With SyncType set to StopWait  if there is already something playing to sync to  the current riff  will wait for what is playing to stop before starting  This way you can trigger the riff to start  ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the release  stopping  of the riff  arpeggiator  or song  that you are syncing to  The difference from Stop is that if there is nothing playing to sync to  the  riff will not start  This can be useful if you want to get your riff ready to sync before you start  whatever you are syncing it to  If the riff or song that you are syncing to is already running   StopWait behaves just like Stop     RelSynZn  Release Sync Zone     RelSynZn has the same settings available as SyncZone  see SyncZone  above   but RelSynZn  determines what the releasing  stopping  of the current riff will be synced to when a parameter  other than None is selected for RelSynTyp  see below      RelSynTyp  Release Sync Type     RelSynTyp has the same settings available as SyncType  see SyncType  above   but RelSynTyp  determines how the releasing  stopping  of the current riff will be synced to other riffs   arpeggiators  and Songs  depending on your settings made for the RelSynZn parameter   Wi
209. e 7 36    148 ArpOff Any Value turns Arpeggiator Off   See The ARPEGGIATOR  Page on page 7 36    149 MuteZn Mute Zone     values above 64 will mute the zone  values  below or equal to 64 will unmute the zone    150 ArpOrder Arpeggiator Order  each range of values selects one of nine  options in order on parameters list  0 14  15 28  29 42  43   56  57 70  71 84  85 98  99 112  113 127   See The  ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    151 ArpBeats Arpeggiator Beats  each range of values selects one of seven  options in order on parameters list  0 18  19 36  37 54  55   72  73 90  91 108  109 127   See The ARPEGGIATOR  Page on page 7 36    152 ArpShift The 88 Arpeggiator Shift steps are scaled over the 128 MIDI  controller values  so that O   O steps and 127   88 steps    See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    153 ArpLimit The 60 Arpeggiator Shift Limit steps are scaled over the 128  MIDI controller values  so that O   0 steps and 127   60  steps   See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    154 ArpLmtOp Arpeggiator Shift Limit Option  each range of values selects  one of seven options in order on parameters list  0 18  19 36   37 54  55 72  73 90  91 108  109 127   See The  ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    155 ArpVel Arpeggiator Velocity  each range of values selects one of  twenty three options in order on parameters list  0 5  6 10   11 15   101 105  106 110  111 127   SeeThe  ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    156 ArpDur The Arpeggiator Duration  values are scaled over the 128  MIDI
210. e Aux field  Use the Alpha Wheel or        buttons to change the aux effects chain and play some notes to hear the effect  You can also select  an effects chain by entering its ID  with the alphanumeric pad and pressing the Enter button  or  choose no effects chain by entering 0 with the alphanumeric pad and pressing the Enter button   Change the level of the aux effects chain by using knob 5  labeled Reverb   With knob 5 turned low   only a little of the sound processed by the effects chain will be blended in with the program  If you  turn knob 5 more than half way up  the majority of the program   s sound will be processed by the  aux effects chain     5  When you are satisfied with the selected effects chains and parameter settings  press the Exit button  to save the edited program and return to the Program mode main page  When prompted to save the  program  press the Yes soft button  followed by the Save soft button to save the program with the  same name under the lowest available user ID   To learn how to rename the program or save it  under a different ID   see Saving and Naming on page 5 3        14 6    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips    Change Knob  Switches  and Other Controller Assignments and Control Non Default  Parameters   In Program mode  the PC3LE s factory programs have synthesis and effects parameters assigned  to the PC3LE s knobs  switches and other controls by default  from the Program mode main  page  press the Info soft button at the bottom of the
211. e Copy function  except that the Grab function allows you to copy selected  data from tracks that exist in other songs in memory          En  Function   SrcsSond lo       DstTrack   ALL Events   Notes  Location    1 0101 106 Lokey  C  1 Hi  Mode   Merde Times  1 Lollel   Hi    MANR  From  1 i                     eksong       SrcSong  Song List    The Source Song parameter is set to the ID and name of the song in memory that contains the  desired track data you wish to grab in order to use it in the current song  The source track is  determined by the Track parameter displayed on upper right hand side of the page  selectable  with the Chan Zone buttons     DstTrack  1 to 16  All    Select a destination track for the grabbed events with the DstTrack parameter  All selected  events from the source song and track described in the Region   Criteria box will be placed in the  destination track s  at any bar  beat  and tick you specify     If the currently selected track is All tracks then the destination track will be All tracks as well     No matter what channel the current track  source track in the source song  is set to when you  use the grab function  the events will be played on the destination track   s channel     Location  Bars   Beats   Ticks    Specify a bar  beat  and tick location in the destination track where the grabbed data will be  placed with the Location parameter  If the length of the grabbed region extends from the  Location point beyond the song   s existing 
212. e Name  And Continuous Controller  Front Panel Name  Number And Name   Mod Wheel 1  MWheel   Pitchbend up 130  PitchUp   Pitchbend dn 131  PitchDwn   SW Pedal 1 64  Sustain   SW Pedal 2 66  Sostenut   CC Pedal 1 11  Express   Pressure 132  Pressure   Arp  Switch  Arp Enable  147  ArpOn   148  ArpOff   Arp  latch sw  Arp Latch  157  Latch   Knob 1  Timbre   Knob 2  Mod  14 15  MIDI14 15   Knob 3  Envelope   Knob 4  Effect   Knob 5  Reverb   Knob6  CTL6  16 19  CtlA D   Knob 7 15  CTL7 15  20 28  MIDI20 28   Switch 1 4  SW1 4  80 83  MIDI80 83   Switch 5 10  SW5 10  85 90  MIDI85 90        7 69    Setup Mode       The Control Setup       7 70    Quick Access Mode       Chapter 8  Quick Access Mode    In Quick Access mode  you can select programs or setups with a single press of an alphanumeric  button  or with other data entry methods   The PC3LE offers a number of ways to quickly make  selections while performing  but only Quick Access mode lets you store programs and setups  together for instant access  On the PC3LE  we included several factory preset QA banks that are  organized into useful groupings of sounds that we think you ll find convenient  Below is the QA  page        WAL Emersor Le Maroon SunBass HuhlClubsweet   WALDistlesd CC S4uareChirPLe Downes Lead   HewOrderPulse Fittu Fittu Le WAL Saw Lead  Hono Trekkies       WPose   yl    The top line of the page displays the current mode and the current QA bank     Using Quick Access mode involves selecting Quick Access  QA
213. e assignments set for each control  To  edit these assignments  see The PARAMETERS Page on page 6 9     The PC3LE   s five knobs can control up to 15 parameters per program  acting as 15 virtual knobs   Each of the five knobs can control 3 different parameters  and you can access three groups of five  parameters at a time  one for each knob at a time   Press the Shift button to the left of the knobs  to switch between lighting one of the LED   s for the three rows below the knobs  When a row s  LED is lit it indicates that one of the 3 sets of five parameters  if assigned  can currently be  controlled from the knobs     Each knob row represents 5 of the 15 virtual knob parameters  The top row  labeled Timbre   Reverb  represents knobs 1 5  the middle row  labeled CTL 6 10  represents knobs 6 10  and the  bottom row  labeled CTL 11 15  represents knobs 11 15  The top knob row has general  parameter names  indicating the parameter type generally assigned for each factory program   Press the Info soft button from the Program mode main page to see exactly what parameters are  being controlled  Knob 5  labeled Reverb  almost always controls the aux send level to a reverb  effect  sometimes it s a delay effect   KB3 organ programs conform to a different set of controller  assignments  see Real time Controls in KB3 Mode on page 6 6        6 1    Program Mode       The Program Mode Page    The Program Mode Page    o Sr aml        Jl  E Nv Jazz eyi  IE A    The top line of the Program
214. e current  ARPEGGIATOR ShiftPatt Bank   See The ARPEGGIATOR  Page on page 7 36    172 ShiftPBank Each increment of 7  0 6  7 13   112 127  selects one of the  17 ARPEGGIATOR ShiftPatt Banks   See The  ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    173 VelPatt Selects one of the 128 patterns in the current  ARPEGGIATOR VelPatt Bank   See The ARPEGGIATOR  Page on page 7 36    174 VelPBank Each range of seven values  0 6  7 13   112 127  selects one  of the 17 ARPEGGIATOR VelPatt Banks   See The  ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    175 VelFixed Set s arpeggiator velocity when ARPEGGIATOR velocity is  set to Fixed   See The ARPEGGIATOR Page on page 7 36    176 ShKeyNum Shift Key Number  see below  Shift Key Number  Shift Key   ShKeyNum  ShiftKey  on page 7 22    177 ShiftKey Shift Key  see below  Shift Key Number  Shift Key   ShKeyNum  ShiftKey  on page 7 22    178 ShKeyNuV Same as 176 ShKeyNum  but the Shift Pattern s velocity will  be modified by the current velocity pattern of the zone    Table 7 1 Controller Destination List  Continued        7 21    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Shift Key Number  Shift Key  ShKeyNum  ShiftKey     These controller destinations allow you to play musical scales and single note patterns on any  assignable continuous controller in a setup  without the need of playing the physical keys of the  keyboard  These destinations can be controlled by any continuous controller  a knob  expression  pedal  key pressure  etc  These features are especially useful for pl
215. e field  see above   For more  information on MIDI controllers  see the MIDI Controller Destination list on page 7 17     OffValue    The Off Value parameter sets the parameter or MIDI controller value that is sent when the  switch sends an off value  In the case of conventionally switched functions  such as sustain  the  Off Value should be set to 0 in order to have an affect     EntryState and ExitState    EntryState determines whether an initial setting for the switch will be sent when the setup is  selected  and what that initial setting will be  There are three choices  None  no setting is sent  when the setup is loaded   Off  the Off value is sent when the setup is loaded   and On  the On  value is sent when the setup is loaded      ExitState determines whether a setting for the switch will be sent when you leave the setup   either for another setup or for Program mode   and if so  what that setting will be  There are  three choices  None  no setting is sent when you leave the setup   Off  the Off Value is sent  when you leave the setup   and On  the On Value is sent when you leave the setup      Common Uses for EntryState and ExitState    For basic use  most users will want to set the EntryState to On or Off so that the switch is  always in the desired on or off state when the setup is selected        A setup that has an EntryState set to None is more suited for a live performance situation  For  example if you are using a switch to control a parameter that is common b
216. e mode functionality   e USB Storage port     USB Computer port   e FAT 32 file system compatibility    e Support for song files  sequences  in MIDI Type 0 and Type 1 format    Storage Mode Page    To enter Storage mode  press the Storage button  and the Storage mode page will appear        USE geige     USB PC connection     Format  USB Dro    In the center of the page you can select one of two storage destinations  USB device or USB PC  connection  These refer to a USB device which you can plug into the appropriate type of USB  port on the rear of the PC3LE  Using USB Devices below for details   When you select USB PC  connection  any USB MIDI connection will be temporarily disconnected  and will not be  restored until you select USB device or exit Storage mode        Use the cursor to select the destination that you wish to store your files to or load your files  from  The status of the selected destination will be displayed as either ready or you will see a     No connection    message  The top right hand corner of the page displays the currently selected  storage destination  If you are having trouble selecting a device that you have plugged in  try  exiting Storage mode and then entering Storage mode again     The currently selected device will be read from or written to when you load  save  rename  or  delete files  Use the soft buttons to start any of these operations  Here is a brief description of  each of Storage mode   s soft buttons     Store Save objects or grou
217. e of 0     Use the chan up down buttons to change the direction in which pattern steps are played   indicated by Up  Down  or Flat on the right of the top line   With pattern direction set to Up  the  pattern plays as expected  starting at step one and moving up through each step towards step  48  With pattern direction set to Down  the pattern starts at step one  but then moves to the last  step and continues to move backwards through the steps down towards step 1  Additionally   patterns set to Down base all notes after step one in the octave below the first note played  These  settings are most useful for arpeggiating chord patterns upwards or downwards from the root  note  Patterns set to Flat will not repeat in other octaves like those set to Up or Down   depending on the Limit parameter   Patterns set to Flat play without transposition  the Limit  parameter will not transpose the pattern but it can still restrict note range     AUE mie           Ster  Rename    Press Delete to delete the pattern from memory  Press Rename to rename the pattern and save   Pressing Save gives you the option to save the pattern or rename and save  To create a new  ShiftPatt  edit an existing pattern and choose Rename when saving  Press Exit to return to the  ARPEGGIATOR page  When exiting the editor  it will automatically give you the option to save  the pattern if changes have been made  For more detailed instructions on these functions  see  Saving and Naming on page 5 3           7 42   
218. e of two alternating note maps  set Note Map to 1 of 2  now the zone plays    on every second key  starting on C  but won t play on any other keys  Set another zone to 2 of 2   and this zone will play on every second key  starting on C   thus covering the remaining keys     Three  and four zone alternating notemaps work the same way  but cause each zone to play only  on every third and every fourth key  respectively     Note maps are also used to create drum patterns with the arpeggiator  Several of the included  factory setups use this feature        7 27    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Velocity Scale  VelScale     MIDI Velocity    127 rocco    64    This lets you amplify or diminish velocity response  Normal response is 100   Higher values  make the keyboard more sensitive  you don   t need to play as hard to get higher MIDI velocities   while lower values make it less sensitive  playing harder doesn   t change MIDI velocity as  much   You can also set the scale to a negative number  in which case the velocity response is  turned upside down  playing harder produces a softer sound and vice versa  This is useful for  creating velocity based crossfades between zones  See the following section on Velocity Offset  for ideas about negative scaling     The following illustration shows what happens when you change Velocity Scale  Note that  Velocity Scale is the only parameter changed in this example  the other parameters are set to  their defaults  offset   0  curve   lin
219. e present appareil numerique n emet pas de bruits radioelectriques  depassant les limites applicables aux appareils numeriques de la  class B prescrites dans le Reglement sur le brouillage radioelectrique  edicte par le ministere des Communications du Canada     SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS    Important Safety Instructions    1  Read these instructions   2  Keep these instructions    3  Heed all warnings    4  Follow all instructions    5  Do not use this apparatus near water   6  Clean only with dry cloth     7  Do not block any of the ventilation openings  Install in accordance with the manufacturer   s  instructions     8  Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators  heat registers  stoves  or other appara   tus  including amplifiers  that produce heat     9  Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding type plug  A polarized plug  has two blades with one wider than the other  A grounding type plug has two blades and a  third grounding prong  The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety  If the  provided plug does not fit into your outlet  consult an electrician for replacement of the obso   lete outlet     10  Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched  particularly at plugs  convenience  receptacles  and the point where they exit from the apparatus     11  Only use attachments   accessories specified by the manufacturer   12  Use only with a cart  stand  tripod  bracket  or table specified by the man   ufacturer  or s
220. e riff would play using the program from zone 4 instead of zone 2     When Re Channel is set to On and ALL is selected for SrcTrack  all of the tracks of the sequence  will play through the MIDI channel of the current zone     Note  Track numbers don   t have to match MIDI channel numbers in Song mode  though they do  by default   A song that uses non default MIDI channels for its tracks can cause some confusion  when using it as a riff  For example  using a riff on zone 1  you could set the riff   s SrcTrack  parameter to 1  and expect the riff to play on zone 1  if it is set to MIDI channel 1   But in Song  mode  if the song you are using for the riff has track 1 set to a MIDI channel other than 1  the riff  will play on the zone that has that track   s matching MIDI channel  In this case  set Re Channel to  On in order for the riff to play through the program of the riff   s zone        7 53    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The RIFF2 Page    The second Riff page appears as shown below  and has the following parameters             MACAO   SsuncTupe   Relsundn    FPelSyn Tye Horn               Fath Avail   ee logs  Uel  141                                                           Parameter Range of Values Default     HiKey  C  1 to G9 C  1  Trigger   LoKey  C  1 to G9 G9   HiKey  C  1 to G9 C  1  Release   LoKey  C  1 to G9 G9  CondRel Off  On Off  Local Off  On Off  Loop Once  Forever Forever  BPM Sequence  Setup  External  20 to 400 Sequence  Sync Zone First Avail 
221. e the  pads available to play drum programs  To trigger riffs from the assignable switches  go to the  Setup Editor Controllers page for the zone containing the riff you wish to trigger  Next  select a  switch  such as switch 2 for the Controller field  this can be done by selecting the Controller  field  holding the Enter button and pressing the desired switch   Then  with DestType set to  Ctrl  set the OnControl and OffControl fields to 163 and 164  RiffOn and RiffOff  Lastly  in  some cases you would need to disable any switches that you are using that are already assigned  to other functions in other zones  For example  by default when a zone is created it assigns  switch 1 to mute that zone  for example  when you created zone 6 in this tutorial  switch 1 was  set to mute keyboard playback of zone 6 automatically on zone 6   s Controllers page   Also   many factory setups use the setup MUTES soft button which automatically assigns each switch  to mute its corresponding zone  see Set Controls Zone Mutes  MUTES  on page 7 65   So using  switches 1 and 2 to trigger riffs on zones 4 and 5 would require setting the OnControl and  OffControl fields to OFF for switch 1 on zone 1 and switch 2 on zone 2  do this by entering 0  then pressing Enter on the alphanumeric pad for each of these fields   Doing this would ensure  that zones 1 and 2 wont be muted when using switches 1 and 2  You could try repeating this  tutorial and changing all the riffs to be triggered by the assignable 
222. e the dynamics of    your playing  by having more sounds come in as you play louder  and having sounds drop out when you  play more quietly     1  If you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Next  press 58 and then Enter on the alphanumeric  pad to select the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  see below   You can also select setups by using the        buttons or e Wheel        S   Techno Substance  57 Pad 2 Then Pad 1    cs Piano  59 ape    on Black Low       lit  IHE CHEI ai ou            2  With the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad selected in setup mode  press the Edit button on the front panel   This will bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below         Programe  Channel  Ji i   MidiBank  E EomkHode   Ctl b 32  MidiProge 1   EntreyProgChd 1 On  Status  Active ArPeddistor  Orn    y more  CH PEG          Step3    A    3  From the CH PROG page press the KEYVEL soft button  see above   This will bring you to the  KEYVEL page for the current Zone        13 30    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Switch Between Zones Based On Played Keyboard Velocity    4  On the KEYVEL page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2  see  below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen       OPE i       Loke   e ranspose  BST  Hik e s   
223. e their values  data entry   If  the value of the selected parameter has its own editing page  like when selecting programs in  Setup mode   pressing the Edit button will take you to that page     The Exit Button    Press Exit  located to the right of the display  to leave the current editor  If you   ve changed the  value of any parameter while in that editor  the PC3LE will ask you whether you want to save  your changes before you can leave the editor  See Chapter 5 for information on saving and  naming  The Exit button also takes you to Program mode if you re on the entry level page of one  of the other modes  If at some point you can   t seem to get where you want to go  press Exit one  or more times to return to Program mode  then try again        3 8    User Interface Basics       Data Entry    Data Entry    The data entry section of the front panel includes the Alpha wheel  the     buttons  and the  alphanumeric pad  the Shift functions of the Category buttons      The Alpha Wheel    The Alpha Wheel  see below  is located to the right of the display  It is useful to quickly enter  large or small changes in value  If you turn the Alpha Wheel one click to the right  you ll  increase the value of the currently selected parameter by one increment  One click to the left  decreases the value by one increment  If you turn it rapidly  you   1l jump by several increments   You can also use the Alpha Wheel to enter names when you re saving objects     O           The      Button
224. e to the program   Press Exit  again  and you ll leave the Setup Editor  returning to the Setup mode page        4 1    The Operating Modes       Using the Modes    The following table lists the procedures for moving between modes and editors  Note that the  Exit button won t always take you where the table says it will  it often depends on how you got  where you are  The table assumes that you ve entered a given editor via its corresponding mode   You ll always return to Program mode eventually if you press Exit repeatedly     Current Mode   Editor Status    Available Modes     Editors How to Get There                   Any mode All other modes Press corresponding mode button  Program mode Program Editor Press Edit  Program Editor Program mode Press Exit  Setup mode Setup Editor Press Edit  Setup mode Press Exit       Setup Editor    On CH PRG page  select Program parameter  press Edit    Press Edit  Press Exit    Program Editor  Quick Access Editor       Quick Access mode  Quick Access Editor       Quick Access mode  Song Editor  Program Editor       Select CurSong parameter  press Edit       Song mode    Select Program parameter  press Edit       Most editors Previous mode or editor Press Exit          Finding Square One    If at any time you don   t know where you are  and the mode LEDs are all unlit  press Exit one or  more times  This will return you to the entry level of whatever mode you were in  and if you  press Exit enough times  you will always return to Program m
225. ear  min   1  max   127      Velocity Scale  100       as you strike the keys harder  increase the    velocity  MIDI velocity increases proportionally                Velocity Scale  200        MIDI velocity reaches maximum on    medium strike velocity    j KE a O oe Velocity Scale  50       ge MIDI velocity never reaches maximum  even on       maximum strike velocity       127    64  Strike Velocity       7 28    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Velocity Offset  VelOffset     VelOffset also changes the response  but in a more direct way  by adding or subtracting a  constant to the key velocity  For example  if this is set to 25  assuming a scale of 100    then 25 is  added to the velocity of every keystroke  usually making the sound that much louder  The  softest possible keystroke will have a value of 25  while a keystroke with velocity of 102 will  produce the same sound as a note with velocity 127  102 25 127   Negative values diminish the  response  a setting of  25 means the loudest velocity available will be 102  while any keystroke  25 or below will produce a velocity of 1  a velocity value of zero has a special meaning in MIDI  and cannot be used for Note Ons      You can think of Scale as being a proportional change to the velocity  while Offset is a linear  change  The maximum values for Offset are  127  The following illustration shows the effects of  Velocity Offset  Note that Velocity Offset is the only parameter changed in this example  the  other parameters
226. ears as shown below        Select  Choose which objects will be stored     SMALL Store all user objects     Cancel       At the top right of the page  the display shows how much memory is available in the current  storage device  Press one of the Store page   s three soft buttons  Below is a description of the  function of each soft button     Select Allows you to select specific user objects to store  see The Store Advanced Page below  for details    SvAll Saves all user objects    Cancel Exits the Store page and returns you to the Storage mode page     You cannot store ROM objects  If you wish to store a ROM object  such as a program  you must  first save itinternally as a user RAM program  When one or more objects are saved  the PC3LE  saves a file with a   PLE  extension  This enables the PC3LE to recognize it as a Kurzweil file  when it examines the directory  Note that although  PLE files are    collections    of objects  you  can load individual objects if you want to  See Loading Individual Objects on page 11 6     The Store Advanced Page    Pressing the Advnce soft button calls up the Store Advanced page  on which every user defined  object   as well as its object type   on the PC3LE is displayed and selectable for storage  On this  page  you can select and store objects individually  The objects are organized by numerical ID  and object type    There are five soft buttons on the Store Advanced page     Select Select the highlighted object  An asterix     appears bet
227. eceived via MIDI     Interface with the PC3LE   s USB ports to load and save programs  setups   and transfer software updates        3 1    User Interface Basics       Mode Buttons    The PC3LE s tone wheel organ emulation is called KB3 mode  You automatically enter this  mode when you select a KB3 program  You can find KB3 programs by pressing the Organ  category button while in Program mode  The programs that use KB3 mode will light the KB3  LED to the left of the knobs  indicating that the PC3LE   s knobs and switches are now dedicated  to the organ controls that are labeled on the front panel     Mode Buttons    Program    Q Access Master Storage  FX Bypass Compare       When you press a mode button  its LED lights up to indicate that the mode has been selected  If  pressing a mode button does not light its LED  press the Exit button one or more times  then try  again     Assignable Controls    KB3 O ASSIGNABLE CONTROLS  Timbre Envelope Effect Reverb    16 5 1 3 8 4 22 3    O  O CTL6 CTL7 CTL8 CTL9 CTL10  2 13 5  11 3  T Swell  fo   CTL11 CTL12 CTL13 CTL14 CTL15   The PC3LE s Assignable Controls  see above  are the five knobs on the left of the front panel   Each of the five Assignable Controls can control three separate functions independently  giving  you access to knob control of 15 parameters  Use the Shift button to the left of these knob  controls to toggle between accessing controls 1 5  Timbre Reverb   CTL 6 10  or CTL 11 15   Pressing this Shift button will light
228. ed  before starting  see   Loop on page 7 55 for looping riffs  and Loop on page 10 11 for looping songs   This way you can  trigger the riff to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the start of the playing riff or  song   s loop     With SyncType set to Stop  if there is already something playing to sync to  the current riff will  wait for what is playing to stop before starting  This way you can trigger the riff to start ahead of  time  and have it start in sync at the release  stopping  of the riff  arpeggiator  or song that you  are syncing to     With SyncType set to StartWait  if there is nothing playing to sync to  the current riff will wait  for something it can sync to to begin playing first before starting  This is similar to  DownBeatWait  but it will only trigger the riff the first time that whatever it is syncing to starts   This way you can trigger the riff to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the start of the  riff  arpeggiator  or song that you are syncing to  If you stop the riff and try to start it again while  the thing you are syncing to is already playing  StartWait will not start the riff     With SyncType set to LoopWait  if there is already a riff or song playing to sync to  the current  riff will wait for the playing riff or song to restart its loop  if it is looped  before starting  see  Loop on page 7 55 for looping riffs  and Loop on page 10 11 for looping songs   This way you can  trigger the riff to start ahead of tim
229. ed song in Song mode  You can also set the tempo  using the tap tempo button  located on the front panel below the Mode buttons   Tap the Tap  Tempo button on beat for a measure or two at the desired tempo to set a tempo  This also brings  up the Tap Tempo page  see Tap Tempo Button on page 7 4      Clock Source    With the Clock Source parameter  you can set the PC3LE   within the current setup   to generate  its own tempo by setting Clock Source to Internal  or you can set the PC3LE to sync up with the  tempo from another device   assuming the device is sending MIDI clock data to the PC3LE via  MIDI or USB   by setting Clock Source to External  When Clock Source is set to External  the  Tempo parameter disappears from the display     Arpeggiator Global  ArpGlobal     With the ArpGlobal parameter  you can set each zone   s Arpeggiator to act as if they all have the  same parameters on the ARPEGGIATOR page  In addition to OFF  there are as many ArpGlobal  settings as there are zones in the current setup  For example  in a seven zone setup  you can  select a value of OFF  or Arp 1 7 for ArpGlobal  The number of the ArpGlobal setting indicates  which zone   s Arpeggiator is being globalized  Thus  in this same seven zone setup  with  ArpGlobal set to Arp 4  all seven zones will behave as specified by the ARPEGGIATOR page  parameters for zone 4        7 49    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Arpeggiator Sync  ArpSync     Setting ArpSync to Sync Mode allows you to arpeggiate 
230. effects chains at once  an insert effect and an aux  effect  see The EFFECTS  FX  Page on page 6 13 for more details   Almost all of the PC3LE   s  factory programs use a reverb or delay effects chain as the Aux effect  and the level of the effect can  be controlled by knob 5  labeled Reverb  by default  The PC3LE   s factory programs use a variety  of effects chain types for the insert effect  ranging from subtle effects to those that drastically  change the program   s sound     3  On the EditProg FX page  the Insert field will be selected  Use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to  change the insert effects chain and play some notes to hear the effect  You can also select an effects  chain by entering its ID  with the alphanumeric pad and pressing the Enter button  or choose no  effects chain by entering 0 with the alphanumeric pad and pressing the Enter button  Some insert  effects chains may require you to turn up a parameter in order to hear the effect  Most effect  parameters are automatically assigned to knobs  You can view and change parameter assignments  and values on the PARAMETERS page by pressing the PARAMS soft button at the bottom of the  display  see The PARAMETERS Page on page 6 9 for details      4  If changing the insert effects chain changes the program   s sound too drastically  try returning it to  the program   s original chain and change the aux effect instead  To change the aux effects chain  on  the EditProg FX page use the cursor buttons to select th
231. effects chains so that different effects can be applied to  different parts of the drum kit  One insert chain may only apply to a group of the program   s kick  drum samples  another may only apply to certain snare drum samples  and one may apply to  the whole program  The number of insert chains and their configuration depends on the  program  When more than one insert is being used  the total number of inserts being used will  be displayed on the top line of the EFFECTS page  for an example see program 373  EpicRemixDrums   To view or change the additional insert effects chains  use the cursor buttons  to select the 1 field to the left of the current insert chain name  With this field selected use the  Alpha Wheel or      buttons to see the other insert effects chains  whose names will appear in  the field to the right  You can also use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to change  the insert number being viewed  The insert   s chain name will usually give you a clue about  which samples it applies to  for example  an insert chain with    snare    in the name will usually  apply to some of the snare samples   To check which samples the current insert chain applies to   you could play a key or group of keys while changing the insert chain  When the current insert  chain applies to a sample  you should be able to hear the sound of the sample changing as you  change the insert chain     Aux    Choose an Aux effect that will be applied to the auxiliary audio bus  
232. efore reaching the transmit Velmap     The default map  Linear  allows MIDI velocities to pass unchanged  Maps Light 1 3 make it  increasingly easier to produce high MIDI velocity values for the same key strike velocity  with  Light 3 being the easiest   so these maps may work better for users who play with a lighter  touch  Hard 1 3 make it increasingly harder to produce high MIDI velocity values for the same  key strike velocity  with Hard 3 being the hardest   so these maps may work better for users  who play with a harder touch  Piano Touch simulates the general velocity response of an  acoustic piano  and is best suited for playing acoustic piano sounds  Easy Touch is similar to the  Light settings  making high velocities easier to play  but it allows more sensitive control over  playing high velocities by not boosting the MIDI velocity for fast strike velocities as much as it  does for medium strike velocities  GM Receive mimics the velocity map commonly used by  keyboards that use the General MIDI  GM  sound set  The GM Receive map makes medium  strike velocities produce higher MIDI velocities compared to the Linear map        9 13    Master Mode       MIDI Transmit  XMIT     Pressure Map  Transmit     Change the Transmit Pressure Map setting if you are triggering external MIDI gear which is  producing MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values that are too high or too low based on your playing  style  how soft or hard that you press the keys   The default map provides the wide
233. egory buttons to select a grouping of PC3LE programs by instrument type  Press the  All Category button to list all programs regardless of type  The Category buttons also double as  an alphanumeric pad  See Data Entry  below      CATEGORY       Piano E Piano Clavier Organ       Leads Pads Synth Syn Bass  Strings Brass Winds Ensemble    Guitar Bass Drums Percussion     J J    Voices Mallets Hybrid Misc    a    Al    Picking Favorites    You can select a favorite program within each category that will be automatically recalled when  you choose that category  To do this  first select a category by pressing one of the Category  buttons while in Program mode  make sure the category Shift button is not lit   Next  find your  favorite program in that category by using the Alpha wheel       buttons  or up down cursor  buttons   Alternatively  you can find the program by pressing the category Shift button and  using the numbered category buttons to enter the program s ID number  then press the category  Enter button  If you use this method  make sure to unlight the category shift button by pressing  it again after making your selection   Lastly  hold the category button that you wish to save a  favorite for for a few seconds  The next time you choose that category  your favorite will be  selected        User Interface Basics  Pitch Wheel and Mod Wheel       Pitch Wheel and Mod Wheel    Arp Enable Arp Latch    Pitch Mod    To the left of the PC3LE   s keyboard are the Pitch Wheel and t
234. either a physical controller or MIDI  CC number  which that parameter is controlled by  For each parameter selected  the right top  line of the page displays what type of parameter it is  The three parameter types are Prog  either  one of the 5 basic parameters  or a parameter specific to the program   FXAux1  a parameter for  the program   s current Aux FX chain   or FXInsert1  a parameter for the program   s current Insert  FX chain  Drum programs may have more than 1 insert effects chain      If you stop hearing sound from programs on one MIDI channel  or if programs only play  from the left or right speaker for a MIDI channel  it may be because of changes you ve made  on the Parameters page  even if you haven t saved a program  See the notes below for  explanations and solutions     Parameters    Use the cursor buttons to select a parameter in the left column  and use the Alpha Wheel       buttons  or cursor up down buttons to scroll through parameters in that column  All programs  have at least these five basic parameters  Pan  Expression  program volume   Aux FX1 Wet   Dry   Sustain  and Sostenuto  The parameters column will also display any available VAST synthesis  parameters for the current program and parameters for the current program   s insert and aux  effects  if effects are in use    All available parameters are listed  see A Note About Processor Power  Allocation on page 6 13 for details on parameters labeled Not Available        6 9    Program Mode       The 
235. elow is the state of the PC3LE event pool with 0  New Song    selected   and no other user objects loaded in any other modes          P   B   T      ia     11   13  1 15    4  a  h nore  RecFlt  PluFlt MERA    The events in the PC3LE are similar to events of other sequencers with a single major difference   the Note events are stored as a single big event  i e   one PC3LE Note event is comprised of the  note on and note off events  All other events are stored as single events on the PC3LE     The fields on the STATS page are    e Max  the maximum number of notes   events in memory      Used   the total number of notes  events being used    e Free     the number of notes  events that are free    e Part      the number of partitioned events  which are events for which space in memory is    allocated  This is technical information of importance only to engineers  and maybe a few  power users         10 18    Song Mode and the Song Editor       The Song Editor      Song  the total number of events  including notes  in the current song     e Temp  the total number of events in the temp buffer  the temp buffer is used when  grabbing events from a different song      e Riffs 1 16     the total number of events in each riff     The Song Editor    In general  you ll get to the Song editor pages by pressing the Edit button any time you re in  Song mode  There s one exception  if the Program parameter is currently highlighted on the  display  you ll enter the Program editor when you pre
236. es polyphonic key pressure events to be recorded   played back     The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons    These soft buttons function as described in The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons on page 10 7        10 16    Song Mode and the Song Editor  Song Mode  The MISC Page       The Done Soft Button    If no changes were made in the RECFLT  PLYFLT page  pressing the Done soft button calls up  the MAIN page  If changes were made  pressing the Done soft button calls up the    Save  Changes    dialog     Song Mode  The MISC Page    The MISC page contains five miscellaneous  but very important and useful  sequencer  parameters  The MISC page appears below         Grid 21 5  Swing Hz  keleaze   Ho    Rec  Play E                         Parameter Range of Values Default  Control Chase On  Off On  Quantize Off  1 to 100  Off  Grid Resolution 1 1 to 1 480 1 8  Swing  100  to 125  0  Release Quantization Yes  No No   Key Wait Off  On Off       Control Chase    A common shortcoming of many older sequencers is that when you start a sequence at some  point in the middle of sequence  the controllers remain at their current levels until the sequencer  comes across a controller event  Control Chase remedies this  generally  undesired behavior     When Control Chase is On  all non note MIDI events from the beginning of the song up to the  current time are computed  and the most recent non note MIDI event is sent out before starting  playback  This ensures that the volume  panning  program cha
237. ess the Back soft button to return to the previous  screen        B  2             Use the     buttons  up and down cursor buttons or the Alpha Wheel to choose a file from the  file list displayed on the screen  The asterisk on the left side points to the file selected  If there are  subdirectories on the device  you can use the soft buttons labeled DOWN and UP to navigate  through them  When you ve selected the file you want to install  press the soft button labeled  OK to perform the installation  Press the CANCEL soft button to return to the previous screen     If you have updated an image but wish to return to the earlier version  you can use the  RESTORE OLDER feature in the UPDATE IMAGE menu  You will again be asked to choose the  image to restore  Note that only one version of the previously installed image is available to be  restored  If you ve restored once  another restore will bring back the most recently updated  version     Run Diags    This program runs specific hardware checks on PC3LE systems  Most of the time you won t  need to run the diagnostics  but if you re having some problems with the instrument it may be  helpful to perform these interactive tests when contacting Kurzweil support     To exit the diagnostic program  press the EXIT button  You will return to the main Bootloader  menu     System Reset    If you ve made many complex updates to your objects and have saved a number of files off to  external storage  you might want to restore the instrument
238. essages from the pitch wheel  This way the pitch of these layered  zones will bend simultaneously when using the pitch wheel  But say for example that you also  have a zone three with a different key range than zones one and two  but which sends the same  messages from the pitch wheel  While playing and recording your setup  the function of the  pitch wheel will be obvious  but some confusion can arise when you have recorded your setup  and you proceed to record more tracks in Song mode  Because you have recorded with Mult  selected for RecTrk  the track for zone three will have pitch bend messages recorded wherever  zones one and two have bend messages  even if zone three was not playing any notes at that  time  For example  lets say zones one and two were bending during bar 1  If you want to  separately record zone three during bars 1 and 2  you will probably want to delete the existing  bend messages from zone three   s track  You can do this from the EditSong  Track page  see Song  Editor  The TRACK Page on page 10 21  and an example of its use in the Mono Pressure section  above    Alternatively  if there is nothing to preserve on the track for zone three  you can record it with  the song Mode parameter set to Erase  which will erase any existing events on the track during  the time that you record  Just remember to change the RecTrk parameter in order to record to a  single track        7 67    Setup Mode       The Control Setup    The Control Setup    The control setup
239. et the Metron parameter back to Rec so that you will only hear the metronome during recording   see below   When finished  press the BIG soft button again to return to the Song mode MAIN    page       E a  STOPPED          Time a i     a Loop  Se  ime Out  21  unch g  Song End  1 1110 Metro    pare  BIG  Load  Save JExekort  more d    Part 3  Record Your First Track  Save The Song    1  On the Song mode MAIN page  use the Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to  choose the track you wish to record to  The track number is displayed in the RecTrk field   see below   Let s begin by recording to track 1 to which we have assigned a piano program     rad Seek  Cursh TemPo  106 4    LIFE  Prog dard Grand Locat  1 il         RecTr SL  357 Panied Mode  Merde    Track if    de  Ble those sue rene ore A          12 4    Tutorial  Song Mode       2  Press the Record button located on the front panel  This prepares the PC3LE for recording on the  current RecTrk  The Record button lights  and on the Song mode MAIN page the right of the top  line will display REC  READY  which means that the sequencer will record when the Play Pause  button is pressed  see below        nr EEE   Curro Son Po tee   RecTrk  Mol   357 Pan  6 4 Mode  Herse  Frog  andard Grand Locat  1 il             Track TR enne a a a  Pare  Eio Load  save  Export   mares  3  Press the Play Pause button located on the front panel  The metronome will play for 1 bar and then    recording will begin  see the Song mode ch
240. etween multiple  setups you are using  like a switch set in multiple setups to turn reverb on and off   you can set  the EntryState to None  so that the state of the reverb  on or off  remains the same when you  switch to another setup  In this situation  you would want your setups that use the same switch  for reverb to have an ExitState set to None  For these setups  an ExitState of On or Off could be  used for special situations in which you know you will want to switch the reverb on or off when  you choose another setup        7 14    Setup Mode       Pads    The Setup Editor    You can assign each of the 8 pads to a different note  chord  MIDI controller destination   program parameter or Riff  First  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select  the desired zone that you wish to assign a pad to  Next  use the cursor buttons to select the  Control field  and select a pad by holding the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and pressing  the desired pad  With the Controller field selected you can also select the desired pad by using  the Alpha Wheel or     buttons  Next  use the cursor buttons to move to the Type field and  select one of the options with the Alpha Wheel or     buttons  In the Type field  select Note to  assign a note  Chord to assign a chord  Switch to assign a MIDI continuous controller  destination or program parameter  or Riff to assign a Riff  Lastly  use the Zone field to set the  desired zone that you wish to control with the curren
241. except for the 0 button      When you    re ready to create your own Quick Access banks  turn to Chapter 8 to learn about the  Quick Access Editor        2 8    Startup  The Other Modes       The Other Modes    There are three other mode buttons on the front panel  See Chapters 3 and 4 for more detailed  descriptions of the modes     Master mode Define performance and control settings  Configure the PC3LE for  sending and receiving MIDI information    Song mode Record and edit sequences  songs   play Type 0 and Type 1 MIDI  sequences    Storage mode Load and save programs  setups  sequences  and other objects via USB     Software Upgrades    It   s easy to upgrade the PC3LE s operating system and objects  programs  setup  etc   using the  boot loader to install upgrades into flash ROM  When upgrades are available you can download  them from www kurzweil com and install them via one of the PC3LE s two USB ports     As upgraded software becomes available  you can either get files from your Young Chang dealer  or download the new stuff from the Web     To stay in touch  check out our Web site   www kurzweil com    When you ve acquired an upgrade  you can install it yourself in a matter of minutes  Use the  Boot Loader  as described in Appendix B        2 9    Startup       Software Upgrades       2 10    User Interface Basics       Chapter 3    Mode Selection    User Interface Basics    This chapter will show you how to get around the front panel of your PC3LE  Your interactions
242. external sequencer  you will run into the same  issue when using the transport on the external sequencer  if it is sending MMC   In this case   either turn off outgoing MMC on the external sequencer  or use the same precautions as above     The Load  Save  and Export Soft Buttons    The Load soft button calls up a scrolling list from which you can quickly locate and load a  sequence  You can select a sequence using either the Alpha Wheel or     buttons  or you can  enter a sequence   s ID number     The Save button calls up the    Save As    dialog     The Export button exports the current song to a Computer or USB device as a Standard MIDI  File  Select Standard MIDI File type 1  saves with multiple channels   or Standard MIDI File type  0  saves as 1 channel      The NewSng and CirSng  and Delete Soft Buttons    The NewSng soft button creates a new song using the Default Sequence  specified on Page 2 of  Master Mode  as a parameter template  Pressing this button is the same as selecting 0 New  Song        The ClrSng soft button creates a new song whose parameters are set to the default values listed  in the table beneath this section   s header  Song Mode  The MAIN Page   Keep in mind that the  selected program for the new song will be the currently selected program     Use the Delete soft button to delete a user created or edited song  Pressing the Delete soft  button prompts you to continue by pressing Delete or to return to the previous screen by  pressing Cancel        
243. ey A ane    Pre  YY Post 1  Rs ge  Y              Send Levels      O       O  Program      Insert    Chain  ZONE TRACK2 E     L  LI  J  1 Pre  Y  Post    LJ a  O    fer    one    Send Levels      7   O     gt           Output       When using effects  the first decision to make is whether you want to use an Insert or Aux effect   see the Insert Effects and Aux Effects sections above   If you are using both types of effects for a  zone  or track in Song Mode   you can choose to have your signal sent to the Aux effects before  or after being processed by the Insert effects  When your signal is sent to the Aux Effects after  being processed by the Program   s Insert Effects  this is called applying the Aux Effect post   Insert  When your signal is sent to the Aux Effects before being processed by the Program   s Insert  Effects  this is called applying the Aux Effect pre Insert     When an Aux Effect is applied post Insert  the wet  processed  Aux signal has a series of effects  applied to it   i e   cascaded effects  This means that the signal that is blended back in from the  result of the Aux Effect will also contain the result of the Insert Effect     When an Aux Effect is applied pre Insert  the wet Aux signal has no Insert effect applied to it   and the final output has parallel effects   i e   distinct effects  This means that the signal that is  blended back in from the result of the Aux Effect will not contain the result of the Insert Effect        7 61    Setup Mode   
244. f the display  to move to zone 1  The  currently selected zone number can be viewed in the top right corner of the display  Use one of the  more soft buttons at the bottom of the display to find the RIFF1 soft button  then press the RIFF1  soft button  This brings you to the RIFF1 page for zone 1  Use the cursor buttons to select the Sre  Track field  then press the minus button  below the Alpha Wheel  to select ALL  see below   This  setting makes zone 1   s riff  riff 1  play all of the tracks from the song 428 H Fact Sng  Try pressing    pad 1 to play riff 1  and you will hear the entire song 428 H Fact Sng play  Press pad 1 again to  stop the riff before continuing         Son Sa H F act Sr  Start  1 1 38 SroTrack  i  J a   Re Channel      Stops  TI A    more 3        O an an    TransPose    How does riff 1 play the entire song  Since each track of the song is assigned to MIDI channels 1   4  in Song mode   each track is still played by the zone assigned to that MIDI channel  So even  though zone 1   s riff is now playing sequence information from all tracks of the original song   each track is still played by a separate instrument program on zones 1 4     8  Lastly  lets make riff two play all tracks of the same song  but we will have it play the song from a  different point than riff 1  This is meant to demonstrate how you would set up riffs to play different  sections of a song  though the song 428 H Fact Sng is only 4 bars long  so it is only useful as an  example in 
245. f there is already a riff or song playing to sync to  the current  riff will wait for the playing riff or song to restart its loop  if it is looped  before stopping  see  Loop on page 7 55 for looping riffs  and Loop on page 10 11 for looping songs   This way you can  trigger the riff to stop ahead of time  and have it stop in sync at the start of the playing riff or  song   s loop  The difference from Loop is that if there is nothing playing to sync to  the riff will  not stop when released  If the riff or song that you are syncing to is already running  LoopWait  behaves just like Loop     With RelSynTyp set to Stop Wait  if there is already something playing to sync to  the current riff  will wait for what is playing to stop before releasing  This way you can trigger the riff to stop  ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the release  stopping  of the riff  arpeggiator  or song  that you are syncing to  The difference from Stop is that if there is nothing playing to sync to  the  riff will not stop when released  If the riff or song that you are syncing to is already running   StopWait behaves just like Stop     Note  For all RelSynTyp settings except Stop  StartWait and StopWait  a riff can sync its release  with its self  For example  you could use riff 1 and sync it to its self by setting Riff 1 for the  RelSynZn parameter  Then  if you set DownBeat for the RelSynTyp parameter  when released  the riff would always wait until its next downbeat to stop     Duration 
246. fety purpose of the plug     11  The power supply cord of the product should be unplugged from the  outlet when left unused for a long period of time  When unplugging  the power supply cord  do not pull on the cord  but grasp it by the  plug    12  Care should be taken so that objects do not fall and liquids are not  spilled into the enclosure through openings    13  The product should be serviced by qualified service personnel  when    A  The power supply cord or the plug has been damaged    B  Objects have fallen  or liquid has been spilled into the product    C  The product has been exposed to rain    D  The product does not appear to be operating normally or  exhibits a marked change in performance    E  The product has been dropped  or the enclosure damaged    14  Do not attempt to service the product beyond that described in the  user maintenance instructions  All other servicing should be  referred to qualified service personnel    15  WARNING  Do not place objects on the product s power supply  cord  or place the product in a position where anyone could trip  over  walk on  or roll anything over cords of any type  Do not allow  the product to rest on or be installed over cords of any type     Improper installations of this type create the possibility of a fire  hazard and or personal injury     RADIO AND TELEVISION INTERFERENCE    WARNING  Changes or modifications to this instrument not expressly  approved by Young Chang could void your authority to operate the  instr
247. ff is set to loop forever  the default  setting   With the left most Stop field selected  press 9 and then the Enter button on the  alphanumeric pad to select 9 for the Stop field bars value  see below   Now the horn riff should loop  with no gaps     ea   Badl         Src Track  El Re Channel    CH EROYCTRLS  SEANUOLIREYUEL    At this point you may want to adjust the volume of the horns program on the PAN VOL page   an EntryVolume of 100 may be a more comfortable volume for the horns riff   You can also see  how the riff sounds with different programs by selecting different programs on the CH PROG    page        19  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this  chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor     You may wish to disable some controls for zones that play riffs  For example  the zone with our  horn riff responds to the sustain pedal  but this doesn   t sound good when we are using the  sustain pedal for the zone with the piano program  To disable the sustain pedal for zone 6  go to  the Controllers page for zone 6  select SW Pedal 1 for the Controller field and select None for the  OnControl and OffControl fields     There are many possible ways to use riffs in a setup  For example instead of triggering riffs from  the PC3LE   s pads you could trigger riffs from the assignable switches  This would leav
248. for other programs  If a chain is  selected for the Insert and or Aux effect  but there are not enough DSP units available to load  the chain s   the parameters for that chain or chains will be displayed as Not available on the  PARAMETERS page  see page 6 9 for details on the PARAMETERS page         6 13    Program Mode       The Program Editor    In Program mode  since you can play up to 16 programs  one on each of 16 MIDI channels   the  PC3LE attempts to load as many effects as is possible for all channels until it uses all of the DSP  units  The program of the currently selected channel will have priority for using DSP units and  loading effects  followed by the pad program of the program on the currently selected channel   which replaces the program on channel 10  if the current channel s program has a pad program   see Drum Pad Program on page 6 12   followed by the lowest to highest remaining MIDI  channels     Parameters On The EFFECTS Page     Insert    Choose an effects Chain that will be applied to the current program  If you only need to use one  effect at a time on one MIDI channel  Insert effects may be all you need  If you plan to use  multiple types of effects or multiple programs on different MIDI channels  it is best to use both  Insert and Aux effects  see Aux below   Aux effects have the advantage of being available to all  programs on each MIDI channel at the same time     Insert Effects Chains For Drum Programs    Some drum programs use multiple insert 
249. ful range makes the controller harder to use accurately  To  remedy this  you can adjust a controllers behavior by using the Scale parameter on the  corresponding controller   s setup page  see Scale below   Adjust the Scale value to stretch the  useful values of the controller across it s whole physical range  A scale value of less than 100   will be helpful for patterns with fewer than 12 steps  Experiment by adjusting the scale value  until the highest desired note is triggered at the top of the controller   s physical range  See Scale  in the Continuous Controller Parameters section of this chapter for more details on the Scale  parameter  For shift patterns with more than 12 steps  you will run out of controller values  before your shift pattern triggers in every octave  If you want to be able to access all of the  available octaves  you can achieve this by setting multiple controllers to Shift Key Number   Next  use the Scale and Offset parameters for each controller  adjusting each to trigger the  desired range of octaves        7 24    Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       The Pan Volume  PAN VOL  Page    By changing the parameters on this page  you can define how each zone sends MIDI volume  and pan messages        Entrablolume  ExifVolume    Hone  Hone    EntruParn  ore ExitPan    y more  CH PEG       PANWOL ASA                         Parameter Range of Values Default  Entry Volume None  0 127 None  Exit Volume None  0 127 None  Entry Pan None  0 127 None  Exit Pan No
250. g notes with a pedal  You might find all  your sustains missing from your sequence  for example  if you re driving your PC3LE from one  of Roland s hardware sequencers  Setting this parameter to Ignore takes care of this problem     Regardless of the setting for this parameter  the PC3LE always responds to its own Panic button  by shutting off all active notes and controllers     Program Change Mode  PrgChgMode     This determines how the PC3LE responds to program change commands received via MIDI  See  Program Change Formats on page 9 21 for an explanation of the various values available for this  parameter     System Exclusive ID  SysExID     The SysExID parameter differentiates between more than one MIDI device of the same model   You won t need to change the default setting of 0 unless you have multiple PC3LEs  or PC3   s   K2600s  K2500s  or K2000s  receiving SysEx messages from a single source  In that case  make  sure each instrument has a different SysExID  Then you can direct SysEx messages to the  appropriate PC3LE with the SysExID byte that s included with every SysEx message  A value of  127 specifies    Omni Receive     That is  at this value  a PC3LE responds to a SysEx message  regardless of the SysEx ID of the message     Bank Select    BankSelect allows you to choose between having the PC3LE respond to Controller 0 or  Controller 32 or both  The reason for this is that various manufacturers have chosen one method  or the other  The three possible values for t
251. gram that will become a layer in your new setup  Select a program  from the program list by using the Category buttons  Alpha Wheel      buttons  You can also  enter a program   s ID   To do this  press the Shift Category button  enter the ID  with the  alphanumeric pad  then press the Enter button     Transpose  Volume  Pan    These parameters function the same for Layer zones as they do for Split zones  See the  explanations for these parameters in the    Parameters on the Split Layer  LOWERSPLIT and  UPPERSPLIT pages     section above     LowKey    The LowKey parameter specifies the lowest key that will play the new layer zone you are  creating  Select the field for the LowKey parameter and choose your Low Key by holding the  Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and playing a key  You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to enter a note name and number     HighKey   The HighKey parameter specifies the highest key that will play the new layer zone you are  creating  Select the field for the HighKey parameter and choose your High Key by holding the  Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and playing a key  You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to enter a note name and number     Tap Tempo Button    Tap the Tap Tempo button  located to the left of the display  below the mode buttons  to set the  tempo for the current setup  This controls the tempo of any arpeggiators used in the current  setup  any riffs that have their BPM parameter set to Setup  any tempo
252. h StartOnly selected  the PC3LE will only count off at the beginning of a sequence  With  Always selected  the PC3LE will count off from any point in a sequence     Program    This parameter determines the program with which the metronome is played  If you wanted a  piano for a metronome  for instance  you could set Program to a piano program  The default  program is 998 Click Track        10 13    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The METRO Page    Channel    This parameter determines the MIDI channel to which the metronome program and events are  sent     Strong Note    This parameter determines the MIDI number of the note played by the metronome for the  downbeats  the    1    of each measure      Strong Vel    This parameter determines the velocity of the note played by the metronome for the downbeats   the    1    of each measure      Soft Note    This parameter determines the MIDI number of the note played by the metronome for the  upbeats  the    2        3     and    4    of each measure      Soft Vel    This parameter determines the velocity of the note played by the metronome for the upbeats   the    2        3     and    4    of each measure      The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons    These soft buttons function as described in The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons on page 10 7     The Done Soft Button    If no changes were made in the METRO page  pressing the Done soft button calls up the MAIN  page  If changes were made  pressing the Done soft button
253. ha 1 On  Status  Active Arreaaiator   Or    pare Newer  Dureza  imPen  Del  n   more          6  Next  use one of the more soft buttons in the bottom corners of the display to cycle through the soft  buttons at the bottom of the display and find the RIFF1 soft button  Press the RIFF1 soft button   This will bring you to the RIFF  page for zone 6  see below        Sree O       ES AA A AA More d       13 37    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    7  On the RIFFI page  the Riff field will be selected  Press the   button below the Alpha Wheel to turn  on the riff for the current zone  zone 6   When the riff has been turned on  you will see the riff  options appear on the riff 1 page   see below               o Mier           1  Son  Start     Shop  2  Tran Po se    El Src track  El Re Channel    ALL  Off       AREE RIFFi IRIFFZ   more d    8  Use the cursor buttons to highlight the Song field  Here you can pick one of the songs saved on  your PC3LE to use as a riff for this zone  Use the alphanumeric pad to enter 115  then press the  Enter button  This will select the song 115 Jazz  see below           o Mienbro           1  Son   Jazz  Start  z      ALL    Stop  Re Channel   Off  TransPose         ARPE RIFFi IRIFFZ   more      9  At this point  playing any of the keyboard keys will trigger the riff  and the riff doesn   t sound good  because it is playing multiple tracks and triggering multiple zones  not just the horn program on  zone 6  First lets make the riff
254. hanges to the current  song are not saved  though the sequencer will remember changes to certain settings from the  MAIN and BIG pages  These settings are Tempo  Merge  Erase Mode  Locate  track mute status   Time In  Time Out  Song End  Loop  Punch  and Metron  To permanently save these changes  with the song  make sure to choose Save from the soft button menu before powering off or  loading a new song  Alternatively  you will be prompted to save these changes upon loading a  new song if the MAIN page settings were changed while recording or with recording armed  or  if any of the BIG page settings were changed        About ID s    When saving  you must choose an ID   An ID  gives you a way to locate a song aside from its   name  you can store up to 2 560 unique ID s for each object type  songs  setups  programs  etc    though many ID s are already used for factory ROM objects   ID s also allow you to save songs  with the same name under different ID s  and rename them at a later time if desired  Choose an       12 6    Tutorial  Song Mode       unused ID  to save a new song  The next available unused ID  is automatically selected when  editing a factory ROM song  When editing a song that has been stored in user memory  any  originally unused ID    the edited song   s ID  is automatically selected  This assumes that you  wish to replace the existing song  but you can choose another ID  if desired to save a new copy   Choose a used ID  to replace an existing saved song  If yo
255. he Aux effects  Using the Aux Send Level  Offset parameter on the PADS page allows you to quickly change the Aux send level of the  program on MIDI channel 10 without editing that program        6 12    Program Mode       The Program Editor    The EFFECTS  FX  Page    Press the FX soft button to call up the EFFECTS page  Use this page to apply audio effects to a  program  You can choose an effects Chain for insert effects and an effects Chain for aux effects   Some drum programs use multiple insert effects chains     The PC3LE   s chains contain a variety of effects including different types of reverb  chorus  delay   flanger  phaser  tremolo  panner  leslie  distortion  EQ  compression  filter  envelope following  filter  frequency stimulator  ring modulator  frequency offset  pitch LFO  and stereoizer  Chains 1  through 81 contain many configurations of these effects  which are useful for quickly finding a  suitable effect  The remaining chains are used by the PC3LE   s factory programs  setups  and  songs  though they can be used for any user program  setup  or song as well  If you discover a  factory program  setup  or song that uses an effect that you like  look at the chain number in the  program  setup or song editor so that you can use it later in your own program  setup  or song   A complete list of the PC3LE   s effects chains can be found at www kurzweil com     urli        Aus  29 Dub Delay  Ily  TEE  On the PC3LE  a program can have a Chain of up to 8 insert effe
256. he ExitPan parameter of that zone  on the  SetupMode PAN VOL page   If multiple zones use the same MIDI channel  the ExitPan of the  highest numbered zone that uses that channel will set the Pan for tracks that use that channel  If  ExitPan is set to NONE  the value for EntryPan is used  If EntryPan and ExitPan are set to  NONE  then the track for that channel uses the Pan setting of that channel in Program mode or  Quick Access mode  If there is no zone that uses certain channels used by your song  then those  channels in your song will use the Pan setting of those channels set in Program mode or Quick  Access mode     If Mode is set to Merge you will be able to overdub when recording on a track containing  previously recorded data  You ll usually want to set Mode to Merge when RecMode  on the BIG  page  is set to Loop  Otherwise  each time through the loop  the previously recorded  information will be erased     If you set Mode to Erase  the previously recorded data on the record enabled track will be  replaced with the new data only during the Bars and Beats you are actually recording  and the  previously recorded data before and after the newly recorded Bars and Beats will be preserved     Location  Locat     The Bar and Beat displayed as the Locate value changes relative to current location of the song  during playback and recording  You can set this to a negative Bar and Beat location to start  playback a set length of time before the beginning of the song     Whenever 
257. he Mod Wheel  as well as the Arp  Enable and Arp Latch buttons     Push the Pitch Wheel away from you to raise the pitch of the note s  you are playing  Pull it  towards you to lower the pitch  Most programs are set so that the pitch wheel will raise and  lower pitch by a whole step  although some programs use the pitch wheel to lower pitch by as  much as an octave  The Pitch Wheel has a spring so that it will snap back to place  i e   back to  the original pitch  when you release it     The Mod Wheel performs a variety of functions  Different programs may use it for filter sweeps   tremolo  vibrato  wah  or zone volume     The Arp Enable button is set by default to turn on and off the PC3LE   s Arpeggiator  It can also  be assigned to control other parameters     The Arp Latch button is set by default to trigger the Arp Latch function  It can also be assigned  to control other parameters        User Interface Basics       Navigation    Navigation    The navigation section of the front panel consists of the display and the buttons surrounding it   These navigation buttons will take you to every one of the PC3LE   s programming parameters     The Display    Your primary interface with the PC3LE is its backlit graphic display  As you press various  buttons  this fluorescent display reflects the commands you enter and the editing changes you  make     Pages    Within each mode  the functions and parameters are organized into smaller  related groups that  appear together in the d
258. he PC3LE s  assignable switches  See above  SW Pedal 1     2  Arp  switch  Arp  latch sw  Switch 1    10 on page 7 13 for explanations of the parameters on this page  When a pad is being used as a  switch  the pad will light up red when the switch is on     Riff    Set the Type to Riff to use the pad as a switch to start or stop the Riff for the current zone  if a  Riff is assigned for the current zone  see Riffs on page 7 51 to learn how   When a pad is assigned  to play a Riff  the pad will light up blue when the riff is started         Trig  Mode    y more  CH  PEG    Trig  Mode  Trigger Mode     With Trig  Mode set to Start Stop  the pad will act as a toggled switch  meaning it will alternate  between starting the Riff when pressed and released  and stopping the Riff the next time the pad  is pressed and released  With Trig  Mode set to One Shot  the riff will restart each time the pad is  pressed and released        PANLOLIKEYLEL       EntryState and ExitState    EntryState determines whether or not an initial setting for the Riff will be sent when the setup is  selected  and if so  what that initial setting will be  There are three choices  None  no setting is  sent when the setup is loaded   Off  the Riff is turned off when the setup is loaded   and On  the  Riff is turned on when the setup is loaded      ExitState determines whether or not a setting for the Riff will be sent when you leave the setup   either for another setup or for Program mode   and if so  what that
259. he PC3LE will start up on its own without any problem  However  if you want to  update your unit  or perform maintenance on it  you may need to interact with the Bootloader  program itself  This appendix describes what the Bootloader can do and how you can use its  functions     The first thing to understand is that PC3LE executable programs and all object data reside on a  file system contained inside the instrument  This file system is based on flash memory  technology and will persist across power cycles  When the PC3LE starts up  the Bootloader  copies the synthesizer program into memory and executes it   just like a PC    boots up    when  you turn it on  The PC3LE also stores its factory defined objects  and all of your own customized  user objects on the file system  The Bootloader program itself is not found on the file system   Instead  it resides in a ROM chip that cannot be erased  and therefore is permanently installed in  your PC3LE     Using the Bootloader Menu    Normally the Bootloader program will do its tasks and hand over control to the synthesizer  program automatically  If you want to interact with the Bootloader itself  hold down the Exit  button  to the right of the display  while turning the power on  while the message    Loading        is displayed on the front panel   Instead of completing the boot process  the Bootloader will  display its main menu page on the screen     ELLA WF date  PCSLE  made    Use the soft buttons underneath the display to cho
260. he RIFF2 page for zone 2  use the cursor buttons to select the SyncType field and use the Alpha  Wheel to set this field to None  see below   This turns off the riff sync settings that had been saved  with this setup  Now pad 1 and 2 will each play a different section of the song 428 H Fact Sng  Try  starting and stopping each pad separately to hear each two bar loop        cet RelsunTur 1 None  Forever are aa Welt 166         11  Since each riff is now playing a different section of the song  lets use some riff sync settings to sync  the timing when switching between the two riffs  On the RIFF2 page for zone 2  use the cursor  buttons to select the SyncType field and use the Alpha Wheel to set this field to Loop  see below    Leave the SyncZone field set to Riff 1  see below   These settings make riff 2 wait to start until the  loop point of riff 1 occurs  Next  use the cursor buttons to select the RelSynTyp field and use the  Alpha Wheel to set this field to Start Wait  see below   Next  use the cursor buttons to select the  RelSynZn field and use the Alpha Wheel to set this field to Riff 1  see below   These settings make  riff 2 wait to release  stop  until riff 1 starts     Forever       Ere ET k       13 51    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    12  Press the bottom Chan Zone button  to the left of the display  to move to the RIFF2 page for zone  1  On the RIFF2 page for zone 1  use the cursor buttons to select the SyncType field and use the  Alpha Whee
261. he factory program  but  you can always return a factory ROM program to it   s original settings by deleting the program  at that ID   see Delete on page 6 15      Updating A Previously Edited Program   If you are saving changes to a program that you have previously edited  the same ID  that the  edited program was saved with will automatically be selected  and you can simultaneously  press the       buttons  below the Alpha Wheel  to jump between selecting the program   s same  ID  and the first available User category ID   If you wish to make an updated edit to a  previously edited program and replace the old version at the same ID   pressing the Save  button twice will have the same result as pressing the Save button and then the save soft button        14 3    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips    Advanced Tips    Intuitive Controller Selection Data Entry    For certain parameters you can select values    intuitively     rather than having to scroll through a  list  Do this by selecting the desired parameter  then holding the Enter button while moving the  desired physical control     For example  on the Program Mode PARAMETERS page  see page 6 11  you can assign a  physical controller for a parameter by selecting the Control Source column for a parameter   holding the Enter button and moving the desired controller     On the Setup Mode Controllers page  see page 7 9   you can choose the controller that you wish  to make an assignment for by selecting the Controller fiel
262. he following parameters        mp  FIn  Son    Start  1  Stori 4    ALL  Off      1  SrcTrack  21 16 Re Channel  Trans sPo se   Off    ARPE RIFFi RIFF     more d                                              Parameter Range of Values Default  Riff Off  On Off  Song Song List 0 None   Bar   dependent on sequence  1  Start  Beat  1 to  dependent on time signature  1   Tick  0 to 959 0   Bar   dependent on sequence  2  Stop  Beat  1 to  dependent on time signature  1   Tick  0 to 959 0  Transpose Off  On Off  Root Note C  1 to G9 C4  SrcTrack  Source Track  ALL  1 to 128 ALL  Re Channel Off  On Off       7 51    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Riff  Setting the Riff parameter to On will enable the riff feature for the current zone in setup mode   Setting this parameter to Off will disable the riff for this zone     Song    Select the song you wish to use in the Song parameter by using the Alpha Wheel      buttons  or  the alphanumeric pad     Start    Use the Start parameter to specify the riff start point  The time format is Bar   Beat   Tick  Bar can  be set to any bar in the sequence  and Beat can be set to any beat in that bar  beat range is  dependent on time signature   Tick can be set from 0 to 959  Since there are 960 possible start  points within a beat  you can specify your riff to start on any common beat subdivision  moments  and a few uncommon ones   The following Tick values correspond to the following  beat subdivision moments                                  
263. he selected objects  Cancel Exits the Store Advanced page and returns you to the Store page     Select All Deselect All    Selecting or deselecting all of the objects at once can be done with the same double presses as  described for the file list dialog  namely     e Left Right cursor double press  Select All Objects  e Up Down cursor double press  Clear All Selections    If you want to load most but not all of the items from a file  for example  if there happens to be a  Master table in the file that you don   t want to load   it may be fastest to first select all objects  using the Left Right double press  and then manually deselect any unwanted items     Loading Methods    Once you have pressed OK to load  you will see this dialog        Qykete  Delete all existing user objects and  load the file     Append  Load objects in file to available  space        Qube te  APPRend Cancel  The soft buttons control the mode for loading and renumbering of objects from the file  Here s    how they work     Overwrt First deletes all existing user RAM objects and then loads objects using the object ID  numbers stored in the file        Storage Mode       The Utilities  UTILS  Page    Append Try to use the object ID numbers stored in the file for the objects to be loaded  If an  ID number is already in use  increment the ID number until a free slot is found     Cancel Cancel the mode selection  and go back to choosing files     The Utilities  UTILS  Page    Pressing the UTILS soft button
264. he selected region  are placed  one after another  in the destination track     Bounce    Use the Bounce function to move the selected events from the current track to another track   either merging with or overwriting existing data on the destination track  The Bounce function  differs from the Copy function in that the original data is not preserved in the original track  As  on a multi track tape recorder  Bounce will always put the data in the same timeline on the new  track that it was on the old track           From  1 1   Det Track O   me  EE   Mode Events   All    DstTrack  1 to 16       Select a destination track for the events to be moved to with the DstTrack parameter  All selected  events described in the Region   Criteria box will be placed in the destination track at the data s  original location     No matter what channel the current track  source track  is set to when you use the bounce  function  the events will be played on the destination track s channel     Mode  Merge   Erase    The Mode setting determines whether the bounced events merge with  or erase existing events  on the destination track from the location point to the end of the copied region        10 25    Song Mode and the Song Editor  Song Editor  Track Functions       Insert    The Insert function is used to add blank time to the current song  modifying the song s End  point appropriately  The Insert function will affect all tracks  This is similar to splicing a piece of  blank tape to an exis
265. he volume for this Zone is already at its  maximum value 127  Let s use the Alpha Wheel to turn this parameter down to 90  see below   Now  the Zone will play the piano program 8 Grand    Evans    at a lower volume than Zone 1        EntruUclume ER  EntruParn  ExitVolume   ExitPan    a more  CH PREG PANUOL EESEL    Next  let   s adjust the Pan  left right speaker position  of Zone 2   S     mi    D  a  Ji       On the PAN VOL page of Zone 2  use the cursor buttons to select the EntryPan field  Use the  Alpha Wheel to turn this parameter to 127  see below   Now the Zone will play the piano program  from only the right speaker   For the EntryPan parameter  a value of 64 plays the program at  equal volume from left and right speakers  A value of 0 plays the program from only the left  speaker  and a value of 127 plays the program from only the right speaker  Values in between make  the sound appear to come from a position between the left and right speakers         Entrablolume    EntruParn  Exit Volume    1zr ExitPan           5          A more  CH PEG PANUOL EESEL    Use the same methods to adjust volume and pan for any Zone  To finish  press the Exit button to the  right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your changes to this setup under a new ID   See The    Setup Editor section at the beginning of this chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup  Editor           13 12    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Diffe
266. her synths     Program mode is the heart of the PC3LE  where you select programs for performance and  editing  The PC3LE is packed with great sounds powered by the same powerful synthesis as  used in Kurzweil s PC3  The PC3LE give you easy access to this synthesis  Though you can t edit  programs as deeply as you can on the PC3  you can still get a pretty wide range of sounds from  a program by changing the available controls and effects  You can start tweaking sounds right  away from the Program mode main page by moving the knobs and using the assignable  switches  When you would like to change a program   s FX  the Program Editor is the place to  start     Pads    When you select a PC3LE program  the PC3LE will also select an associated Drum program to  be triggered by the Pads  The program for the Pads is assigned to MIDI channel 10  Also  any  factory program in the Drums category is playable from the pads  See The PADS   Page on page 6 12 for details on changing the drum kit for each program     Assignable Knobs  Switches  Pedals  and Wheels    In Program mode  each of the PC3LE s assignable knobs  switches  pedals and wheels can be  used to control a program specific parameter  or to send MIDI continuous controller values to  external equipment  Each factory program has some of these controllers assigned to program  parameters  for example  filter frequency  attack time  distortion drive  etc   Press the Info soft  button from the Program mode main page to see a list th
267. here the song   s initial tempo can be set or modified     TimeSig    Affects the click  playback looping  and locate function as well as some editing operations  Does  not change the recorded data  though it does change the way data is displayed on the screen     FX Track    The PC3LE uses the channel of the track specified for FX Track as the Aux FX channel     DrumTrack  DrumTrk     Any of the song   s tracks can be defined as Drum Tracks so that their Note events do not get  transposed when a transposition is applied when using the track as a riff in a setup  see   Riffs on page 7 51 and Transpose Root Note on page 7 53   With tracks designated as drum tracks   you can transpose a whole song that is being used as a riff  but the drum tracks will continue to  play the correct sounds that they played in the original key  Otherwise  the drum sounds would  change with each transposition     Use the cursor buttons to select a track number  You can access 8 tracks at once  either tracks 1 8  or 9 16  Use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select one of the tracks 1 8   viewed in the top right corner of the page  in order to access tracks 1 8  or select one of the  tracks 9 16 to access tracks 9 16  With the desired track number selected in the DrumTrk field   use the Alpha Wheel or      buttons to toggle between D  to designate the track as a drum track   or         to designate the track as a non drum track     Drumlrks 10 2      4D 50 6  r   amp      The Drum
268. his parameter are     Ctl 0 Responds to controller 0 only   Ctl32 Responds to controller 32 only   Ctl 0 32 Responds to 0 or 32     Local Keyboard Channel  LocalKbdCh     Changing the setting of the Local Keyboard Channel parameter is useful only when your PC3LE  is receiving MIDI information from an external source   maybe you have a favorite MIDI  keyboard that you use to control all the gear in your studio  or you use a lot of outboard  sequencing  If you   re using the PC3LE as a standalone music workstation or performance  keyboard  you can ignore this parameter     The local keyboard channel enables the PC3LE to receive MIDI information on a single channel   then rechannelize that information so you can play and control all 16 zones of a setup  even if  your MIDI source transmits on only one channel  When you   re in Program mode  the local  keyboard channel remaps incoming information to the PC3LE   s current channel  the one shown  in the top line of the display   When using the local keyboard channel all the MIDI information  received on the local keyboard channel also gets sent   after being remapped    to the PC3LE s  MIDI and USB Out ports        9 19    Master Mode       MIDI Receive  RECV     When you re in Program mode  and playing a KB3 program  you may want to leave  LocalKbdCh set to None  which is its default value  In this case the MIDI Controller messages  for KB3 control listed in Table 6 2 on page 6 8 are certain to work  if you haven t edited the  Cont
269. his trigger field  If you want to have only one key start a riff  set the Trigger key range       7 54    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    from A 0 to A 0 for example  and your riff will be triggered to start only by pressing the A 0  key  If you want your trigger key range to be larger  set your Trigger key range to be  for  instance  A  0 to A 1  Now any key that is pressed within this range will trigger your riff to  start     Note  the LoKey and HiKey values on the KEYVEL page do affect the riff  If your riff s trigger and release  notes are not within the LoKey and HiKey range on the KEY VEL page  your riff will not be able to be  triggered from the keyboard     Release    The way you release riffs is analogous to the way you trigger them  You can assign a physical  controller to destination 164 RiffOff  or you can select a key or key range with the Release  parameter  You set this the same way that you set the trigger range  Move your cursor so that the  left field of the Release parameter is highlighted  this will be the low end of the trigger key  range   Now select a key value by using the Alpha Wheel       buttons or intuitive entry  Move  your cursor to the right field and repeat the process  this will be the high end of the trigger key  range   If you set both of the Release values to AO  the Riff will stop when you release AO     So  if you use the settings described above and in the Trigger section above  your setup s riff will  start when you press A 0  and
270. hysical  controllers as a control source  or choose a value of None if you don   t want to use a physical  controller for this parameter  You can also choose a value of None by entering  1 with the  alphanumeric pad followed by the Enter button     To choose an external MIDI CC number as a control source  you must enter the number of the  controller with the alphanumeric pad followed by the Enter button  Using the Alpha Wheel or  the     buttons will bring you back to the list of the PC3LE   s physical controllers  Also  the  PC3LE s physical controllers each use one of the available MIDI CC numbers  so you must  choose one of the other available CC numbers when using an external MIDI control source  See  page 7 69 for a list of the default CC numbers that are used by the PC3LE   s physical controllers     Important Note About Selecting A Control Source     When you change the control source for a parameter  the new control source immediately sets its  current value for the MIDI value of the current parameter  If the MIDI value of the parameter is  set to None  the new value will be set  but the MIDI Value column for the parameter will still  display None  see above for an Important Note About Values of None   This can be troublesome   for example  if you were to change the Control Source for the Expression parameter  you may       6 10    Program Mode       The Program Editor    accidentally set the MIDI Value to 0  but wouldn t know it because None would still be  displayed
271. iffs  and then change the setup to  make one riff play multiple tracks of the song     1  First lets look at the song that our setup will be using for riffs  Press the Exit button until you reach  the ProgramMode page  Next  press the Song mode button  located with the mode buttons to the  left of the display  This will bring you to the Song mode MAIN page  see below              oga  HHIH  Events IHS    S LOREEN      Cursnal TemPo  125 4  RecTrk  an  Mode  Merde  Frog  oand Grand Locate 1       Track      dira irrin m amit    2  On the Song mode MAIN page  use the cursor to select the CurSng field  if not already selected    In the CurSng field  use the alphanumeric pad to enter 428 followed by the Enter button to select  the song 428 H Fact Sng  see below   Press the Play Pause button to the left of the display to hear  the song  which is a four bar loop  Press the Stop button to the left of the display when you are  finished listening  The Track field shows that four tracks have been recorded  You can use the  Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to view the programs used for tracks 1 4 in the Prog  field  The currently selected track number is shown in the RecTrk field  The setup that we will look  at uses the same programs for zones 1 4 that this song uses for its tracks 1 4  as well as sequence  information from tracks 1 4 for riffs 1 4        ay mee          13 47    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    Next  press the Setup mode button  located
272. ignal to noise ratio 2 4  Soft buttons 3 7  Setup Editor 7 64  Software Upgrades 2 9  Soloing a zone 7 5  Song Editor 10 19  TRACK Page 10 21  Song Mode 10 1  12 1  Demo Songs 12 15  Loops 12 15  Program Changes 12 15  Song Structure 12 15  The Event List 12 16  Song mode 4 3  Songs  Recording 3 13  14 5  Sostenuto 7 18  Specifications A 2  Split Point 13 5  Split Program Setup 13 4  Startup 2 1  Storage Mode 5 6  11 1  Storage mode 4 3    Sustain 7 18  Sustain not working 9 19  switch pedals 1 4  Switches   In Setup Mode 7 13  System Exclusive ID 9 19    T    Tap Tempo 12 3  Tempo 12 3  Master 9 2  Song mode   Tempo Track 10 33  Tap Tempo function 12 3  time signature 12 3  Top line of display 3 6  TRACK Page  Song Editor 10 21  Transpose  Master 9 2  MIDI 9 12  Song Mode TRACK Page 10 28  Transposing setups 7 1  Tuning to other instruments 9 2    U    USB Device   formatting 11 2  11 8  USB MIDI disabled 2 3  USB MIDI disconnected 11 1  USB Port 2 4  Using the modes 4 2    V    Variable Architecture Synthesis 1 2  VAST 1 2  VAST programs 2 7  Velocity Map  MIDI Receive 9 17  MIDI Transmit 9 13  virtual drive  USB Storage Mode 2 5    W    World Wide Web 2 9    X    Xpose 2 7  6 3  8 2    Z    Zones  Soloing 7 5  zones 13 2       
273. in the Load Object dialog   Note  The file must be in  PLE format in order to  load individual objects from it   The PC3LE then scans the file contents in order to present a list  of all of the objects in the file  Sometimes this procedure can take a few moments  depending on  how many objects are in the file     The objects in the list are usually grouped by type  program  setup  etc    The list can be scrolled  using the Alpha Wheel        buttons  or the Up or Down cursor buttons  Each line in the  scrollable list represents one object  and displays the object   s type  ID  and name  The ID       11 6    Storage Mode       The LOAD Page    numbers are the same numbers that were used to reference the objects when the file was last  saved by the PC3LE     As with the file list  entering in a number from the alphanumeric buttonpad will jump to the  indexed entry  and typing in a large number like 9999 will go to the end of the list     The soft buttons on this page are used for multiple selection of the objects in the list as well as for  moving around the list when there are many items selected or listed Here is a brief description  of each button   s function     Select Select the highlighted object  An asterix     appears at the left of the objects list  number   Next Scroll to next entry  Same function as pressing the down cursor button or the      button  or turning the Alpha Wheel one click clockwise     Type Jump to next object type   OK Tell PC3LE to proceed to load t
274. in the Setup Editor  See  Set Controls KB3  KB3CTL  on page 7 65        7 5    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    The Channel Program  CH PROG  Page    This is the first page you see when you enter the Setup Editor  Here  you can select programs   MIDI channels  and MIDI Bank numbers for each of the setup   s 16 zones  You can also solo or  mute each zone          Ores    Programe  Channel  z   MidiBank  El Eade   Ctl 6732  MidiProge 1   EntruProsStha 1 On  Status  Active Arresaiator   Or    r more  CH FRGICTELS IPANUOL EEYLUEL 1 more 3                                        Parameter Range of Values Default   Program Program List 1 Standard Grand   Channel 1to 16 1   MIDI Bank 0 to 127 0   MIDI Program  MidiProg   Depends on MIDI Bank Mode  1   Status Muted  Active  Solo  Solo Muted Active   Destination Destination List USB_MIDI MIDI Local   MIDI Bank Mode  BankMode  MIDI Bank Mode List Ctl 0 32   Entry Program Change  EntryProgChg  On  Off On   Receive Channel  Recv Channel  All  1 to 16 Same as Zone    Program    This selects an internal program to play on each zone  As you change the value of Program   notice that MIDI Program and MIDI Bank match the local program and bank numbers   programs 1 127 fall into MIDI Bank 0  128 255 fall into MIDI Bank 1  and so on   both MIDI  Banks and PC3LE banks can hold 128 programs   If you want to transmit different program and  bank numbers over MIDI  highlight either MIDI Program or MIDI Bank and select a new value   Note that chang
275. in turn  scaling the balance of volume between left and right speakers in a stereo setup  or headphones    At a Pan value of 64 the zone you are creating will play at equal volume from both speakers   making the sound for that zone appear to come from the center of the sound field  Values  between 0 and 64 will increasingly turn down the right speaker as values approach 0  making  the sound appear to be coming from increasingly further towards the left side of the soundfield   A Pan value of 0 stops sound from the zone you re creating from going to the right speaker  and  only outputs sound from the left  Values between 64 and 127 will increasingly turn down the left  speaker as values approach 0  making the sound appear to be coming from increasingly further  towards the right side of the soundfield  A Pan value of 127 stops sound from the zone you re  creating from going to the left speaker  and only outputs sound from the right        7 3    Setup Mode       Tap Tempo Button    Adding a Layer Zone    On the Split Layer page  press the Layer soft button to add a new zone to the currently selected  setup  You will be brought to the Split  Layer  LAYER page  see below   Play the keyboard as  you adjust these parameters to find the right settings           Main Sound  11 pas  Laver Programs bs ase Shimmer  TransPose  h  LowkeyiG 3 HishkeyiG A    Wolume  Se Pan  64    Save  Cancel       Parameters on the Split Layer  LAYER page     Layer Program   Use this field to select a pro
276. inear curve    Velocity Curve  Reverse Crossfade  Below medium strike velocity  MIDI velocity is greater  than with Reverse Linear curve  above medium strike  velocity  MIDI velocity is less than with Reverse Linear  curve       7 32    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Low Velocity  LoVel   HighVelocity  HiVel     LoVel and HiVel set the minimum and maximum velocity limits that the current zone transmits   A keystroke in the current zone whose velocity     after it has been scaled and offset     is below  the minimum does not generate a Note On  Neither does a keystroke whose velocity after  processing is above the maximum  These parameters are useful for    velocity switching      having a key play different sounds depending on how hard you strike it     The values can be anywhere from 1 to 127  As with other parameters  zones can overlap or be  totally discrete  or be identical  Usually  LoVel will have a smaller value than HiVel  but as with  LoKey and HiKey  you may also create a gap in velocity response  by setting negative ranges for    velocity   127     gt    A  is Velocity Min  1  Max  64  fe  No MIDI Note Ons are transmitted when you strike  o keys with medium velocity or greater  a          0  64 127  Strike Velocity  127   Y  7  7     7  5 7               Velocity Min  64  Max  127  xe  7 No MIDI Note Ons are transmitted unless you strike  D 7 keys with velocity of medium or greater  Z 64 7  a          0  64 127    Strike Velocity       7 33    Setup Mode     
277. ing the Program parameter again will reset both the MIDI Program and MIDI  Bank parameters to match the local program and bank numbers  You can enter the Program  Editor for the program on the currently selected zone by selecting the Program field and  pressing the Edit button to the left of the display  Exit the Program Editor to return to the Setup  Editor of the current setup     Channel    The Channel parameter defines the MIDI transmit channel for the currently selected zone  You  can set it to any of the 16 MIDI channels  Normally  you will want each zone on a separate MIDI  channel  This is necessary if you want to combine different programs in the setup     If two zones have the same MIDI channel  and destination   but they have different program  settings  there will be conflicts  no MIDI device  including the PC3LE  can respond correctly to  two different simultaneous Program Change commands on one channel  The result will be that  only one Program Change will be recognized  and every note played will sound double  if Note  Maps are on   This can create odd and unpredictable timing effects  and will reduce your  polyphony by 50         7 6    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Nevertheless  there will be occasions when    stacking    zones on the same MIDI channel might  come in handy  Suppose you want a physical controller on the PC3LE to send data for two  different numbered MIDI Controllers on the same channel  In this case  you must create two zones  assigned 
278. ing the value of the Num  Beats parameter  you can make zones with a SyncType setting of Downbeat or DownbeatWait  behave as if downbeats are occurring less or more frequently        7 46    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Real time Control of Arpeggiator Parameters    You can have real time control over several arpeggiator parameters  by assigning physical  controllers to special arpeggiator Controller Destinations  Any input  or entry value  from a  physical controller assigned to an arpeggiator Controller Destination overrides the programmed  values for the parameters of the arpeggiator on that controller   s zone  The override remains in  effect until you select a different setup  or a different program in Program mode   Remember   each of the following Controller Destinations affects only the arpeggiator for the zone which    your controller is assigned to                                            Controller Corresponding  ARPEGGIATOR Operation  Number  Parameter   147 ArpOn Any controller value turns the Arpeggiator On    148 ArpOff Any controller value turns the Arpeggiator Off    150 ArpOrder Arpeggiator Order  each range of values selects one of  nine options in order of the parameters list  0 14   Played   15 28  Upwards  etc    29 42  43 56  57 70   71 84  85 98  99 112  113 127  Simultaneous     151 ArpBeats Arpeggiator Beats  each range of values selects one of  seven options in order of the parameters list  0 18   Quarter notes   19 36  8th notes  etc    3
279. intervals to each  octave     Like many instruments before the adaptation of equal temperament  most of these intonation  maps were designed to sound best in one specific key  Though some may have historically been  in a different key  all of the PC3LEs factory intonation maps are set to root note C by default  You  can change the root key of the current intonation map by using the Int Key parameter  see the  Intonation Key  Int Key  section below         Master Mode       Master Mode Page 1  MAST 1     List and Description of Intonation Maps                                                       O   None No intonation map is used  intonation is equal but cannot be edited   Equal No detuning of any intervals  The standard for modern western music   Classic Just Tunings are defined based on the ratios of the frequencies between intervals   The original tuning of Classical European music   3   Just Flat 7th Similar to classic Just  but with the Dominant 7th flatted an additional 15 cents   4   Harmonic The perfect 4th  Tritone  and Dominant 7th are heavily flatted   5   Just Harmonic   Approximation of a historical intonation   6   Werkmeister Named for its inventor  Andreas Werkmeister  It   s fairly close to equal  temperament  and was developed to enable transposition with less dissonance   7   1 5th Comma Approximation of a historical intonation based on the comma system   8   1 4th Comma Approximation of a historical intonation based on the comma system   9   Indian Raga Ba
280. ion characters  The easiest  way to get to them is to press one of the alphanumeric buttons to select a character close to the  one you want  then scroll to it with the Alpha Wheel  Here   s the whole list     1        amp            0123456789      lt     gt      AthroughZ        _   athrough z   space      Pressing the     buttons simultaneously is a short cut to the following characters   0  A  a and  space      If you   re wondering how we came up with this sequence of characters  it   s composed of ASCII  characters 33 through 122     When you press OK  the final Save dialog appears  where you assign an ID to the edited object   If you change your mind about the name  press the Rename soft button for another try     Note  For an additional naming method  see Keyboard Naming below        5 3    Editing Conventions       Saving and Naming    ROM Objects    If the object you edited was a ROM  factory preset  object  the PC3LE will automatically suggest  the next available  unused  ID as the ID for the edited object upon saving  If that   s the ID you  want  press the Save soft button  and the object will be stored in memory with that ID   Otherwise  you can select any ID from 1 to the maximum  This page also gives you the  opportunity to return to the naming dialog  as described in the previous section      If you select an ID that   s already in use  the PC3LE will tell you that you   re going to replace the  ROM object that   s already been assigned that ID  If you don   
281. isplay  Each one of these groups of parameters is called a page  Each   mode has what we call an entry level page  it   s the page that appears when you select that mode  with one of the mode buttons  Within each mode and its editor s   the various pages are selected  with the navigation buttons  There are many pages  but there are a few features common to each    page     This is the entry level page for Program mode     PoSr Str        E HYE Jazz brand  Octav T Octan  WE     The Top Line    On the top line of most pages  there   s a reminder of which mode you   re in and which page  you re on  Many pages display additional information in the top line  as well  The Program  mode page above  for example  shows you the current amount of MIDI transposition  the  current program   s category  and the currently selected MIDI channel  The top line is almost  always    reversed       that is  it has a white background with blue characters        The Bottom Line    The bottom line is divided into six  sometimes fewer  sets of reversed characters that serve as  labels for the six buttons directly beneath the display  These labels   and the functions of the  buttons   change depending on the currently selected page  Consequently the buttons that  select these functions are called    soft    buttons        3 6    User Interface Basics       Navigation    The Soft Buttons    The soft buttons are located directly under the display  see below   The soft buttons are called     soft    beca
282. it   G4   therefore first downward note  is E4  2 ST below last upward note     A4 is 1 ST from shift limit  therefore    8 ST  G 4  C4  D 4  F 4  F4  D4  D 4      first downward note is F4  1 ST  lower than last upward note           All symmetrical again  now A4 is             Ha p   Hp p    RSA  ODA FAAA F4  D A G4  D 4    within shift limit  Next upward note would be C5  ta pt      gt   10ST  A 4    C4  Dra F 4  A4  G4  E4  C   4  D   4        which is 2 ST from shift limit  11 ST  B4  C4  D 4  F 4  A4  G 4  F4  D4  D 4      C5 is 1 ST from shift limit  12 ST  C5  C4  D 4  F 4  A4  C5  As  F 4  D 4  C4  D 4      Symmetrical again  including C5                   7 40    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Bipolar starts out the same way as Unipolar  but during downward note shifting  it continues  past the original pitch until it hits the shift limit in the opposite direction  where it reverses again     Float Res adds a bit of apparent randomness to the process     Float    means that when the  Arpeggiator reaches the shift limit  it resets   but not to its original pitch as with plain Reset   Like Unipolar and Bipolar  it looks at the first note that would exceed the shift limit  and  calculates the interval between that note and the shift limit  It then restarts the cycle of latched  notes  transposing the entire cycle by the interval it just calculated  then shifting each  subsequent cycle by the value of Note Shift  until it reaches the shift limit again     Here s a
283. it is looped  before starting   see Loop on page 7 55 for looping riffs  and Loop on page 10 11 for looping songs   This way you  can trigger the arpeggiator to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the start of the  playing riff or song   s loop  The difference from Loop is that if there is nothing playing to sync to   the arpeggiator will not start  If the riff or song that you are syncing to is already running   LoopWait behaves just like Loop     With SyncType set to StopWait  if there is already something playing to sync to  the current  arpeggiator will wait for what is playing to stop before starting  This way you can trigger the  arpeggiator to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the release  stopping  of the riff   arpeggiator  or song that you are syncing to  The difference from Stop is that if there is nothing  playing to sync to  the arpeggiator will not start  This can be useful if you want to get your  arpeggiator ready to sync before you start whatever you are syncing it to  If the riff or song that  you are syncing to is already running  StopWait behaves just like Stop     Num Beats    This affects the syncing of other arpeggiator or riff zones to the current zone  only if those other  zones have a SyncType setting of Downbeat or DownbeatWait  For zones being synced to the  current zone   s arpeggiator  this determines how many notes must be played by the current  zone   s arpeggiator before a downbeat occurs  By decreasing or increas
284. itch button Shift LED is lit  the  switches access switch functions 6 10  You can use a switch to control MIDI or other functions on  the PC3LE     For both pedals or switches  you can use the Type field to assign the control to Momentary or  Toggled  If you choose SW  Momentary  in the Type field  the control will send the value for its  OnValue parameter when pressed  and the value for its OffValue parameter when released  If  you choose SW  Toggled  in the Type field  the control will alternate between sending the value  for its OnValue parameter when pressed and released  and the value for its OffValue parameter  the next time itis pressed and released  The parameters for SW  Momentary  and SW  Toggled   behave the same aside from that distinction     SW  Momentary  is suited for use with functions that need to turn on and off quickly for short  periods of time  like sustain or portamento  SW  Toggled  is suited for use with functions that  you will want to leave on or off for longer periods of time  such as arpeggiator on   off  See below  for parameter explanations of both switch types          One    ntrusTale  Exil State  Test Tyre       fone  Hone  Ctrl        FANUOL JEEYUEL Y more d       DestType   This field determines which type of control destinations will be listed in the OnControl and  OffControl fields  see below   Choose Params if you would like to control one of the parameters  for the program on the current setup zone  such a parameter for an effect in the
285. ithin the PC3LE  KB3 programs  can play only on a single channel at a time  which you designate  V A S T  programs will work  fine on that channel  too      When you re ready to learn about editing programs  check out Chapter 6        2 7    Startup       Setups    Setups    Setups allow you to play a combination of programs  as well as giving you advanced  performance and control options  Setups can have up to 16 zones  each of which can be assigned  to any range of the keyboard  overlapping or split   Each zone can have its own program  MIDI  channel  and MIDI control assignments  as well as riff and arpeggiator settings     Press the Setup mode button to the left of the display  Its LED will light  telling you that you   re  in Setup mode  Notice that the Setup mode display is similar to the Program mode display  Press  the Info soft button to which programs and assignments are set for each zone  See page 7 1 for a  more detailed description               2 Big Whoosh         5 Elues  am    Dotau  K    Many setups include arpeggiation and note triggered songs to create grooves that you can use  as is  or as templates for your own material  As you play with these setups  experiment with the  knobs and other controllers for a wide range of effects  Some of these grooves keep playing after  you ve released the controls that got them going  When you want to stop them  select another  setup  press the Setup mode button  or press the Stop button          gtan          Quick Acce
286. itor for the riff s zone  make sure its Trigger  keyboard  range  on the RIFF2 page  is within LoKey and HiKey range  on the KEY VEL page       In the Setup Editor for the riff s zone  make sure the Status  parameter on the CH PROG page isn   t set to Muted          In the Setup Editor for the riff s zone  make sure the  Notemap parameter is set to Linear  some factory setups  that trigger riffs from the pads have Notemap set to Off         The riff wont stop playing when e In the Setup Editor for the riff s zone  check the RelSynZn   released  and RelSynTyp parameters  see Re SynTyp  Release Sync  Type  on page 7 57 for details  It is possible to make settings  which don   t allow the riff to stop in all situations  In this case   you can still use the front panel Stop button  to the left of the  display  to stop all riffs        The riff doesn   t sync its triggering or   In the Setup Editor for the riff   s zone  if the SyncZone or  releasing as expected  RelSynZn parameters are set to First Avail or FirstRiff Av    some SyncType and RelSynTyp settings may not work as  expected when triggering or releasing riffs  In these cases set  the SyncZone or RelSynZn parameters to a specific riff   arpeggiator or sequence to sync to        Can   t play a zone from the keyboard e In the Setup Editor for the riff s zone  set the Local  when its riff is turned on  parameter to On on the RIFF2 page  Local is set to Off by  default  see Local on page 7 55 for details           13 53    T
287. itor s page s  with the soft buttons and select parameters with the  cursor  arrow  buttons  When you ve selected a parameter  its value is highlighted by the  cursor   you can change its value with one of the data entry methods  When you change a value   you ll normally hear its effect on the object you re editing  The PC3LE doesn   t actually write  your editing changes to memory until you save the object you re working on  It then allows you  to choose between writing over the original object  or storing the newly edited version in a new  memory location     What s an Object     If you ve been wondering what we mean by the term    object     it   s an expression we use for  anything that can be named  saved  deleted  or edited  A complete list of the latest PC3LE  factory objects can be found at kurzweil com  Here s a list of all the types of objects     Programs Factory preset or user programmed sounds stored in ROM or flash  memory  A program is one or more layers of sound generated by samples  or oscillators  which is then routed through digital signal processing     Setups Factory preset or user programmed MIDI performance presets consisting  of up to 16 zones  each with its own program  MIDI channel  and  controller assignments  and  optionally  arpeggiation and   or riff  specifications     Songs Sequence files loaded into memory  or MIDI data recorded in Song mode     Quick Access banks Factory preset or user programmed banks of ten entries each  that store  program
288. k Status Indicator   any of which can be switched back to empty     if at any time recording on specific tracks is not  desired     If there isn t a track with an  R   the RecTrk parameter   s value will be None   The exception is  when the RecTrk is set to Mult and you have switched all of the tracks out of record enable      Track Channels    Each track has a MIDI Channel that it uses to receive and transmit data  By default  tracks 1 16   of a new song are assigned to Channels 1 16 respectively  although a track can play or record on  any channel and the same channel can be used for more than one track  Keep in mind  however   that only one program can be assigned to a channel at a time  so if you have more than one track  assigned to the same channel  they ll play the same program   the one on the higher numbered  track  since that s the most recent Program Change command received on that channel     Soft Buttons on the MAIN Page    This section contains descriptions of the functions of the function soft buttons  that is  the  buttons with labels not in all caps  As with all other modes  the soft buttons in Song Mode that  have labels in all caps call up different pages  See the following sections for descriptions on how  these pages work     The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons    NOTE  These buttons are similar to the transport controls on a tape deck  Some of those decks require you  to press Play and Record simultaneously to begin recording  The PC3LE s transport butt
289. l Sequencers  on page 10 8 for related information     Digital Output Volume  Dig Out Vol     The Digital Output Volume parameter specifies the behavior of the PC3LE s Digital Output   Setting this parameter to Variable makes the Digital Output respond to changes made on the  volume slider  Setting this parameter to Fixed makes the Digital Output output a signal with a  fixed volume     FX Mode    With FX Mode set to Performance  the PC3LE minimizes disruption of existing effects when  changing programs  and entry values will not disrupt sustained notes when changing programs  in Program or Quick Access modes  When controlling the PC3LE from an external sequencer in  Program Mode  you will want to set FX Mode to Multitrack to minimize effect disruption  FX       9 8    Master Mode       Master Mode Page 2  MAST 2     Mode is set to Performance as a default  with some exceptions  In Song mode  Multitrack mode  is always used  despite how this parameter is set in Master Mode  Also  the FX Mode parameter  does not affect Setup Mode because it uses its own FX mode     OS Object Ver  Operating System Object Version     The version numbers for the currently installed Operating System and Object set are displayed  on these lines     Default Song    Use the Default Song parameter to choose the default song that is loaded in Song mode each  time the PC3LE is powered on     Output Clock    To send a MIDI clock pulse to the MIDI Out port  set this parameter to On  Otherwise  set it to  
290. l Values For All Tracks    An important last step before saving a finished song is to store initial values of Program  Volume  and Pan for all tracks  This can be done at any time  but is best done as a last step if you plan to  make a lot of adjustments to these settings  To write initial settings for all tracks  press the Keep  soft button on the Song MIXER page  see Song Mode  The MIXER Page on page 10 12   After  pressing the Keep soft button you must save your song to save these settings  you are  automatically prompted to save upon exiting the Song MIXER page   Pressing the Keep soft  button stores the current value of each track   s Program  Volume and Pan settings as initial  settings  Be sure that these values on each track are set to the value that you wish to store  as the  settings may have changed if you have written any automation     Note  Don   t use the Keep soft button if you would like certain tracks to not be stored with initial values   In this case  only set initial values for each desired parameter as described above  see Setting Initial  Volume Per Track      Volume Sources When An Initial Volume Is Not Set    If an initial volume is not stored with each track  the volume for each track of your song will be  set depending on what mode you were in previous to loading the song  If you are in Song mode  and have played a song  and then you load a song without initial volumes  the volume of each  track of the newly loaded song will be set by the previously
291. l keys played while Controller 158 is on will also latch   similar to Add mode   When Controller 158 is off  any keys that are not currently held down  will be removed from the arpeggiation  If you activate Controller 157  keys currently held down  will latch  and any additional keys played while Controller 157 is on will play normally  similar  to Overplay mode   This mode is called Pedals mode because you might want to assign  Footswitch 1 to Latch  Controller 157  and Footswitch 2 to Latch2  Controller 158  to make the  pedals function similarly to sustain and sostenuto pedals  Additionally  you could assign one  Footswitch to SusLatch  Controller 160    doing this makes the Footswitch act as a sustain pedal  when Arp is off  and as a Latch pedal when Arp is on     Autohold is similar to Auto  Holding at least one arpeggiated note on and playing other notes  latches those notes  Unlike in Auto mode  if you stop holding at least one arpeggiated note on   the arpeggiation continues playing  although you can t latch any more notes   In this case  if you  strike another key within the setup s arpeggiation range  you start a new arpeggiation sequence   Autohold is useful for arpeggiating chords  when you play a chord  it gets latched  and  continues arpeggiating after you release the chord  When you play another chord  the previous  chord gets unlatched  and the new one gets latched  You can use the Panic soft button to stop  arpeggiation at any time     1NoteAuto is similar to
292. l to set this field to Loop  see below   Next  use the cursor buttons to select the  SyncZone field and use the Alpha Wheel to set this field to Riff 2  see below   These settings make  riff 1 wait to start until the loop point of riff 2 occurs  Next  use the cursor buttons to select the  RelSynTyp field and use the Alpha Wheel to set this field to StartWait  see below   Next  use the  cursor buttons to select the RelSynZn field and use the Alpha Wheel to set this field to Riff 2  see  below   These settings make riff 1 wait to release  stop  until riff 2 starts                 Ancone 1  Release   E 1 C 1 sunclure    Condrel   off Relsundn     Local   Off SSE WME aa  En  Loof   Forever    E TE    With the settings described in steps 11 and 12 completed  riffs 1 and 2 should sync with each  other when triggering or releasing each  Follow these steps to see how the riffs sync  First  make  sure nothing is playing by pressing the front panel Stop button  to the left of the display   and  pressing and unlighting any lit pads  Next  press and light pad 1 to start riff 1  then  press and  unlight pad 1 to release riff 1  Since riff 1 has its RelSynTyp set to StartWait and RelSynZn set to  Riff 2  riff 1 is now waiting for riff 2 to start before releasing  stopping   Next  press and light pad 2 to  start riff 2  Since riff 2 has its SyncType set to Loop and SyncZone set to Riff 1  riff 2 waits to start until  riff 1 reaches its loop point  When riff 1 reaches its loop point  riff 2 
293. ll make no difference   See Signal Flow on page 7 61  for details on pre  and post Insert Aux Effects     The Setup Editor Utility Soft Buttons    Name    Save    Delete    In addition to the Setup Editor s pages  there are basic library and editing soft buttons  Their  functions are described below     This enables you to rename the current setup  Use any data entry method to do this  including  the letters on the alphanumeric pad     Pressing Save calls up the standard Save Dialog  When choosing an ID   simultaneously  pressing the   and   buttons  below the Alpha Wheel  toggles between saving the setup to the  first available empty location  or replacing a currently existing setup  For more detailed  instructions on saving  see Saving and Naming on page 5 3     This erases a setup from memory  freeing up space to store setups in other locations   You can  check the free memory in the PC3LE at any time  on the top line of the Master mode page   Press  Delete  and you will be given a choice to Delete or Cancel  Press Delete again  and an    Are You  Sure     message will appear  Press Yes to delete the setup  or No to cancel     As with programs  setups can be saved to and deleted from memory only  The names of all  setups in RAM have an asterisk     next to them  If you try delete a setup from ROM  the PC3LE  will indicate that it cannot be deleted  and the setup will remain in memory     New Zone  NewZn     Press NewZn to create a new zone with default parameters  The PC3L
294. lso set one zone   s  arpeggiator to override arpeggiators on other zones using the Arpeggiator Global  ArpGlobal   parameter on Setup Mode   s COMMON page     The concept behind the PC3LE   s Arpeggiators is fairly simple  although the options are  extensive  You might think of each Arpeggiator as a    note processor     generating complex  output from relatively modest input  You can select any number of notes for the input  and tell  the Arpeggiator to recognize and remember them  This is called    latching    the notes  The  Arpeggiator then processes them by playing them repeatedly  and or transposing them up and       7 35    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    down the keyboard  You have control over several processing parameters  velocity  order   duration  transposition  orchestration  whether the notes are played simultaneously  and  whether the intervals between notes are filled chromatically  You can also tell the Arpeggiator  how to deal with new information coming from the keyboard when the Arpeggiator is already  processing notes     The arpeggiator also includes step sequencers for note and velocity shifting  allowing you to  more precisely control how your MIDI note input is processed  Set the arpeggiator parameters  on the ARPEGGIATOR and ARPEGGIATOR2 pages     The ARPEGGIATOR Page    A    Note  In Program Mode  pressing the Arp button will bring you to a similar Arpeggiator screen for the  current program         Horne  ShiftLimit   24 LimitQet 2 UniPolar 
295. lue 7 16  red 7 16  Pages 3 6  Master mode 9 1  MIDI XMIT 9 11  Panic button 2 7  6 3  Path 11 3  PC3LE6 1 1  A 2  PC3LE7 1 1  A 2  PC3LE8 1 1  A 2  PCH 9 22  Pedals 2 3  pedals 1 4  Pitch Wheel 3 5  Play  Pause button  with Easy Audition 2 6  6 2  14 3  Power cable 2 2  Pressure Map  Master 9 5  MIDI Receive 9 18  MIDI Transmit 9 14  PrgChgMode 9 19  Program change formats 9 21  Program change mode 9 19  Program changes  Extended 9 21  MIDI 9 15  Quick Access mode 8 1  Program mode 2 6  4 2  6 1  6 2  Soft buttons 6 3  Program mode page 6 2  Programs  Editing  VAST  6 9  KB3 2 7  selecting 2 6  VAST 2 7  punching in 12 9  Punctuation 5 3    Q    Quantize  Song Mode TRACK Page 10 27  Quantizing 12 15  Quick Access Editor 8 1  Quick Access mode 2 8  4 3    R    RAM objects 5 2  5 4   Real time Control of Arpeggiator Parameters 7 47  Recording Overview 12 1   Recording songs 3 13  14 5    Region   Criteria window   Song mode 10 21  Remap   Song Mode TRACK Page 10 31  Rename 12 6  Renaming objects 5 3  Reset   hard 9 22  Riff Troubleshooting 13 53  Riffs   Setup mode 7 50  ROM objects 5 4  ROM objects  saving 5 2    S    S PDIF 2 2  sample rate 2 2  Save dialog 5 3  Saving  Naming 12 6  Rename 12 6  Setup Mode 13 3  Song Mode 12 5  Saving and namingObjects  Saving 5 3  Saving files 5 6  Saving Master and Everything Files 11 6  Saving objects  RAM 5 4  ROM 5 4  Saving RAM objects 5 2  Saving ROM objects 5 2  Search function 3 12  14 4  Select soft button 11 8  Selecting modes 3 1
296. lues created for each note depending on how hard you strike a key  The Master  Velocity Map affects MIDI velocity values for all MIDI sources and destinations used in the  PC3LE  see the circled box above for its location in the MIDI signal flow   Different maps used  for the Master Velocity Map generate different MIDI velocity values for the same physical key  strike velocity  Each map applies a different curve to received MIDI attack velocities and remaps  them to new velocities before letting them pass  The default map provides the widest range of  velocity expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit your  playing style  See the diagram above for the other pages that affect the MIDI attack velocity  before and after reaching the Master Velocity Map     The default map  Linear  allows MIDI velocities to pass unchanged  Light 1 3 make it  increasingly easier to produce high MIDI velocity values for the same key strike velocity  with  Light 3 being the easiest   so these maps may work better for users who play with a lighter  touch  Hard 1 3 make it increasingly harder to produce high MIDI velocity values for the same  key strike velocity  with Hard 3 being the hardest   so these maps may work better for users  who play with a harder touch  Piano Touch simulates the general velocity response of an  acoustic piano  and is best suited for playing acoustic piano programs  Easy Touch is similar  to the Light settings  making high velocities
297. n LED nor the Play Pause   button LED is lit or flashing   press Record to put the sequencer in REC READY status  The  Record button LED lights  red   Then press Play Pause to start recording  The Play Pause   button flashes  green  to indicate the tempo  Any count off is determined by the current Song   mode setting for the CountOff parameter  Press Play Pause or Stop to end recording and go to  the Save dialog  where you can save the song  or discard it     When the sequencer status is STOPPED  press Play Pause to begin playing the current song   Press Play Pause again to pause playback  and again to resume  Press Stop to end playback     See Chapter 12 for more information on Song Mode        14 5    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips  Program Mode    Change The Effects Chain    In Program mode you can easily change a program   s effects chain by editing the program  An  effects chain can cause either a dramatic or a subtle change to the sound of a program  depending on how it is used  Follow these steps to change the effects chain of the currently  selected program     1  In Program mode  choose the program you would like to edit  then press the Edit button to the left  of the display  This will bring you to the EditProg PARAMETERS page     2  From the EditProg PARAMETERS page  press the FX soft button at the bottom right of the  display  This will bring you to the EditProg FX page  where you can change the program   s two  effects chains  Each program can use up to two 
298. n and use the numbered category buttons to enter a specific  program ID number  then press the Enter category button  Press the Shift category button  again to return the category buttons to their primary function     The PC3LE has various settings for responding to MIDI Program Change commands from  external sources  These are explained in Chapter 9  so we won t go into them here  You should  be able to change programs by sending Program Change commands from your MIDI controller     Easy Audition    Any time you want to hear what a program sounds like  highlight the program s name  while in  Program mode  then press the Play Pause button to play a brief sample  The Demo Button  parameter on the Master Mode 2 page must be on for Easy Audition to work  the parameter is  on by default  Master mode is described in Chapter 9     Program Mode Display    Take a minute to familiarize yourself with the Program mode display  The top line shows you  the MIDI transposition  the current programs category  and what MIDI channel you re on  The  currently selected program is highlighted in the list on the right side of the screen     ror am             5 NOE Jazz Grand  E AT Info A    Info Box   There   s an info box at the left side of the display  Changing the value of a control  moving a knob  or pressing a switch  will display the name of the last moved controller along with its parameter  assignment  there s also an info box for Setup mode            2 6    Startup       PC3LE Programs
299. n on the front  panel  This will bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below         Programe  Channel   mj   MidiBank  4 Mode    Ctl B732  MidiProgi 1 EntriiProsth3   On  Status  Active ArPedSiator   Orn    Po more  CHPRGICTRLS SPANWOL JKEYVWEL   more d    Step 3 A        3  From the CH PROG page  press the CTRLS soft button on the bottom of the screen  see above    This brings you to the Controllers page where you can view and assign physical controllers to  destinations for the current Zone        13 17    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    4  On the Controllers page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen                 IAAF   Bodh  Scale   LEE  Cure   Linear  Offset    DestTuPe   Par am       TELS S PARLOLTEEYLEL    5  On the Controllers page for Zone 2  the Controller field will be highlighted  if not  select the  Controller field with the cursor buttons   Make sure the LED to the left of the Timbre Knob is lit  if  it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter  button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for  the Controller field  see below   You can also set the desired controller in the Controller field by  using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons           Dest Type Param    
300. n the RecTrk parameter  To  permanently store your volume settings with the song  you must store an initial volume for each  track  Let s use the song we created in the parts above as an example  Let s adjust the volume of  track 1 and store the value as an initial volume setting     1  On the Song mode MAIN page  use the Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to Set the  RecTrk parameter to track 1     HHIH AO tase   STOPPED    MY Sons TemPo  1606  H    CurSrnas   RecTrk 011127 Pani  d Mode  Merge  Prog dard Grand Locat  1 il  Track    EEE EEEE EEOAE    2  Find the desired volume level by adjusting the Vol parameter during playback  then press stop  For  this example  let   s set the Vol parameter to 80     THIN events  Har  a   STOPPED     CurSnar 1025   0 TemnFo  104 4   RecTrks 1 Lol an      4 Mode  Merde   Frog  1 Standar E Locate 1 il    O                       Track    cic tram tise lodos    3  Use the left and right more soft buttons at the bottom corners of the display to find the MIXER soft  button and press it  see below   This brings you to the Song MIXER page           12 10    Tutorial  Song Mode          MAI AO tase   SUPPEN    Curro 1625   NY Sons Teneo  106 4  RecTrki 1 Mol   Fan  64 Mode  Merde  Prog L Lancer rang Locat  1 il        Track MEE S a o a el el a a ge    Haning  mare       4  On the Song MIXER page  press the Keep soft button to store initial values for all tracks  see  below          2 3 z    64 64 64 64   d  oH iff iff ler ler  143 242 
301. nations    PC3LE Sound Engine MIDI Out via MIDI Out port or USB Computer port  to       PC3LE Keyboard                         PC3LE audio outputs    The receive Velocity Map affects the way the PC3LE receives MIDI velocity values from its USB  or MIDI In port  see the circled box above for its location in the MIDI signal flow   Different  maps output different MIDI velocity values for the same received MIDI attack velocity  Each  map applies a different curve to received MIDI attack velocities and remaps them to new  velocities before letting them pass  this parameter has no effect on MIDI data sent from the  PC3LE   s keyboard   The default map provides the widest range of velocity expression  but you  may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit your playing style  See the  diagram above for the other pages that affect the MIDI attack velocity before reaching the  receive Velocity Map     The default map  Linear  allows MIDI velocities to pass unchanged  Maps Light 1 3 make it  increasingly easier to produce high MIDI velocity values for the same key strike velocity  with  Light 3 being the easiest   so these maps may work better for users who play with a lighter  touch  Hard 1 3 make it increasingly harder to produce high MIDI velocity values for the same  key strike velocity  with Hard 3 being the hardest   so these maps may work better for users  who play with a harder touch  Piano Touch simulates the general velocity response of an  acoustic piano  a
302. ncated to 127 if the result of scaling is greater than 127     1  Tf you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Next  press 58 and then Enter on the alphanumeric  pad to select the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  see below   You can also select setups by using the        buttons or oe Wheel        S   Techno Substance  57 Pad 2 Ther Pad 1    sa Fi ae no    eg  Ol Blank Con i lit  Octav  EES Panie Jintao   Tebose TePose    2  With the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad selected in setup mode  press the Edit button on the front panel   This will bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below              Ores         Programe  Channel   MidiBank  El  MidiProge 1    Status  Active    1001 Usb _MIDI NIDI LOCAL  BankMode   Ctl B7532  EntruProstha 1 On  Arresaaiator   Orn              Step 3 A    3  From the CH PROG page  press the CTRLS soft button on the bottom of the screen  see above    This brings you to the Controllers page where you can view and assign physical controllers to  destinations for the current Zone     4  On the Controllers page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2  see  below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen     A       Par am    TELS 4 PANWOLIKEYWEL   more           13 21    Tutorials  Setup
303. nd  PLYFLT  on page 10 15   This will prevent Mono Pressure messages from being recorded to any  track  Alternatively  you can erase Mono Pressure messages from specific tracks after recording   To do this  go to the EditSong  Track page  see Song Editor  The TRACK Page on page 10 21   On  the EditSong  Track page  use the Chan Zone buttons to choose the track to edit  visible in the  Track field at the top right corner of the display   Set the Function parameter to Erase and the  Events parameter to MonoPress  Use the From and To fields to select the entire length of your  song  and press the Go soft button to erase Mono Pressure messages from the selected track   Repeat this for each desired track  You can also choose ALL for the Track parameter to erase  Mono Pressure messages from all tracks     Controller Messages  When recording a setup to Song mode with Mult selected for RecTrk in  Song mode  you may often be recording more controller messages than you realize  This can  happen because multiple setup zones often respond to the same physical controllers  This is  likely to be the case when you use a setup created by duplicating zones and do not change the  controller destination assignments for each new zone  Often this is the desired behavior  such as  when using zones to create layers  For example  if zone one sends pitch bend messages from the  pitch wheel  and you duplicate this zone to create a layered zone two  you will likely want the  zone two to send the same m
304. nd Adv   Advance      When set to On or Adv  the keys   MIDI note numbers  actually   correspond to all the characters  shown on page 5 3  There are  also equivalents to the cursor  movement  insertion  deletion   and OK  Enter  buttons     On requires you to move the  cursor to enter each letter  just as  you have to do when using the  normal data entry methods for  naming  Adv automatically  moves the cursor one space to  the right each time you strike a  key  just like a typewriter or  computer keyboard  This is the  most convenient setting     Move cursor left one space  Move cursor right one space   Shift     Space     Move cursor left one space  Move cursor right one space  Move cursor to end of name       AO      gt   __   _       _   _         c2    a           c3       _         C4                      C5       _     gt     C6              T     C7       _         C8                                                          Delete  move characters left one space  Insert  move characters right one space    il  2   3              go    9    0  zero         Hyphen  _  Underscore      Equals      Backspace        Semicolon      Apostrophe        Colon      Quote        Comma   lt      Period   gt      Slash          Left bracket     Back quote      Right bracket     Backslash      OK  Enter   Delete  move characters left one space  Insert  move characters right one space    Use the  Shift  keys or  Sustain pedal to enter  upper case and  special characters       Editing C
305. nd is best suited for playing acoustic piano sounds  Easy Touch is similar to the  Light settings  making high velocities easier to play  but it allows more sensitive control over  playing high velocities by not boosting the MIDI velocity for fast strike velocities as much as it  does for medium strike velocities  GM Receive mimics the velocity map commonly used by  keyboards that use the General MIDI  GM  sound set  The GM Receive map makes medium  strike velocities produce higher MIDI velocities compared to the Linear map        9 17    Master Mode       MIDI Receive  RECV     Pressure Map  Receive     Change the receive Pressure Map setting if you are triggering the PC3LE with external MIDI  gear which is producing MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values that are too high or too low based on  your playing style  how soft or hard that you press the keys   The default map provides the  widest range of pressure  aftertouch  expression  but you may want to choose a different map if  the default does not suit your playing style     MIDI  Sources         PC3LE Keyboard    MIDI In via MIDI In port or USB Computer port                  Destinations    PC3LE Sound Engine MIDI Out via MIDI Out port or USB Computer port  to    PC3LE audio outputs    The receive Pressure Map affects the way the PC3LE receives MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values  from its USB or MIDI In port  see the circled box above for its location in the MIDI signal flow    Different maps output different MIDI pressure  af
306. ne  0 127 None    Entry Volume  Exit Volume    Entry Volume enables you to control the initial MIDI volume setting for each zone of the current  setup  When you select a setup in Setup mode  MIDI channels for zones that have an Entry  Volume value other than None will receive that value as a MIDI volume control message  MIDI  Controller 07   This sets the starting volume level for each zone  Subsequent MIDI volume  control signals sent to the setup   s MIDI channels affect the volume normally     When you exit the current setup  each zone sends another volume control message  MIDI  Controller 07  to set the volumes on the PC3LE   s MIDI channels  according to the value of the  Exit Volume parameter  unless Exit Volume is set to None      Entry Pan  Exit Pan    Entry Pan enables you to control the initial MIDI pan setting for each zone of the current setup   When you select a setup in Setup mode  MIDI channels for zones that have an Entry Pan value  other than None will receive that value as a MIDI pan control message  MIDI Controller 10    This sets the starting pan position for each zone  Subsequent MIDI pan control signals sent to  the setup   s MIDI channels affect the pan normally     When you exit the current setup  each zone sends another pan control message  MIDI Controller  10  to set the pan positions on the PC3LE   s MIDI channels  according to the value of the Exit Pan  parameter  unless Exit Pan is set to None      Most programs respond to pan messages on the next
307. ne sends and receives  normally via MIDI  Solo causes only the current zone to play     backgrounding    all other zones   backgrounded zones send and receive program changes and entry exit controller values  but  don t play notes   With a value of Solo Muted  the current zone is both soloed and muted   when the zone isn t soloed  it won t produce sound   See Set Controls Zone Mutes    MUTES  on page 7 65 for a way to automatically set the assignable switches to mute zones     ation    This parameter determines whether the currently selected zone transmits only to the PC3LE   Local   transmits only to the MIDI port  MIDI   transmits only to the USB port  USB_MIDI    transmits to a pair of destinations  MIDI Local  USB_MIDI Local  or USB_MIDI MIDID   or  transmits to all destinations  USB_MIDI MIDI Local      ank Mode  BankMode     The BankMode you choose determines how bank numbers will be sent over MIDI when the  setup is selected  and in what format  It also affects how many MIDI banks and programs you  can choose     None means no bank number is sent  just the program number  Ctl 0 means that the bank  number is sent as a MIDI Controller  0 message  Ctl 32 means it is sent as MIDI Controller  32   Ctl 0 32 means it is sent as a dual controller  two byte  message  with the most significant byte   MSB  of the bank number sent as Controller 0 and the least significant byte  LSB  as Controller  32  Bank Select messages allow you to specify banks numbered 0 127     The MIDI Spe
308. new  program at the desired time  This can be done most precisely if you know the ID  of the program you wish       12 15    Tutorial  Song Mode       to change to  Enter the number with the alphanumeric pad and then press Enter when you want to make  the change  You won t be able to see the numbers you ve entered until you press Enter  but you can  press Cancel to start over if you   ve made a mistake or if you are unsure what you ve entered   Use the same method if you would like to change the program back to the original after the new section     The Event List    Song mode is a powerful composition tool because just about anything that you do on the  PC3LE is recorded into a track as event messages  Once recorded  these events can be altered   copied or removed  Each track has an event list  containing all of the events recorded into a  track  from which they can be viewed and edited  For details see the Song mode chapter  Song  Editor  The EVENT page        12 16    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Chapter 13  Tutorials  Setup Mode    In This Chapter     Tie Setup Editt satsene aneren tanaan ta datada 13 3  Using And Editing A Split Program Setup     0    eee 13 4  Using Setup Mode To Play Layers Of Instruments       060000 13 8  Adjusting The Volume And Pan Of Zones    0 6 06 eee 13 11  Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Different Zones      ooooooommommmm  m   13 13  Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones        oooooooo o   13 17  
309. ng each cycle according to the settings for Note Shift and Shift Limit  If  the limit allows the notes to go out of MIDI range  for example  if you set Shift to 12  set the limit  to 60  and play C6   then those    ghost    notes don t sound  but they take up rhythmic space  the  Arpeggiator waits for the cycle to play itself out before starting over     Unipolar means that after playing up to the shift limit  the Arpeggiator begins shifting notes in  the opposite direction  until it reaches the original pitch  where it reverses again  To determine  the next note when it reaches the shift limit  the Arpeggiator calculates the interval between the  shift limit and what the next note would be if the shift limit weren t there  It then plays the note  that is the calculated interval lower than the last note before the shift limit  The same thing  happens in reverse when the arpeggiated notes get back down to the original pitch  The  following table makes this easier to visualize by showing the result of arpeggiating one note   C4  in Unipolar mode  with Note Shift set to 3 ST and various values for Shift Limit     Resulting Arpeggiation  When LimitOption is Unipolar           Shift Limit Comment  Up Down Up  Same notes play in both directions  6 ST  F 4  C4  D 4  F 4  D 4  C4 D 4      when Shift Limit is a multiple of  Note Shift       Last upward note before shift limit is  F 4  next upward note would be  7 ST  G4  C4  D 4  F 4  Es  C 4  D 4      A4  which is 2 ST from shift lim
310. ng from the rubber feet and  attach them now  near each corner  all on the same level     3  Connect the power cable     4  Make sure your sound system is at a safe volume level  Also make sure that the PC3LE   s  MASTER VOLUME slider  on the far left side of the front panel  is all the way down     5  Plug ina pair of stereo headphones or run standard  1 4 inch  audio cables from your  amplifier or mixer to the Balanced Analog Outputs on the PC3LE   Use the Balanced  Analog Outputs Left out for mono   Balanced     TRS    or    Stereo     cables are                   recommended   Balanced   lt  gt  USB MIDI PEDALS Analog Outputs     O Digital    gt       In Thru Out Contrast Out sw sw2 cc Left Right Headphones  m  O00 85666 66  A Sustain Mono    Make Music    1  Power up your PC3LE  raise the level of the MASTER VOLUME slider  and check out  some of the programs  The PC3LE starts up in Program mode by default     2  Scroll through the program list with the Alpha Wheel      buttons  or use the category  buttons to select programs and try the PC3LE   s many sounds        2 1    Startup       Startup   the Details    Startup    the Details    This section walks you through the hookup of your PC3LE  We ll take a look at the rear panel   then describe the power  audio  and other cable connections     Before You Start       Don t connect anything until you make sure your PC3LE is properly and safely situated  Also  if  your PC3LE has been out in the cold  give it time to warm up t
311. nges  and other controllers for the  song are correct  regardless of where you start the song  With Control Chase set to Off  the  sequencer behaves as previously described     Quant    The Quantize parameter determines the amount of real time quantization  if any  applied to the  sequence during recording  The percentage specified for this parameter is the amount of  quantization the sequencer applies to the grid  see below  for each Note event recorded     Note that using real time quantization has the same effect as recording normally  and then using  the Quantize Track Editing operation        10 17    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The STATS Page    Grid    The grid parameter determines the resolution of quantization and the position of the grid  points     Swing  The Swing parameter determines the amount  in units of percent  of    swing    applied during    quantization     Release    The Release parameter determines whether or not note off events are quantized     Key Wait    With Key Wait set to on  a key strike will trigger playback of a sequence  if the play  pause  button is armed   or trigger recording of a sequence  if the record button is armed      Song Mode  The STATS Page    The STATS page is a display only page that shows the status of the PC3LE event pool  The event  pool is used by all the sequences loaded at a given time in the system  These include  the current  song  the compare song buffer  and up to 16 riffs     The STATS page shown b
312. ngs  As with any tool  however  it s best to start with  the basics  If you are familiar with other sequencers  you will have no problem using Song mode  in the PC3LE  Read through this section  however  to learn about the features that make the  PC3LE   s sequencer unique     What is a Sequencer     A sequencer is similar in some ways to a multi track tape recorder  you can record and play back  all sorts of music and sounds  layer sounds on top of other sounds  and change or manipulate  things that you   ve previously recorded  Unlike a tape recorder  however  you do not actually  record sounds with a sequencer  Rather  you are recording commands that cause sounds to be  played  Nonetheless  we will sometimes explain sequencer features by drawing analogies to  familiar tape recording techniques such as splicing and overdubbing     There are several advantages to recording a song by sequencing  For one thing  sequencer  commands take up much less disk space than digitally recorded music would  so you can get a  lot of information  that is  music  per megabyte  Furthermore  you can easily make changes to  your sequences  For example  you can change individual notes  transpose parts  or change  instrumentation  Lastly  you can share the sequences you create with other musicians     Song Mode  The MAIN Page    The Song mode MAIN Page allows real time recording and playback  song and track selection   From this page you can view and edit the tracks    channel  program  volume an
313. ni 7 17  Te Pani  Volume  PLANT VOL  Page ro A is 7 25  The Key  Velocity EY Y ELIPSE a iiaea iaaea veasisteS eacuarestanneanionase RES 7 26  Low Key  LoKey   High Key  ES  ita 7 26  TANS posee ae ae e aaa E A O ates aanseushs nase spensbhas a ae a E S a TRS 7 27       Note Map 00 EAS IA A eases sestseee 2S 7 27    Velocity Seale VelScl h syns a R AA E a 7 28  Velocity Offset  VelOffset  saie eroaa eiii it deis sien ee 7 29  Velocity Curve  Vel CUYO tia TE id ota 7 31  Low Velocity  LoVel   High Velocity   HiVel  iia inn in E o a 7 33  THE BEND Pase a ida 7 34  Bend Range  Semitones  and Bend Range  Cents   Up and DOWN   occocinccninonnnnnnncnnancncancncancncanancnncncanancnncninnos 7 34  The ARPEGGIATOR  amp  ARPEGGIATOR 2  ARP1  ARP2  Pages  ccmcocioconionnininncinancrncicincncrnonarnonaricnan conan coran conan 7 35  Real time Control of Arpeggiator ParaMetelS  cococoninoninnononenoncnncnrnrarnnnncnnnnnnnnnncannnannnnn coran nano nanan anna rarananannnnos 7 47  Th   COMMON Page sont ansaa aa dc uvan a ii aana 7 49  A O E 7 49  BR AA Bie aed eee iene eee hacen We Gein a ee Se ee 7 49  Pax BX Chame Lc RON 7 50  KB3 Channel nani a A A Seles ones Ae Senn 7 50  Riscal ida ib 7 51  Real time Control of Riff Parameters sisisi ennea n a a a nono non none cnn nena non nano S nn corno naar 7 59  The FX Pages  FX AUX ANEXO  nO ia cae tea ena an aaia AAEN aS AEA AEEA KAREKA Raa 7 60  Effects  OVErVi Wisin 7 60  A A CaS esd Sct es canta ths Aa T E teats E 7 62  The AUXEXT and AUXFX2 PAC
314. nly hear part of the pattern from each key  often making the pattern  unrecognizable  Though triggering a Shift pattern from multiple keys can be used creatively  it  can also make it hard to predict what the output will be     You can edit the included patterns by pressing    Edit    with a pattern highlighted in the ShiftPatt  field  see edit screen below   The top line of the    EditShiftPatt    page shows the full name for a  pattern whose name does not fit on the ARPEGGIATOR page  This page also displays the  pattern s total number of steps  as well as pattern direction  Pressing Step  removes the last step  in the list  pressing Step  inserts a new note step at the end of the list  the pattern editor  remembers the values of removed steps until you save or exit   Use the cursor to move between       7 41    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    pattern steps  use the alpha wheel  alphanumeric pad  or plus  minus buttons to enter the note  shift amount for each step  Press More to see a second page for patterns with more than 24 steps   You can insert a step with a value of    none    by entering  127 and then shifting down one more  step  A step with the value    none    causes the arpeggiator to play nothing for that step  allowing  you to create rhythmic patterns by using    none    to leave spaces  When the arpeggiator  determines the range of pattern notes played with the Limit parameter  see below   steps with a  value of    none    will be calculated as a step valu
315. nments  like loss of program volume     6  When you are finished making controller assignments  press the Exit button to save the edited  program and return to the Program mode main page  When prompted to save the program  press the  Yes soft button  followed by the Save soft button to save the program with the same name under the  lowest available user ID   To learn how to rename the program or save it under a different ID   see  Saving and Naming on page 5 3        14 7    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips    Setup Mode    Assign A Zone To Use Pads Only    In Setup mode it s common to have a zone that can be played from the pads  but not from the  keyboard  To do this  follow these steps     1     From the Setup mode main page  choose the setup that you wish to edit and press the Edit button to  the left of the display  This will display the Setup Editor     In the Setup Editor  select the zone that you have assigned to be played from the pads by using the  Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display  The currently selected zone can be viewed in the top  right corner of the display   For details on assigning pads to a zone  see Pads on page 7 15      With the desired zone selected  press the KEY VEL soft button at the bottom of the display  This  will bring you to the KEY VEL page     On the KEY VEL page  select the LoKey field  then use the Alpha Wheel to turn this value all the  way up to G9  Do the same for the HiKey field if G9 is not already selected  Now this zone 
316. note velocity within a range in  order to make arpeggiation sound more human like  with each note varying slightly in velocity   The Human settings use the velocity received from the first note played as the center of the  randomization range  Each note of the arpeggiator will randomly choose a velocity within the  given range   See the table below for velocity ranges      The Chimp1 through Chimp4 settings function in a similar fashion to the Human settings  see  above   Like the Human settings  the Chimp settings randomly change played note velocity  within a range  but the Chimp settings have larger randomization ranges  The Chimp settings  use the velocity received from the first note played as the center of the randomization range   Each note of the arpeggiator will randomly choose a velocity within the given range   See the  table below for velocity ranges      Note  For Human and Chimp modes  if the velocity of the first played note is low enough that the selected  randomization range could result in a velocity of zero  some notes may have a velocity of zero and  therefore produce no sound                          Velocity  Velocity Setting Randomization  Range  Human  3  Human2  Human3  Human4    Chimp1  25  Chimp2  35  Chimp3   50  Chimp4   64       MissNotes1 through MissNotes9 makes the PC3LE randomly miss playing a percentage of  inputted notes  See the table below for percentages and their equivalent settings  Each of these  settings also randomly changes some of
317. ns    Pedals    The PC3LE has two stereo jacks  labeled SW1  amp  SW2  for switch pedals  assignable to on off  functions  these pedals control sustain and sostenuto by default   The PC3LE also has one jack  for a continuous pedal  assignable to continuous controller functions  this pedal controls  volume by default   Ask your Kurzweil dealer about the following optional pedals     FS 1 Standard box shaped switch pedal  KFP 1 Single piano style switch pedal  KFP 2M Double piano style switch pedal unit  CC 1 Continuous pedal    USB Storage Device    You can plug a USB mass storage device such as a    thumb drive    into the PC3LE for backing up   archiving  sharing your work  and updating your software  Any size USB mass storage device  will work  though thumb drives are recommended for their portability  durability  and low  price        1 4    Startup       Make Connections    Chapter 2  Startup    If hooking up new gear is familiar to you  and you just want to get going  here   s a quick  description of what you need to get started with your PC3LE  If you need more information   thorough descriptions of each step follow     Make Connections    1  Set the keyboard on a hard  flat  level surface  Make sure to leave plenty of room for  ventilation     2  Four adhesive backed rubber feet are provided with your PC3LE  If you want to attach  them to the bottom of the PC3LE  recommended to prevent scratching your tabletop    carefully turn the keyboard over  remove the paper backi
318. nspose based on the  key set for the Root Note parameter  Since this bass part was originally played starting on a G in  the song 95 Old School Jam  the Root Note parameter has been set to G1  When you play a G  within the trigger range  this riff will play in the correct key  If you have changed settings on  this page  make sure Transpose is set to On and Root Note to G1 before continuing this    tutorial  see below         Ar  35 Old School Jam    1 265 SrcTrack    Pi    Re Channel         AAA A   more j    When using your own riff  setting the Root Note parameter to match the root note of the riff in  its original song will allow you to transpose the riff while keeping it in tune with programs on  other zones  When the Root Note parameter is selected  you can set a root note by holding the  Enter category button and then playing the desired keyboard key        13 45    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    8  Next  press the RIFF2 soft button at the bottom of the display to move to the RIFF2 page once  again  On the RIFF2 page  We can see that the bass riff on zone 2 is set to sync with the first riff   arpeggiator  or song available  because the SyncZone parameter is set to First Avail  The riff waits  to trigger until the next down beat of whatever it is syncing with because the SyncType parameter  is set to DownBeat  see below   This is why the riff waits for a downbeat before transposing and  restarting its loop when triggered     PelounT  e   Downbeat  
319. nt functions for the 5 assignable  switches to control up to 10 parameters   plus two more parameters can be controlled using  the assignable Arp Enable and Arp Latch buttons   Use these to enable or disable effects   mute layers of sound  or control other functions      e Easy controller assignment  in Program mode press the Edit button  then the PARAMS soft  button  On the Parameters page  select a parameter to control from the list  highlight the  control source column  then assign a control by holding the Enter button and touching the  drum pad  knob  switch  or other control that you wish to assign      e Easily set favorite sounds  for each category of sounds  make your favorite program get  selected first when you press its category button  Just select your favorite program in a  category and hold its category button for a few seconds      e    Split Layer    button  press this button to quickly create setups that split the keyboard into  ranges of different instrument sounds  or layer instrument sounds on the same keys      e    Arp Settings    button  easily access the arpeggiator settings for a complete set of  arpeggiator parameters      e    Save    button  save your settings with two easy button presses         1 1    Introduction       Keeping Current    The PC3LE contains many of the same sounds as the PC3  This includes detailed acoustic and  electric pianos  rich orchestral sounds  and many other instruments from Kurzweil s extensive  sample collections  The 
320. ntrol O O  All Notes Off O O  Aux Messages    Active Sense X X  Reset Xx Xx  Notes  Manufacturer   s ID   07  Device ID  default   0   programmable 0 127                A 1    Specifications       Specifications  Mode 1  Omni On  Poly Mode 2  Omni On  Mono  Mode 3  Omni Off  Poly Mode 4  Omni Off  Mono  Specifications  PC3LE6    Height   5    12 7 cm   Depth   14 5    36 83 cm   Length   41 5    105 41 cm   Weight   31 Ib    14 06 kg     PC3LE7   Height   5    12 7 cm   Depth   14 5    36 83 cm   Length   49 9    126 7 cm   Weight   37 5 lb    17 kg     PC3LE8   Height   5    12 7 cm    Depth   14 5    36 83 cm   Length   56 48    143 41 cm   Weight   54 15 lb    24 56 kg     Power  PC3LE6  PC3LE7  PC3LE8    Internal AC power supply   Automatic selection 90 250V AC operation  50 60 Hz   Fuse  0 25A slow blow   Measured AC input current  130 mA at 120 VAC  65 mA at 240 VAC    Audio Outputs  PC3LE6  PC3LE7  PC3LE8   Main  Balanced 1 4 TRS jack   21DBu maximum output  400 ohms balanced source impedance  24 bit A to D converters     gt 120dB dynamic range  balanced    Headphones  8Vrms maximum output   47 ohms source impedance    O yes  X  no       A 2       Appendix B  PC3LE Bootloader    The Bootloader is the program that runs when the PC3LE is first turned on  Its job is to check  that hardware is functional  initialize the digital systems  and load the main synthesizer  program  Under normal circumstances you might not even notice that the Bootloader is there at  all  since t
321. o Switch 1   Switch 2   Switch 3   Switch 4 l Switch 5  shift row for accessing         l   different switches l   l l l   l   or knobs corresponds   O Switch 6   Switch 7   Switch 8   Switch 9   Switch 10       to the switch and knob  names in the Setup ke3    ASSIGNABLE CONTROLS           ___   _        Editor  Press the        Shift button to the left GAN GAN GAN GAN GAN  of the switches or  knobs to access each i  I I I l    row  The LED to the  left of each row will    light to show which O Knob 1    Knob2    Knob3   Knob4   Knob5  row is being l l l l  accessed  l l   O   Knob 6 Knob 7 Knob 8 l Knob 9 Knob 10    l  l  knob 11  Knob 12   Knob 13         Knob 14 Knob 15    Once you have selected the desired controller in the Controls field  use the cursor buttons to set  the controller destination and other available parameters  See below for explanations of each  controller   s parameters        7     le     Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Knobs  CC Pedal  Modwheel  Pitchbend up dn  Pitch Wheel   Pressure    The parameters for the Knobs  CC Pedal  Modwheel  and Pressure are the same  see an example  of the Knob 1 page  below   The parameters for the Pitch Wheel are the same  but there is a  separate page of parameters for moving Pitch Wheel up  Pitchbend up  and moving it down   Pitchbend dn      The PC3LE features mono pressure  commonly called aftertouch on other keyboards         Aone Oo  AE nob       alle    r  ExiTllalue    PANLIOLIKEYLEL                       
322. o la iE pct ep taal Shs A testa See RUS Bek Sag Wattle RD a E RES 14 7  Setup Mode  e Assign A Zone To Use Pads Only    6  enn nes 14 8    e Assign Pads To Play Notes  Chords  Riffs  Or To Toggle Other Functions Like Arpeggiators 14 9  Create A User Shift Or Velocity Pattern For Custom Arpeggiations      ooooooommo    14 10  e Record A Short Song For Use As A Riff  Record A Setup To Song Mode                14 10       14 1    Power User Tips       General Tips    General Tips    Set The Start up Program And MIDI Channel    ES  amp     When the PC3LE is turned on  Program mode is automatically selected  You can set a MIDI  channel and program to be automatically selected in Program mode when the PC3LE is turned  on  Follow these steps to set the start up MIDI channel and program     1  First enter Program mode  if you are not in Program mode  press the Exit button to the right of the  display until you see ProgramMode in the top left of the display      2  Once in program mode  use the Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to select the start up  MIDI channel  The current MIDI channel is displayed in the top right of the display     3  Next  select the start up program by using the Alpha Wheel  cursor buttons        buttons  Category  buttons  or press the Category Shift button to use the Category buttons as an alphanumeric pad and  enter a program ID      4  Next  press the Master Mode button  grouped with the Mode buttons to the left of the display  to  enter Maste
323. o layers or algorithms  just a set of  oscillators  designed to emulate the tonewheels in a Hammond Organ  that start running as  soon as you select a KB3 program  We ve done extensive testing and analysis with several tone  wheel organs  and created our own models to emulate the unique tone wheel sound  Each  oscillator operates independently  and has its own pitch and amplitude settings  The  oscillators   we   ll call them tone wheels from here on   are divided into an upper and lower  group  The upper tone wheels use the samples in the PC3LE s keymaps to generate sound   while the lower tone wheels use sine waves     KB3 programs are different enough from V A S T  programs that we use the term KB3 mode to  describe what s going on when you play a KB3 program  Whenever you play a KB3 program   you are in KB3 mode  You can find KB3 programs by pressing the Organ category button while  in Program mode  The programs that use KB3 mode will light the KB3 LED to the left of the  knobs  indicating that the PC3LE s knobs and switches are now dedicated to the organ controls  that are labeled on the front panel  KB3 program will also be displayed in the program mode  info box     Note  You can play KB3 programs only on a single channel at a time  When a channel other than  the currently selected channel is using a KB3 program  the info box on the program mode main  page will indicate which MIDI channel is using a KB3 program        6 5    Program Mode       V A S T  and KB3 Programs
324. o room temperature before  starting it  since condensation may have formed inside the PC3LE  It is normal for the rear panel  near the MIDI jacks to become warm after a while     Connecting the Power Cable  Line Cord     The PC3LE runs on AC power and works with voltages from 90 260 volts at 50 60 Hz  The  voltage level is detected and set automatically by the PC3LE     As you face the back of the PC3LE  the power connection is at the left  First connect the power  cable to the PC3LE  then plug the power cable into a grounded outlet  If your power source does  not have the standard three hole outlet  you should take the time to install a proper grounding  system  This will reduce the risk of a shock     Connecting Audio Cables    Analog    After you ve turned down the level on your sound system  connect the PC3LE   s analog audio  outputs to your sound system using a pair of stereo or mono audio cables  Mono cables will  always work  but if you   re going into balanced inputs  use stereo cables for a better signal to   noise ratio and a bit more volume  The PC3LE s analog outputs are balanced  and generate a     hotter    signal than some previous Kurzweil instruments     Connect one end of each audio cable to your mixing board or PA system inputs  and connect the  other end to the jacks marked Main Left and Right on the rear panel of the PC3LE  If you have  only one input available  use the PC3LE   s Main Left output to get the full signal in mono     Alternatively  connect 
325. ode  the startup mode  If you ve  made any changes  you ll be asked whether you want to save before leaving any editor  Press  the No soft button or the Exit button if you don t want to save  If you want to save  press the  Rename or Yes soft button  and you ll see the Save dialog  which is described in Saving and  Naming on page 5 3     Using the Modes    You can play your PC3LE regardless of the mode you re in  The PC3LE s MIDI response is  almost always active  Even so there are three modes that are more performance oriented than  the others  These are Program  Setup  and Quick Access modes  We   ll describe each of the six  modes briefly in this section     Program Mode    The PC3LE starts up in Program mode  where you can select  play  and edit programs  The  Program mode entry level page shows the currently selected program  as well as a small  segment of the program list     The Program Editor takes you to the core of the PC3LE s sound editing parameters     Setup Mode    Setup mode lets you select  play  and edit setups  Setups consist of up to 16 separate zones  split  or overlapping  each having its own program  MIDI channel  and control parameters  Setups are  great for performance situations  whether you re playing multiple PC3LE programs or  controlling additional synths connected to the PC3LE   s MIDI Out port  Chapter 7 describes  Setup mode        The Operating Modes       Using the Modes    If you re using a different MIDI controller  you can make use of Setu
326. of control destinations will be listed in the Dest field  see  below   Choose Param if you would like to control one of the parameters for the program on the  current setup zone  such a parameter for an effect in the program   s effects chain  or a parameter  for a synth function such as a filter or LFO used by the program  The parameters listed depend  on what parameters exist for the current zone   s program and effects chain  see Dest below for  details on available parameters   Choose Ctrl if you would like to control a MIDI continuous  controller number  when Param is selected  each parameter sends a MIDI CC value as well  see  the note under Dest  below  for details   By default  MIDI continuous controller values are sent  internally to the program on the controller   s zone  as well as to the USB and MIDI out ports  To  change this from the default  see Destination on page 7 8        7 11    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Dest    Depending on the DestType field  see above   use this parameter to select a destination either  from the Parameters list for the program on the current zone  or from the MIDI Controller  Destination list  see page 7 17   The Parameters list shows all parameters from the program  mode PARAMETERS page of the program on the current zone  including synth  insert and aux  effect parameters  see page 6 9 for details on the PARAMETERS page   When DestType is set to  Param  the Dest field will prefix insert effect parameters with FXInsert1   and
327. ol KB3 settings  see  Set Controls KB3  KB3CTL  on page 7 65         9 20    Master Mode       Program Change Formats    Program Change Formats    The PC3LE can store more programs than the MIDI program change specification can handle   MIDI lets you send program change numbers from 0 to 127 or 1 to 128 only   So we ve designed  a system that makes program selection more flexible  This is true whether you re selecting  programs from the PC3LE s front panel  or via MIDI     Program Change Type For Use With        Extended Program changes in    banks    of 128 ID  s  This is for connecting a  generic MIDI device as a controller device        K2600 Bank changes and Program changes from a K2600     The PC3LE gives you thousands of program change numbers to work with  These are organized  into 16    banks    of 128 each  starting at program 0  For example  bank 1 contains programs 0 127   bank 2 contains programs 128 255  bank 3 contains programs 256 383  etc  Because the PC3LE s  programs start at program 0  each program   s program change number is its object ID number  plus 1  The PC3LE can use several different formats for interpreting program change  commands  The value for the ProgChgMode parameter on the RECEIVE page determines which  format is used  and the one you should select depends on your MIDI system     If you expect you ll always change programs from your PC3LE   s front panel  selecting programs  is as simple as entering the programs object ID on the alphanumeric 
328. old with the apparatus  When a cart is used  use caution    when moving the cart   apparatus combination to avoid injury from tip   over        13  Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when unused for long  periods of time     14  Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel  Servicing is required when the apparatus  has been damaged in any way  such as power supply cord or plug is damaged  liquid has  been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus  the apparatus has been exposed to rain  or moisture  does not operate normally  or has been dropped     Warning  To reduce the risk of fire or electric shock  do not expose this apparatus to rain or mois   ture  Do not expose this equipment to dripping or splashing and ensure that no objects filled with  liquids  such as vases  are placed on the equipment     To completely disconnect this equipment from the AC Mains  disconnect the power supply cord  plug from the AC receptacle     Kurzweil International Contacts    Contact the Kurzweil office listed below to locate your local Kurzweil representative     American Music  amp  Sound  5304 Derry Avenue  C  Agoura Hills   California 91301 USA    telephone   800  994 4984  fax   818  597 0411  Email  Info AmericanMusicAndSound com    Kurzweil Co   LTD   iPark Building  102  Floor 9  Jeongja Dong 9  Bundang Gu  Soungnam Shi  Gyeonggi Do 463 859  South Korea    www ycpiano co kr  www youngchang com  www kurzweil com             TECHNICAL SUPPORT  Email  support 
329. om the Event list and temporarily stores it in a  memory buffer so that you can immediately paste it into a new location     Copy  Makes a duplicate of the currently selected event and temporarily stores it in a memory  buffer so that you can immediately paste it into a new location     Paste  Inserts the most recent cut or copied event into the Event list at the currently selected  Bar   Beat   Tick location  The pasted event will share the same location with the event that  already existed at that location in the Event list  but it will appear before the pre existing event     New  Inserts a new event by duplicating the current event     Done  On the View page  returns to the EVENT page  On the EVENT page  returns to the  COMMON page     Tempo Track    To access the tempo track  use the channel up down buttons to navigate to track 1  then press  channel down  The tempo track functions the same as the other tracks  except the only event  type available is tempo change        10 33    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The EVENT Page       10 34    Storage Mode       Storage Mode Page    Chapter 11  Storage Mode    Storage mode lets you use a USB device  such as a thumb drive  to load  save  back up  and copy  files between the PC3LE and the outside world     Storage mode in the PC3LE allows flexibility to organize files and their contents  Its features can  save you time by allowing you to select and organize files and directories     Here s a summary of Storag
330. om value   the PC3LE updates the To value     Play will start the playback of the song from the Bar and Beat set in the Locate parameter  When  the song is playing  this soft button functions as a Pause button  Stop stops the playback of the  song and return to the Bar and Beat set as the Locate value     Go performs any of the Track based edit functions described above  Done will return you to the  EditSong   COMMON page        10 23    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  Track Functions    Song Editor  Track Functions    Erase    This function erases specified events from a region of time  but it doesn t delete the region of  time  The result is like erasing a section of recording tape  If you want to completely remove a  segment and shorten the length of the track  you can do it with the Delete function         Eg    Function     i    From  E   1 dE    a    Events   All    Use the Copy function to duplicate the selected events from the current track and place them in  the same track or on another track  either merging with or overwriting existing data     Copy           Ens   Function   DstTrack   Location      lo i    From  k   1 a    a F  Events   All         Tore      If you do not want to copy all of the MIDI events in the defined range of time on the current  track  use the Events parameter in the Region   Criteria box to select a specific MIDI event type  you would like the edit function to affect  Some event types provide you more criteria selection  pa
331. on  Zones 2 and 3  if not  review the previous steps   Zone 2 sends increasing volume values from 0   127 as you turn Knob1 up  Zone 3 sends decreasing volume values from 127 0 as you turn Knob  1 up  This is because the Offset of 127 for Zone 3 makes the Zone set 127 as a volume when Knob  1 is down  sending a value of 0  which gets added to the Offset of 127  0 127 127   Zone 3 then  decreases in volume as Knob 1 is turned up  because of the  100  Scale set for Zone 3        16  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup Editor section at the beginning of this chapter  for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor        13 29    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Switch Between Zones Based On Played Keyboard Velocity    Switch Between Zones Based On Played Keyboard Velocity    You can set a setup Zone to only be heard when the keyboard is played within a certain velocity  range  This technique can be used in different ways depending on the situation  Here we will go  over one of its most basic uses  We will edit the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  The setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad is  a layered setup that uses piano on Zone 1 and    pad    type synth sounds on Zones 2 and 3  Lets edit this  setup so that the pad sounds on Zones 2 and 3 are only heard when the keyboard is played with a high  velocity  struck hard   Using Zone velocity ranges in this way allows you to emphasiz
332. on to the right  of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your changes to this setup under a new ID   See The Setup  Editor section at the beginning of this chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup  Editor           13 6    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using And Editing A Split Program Setup    Part 3  Creating A New Split Setup From An Existing Split Setup    It is convenient to use an existing split setup as a template for a new split setup  This allows you  to easily create a new split setup by using the split point from an existing setup and using  different programs for each Zone  For example  let s use the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano  which    uses acoustic bass and acoustic piano programs  to create a split setup which uses electric bass  and electric piano programs     1  If you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page     2  Use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to select the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano or use the  alphanumeric pad to enter 38 and press Enter     3  With the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will  bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor     4  Use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 1  You can view the number of  the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen 
333. one 3  use the  cursor buttons to select the Offset field  On the alphanumeric pad press 127  then the Enter button  to enter 127 as an offset value  see below              foresee  ntrallslue  ExitUalue        DestTuPe z  Wi PANWOL A           13 28    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones    14  Next we will set a negative Scale value for Zone 3  On the Controllers page for Knob 1  Zone 3   use the cursor buttons to select the Scale field  On the alphanumeric pad press the     button  then  100  then the Enter button to enter  100  as a Scale value  see below         15  Use the cursor buttons to select the Curve field and then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to  select Expand  see below   This makes Zone 3 louder when Knob 1 is half way up than it would be  with the standard Linear curve  This allows for the pad sound to be closer to its full volume when  Knob 1 is half way up  which will give us an equal blend of both pad sounds when we are done    We are using the Expand curve here instead of the Compress curve as in step 8  above   This is  because we used the  100  Scale value for Zone 3  which makes the Expand curve boost middle  values  like the Compress curve usually does   instead of decreasing middle values as Expand  usually does                i TIE Le  ExiTllalue    DestTuPe       PANWOLIEEYUEL   more d    Knob 1  labeled Timbre on the front panel  should now crossfade between the pad sounds 
334. ons aren t like  that  however  It   s important that you press only one of these soft buttons at a time to insure proper  recording start points  and to always be sure of the current sequencer status     The Rec soft button changes the Song Status to REC  READY if the current Song Status is  STOPPED  If the current Song Status is PLAYING  it will be switched to RECORDING when you  press Rec     The Play soft button plays back any recorded data when pressed while the song status is  STOPPED  Playback will begin from the bar and beat specified in the Locate parameter  When the  Song Status is REC READY  pressing the Play soft button will begin recording     The Play soft button functions as a Pause button  but only when the Song Status is PLAYING or  RECORDING  Pressing Play while the song is playing will stop the playback  and the location  remains at the current bar and beat  allowing you to continue from that location by pressing  Play again     Pressing Pause while recording will stop the recording process as if you had pressed Stop        10 7    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page    The Stop soft button halts the playback or recording  and resets the song   s location to either the  default Bar 1  Beat 1 value  or to whatever location you defined with the Locate parameter  If the  location is defined as something other than Bar 1  Beat 1  press Stop twice to reset to 1 1     Pressing Stop when the Song Status is RECORDING will always prompt the 
335. onventions       Deleting Objects    Deleting Objects    Within most editors  there are soft buttons for deleting objects  When you want to delete an  object  press the Delete soft button  and the PC3LE will ask you if you want to delete the object    At this point in the dialog  you can select another object with any of the data entry methods    Press OK if you want to delete it  or press Cancel if you don t  The PC3LE won t let you delete  ROM objects  also known as    factory    objects      Memory objects  on the other hand  are gone when you delete them  If you ve    replaced    a ROM  object by saving a memory object with the same ID  the ROM object is invisible  but still there   Deleting the memory object stored at the same ID will restore the ROM object     You ll often delete objects to gain memory space  or to organize the memory banks before saving  objects to storage     Dependent Objects    A dependent object is an object that s linked in memory with at least one other object  For  example  if you create a setup that uses a program that you also created  that program is a  dependent object of the setup     When you start to delete an object that has dependent objects  the Delete dialog gives you a  choice  Delete dependent objects  If you press Yes  the PC3LE will delete the object and all its  dependent objects when you execute the Delete function  Continuing with the example from  above  if you were deleting the setup you created  and you chose to delete depen
336. ose an action        RUN PC3LE This will boot the system in its usual way  This is useful if you    ve updated  the synthesizer program and want to try it out    UPDATE IMAGE This offers a menu of choices to you for system update    RUN DIAGS This will run the PC3LE diagnostics which can help determine if there   s a    hardware error on your unit  and if so what it is     SYSTEM RESET This will clear out all user defined objects and return the PC3LE to its  default    Factory    state     FILE UTILITIES This offers a menu of file system functions that can be useful in  maintaining your system or diagnosing software problems        B  1       Updating PC3LE Software and Objects    The most common use of the Bootloader menu is to update your PC3LE using new versions of  software and objects supplied by Kurzweil  New versions will be made periodically as we add  new features or improve performance  download these free upgrades from our website at  www kurzweil com     There are two ways to send files to the PC3LE  using a USB device such as a thumb drive  or via  a USB cable connected to a computer  The Bootloader recognizes both methods  and will choose  the one that is active when requested  i e  a USB device plugged into the USB Storage port on the  rear panel or a USB cable plugged into the USB Computer port and an active computer  supporting USB communications     To use a USB device you ll need a valid USB device and a computer with a USB type A port   Most modern Windows
337. ow      ree tracks   STOPPED       Time In  21 50 Loop  1      Ime Outs   i   Punch   PUNCH  Sond End  11 sili Metroni Rec    pora  BIG  Load  Save   Exbort  more y    7  Press the Record button  then the Play Pause button located on the front panel  Play your new part  when the song reaches the part you want to replace  This technique is called    punching in     You will  often get more natural sounding results if you play along with the song before the part that you are  fixing  Doing this allows you to match your performance style  loudness  timing  phrasing  with  what has already been recorded  Because of your settings in steps 4 5 and 6  no extra notes will be  recorded outside of the time that you want to replace        8  Press the Stop button when you are done  You will be able to review and save your changes just as  in Step 4 of Part 3  see above      9  Remember to switch off the Punch parameter when you are done if you wish to record in the  standard way again  as in Part 3  above   This is done on the Big Time page  see below         12 9    Tutorial  Song Mode          Sond Ends 11    Fec eacks     1   STOPPED  Time Int 3 1115 Loot 5  Time Gut  4 21 6 Punch  IH E       Part 6  Adjusting The Volume Of Each Instrument    Adjust the volume of an instrument by adjusting the volume of the track containing that  instrument program  While your song is playing  you can use the Vol parameter on the Song  mode MAIN page to adjust the volume for the track currently set i
338. p  see FX Track on page 10 20 for  setting the track in Song mode   Alternatively  the Aux Effects can be set directly on the AUXFX1  and AUXFX2 pages in Setup Mode  and Song Mode   This is called an Aux Override  see  Override on page 7 63   Each zone or track can use its own insert effects at the same time  if there  are enough DSP units available to load every effect  see The FX Page on page 7 62  below         7 60    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Signal Flow    When using effects  it is important to understand how your signal is being processed  For each  zone  or track in Song Mode  your signal can be sent to the Aux effects before or after being  processed by the Program   s Insert effects     The diagram below shows the possible routes that the signal of a program can    flow    through to  reach the different types of effects  Follow the appropriate route to help visualize the stages in  which the signal is being processed  The first two zones  or tracks in Song Mode  are diagramed  as an example  represented by dark lines   The 14 additional available zones  or tracks in Song  mode  are represented by gray lines  labeled as Etc   The dotted lines represent your options for  choosing either a pre  or post insert Aux send for each zone  track  A circle with an arrow  through it shows a point where the signal level can be adjusted  A circled sigma  looks like an     E     shows where signals are mixed together     Insert  Chain    LI  ZONE TRACK1 4      gt     w
339. p Mode  Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones       Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The  Volume Of Different Zones    You can assign a Knob to crossfade between sounds on different Zones  Crossfading allows you  to smoothly blend between two sounds by increasing the volume of one Zone as the volume of  the other Zone is decreased  For example  let s edit the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  The setup 58 Piano   amp  Pad is a layered setup that uses piano on Zone 1 and    pad    type synth sounds on Zones 2 and 3  Let s  assign a single Knob to crossfade between Zones 2 and 3  This will allow us to hear either the piano and  one of the pads  or the piano and a blend of both pads     1  Tf you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Next  press 58 and then Enter on the alphanumeric  pad to select the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad  see below   You can also select setups by using the        buttons or ni Wheel        S   Techno substance    ae z Then Pad 1         50 Elack Poi    Lit  Oetau    T Oetau  Into oy ae    2  With the setup 58 Piano  amp  Pad selected in setup mode  press the Edit button on the front panel   This will bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below             Programe  Channel   Mij   MidiBank  E Meda   Ctl 6 32
340. p mode even if your MIDI  controller can transmit on only one MIDI channel at a time  To do this  go to the MIDI Receive  page in Master mode  by pressing the RECV soft button while in Master mode   and set the  Local Keyboard Channel parameter to a value that matches the transmit channel of your MIDI  controller  When you select Setup mode  the PC3LE will interpret incoming MIDI information  according to the settings for the currently selected setup  See the discussion of the Local  Keyboard Channel parameter in Chapter 10 for details     Quick Access Mode    Another feature for live performance  Quick Access mode enables you to combine programs and  setups into banks of ten entries  Each of these programs or setups can be selected with a single  alphanumeric button  Different banks are selected with the Chan Zone buttons  There s a  selection of factory preset banks  and you can use the Quick Access Editor to create your own  banks and store them in the PC3LE   s memory  There s a full description in Chapter 8     You can also use Quick Access banks as a way to remap incoming or outgoing Program Change  commands     Master Mode    Master mode  described in Chapter 9  contains the parameters that control the entire PC3LE   Global settings for tuning  transposition  velocity and aftertouch sensitivity  and other  preferences are adjusted here  You can also get to General MIDI Mode from here     Song Mode    Song mode enables you to play sequences  songs  stored in the PC3LE s
341. pad  and pressing Enter   Even program numbers above the usual MIDI limit of 127 can be selected this way     Extended Program Changes    If you re controlling your PC3LE from a MIDI device that can handle the MIDI Controller 0 or 32  program change format  you ll have the greatest flexibility if you set the ProgChgType  parameter to a value of Extended     When you re using the extended program change format  then depending on the value of the  BankSelect parameter on the Receive  RECV  page in Master Mode  the PC3LE will respond to  either MIDI Controller 0 or 32 program change commands for bank selection  and standard  program change commands for program changes within the current bank  Different values have  different results  as shown in the following table        Program Change Command Value of  Result   Type Message   MIDI controller O or 32 0 to 16 Selects a    bank    0 16    MC 0 or MC 32    Standard  PCH  0 to 127 Selects corresponding program number  minus 1  in  current bank             9 21    Master Mode       Soft Buttons In Master Mode    If your PC3LE is already in the bank you want to use  group of 128 programs starting from 0    you can send it single PCHs  standard program change commands  from 0 to 127  to select  programs within that bank  The PC3LE   s response depends on the setting for the Bank   Select  parameter on the Receive  RECV  page in Master mode  If you want to change the bank of  available programs  the PC3LE must receive either an MC  MID
342. peggiation and the lead arpeggiation have this  parameter set to FirstArp Av   the arpeggiation that is started first will be the main     timekeeper     If the lead arpeggiator starts first  the bass arpeggiator will see that as the first  available arpeggiator to sync to and will do so  If the bass arpeggiator is started first  the lead  arpeggiator will see that as the first available arpeggiator to sync to and will do so  This can be  very handy if you are using multiple arpeggiators and want to do some live improvisation  you  can start and stop different arpeggiators and as long is there is one arpeggiator playing  any  arpeggiator with SyncTo set to FirstArp Av  will sync back up when triggered again     You can also choose FirstRiff Av   which behaves the same way as FirstArp Av   but makes your  arpeggiator look for the first available riff to sync to  A setting of Main Seq  will sync the  arpeggiator to the song currently loaded in Song mode  You can select a song in Song mode   then play it from setup mode with the front panel Play Pause button   Doing this temporarily  replaces the programs in your setup s zones with the program used for each channel in the song  so it   s  best to make a setup that uses the same programs as your song on the same MIDI channels  If you plan on  syncing riffs with a song  it may be easier to start by creating a setup  then recording the setup into a  song  See Recording A Setup To Song Mode on page 7 66 for details   A setting of Fi
343. pose changes the MIDI note numbers generated by the keys  in the zone  without physically shifting the zone  The range is  128 to 127 semitones  Since there  are 12 semitones  or half steps  to an octave  you can transpose up or down over ten octaves  If  you transpose out of the range of the active voice  however  no notes will sound  though MIDI  note numbers will still transmit     Split High Split Low   Select the field for the Split High   Split Low parameter and choose your split point by holding  the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and playing a key  You can also use the Alpha Wheel  or     buttons to enter a note name and number     If you are on the Split  Layer  LOWERSPLIT page  the Split Key will become the highest key that  plays in that zone  The Split Key and all below it will play the new zone you are creating  but no  keys above it will trigger this zone     If you are on the Split  Layer  UPPERSPLIT page  the Split Key will become the lowest key that  plays in that zone  The Split Key and all above it will play the new zone you are creating  but no  keys below it will trigger this zone     Volume    Use the Volume parameter to set the MIDI volume setting for the new zone you are creating  A  setting of 127 is the maximum volume  and a setting of 0 is the minimum volume     Pan    Use the Pan parameter to set the MIDI pan setting for the new zone you are creating  The Pan  parameter scales the balance of volume between the PC3LE s left and right outputs  
344. ps for each zone with a different pad to have  separate on   off controls for each zones arpeggiator  You can also use the same pad for different  zones if you want to control multiple arpeggiators from the same pad        14 9    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips    Create A User Shift Or Velocity Pattern For Custom Arpeggiations    The PC3LE s arpeggiator can trigger melodic sequences called shift patterns  and velocity  sequences called velocity patterns  Shift patterns allow you to trigger complex arpeggiations by  playing a single key  and velocity patterns allow you to add complex velocity changes to  arpeggiations  The PC3LE comes with a number of factory shift and velocity patterns  but you  can also program your own in Setup mode for custom arpeggiations and velocity patterns     For details on using and creating shift patterns  see Shift Pattern  ShiftPatt  on page 7 41  For  details on using and creating velocity patterns  see the Pattern setting under  Velocity on page 7 37     Record A Short Song For Use As A Riff  Record A Setup To Song Mode    Riffs are full songs or individual tracks of a song created in the PC3LE sequencer that you can  trigger in setup mode  Every zone in a setup can have it s own riff   a completely independent  sequence  Riffs can be used to accompany your playing like a backing track  but riffs give you  more options such as endless looping  stopping or starting different instrument parts  the ability  to transpose instruments or change
345. ps of objects as a  PLE file on the current device        Storage Mode       Storage Mode Page    Load Load selected file s  or object s  from the current device into PC3LE memory   Utils Create new directories  delete  rename or copy files and directories    Format Format the USB device currently connected to the USB Storage port   USBDrv Select the USB drive     Using USB Devices          AD    You can plug a USB mass storage device such as a    thumb drive    into the PC3LE for backing up   archiving  sharing your work  and updating your software  Any size USB mass storage device  will work  though thumb drives are recommended for their portability  durability  and low  price  There is a USB Storage port on the back panel of the PC3LE  but it is easily accessible from  the front of the instrument  see below       gt  USB  O      Computer Storage    Caution  A USB connector will only fit into the port if oriented properly  so don t force it into the  port  as this may damage your PC3LE or USB device  If you are having trouble inserting your  USB connector into the port  try flipping the connector over     You can also transfer files directly to a computer that is equipped with a USB port by using the  USB Computer port on the back panel of the PC3LE  see above   Connect a USB cable from the  PC3LE   s USB Computer port to a USB port on your computer  When you enter Storage mode  and select USB PC Connection  a virtual drive named PC3LE will appear on your computer   s  desk
346. r 1 and bar 8  and you jump from bar 1  to bar 9  any notes you scroll through will be played with the program change from bar 1     Initial Program  Volume  Pan    At the top of the event list for each track  you can view and change the initial program  volume  and pan settings for the current track  See Song Mode  The MAIN Page on page 10 1 for details on  initial settings for program  volume  and pan  Each of these parameters can be set to NONE by   entering 0 on the alphanumeric pad and then pressing the minus button to find NONE     Location    The first column represents the Bar and Beat Locations of the different events in a song  Scroll  through the events on the selected track s  with the Alpha Wheel or enter in a specific Bar and  Beat on the alphanumeric button pad to jump to events occurring on that Beat  A quick way to  jump to the End point in a track is to press 9999 and then Enter on the alphanumeric button pad     Bar  Beat  and Tick    Bar  Beat  and Tick are editable parameters for each event  They determine when an event  happens relative to the other events within the song     Event Type and Value    The Event Type and Value region displays the MIDI event type  and related information  at each  Event list location in the song  Different event types display different kinds of information  and  have different editable values     The event type is the left most field  You can highlight this field and change the event type   MIDI note events are denoted by a 
347. r details      Compare    Pressing the Storage button calls up the Compare Editor  which recalls the setup pre edit  settings  allowing you to compare your edited setup with the original setup  Pressing the  Storage button again returns you to the Setup editor  Using the Compare Editor makes no  changes to the current setup     The display diagrams you see in this chapter show the default values for setup 126 Internal  Voices     Soloing a Zone    To solo a zone  set the Status parameter on the Setup Editor CH PROG page  see below  to Solo   or Solo Muted   When a zone is set to Solo  or Solo Muted   the Chan Zone buttons will  scroll through the zones of the current setup  soloing each zone  Change the Status parameter of  the current zone back to Active in order to stop soloing zones     Additionally  you can configure a setup such that you can solo zones in real time  from outside  of the editor  by assigning any of the controller destinations to SoloZn  See Controllers  CTRLS   Page on page 7 9 for more information on controller destination assignments in Setup mode  See  Set Controls Zone Mutes  MUTES  on page 7 65 for a way to automatically set the assignable  switches to mute zones     KB3 Programs In Setup Mode    In Setup mode the assignable switches mute and unmute zones by default  If you want the  assignable switches to control the functions of a KB3 program in a setup  you can edit the setup  and automatically assign the KB3 controls using the KB3CTL soft button 
348. r have to worry about how the  sound you are using is constructed in order to modify it  The PC3LE gives you easy access to a  program   s relevant parameters via the front panel knobs and buttons  allowing you to easily  modify a program without having to navigate through a series of menus        1 2    Introduction  KB3 Tone Wheel Emulation       KB3 Tone Wheel Emulation    In addition to sample playback and V A S T  synthesis  the PC3LE features Kurzweil s KB3 organ  simulator  which is designed to emulate the signature sound of classic tone wheel organs like the  Hammond B3  The five knobs  which can control 15 parameters with the Shift button  on the  PC3LE s front panel provide real time control for 9 virtual drawbars  The PC3LE s assignable  switches control rotary speaker speed  percussion volume and duration and chorus   vibrato  settings  all of which are silk screened on the front panel     You can find KB3 programs by pressing the Organ category button while in Program mode  The  programs that use KB3 mode will light the KB3 LED to the left of the knobs  indicating that the  PC3LE   s knobs and switches are now dedicated to the organ controls that are labeled on the  front panel     KVA Programs    The KVA  Kurzweil Virtual Analog  programs included with the PC3LE offer realistic  emulations of classic analog synthesizers  built from Kurzweil s unique anti aliased DSP   generated oscillators  called KVA oscillators   These oscillators  combined with the PC3LE s  a
349. r mode     5  Once in Master Mode  press the Exit button  to the left of the display  to return to Program mode   The next time you turn on the PC3LE  the MIDI channel and program you chose will be selected     Note  The PC3LE sets the currently selected MIDI channel and program as the start up channel  and program whenever you exit Master mode  Because of this  you may accidentally overwrite  these settings when using master mode  If this happens  just repeat the above steps     Note  When you set the start up channel and program  the PC3LE s other 15 MIDI channels also  remember their currently selected program  Before following the steps above  you could set a  program on each channel  so that each channel will have a specific program upon startup  This  could be useful if you are triggering the PC3LE from an external sequencer and want to use a  default program for each channel  As described in the above note  use caution because these  settings can be accidentally overwritten when using Master mode  You can also save these  settings as an external file  called a Master Table file   which can be used as a backup of your  settings  or you could load a different Master Table file for each song  See Saving Master Table  Files on page 11 6 for details  If you use Master Table files for storing song setups  you may want  to read about Song Mode  which can also be triggered from an external sequencer and has some  advantages over Program Mode  see Chapter 10  Song Mode and the 
350. r riff is playing  If something is already playing to sync to   AnyBeatWait behaves just like AnyBeat     With RelSynTyp set to Loop  if there is already a riff or song playing to sync to  the current riff  will wait for the playing riff or song to restart its loop  if it is looped  before stopping when  released  see Loop on page 7 55 for looping riffs  and Loop on page 10 11 for looping songs   This  way you can release the riff to stop ahead of time  and have it stop in sync at the start of the  playing riff or song   s loop     With RelSynTyp set to Stop  if there is already something playing to sync to  the current riff will  wait for what is playing to stop before releasing  This way you can trigger the current riff to  release ahead of time  and have it stop in sync at the release  stopping  of the riff  arpeggiator  or  song that you are syncing to     With RelSynTyp set to StartWait  if there is nothing playing to sync to  the current riff will wait  for something it can sync to to begin playing first before releasing  This is similar to  DownBeatWait  but it will only release the riff the first time that whatever it is syncing to starts   This way you can trigger the riff to stop ahead of time  and have it stop in sync at the start of the  riff  arpeggiator  or song that you are syncing to  If you restart the riff and try to release it again  while the thing you are syncing to is already playing  StartWait will not stop the riff     With RelSynTyp set to LoopWait  i
351. ram Change  Pros Chance  id ists a Ege snails ead a ah 9 15  Change Setups  Che Setups  oda dia 9 15  e  se ss sch eee haath rele he Me O 9 16  Basto Gi a4 2 cl RETA A a e ETE  9 16  MIDI Receive Mode  MIDI Mode      c cccccessssssssssescssessssessssesscsesscsessssssscecsssecsssscsssscssssessesssaseseeseceesesseseceesecseseeeses 9 16  Velocity  Map  Rec  ive  ai iaa 9 17  Pressure Mia Pi RECEIVE  ares Ein adi at id aa a o ARAS 9 18  AN SO NN 9 19  Program Change Mode  Pig Ch Mod a i aa 9 19  System Excl  sive ID  Syst TID i haa bis tied dia 9 19  Dale ii A A at Sie  sai nace ered web A a ey 9 19  Local Keyboard Channel Doral RDA ia A a oasis 9 19  Program Change Forma a 9 21  Soft Buttons In Master Mode ninini reinate se Cu eera eaS E ne RE Sa EE REAO TEE EDE EERE EREE AASR ERT 9 22  Resetest A Ae EE ea a E e e sels OSO 9 22  A NO 9 22  Chapter 10 Song Mode and the Song Editor  Getting Started  with the So quer a daa dane aE 10 1  Song Mode  The MAIN Pages  a  adic is pi e AN 10 1  Song Mode  The BIG Pa A A RAS 10 10  song Mode  The FX Pages 20 NA AA da 10 11  Song Mode  Tie MIXER Pares a 10 12  Song Mode  The METRO TI A a IA lace cont 10 13  Song Mode  The Filter Pages  RECFLT IPN 10 15  song Mode  The MISC Paren A A 10 17  Song Mode  Th TAS Pa dE 10 18  The SOS Ed adas ii A a A A a cet 10 19  Song Editor  The COMMON Pass a A 10 19  Song Editor The TRACK Page bi A ds 10 21  song Editor  Track FUNCION cities 10 24  song Editor  The EVENT Pare nonai ei Sa els tan sarees are ti
352. rameter to Punch  This causes recording to only take place  between the times set in the Time In and Time Out fields        ree tracks   STOPPED       12 8    Tutorial  Song Mode       S    5  Set times for the Time In and Time Out fields to select the time to fix  For this example we will fix  bar 3  see below      ree tracks     E 0  STOPPED       Loop   Punch dol      Hetron  EA CEA Ce   Export   more     Note  If you need to fix a section which isn t exactly within one bar or an even division of beats   use the following method to find your Time In and Time Out points  Use the big time location  numbers on the top of the page to find a time where the first notes played  when you press play   pause  are the notes that you wish to replace  Enter this location in the Time In field  Next  use  the big time location numbers on the top of the page to find a time where the first notes played   when you press play pause  are the first notes that you wish to keep after the notes that you  wish to replace  Enter this location in the Time Out field           6  Use the big time location numbers on the top of the page and set a time before the area you want to  replace  This will be where you start playback of the song in order to re record the desired section   Leave enough time  usually a bar or two  so that you will have time to prepare before the section  you are replacing plays  For this example we will set our start time to 1  1  0  because it is two bars  before bar 3  see bel
353. rameters  It is often a good idea to set Events to Notes when copying  and then add any  necessary controller or other data to the track at a later time     DstTrack  1 to 16   All    Select a destination track for the copied events with the DstTrack parameter  All selected events  described in the Region   Criteria box will be placed in the destination track s  at any Bar and  Beat you specify     If the currently selected track is All tracks then the destination track will be All tracks as well     No matter what channel the current track  source track  is set to when you use the copy  function  the events will be played on the destination track   s channel     Location  Bars   Beats   Ticks       10 24    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  Track Functions    Specify a bar  beat  and tick location in the destination track where the copied data will be placed  with the Location parameter  If the length of the copied region extends from the Location point  beyond the song   s existing End point  a new End point is defined     Mode  Merge   Erase   Slide    The Mode setting determines whether the copied events merge with  or erase existing events on  the destination track from the location point to the end of the copied region  With Mode set to  Slide  the sequencer creates space for the new events  and slides the existing events to uniformly  later times in the song     Times  1 to 127    The value selected for the Times parameter determines how many copies of t
354. rastically different sounds for a more dramatic effect   Additionally  you could take a setup that uses normal velocity settings for its Zones and add  some velocity switching Zones just for specific background instruments  This allows you to add  more layers of sound to your playing  while keeping your sound uncluttered by only having  sounds enter when the appropriate velocity is played        13 32    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Creating A New Setup    Creating A New Setup    Follow these steps if you would like to create a new setup from a blank template     1  If you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This will  bring you to the Setup mode main page  see below      1 Teknol  2 Thumper Best Set    4   i is    5 Dance Club    Info APo e                     APose        TS TAE       2  Use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to select the setup 128 Default Setup or use the  alphanumeric pad to enter 128 and press Enter  see below                 126 Internal Voices  127 Clear Setup    123 Default Setup  129 GetEernl    130 Pipe Organ 1  Detav Tlctau TPanico Tinto Teeose THe    3  With the setup 128 Default Setup selected  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will  bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below                   Programe   Channel  a HIDI AHIDI LOCAL  MidiBank  E EomkHode   Ctl PES  MidiProg
355. re in the storage device that you wish to store or  load your files to or from  This location is called a directory  When you need to choose a  directory  you will see the Path field  The Path field shows the current directory on the current  device     When you choose a storage function for a connected device  the PC3LE automatically chooses  the root  top level  directory for the Path field  The root directory is displayed as a backslash     Path       When viewing a page that has the Path field  if their are any directories available in the root  directory  you will be able to choose them from a list using the alpha wheel  cursor buttons  or       buttons  Then  press the Open soft button to open that directory  The name of the directory  will be displayed in the Path field  For example  if you have a directory called SOUNDS that is  located in the current device   s root directory  the Path field will appear as     Path  SOUNDS   The backslash character is a directory separator  as in the following Path   Path   BACKUP COVERBAND SONGS     This represents the directory SONGS  which is a subdirectory of the COVERBAND directory   which is a subdirectory of the BACKUP directory in the root directory  If the path is too long to  fit on the top line of the display  it gets abbreviated  The maximum length of a path in the PC3LE  is 64 characters  including the backslash characters      Using the Open soft button causes you to navigate into directories and their subdirectories   
356. red tempo  The plus minus buttons and alpha wheel are useful for making smaller adjustments   Tempo is set in beats per minute  BPM   For this example  let s set a medium tempo of 100 BPM   In the Tempo field use the alphanumeric pad to enter 100 and press Enter  see below      Note  You can also set the tempo using the Tap Tempo Button  see the Master mode chapter for details     MAI   Events  1093   Curro AstHew Son  RecTrki 1 lNol 127 Pan  Prog 1 Standard Grand       Track if    die stor ren ore    2  To hear the metronome play your tempo  use the right more button to find and then press the BIG  soft button  This brings you to the Song Big Time page  On the Song Big Time page  set the       12 3    Tutorial  Song Mode       Metron parameter to Always  see below   Make sure the PC3LE   s main volume is set at a moderate  level  then press the Play Pause button to hear the metronome play the selected tempo     Ese tracks   STOPPED            Time In  1011104  Time uti 1 21 06  Son Eng  1 sli     k more  BIG Tload  save Jesrori  more d    3  Press the BIG soft button again to return to the Song mode MAIN page  the MAIN soft button also  works for this  but using the BIG soft button is quicker   Now you can adjust the Tempo parameter  and press the Play Pause button to hear the metronome play the tempo  For this example we will  leave our previous Tempo setting of 100 0     4  Once you are happy with the tempo  press the BIG soft button to return to the Song Big Time page   S
357. rename them at a later time if desired   Choose an unused ID  to save a new setup  The next available unused ID  is automatically  selected when editing a factory ROM setup  When editing a setup that has been stored in user  memory  any originally unused ID    the edited setup   s ID  is automatically selected  This  assumes that you wish to replace the existing setup  but you can choose another ID  if desired  to save a new copy  Choose a used ID  to replace an existing saved setup  If you replace a  factory ROM setup  you can revert to the original setup by using the Delete soft button in the  Setup Editor  See Chapter 5  Editing Conventions for more details on saving and naming        13 3    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Using And Editing A Split Program Setup    Using And Editing A Split Program Setup    One of the simplest uses of Setup mode is to create a split setup  in which different ranges of the  keyboard are assigned to play different instrument programs  The PC3LE can split the keyboard  into a maximum of 16 different instrument programs  though often a split of two programs is  most useful  Follow these steps to learn about using split program setups     Part 1  Load The Example Setup    1  Press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page  Next  press the Setup mode button   located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This will bring you to the Setup mode main    page     2  Use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to select the setup 38 Jazz 
358. rent Zones    4  On the Controllers page  Zone 1 will be selected  You can view the number of the selected Zone in  the top right corner of screen  see below   If you are not on Zone 1  use the Chan Zone buttons to  the left of the display to select Zone 1         Par am    TELS S PARLOLTEREYLEL    5  On the Controllers page  the Controller field will be highlighted  if not  select the Controller field  with the cursor buttons   Make sure the LED to the left of Timbre Knob is lit  if it is not  press  the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter button on the  alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for the Controller  field  see below   You can also set the desired controller in the Controller field by using the Alpha  Wheel or       buttons        Param    CH PROJCTRLS SPANUOL    6  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below               13 14    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Different Zones    7  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field            Zona   ntrallalue  Exitllalue      
359. rent Zones    Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Different    Zones    You can assign a different Knob to each Zone in a Setup so that you can easily adjust the volume    of each Zone  For example  let s edit the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano  which has a bass program on  Zone   and a piano program on Zone 2     1     If you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page  then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Next  press 38 and then Enter on the alphanumeric    pad to select the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano  see below   You can also select setups by using the        buttons or Alpha Wheel        E  40   e Bidet Tae  Octau  Octan  Fanie Tinta i E    2  Next  with the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano selected in setup mode  press the Edit button on the front  panel  This will bring you to the CH PROG page of the setup editor  see below         Program  YE        Channel  i  MidiBank  1 ikode   Ctl Ar  HidiFrog  lay EntruProsCchs  On    Status  Active ArPeddiator   Orn  more  CH PRGICTRLS PANYOL KEVWEL   more d  Step 3 A    3  From the CH PROG page  press the CTRLS soft button on the bottom of the screen  see above      This brings you to the Controllers page where you can view and assign physical controllers to  destinations for the current Zone        13 13    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Diffe
360. rently selected zone number can be viewed in the top right corner of the display   Here we can see that a riff is turned on for zone 1  Zone 1   s riff is using track 1 of the song 428 H   Fact Sng as its source track for this riff  The source track number is displayed in the SreTrack field   see below         1   Son  Start  i  Store 5  Trans sPo se          1 14  ff    ARPE RIFFi RIFF    more         6  Next  press the top Chan Zone button  to the left of the display  to move to the RIFF1 page for  zone 2  The currently selected zone number can be viewed in the top right corner of the display  A  riff is turned on for zone 2  and the riff is using track 2 of the song 428 H Fact Sng as its source  track  see below   If you continue to press the top Chan Zone button to view the RIFF1 pages for  zones 3 and 4  you will see that they also use the same song 428 H Fact Sng for their riffs  though  they use track 3 and 4 for their source tracks  respectively            CORP       This setup  along with the song 428 H Fact Sng which we viewed in Song mode  show a good  example of how to split up a song into riffs in setup mode  One thing that makes this example  simple is that each track of the song 428 H Fact Sng uses its corresponding MIDI channel number  If  you were to go back to the song in Song mode  you would see at the bottom of the display that track 1 uses  channel 1  track 2 uses channel 2  etc  In the Setup Editor for the setup 253 4 Zone Riff Pno  you can  see on the C
361. riggered by Shift Key Number  A Shift Pattern is a relative pattern based on a  root note  All notes triggered by a Shift Pattern are shifted from the root note by the value of  each pattern step  in half steps      Shift Key Settings                                              Value Key  root note   0 9 C  10 19 CH  20 29 D  30 39 D   40 49  50 59 F  60 68 F   69 78 G  79 88 G   89 98 A  99 108 A   109 118 B  119 127 Last Note Played    When using a Shift Pattern with Shift Key Number you can select the key with one or more  controllers set to the Shift Key destination  You can use a continuous controller such as a knob to  cycle through keys  or switches set to predetermined keys  For example  if you are playing a  song that moves between 2 or 3 keys  a couple of switches could be programmed in order to  send the appropriate Shift Key message for each key change  That way all the notes you are  triggering with a Shift Key Number controller will be in the appropriate scale  You could also  create a setup for a song with multiple zones  each with its own pre set key and appropriate  shift pattern  That way  for each chord change you could move a different controller that would  create the correct harmony     Another way to choose a key is to set Shift Key to Last Note Played mode  in which the last note  played in the zone will set the key  For example  you could set the zone being used for Shift Key  Number to have a Key Range that covers only a few of the keyboard   s lowe
362. rn engages a step sequencer for arpeggiator velocity patterns  which shifts the velocity of  each arpeggiated note according to a sequenced pattern  There are 74 pre programed velocity  patterns that you can choose from the VelPatt field  some of which create rhythms by using  velocity values of  127 or    none    to leave rests in the arpeggiation  The sequencer uses the  velocity received from the first note played as the center position to shift velocities up or down  from  If no other keys are playing  patterns will start over each time a key is pressed  there are  some exceptions to this when using ARPEGGIATOR Latch parameters other than    Keys     though a  newly triggered pattern will always start at step 1   When triggering velocity patterns from more  than one key at a time  each consecutive step of the pattern shifts the velocity from a different  inputted key  the order of which is decided by the order parameter on the ARPEGGIATOR page     Note  For patterns with negative velocity values  if the velocity of the first played note is low enough that  a pattern step could result in a velocity of zero  some notes may have a velocity of zero and therefore  produce no sound     You can edit the included patterns by pressing    Edit    with a pattern highlighted in the VelPatt  field  see edit screen below   The top line of the    EditVelocityPatt    page displays the pattern   s  name and total number of steps  This page also shows the full name for a pattern whose name
363. rol Setup  see The Control Setup on page 7 68   There are some possible disadvantages to  having LocalKbdCh set to None  First  the PC3LE doesn t relay incoming MIDI to its MIDI Out  port  Perhaps more importantly  if you change the channel on your MIDI source  the PC3LE  plays the program on the channel used by your MIDI source   regardless of the PC3LE s current  channel  For example  if your MIDI source transmits on Channel 1  and you set the PC3LE s  current channel to 2  you ll still play the program assigned to Channel 1  If that s the way you  like it  there s no problem     You may find it more convenient to use the local keyboard channel  In this case  the PC3LE  remaps incoming MIDI to the PC3LE   s current channel  so in Program mode  you ll always play  the program on the PC3LE s current channel  Incoming MIDI also gets sent to the PC3LE s MIDI  and USB Out port  On the other hand  in this case your MIDI source   s transmitting channel must  match the PC3LE s local keyboard channel for anything to work  Furthermore  for KB3  programs  some of the MIDI Controller numbers listed in Table 6 2 on page 6 8 won t  necessarily work     Things are a bit different for playing setups  In this case  you must use the local keyboard  channel to be able to play and control all of the setup   s zones  Set LocalKbd to match the channel  your external MIDI source is using  if for example your MIDI source transmits on Channel 1  set  LocalKbd to 1   All MIDI information that the PC
364. roller  zones  each of which can have its own program  MIDI channel  and control  assignments  The parameters you define for each setup affect programs only while you are in  Setup mode  An exception to this is the control setup  which we discuss on page 7 68     Press the Setup mode button to enter Setup mode  you ll see a list of setups with the currently  selected setup highlighted in the middle of the list  Select a setup by scrolling through the list  with the Alpha Wheel  cursor buttons  or     buttons  or enter a setup   s ID  with the  alphanumeric pad and press the Enter button        eau  OeLau     When you move a physical controller  knob  switch  pad  etc    that has been assigned to a  control destination  the info box on the left hand side of the main Setup mode page briefly  displays the corresponding Program and controller assignment for the last moved controller   see Controllers  CTRLS  Page on page 7 9 to learn more   Press the Info soft button to see a list of  all of the controller assignments for all zones of the current setup  On the Info page  use the  Alpha Wheel  cursor buttons  or       buttons to scroll through the list     You can transpose the entire setup up or down by octaves with the two Octav soft buttons   When you transpose a setup  the split points between zones remain in place  each program is  transposed within its respective zone  Use the two Xpose buttons to transpose the setup up or  down by half steps     The Panic soft button sends 
365. rom DownBeat is that if  there is nothing to sync to  the arpeggiator will not start  This can be useful if you want to start  multiple arpeggiators synced to something else  For example  you could have a bass arpeggiator  set to DownBeatWait  for instance  and trigger the arpeggiator while no other arpeggiators are  running  As soon as you start something else to sync to  the bass arpeggiator will start playing as       7 45    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    well  provided that it is set to sync to something else or the first available   If something to sync  to is already running  DownBeatWait behaves just like DownBeat     With SyncType set to AnyBeatWait  if there is something playing to sync to  the arpeggiator will  wait for the next beat to start  The difference from AnyBeat is that if there is nothing to sync to   this arpeggiator will not start  This can be useful if you want to start multiple arpeggiators  synced to something else  You could have a bass arpeggiator set to AnyBeatWait  for instance   and trigger the arpeggiator while no other arpeggiators are running  As soon as you start  something to sync to  the bass arpeggiator will start playing as well  provided that it is set to  sync to something else or the first available   If another arpeggiator is already running   AnyBeatWait behaves just like AnyBeat     With SyncType set to Loop  if there is already a riff or song playing to sync to  the current  arpeggiator will wait for the playing riff or song
366. rom the PC3LE and there is no way to retrieve them   Press the soft       B  3       button labeled Format Flash to re initialize the internal file system  This will delete everything  that was stored internally on the PC3LE  and leave a clean  empty file system ready for use     After the format is complete  you will need to install an OS  and objects  see Updating PC3LE  Software and Objects on page B 2  above         B  4    Index    A    All Controllers Off 9 19  All Notes Off 9 19  Alpha Wheel 3 9  Alphabetic entry 3 9  5 3  Alphanumeric pad 3 9  Append soft button 11 8  Arp Active 7 36  Arp Enable button 3 5  Arp Latch button 3 5  Arpeggiator   Active 7 36   Beats 7 37   Duration 7 37   Glissando 7 44   In Program Mode 6 15   In Setup Mode 7 35   Latch 7 43   Limit 7 40   Limit Option 7 40   Low Key  LoKey  and High Key  HiKey  7 44   Order 7 37   Shift 7 40   shifting notes 7 40   Velocity 7 37  ASCII characters 5 3  Assignable Knobs   In Setup Mode 7 10  Assignable Pads   In Program Mode 6 12   In Setup Mode 7 15  Assignable Switches   In Setup Mode 7 13  Audio cables 2 2    Bank Select   MIDI Receive page 9 19  Basic editing 5 1  Basic MIDI channel 9 16  Boot Loader 1 3  Bootloader B 1  Bottom line of display 3 6  Bounce   Song Mode TRACK Page 10 25  Buttons   Panic 6 3    C    Cancel soft button 11 8  Chan   Zone buttons 3 8  Change  Song Mode TRACK Page 10 30  Changing intonation key 9 7    Channel   Program  CH PROG  Page 7 6  Setup Mode 7 68  Characters 5 3  COMM
367. rray of filters and DSP tools  can produce stunningly realistic analog emulations as well as  never before heard synthetic sound scapes     How to Use This Manual    This manual describes how to connect and power up your PC3LE  getting around the front  panel  and a description of the operating modes  as well as step by step tutorials for commonly  performed functions     The best way to read this manual is with your PC3LE in front of you  By trying the examples  provided  which illustrate various functions  you can get a quick understanding of the basics   then move on to the more advanced features     You ll find lists of the PC3LE   s objects     programs  setups  and so forth     at the  www kurzweil com website     Do   Have Everything     Your PC3LE shipping carton should include the following in addition to your instrument     e Power cable   e USB cable   e   Musician   s Guide  this book   e Warranty card   e Sustain  switch  pedal   e 4stick on rubber feet    If you don   t have all of these components  contact your Kurzweil   Young Chang dealer     You may also want to purchase a USB thumb drive for portable backups and storage     Boot Loader    When you need to update the PC3LE   s software or run diagnostic tests  you ll use the Boot  Loader  To bring up the Boot Loader  hold down the Exit button  directly to the right of the  display  while powering on your PC3LE  Refer to Appendix B for details on the Boot Loader        1 3    Introduction       Options  Optio
368. rst Avail  will  sync the arpeggiator to the first available arpeggiator  riff  or song from Song mode     Note  If you have multiple arpeggiators or riffs already playing when using FirstArp Av   FirstRiff Av    or First Avail  for the current arpeggiator  the current arpeggiator will sync to the arpeggiator or riff of  the lowest numbered zone that has an arpeggiator or riff playing     SyncType    The SyncType parameter allows you to choose how your arpeggiator will sync to other  arpeggiators  riffs  or a song playing from Song mode     With SyncType set to None  your arpeggiator will start playing as soon as it is triggered  It will  not sync to anything  With SyncType set to DownBeat  if there is already something playing to  sync to  the current arpeggiator will wait for the downbeat of the next measure before starting   so  you can trigger the arpeggiator to start ahead of time  and have it start in sync at the  downbeat of the next measure  If Syncing to an arpeggiator  see Num Beats on page 7 46 for details  on changing when an arpeggiator s downbeat will occur  With SyncType set to AnyBeat  if there is  already something playing to sync to  the arpeggiator will wait only until the next beat   Depending on when you trigger the arpeggiator  it will sync up  but it may be on an upbeat or a  downbeat     With SyncType set to DownBeatWait  if there is something playing to sync to  the arpeggiator  will wait for the downbeat of the next measure to start  The difference f
369. s    The     buttons are located just under the Alpha Wheel  see above   The          plus  button  increases the value of the currently selected parameter by one  and the          minus  button  decreases it by one  These buttons are most useful when you re scrolling through a short list of  values  or when you want to be sure you re changing the value by one increment at a time  One  press of the plus or minus button corresponds to one click to the right or left with the Alpha  Wheel  These buttons will repeat if pressed and held     Pressing the plus and minus buttons simultaneously will move you through the current list of  values in large chunks instead of one by one  Don t confuse these buttons with the     button in  the category buttons  That category button is used primarily for entering negative numeric  values and switching from uppercase to lowercase letters  and vice versa      The Alphanumeric Pad    When you press the Shift button on the bottom row of the Category buttons  you can use the  Category buttons as an alphanumeric pad to enter numeric values  and enter names one letter at  a time  Pressing the Shift button lights its LED  indicating that the category buttons will  correspond to the numbers  letters  and other functions printed on the buttons  On the main  page for Program mode  the category buttons choose the program category  and you must press  the Category Shift button to enter numbers  On the Quick Access mode main page  the  numbered category bu
370. s  with the right half being a separate box   This is called the Region   Criteria box  The parameters in this box are used to select the range of    events  from a start Bar and Beat to an end Bar and Beat  for modification  as well as which types  of events function will affect     E       10 21    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The TRACK Page    The parameters in this box will generally be the same for most functions  For some functions   however  some parameters may not apply  For example  Quantize and Transpose apply only to  notes  while Remap applies only to Controllers  In addition to the Region   Criteria box  parameters  the Locate parameter is also found on each function     Since these parameters are common to most Track functions  we will define them first  Then  we ll describe the individual functions along with the parameters specific to each  which are  normally found on the left side of the page  The function Quantize has unique parameter in its  Region   Criteria boxes  We   ll describe those parameters along with the functions     Once you ve chosen a function and set the parameters to your liking  press Go  This executes the  editing function  You can then play the sequence to hear the results of your edit  If you don t like  your edit  simply exit the editor and press No when you are asked if you want to save  If you do  like your edit  you can press Done and then Save  or just exit the editor and save the changes   Or  you can go to ano
371. s a aE RAATS 10 31  Chapter 11 Storage Mode  Storage M Ode  La a lie ladies festhdused ie dulut ad 11 1  Using USB  Devices  eii iaiin rE o cn aces cosy di L E FOU  shaven Dd A Cote Lisa dae br ae doa 11 2  Pat A A ss a abst Shit Lleida 11 3  Common 1alOg S250  E eased cesse sr hk Sessa thal seeded EE da dE E anida cas 11 4  TORRE O e MRS PESTLE S 11 5  The LOAD Pape ri A SRA RARA ARS ia 11 6  THe U  lites  UMES  Ae acs carnation cose aretha cnc A oi 11 8  EME a els Phased Mba A A ta o Ain 11 8       Chapter 12 Tutorial  Song Mode    Part 1  Assign Instruments To Tracks       cccccccscsscsescsnsesesesesesesesceceescscsanenesesesuesesesescecesesescanansneseseseseseseecananens 12 2  sra li AA RTT CRMC CF a POPE RISO TOP SUR E aS a ORT REINA RAT REP EE 12 3  Part 3  Record Your First Track  Save The Song jock Sk Rae ba REO 12 4  Part 4  Record Additional Traks pi eeina e E E EE Ae rR E E A ETE E EEE REE 12 7  Parto Fixing  Mistakes siete lod ERE SERE aS EA AEREE EA EREE EAEE E E S 12 8  Part 6  Adjusting The Volume Of Each Instrument a asia 12 10  Part 7  Learning More About Song Mode       cccccccscssssesssnssesesesneesesescecesesescesanssesesesenesesceceeesescsnansnesesesenenesees 12 15  Chapter 13 Tutorials  Setup Mode  A a rah gece ctr Sn COC ad cae Leese E cece th terete 13 3  Using And Editing A Split Program Setup        cccccscsessssessesssescecenesesesnsnsnesssescesesescecensnesssesnaneneseseseeseseseaneneneseseanenenes 13 4  Using Setup Mode To Play Layers Of Instrumen
372. s and arpeggiations that provide instant grooves and backing parts  An on   board sequencer  Song mode  with front panel transport buttons lets you record your musical  ideas any time inspiration strikes     The PC3LE has 64 voice polyphony with 16 multi timbral channels  so that different programs  can be played on each MIDI channel  The PC3LE features a world class effects processor which  provides multiple simultaneous effects  along with real time effects control via the front panel  controls or MIDI     For backup  storage  and moving files  the PC3LE features two USB ports on the rear panel  A  USB storage port allows you to connect a USB device such as a thumb drive  and a second USB  Computer port lets you connect the PC3LE to a computer for file transfer and MIDI connectivity     How the PC3LE Works    The PC3LE integrates a keyboard  high quality samples  a powerful synthesis engine and a high   end effects processor  MIDI events generated by playing the keyboard cause the sound engine to  trigger samples or oscillators which are then processed by Kurzweil s powerful V A S T  digital  signal processing  The resulting sound is then routed through the PC3LE   s effects and to the  audio outputs     V A S T  Synthesis    The PC3LE s uses Kurzweil s Variable Architecture Synthesis Technology  V A S T   to process  samples and oscillators with a variety of powerful digital signal processing  DSP  tools and  functions  All of this happens    under the hood     so you neve
373. s and setups for single button access in Quick Access mode     Shift patterns Factory preset or user programmed sequences of note shift information   used by the arpeggiator for detailed arpeggiations  or by the Shift Key  Number controller destination     Velocity patterns Factory preset or user programmed sequences of note velocity shift  information  used by the arpeggiator for detailed velocity triggering in  arpeggiation        5 1    Editing Conventions       Object Type and ID    Master tables The values that are set for the global control parameters on the Master  mode page  as well as the settings for the parameters on the Transmit   Receive  and Channels pages in MIDI mode  and the programs currently  assigned to each MIDI channel     Name tables Contains a list of dependent objects needed by the other objects in a file at  the time the file was saved     Object Type and ID    The PC3LE stores its objects in memory using a system of ID numbers  Each object is identified  by its object type and object ID  An object s type is simply the kind of object it is  whether it s a  program  setup  song  etc  The object ID is a number that distinguishes each object from other  objects of the same type  For example you can have a setup  a program  and an effect  all with ID  4 because they are different object types  You can t  however  have two programs with ID 4           Object Type Object ID Object Name  Program 4 Horowitz Grand  Setup 4 Acoustic Split  Velocity Map 4 Light
374. s is recommended over  choosing the same program for the Drum Pad Program  because that uses two channels worth of  effects resources  the current channel  and channel 10  the pads channel   A value of Self uses the  same effects resources as the current channel  saving effects resources for other tracks  To turn  the pads off  set this parameter to None by entering 0     Note  Channel 10 can only use its current program as the Drum Pad Program  despite what is  selected on the PADS page  Also  all factory programs in the Drums category have Self selected  as the Drum Pad Program by default     Pad Assignments    On the Pads page  eight boxes represent the eight pads  and each box displays the note which  that pad triggers  To change a pad   s note assignment  first select the pad with the cursor buttons   then select the note  To select a note  hold the Enter button and play the desired note on the  keyboard  or use the Alpha Wheel or     buttons to scroll through the list of notes  You can also  select a note by MIDI note number  To do this  enter the number on the alphanumeric pad and  then press the Enter button     Aux Send Level Offset    Use this field to offset the amount of signal sent from the pads program on MIDI channel 10 to  the Aux effects of the program on the currently selected MIDI channel  Each program that is  selected for MIDI channel 10  as well as programs for all other channels  is stored with a send  level which determines how much signal is sent to t
375. s riff is set to be triggered and released by every key on the  keyboard  Lets change the Trigger and Release key ranges so that the riff is only triggered and  released by the key C  1  a very low key that likely wont be used anyway   To do this  use the cursor  buttons to select G9 in the right most Trigger field  and change it to C  1 by pressing 0 and then  pressing the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad  Next  use the cursor buttons to select G9 in the  right most Release field  and change it to C  1 by pressing 0 and then pressing the Enter button on  the alphanumeric pad  see below   You can also use the Alpha Wheel and scroll all the way counter   clockwise to reach C  1     720 rer   Ey         Fite Avail        PeleurTue Hor  orgie loos  eli 141     Forever        Why did we set the riff trigger and release key ranges to C  1  C  1 is the lowest note possible on  the PC3LE  which you will probably never play unless you press the Octave  soft button a few  times  from the Setup mode main page   and even then you would likely not want to play that  note since most programs do not sound good at such a low octave  Similarly  we could have set  both ranges to only G9  the PC3LE   s highest note  which is not likely to be used either     12  Next we will set a pad to trigger the horn riff  Press the more soft button in the bottom left corner of  the display to find the CTRLS soft button  Press the CTRLS soft button  This will bring you to the  Controllers page for zone 
376. s the  song approaches the Bar and Beat defined in the To parameter  where the full amount of  described change will occur     You can set Mode to NegRamp to achieve the opposite dynamic effect of PosRamp  NegRamp  works in the same way  but the amount of Scale and Offset applied will decrease from the full  amount of change described by Scale and Offset to little or no change as the song approaches the  bar  beat  and tick defined in the To parameter        10 30    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The EVENT Page    Remap  Use the Remap function to apply the values of any one type of controller data  already recorded  on a track  to another controller type  The effect the real time changes of the    Old    controller had  will be replaced by the effect the    New    controller has by using the exact same controller values        Old  Control Source List  0 to 127     The    Old    Controller is set to the Controller type that you wish to remap  This Controller data  must already exist on the current track in order to apply it to the    New    Controller type     New  Control Source List  0 to 127     The    New    parameter is set to the Controller code you wish to have use the existing values   once used by the    Old    Controller  to produce a different effect     Song Editor  The EVENT Page    Every type of recorded MIDI event is visible from this page  You can view and change these  events if necessary  Each track displays its initial program  volume  an
377. s their MIDI program change numbers     The object type and ID enable you to store hundreds of objects without losing track of them  and  also to load files from storage without having to replace files you ve already loaded        5 2    Editing Conventions       Saving and Naming    Saving and Naming    When you ve edited an object to your satisfaction  you 1l want to store it in memory  There s a  standard procedure for saving and naming  which applies to all objects  In any mode or editor   the LED on the Save button to the right of the display will light if you have made any changes  which can be saved for the object associated with the current mode or editor that you are using   When the Save button is lit  press the Save button to bring up a save dialog  Pressing the Save  button again while viewing this save dialog will save the object to the displayed ID   If you  have edited the object before  pressing save a second time will overwrite the object at its  previous ID   If you haven t edited the object before  pressing save a second time will save the  object at a new ID      Also  if you have changed something in an editor that can be saved  a save dialog will appear  when you press the Exit button  If you haven   t actually changed anything while in the editor   you ll simply exit to the mode you started from  If you have made changes  however  the PC3LE  will ask you if you want to save those changes  The first Save dialog gives you options via soft  buttons  Press 
378. se the Alpha Wheel or      buttons to change each MidiDst parameter     Soft Buttons on the COMMON Page  TRACK   calls up the TRACK page  This page accesses useful track based edit functions  There    is a selectable edit function that can be applied to the selected track or all tracks in your song   The TRACK page is described on page 10 21     EVENT   calls up the EVENT page  an event list style editor  On the EVENT page in the Song  Editor  you can scroll through  modify  add  or delete any or all of the tracks    MIDI events  The  EVENT page is described on page 10 31     Rec  Play  and Stop     function as described in The Rec  Play  and Stop Soft Buttons on page 10 7     Save   calls up the    Save as    dialog     Song Editor  The TRACK Page    This page allows you access to useful track based edit functions  These functions are           Erase Shift Insert Change  Copy Transpose Delete Remap  Bounce Grab Quantize             For each function  there is a set of parameters to control how the function operates  and on what  region of the selected track s   As usual  the top line of this page displays the selected track or  tracks  Select the available current track s  for editing by using the Chan Zone buttons  Press  both of the Chan Zone buttons together to select All tracks     Below is an example of the TRACK page for the Bounce function            Function   DstTrack       To 1 S 1116  Mode      Events   Al    You will notice that the page is divided into two halve
379. se to resemble a bell curve  so that notes are loudest when your  keystrike velocity is 64  Notes get softer as the keystrike velocity approaches 0 or 127     MIDI Velocity    127       Strike Velocity    Velocity Curve  Linear    as you hit the keys harder  increase the  velocity  MIDI velocity increases proportionally    Velocity Curve  Bump    MIDI velocity is greatest at  medium strike velocity    Velocity Curve  Crossfade   Below medium strike velocity  MIDI velocity is less  than with Linear curve  above medium strike velocity   MIDI velocity is greater than with Linear curve    The next four velocity curves are Reverse Linear  Rvrs Linear   Reverse Expand  Rvrs Expand    Reverse Compress  Rvrs Compress   and Reverse Crossfade  Rvrs Crossfade   These taper  velocity in reverse of the five curves we just covered  For example  Reverse Linear   s response is  such that striking a key harder will produce a lower volume  striking it softer will produce a  higher volume  and so on  This provides a convenient way to achieve negative scaling  by letting  you set one parameter instead of two     MIDI Velocity    O  K    64  Strike Velocity       Velocity Curve  Reverse Linear    as you hit the keys harder  increase the  velocity  MIDI velocity decreases proportionally    Velocity Curve  Reverse Compress    MIDI velocity is more at  medium strike velocity than Reverse Linear curve    Velocity Curve  Reverse Expand    MIDI velocity is less at  medium strike velocity than Reverse L
380. sed on the tunings for traditional Indian music    10   Arabic Oriented toward the tunings of Mid Eastern music    11   BaliJava1 Based on the pentatonic scale of Balinese and Javanese music    12   BaliJava2 A variation on 1Bali Java  slightly more subtle overall    13   BaliJava3 A more extreme variation    14   Tibetan Based on the Chinese pentatonic scale    15   CarlosAlpha Developed by Wendy Carlos  an innovator in microtonal tunings  this intonation  map flats each interval increasingly  resulting in an octave with quarter tone  intervals    16   Pyth aug4 This is a Pythagorean tuning  based on the Greek pentatonic scale  The tritone  is 12 cents sharp    17   Pyth dim5 This is a Pythagorean tuning  based on the Greek pentatonic scale  The tritone          is 12 cents flat     In general  you should select a nonstandard intonation map when you re playing simple  melodies  as opposed to chords  in a particular musical style  When you use intonation maps    based on pentatonic scales  you ll normally play pentatonic scales to most accurately reproduce  those styles     Intonation Key  Int Key     This sets the tonic  or base note from which the currently selected intonation map calculates its  intervals  If you select G as the intonation key  for example  and the intonation map you select  tunes the minor 2nd down by 50 cents  then G  will be a quartertone flat relative to equal  intonation  If you change the intonation key to D  then D  will be a quartertone flat  If yo
381. see Delete on page 6 15      Updating A Previously Edited Program    If you are saving changes to a program that you have previously edited  the same ID  that the  edited program was saved with will automatically be selected  and you can simultaneously  press the     buttons to jump between selecting the program s same ID  and the first available  User category ID   If you wish to make an updated edit to a previously edited program and  replace the old version at the same ID   pressing the Save button twice will have the same result  as pressing the Save button and then the save soft button     Arpeggiator Settings  Arp Settings Button     Each program has its own arpeggiator settings  Press the Arp Settings button on the front panel   below the mode buttons   This will bring you to the Arpeggiator 1 page where you can access  the arpeggiator settings for the currently selected program  See Chapter 7  The ARPEGGIATOR  Page for more on these settings  The arpeggiator in Program mode acts the same as a single  arpeggiator does in Setup mode  but in Program mode the Arpeggiator 2 page has no SyncTo   SyncType  or Num Beats parameters as it does in Setup mode     Split Layer Button    A    Press the Split Layer button to create a split or layered setup using the currently selected  program  which you can then play in Setup mode  You will be brought to the Split  Layer page   See Chapter 7  Split Layer Button for details on how to use this page     Note  When entering the Split La
382. see Saving and Naming on page 5 3     Song Mode  The BIG Page    On the BIG page  the PC3LE displays   in a large font  thus the page s name   the current time    location of the    playhead    of the sequencer in a Bar   Beat   Tick format  like the Riff time    location display   Also displayed is the current status of the sequencer  and the BIG page   s six  parameters       EE d  STOPPED    A Loot             Time Irn  1    Time Oute 1   Punch    Sond Ends 1      Hetroni    pare TRIG  Load  Save                                                      Parameter Range of Values Default   Bar    Current Position   Beat  Depends on Time Signature   Tick  0 to 959 0   Bar   Time In  Beat  1to4   Tick  0 to 959 0   Bar   Time Out  Beat  1to4   Tick  0 to 959 0   Bar   Song End  Beat  1to4   Tick  0 to 959 0  Loop         Loop        Punch          Punch          Metronome Rec  Always  Off Rec             10 10    Song Mode and the Song Editor  Song Mode  The FX Pages       Time In    The Time In parameter determines the start time for Loop or Punch In recording  more on this  below      Time Out    The Time Out parameter determines the stop time for Loop or Punch In recording     Song End    The Song End parameter determines the end point for the song  Note that when Time Out and  Song End are set to the same location  changes made to Song End are reflected in Time Out   When recording beyond your initially specified Song End point  you 1l notice that the Song End  location automa
383. self and the next note  The lowest value is 1     stacattissimo  This parameter has no effect on  percussion sounds or other sounds whose duration is fixed     Velocity    Velocity sets the attack velocity of the played notes  With Velocity set to First  all notes play at  the velocity of the first played note  With Velocity set to Played  each note repeats with the same  velocity you played it at  With Velocity set to Last  all notes play at the velocity of the most  recently played note  With Velocity set to Aftertouch  the velocities are controlled by keyboard  pressure  as you hold and push down on any key  the velocities get higher  and as you ease up  they get lower        7 37    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor         With Velocity set to MIDI 109  MIDI controller 109 continually sets the arpeggiator velocity  This  works well when MIDI controller 109 is set to a knob or expression pedal     With Velocity set to Fixed  all notes play with the same velocity  The default Fixed velocity is  100  Like MIDI 109  You can control this velocity amount in real time by assigning a controller  to VelFixed  controller destination number is 175  Input from any physical controller assigned to  send VelFixed  or any entry value for a controller assigned to send VelFixed  overrides the  programmed value of the Velocity parameter  disabling it until you select a different setup  or in  Program mode  until you select a different control setup on the MIDI mode TRANSMIT page      Patte
384. setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano and adjust the volume and pan of Zone 2 which  contains the piano program 8 Grand    Evans        1  If you are not already in Setup mode  press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page   then press the Setup mode button  located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This  will bring you to the Setup mode main page  Next  with the setup 38 Jazz Bass Piano selected in  setup mode  press the Edit button on the front panel  This will bring you to the CH PROG page of  the setup editor  see below                    aro  Pale Pe      Programe       AC Buzzer Bass  Channel  I 1001 USBL   HidiBank  1 BankMode   Ctl Ase  HidiFrog  18r EnteyProgChd 1 On  Status  Active ArPes3iator   Or    y more  CH PEG    Step2 A    2  From the CH PROG page  press the PANVOL soft button on the bottom of the screen  see above    This brings you to the PAN VOL page where you can view key and velocity ranges for the current  Zone  see below         Entrablolume     Ea EntruPar   Hone  ExitVolume   ExitPan   64  AA PANWOL    3  On the PAN VOL page  use the Chan Zone buttons to the left of the display to select Zone 2  You  can view the number of the selected Zone in the top right corner of screen  see below            Entrablolume  Exit Volume    EntruParn   Hone  ExitPan         y more  CH PEG       PANWOL SOSA          13 11    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Adjusting The Volume And Pan Of Zones    4  Use the cursor buttons to select the EntryVolume field  T
385. should  only play from the pads which you have assigned  and not from the keyboard     Press the Exit button to save the edited setup and return to the Setup mode main page  When  prompted to save the setup  press the Yes soft button  Next you will be given the choice of choosing  an ID  and renaming the setup if desired  For details see Saving and Naming on page 5 3        14 8    Power User Tips       Advanced Tips    Assign Pads To Play Notes  Chords  Riffs  Or To Toggle Other Functions Like Arpeggiators    In Setup mode you can assign the PC3LE s pads to play notes  chords or riffs  You can also  assign each pad to function as a switch that can control program parameters or send MIDI  continuous controller values  internally or to external equipment   See Pads on page 7 15 for  details on each function     See Chapter 13  Tutorials  Setup Mode for examples of assigning the PC3LE s pads and other  physical controllers to parameters and controller destinations  See The Controller Destination  List on page 7 17 for a list of parameters that can be controlled with physical controllers via  control destination numbers  Controller destinations 147 and above control arpeggiator and riff  parameters     To set a pad to toggle a zone s arpeggiator on and off  select the setup to edit and press the Edit  button to the left of the display to enter the Setup Editor  In the Setup Editor  select the zone of  the arpeggiator you want to control by using the Chan Zone buttons to the left
386. signal        6 14    Program Mode       The Program Editor    Note  Though aux effects Chains are stored for each program  only one channel at a time  the  A  currently selected channel  can use its aux effects Chain on the aux bus  Aux effects Chains on  other channels are made inactive     The ARPEGGIATOR 1  amp  2 Pages  ARP 1  ARP 2     Each program has its own arpeggiator settings  Press the ARP 1 or ARP 2 soft button to go to one  of the two pages of arpeggiator settings for the current program   You can also view and edit these  settings from the Program mode main page by pressing the Arp Settings button on the front panel  below  the mode buttons      See Chapter 7  The ARPEGGIATOR Page for more on these settings  The arpeggiator in Program  mode acts the same as a single arpeggiator does in Setup mode  but in Program mode the  Arpeggiator 2 page has no SyncTo  SyncType  or Num Beats parameters as it does in Setup  mode     The Program Editor Utility Soft Buttons    Import Arpeggiator Settings  ImpArp     The ImpArp button allows you to import arpeggiator settings from other programs  Pressing the  ImpArp button brings you to the ImportArp page  On the ImportArp page  select a program  from the list and press the Import soft button to import the arpeggiator settings from the  selected program to the current program     Delete    This erases a program from memory  freeing up space to store programs in other locations   You  can check the free memory in the PC3LE at an
387. ss    A convenient way to select programs and setups is to use Quick Access mode  where you select  a Quick Access bank from a list of factory preset or user programmed banks  Each bank contains  ten memory slots  or entries  where you can store any combination of programs or setups  While  you re in Quick Access mode  you can select any program or setup in the bank with buttons 0  through 9 or the cursor keys     The PC3LE comes with a few Quick Access banks already programmed so you can get an idea of  how they work  Create your own Quick Access banks to help you select programs and setups  with a minimum of searching  Press the Quick Access mode button to the left of the display  Its  LED lights  to tell you you re in Quick Access mode     The top line of the display tells you which Quick Access bank is selected  Use the Chan Zone  buttons  to the left of the display  to scroll through the banks  The names of each of the ten  entries in the bank are listed in the center of the display  Longer names will be abbreviated  The  currently selected entry s full name is shown near the bottom of the display  The amount of  transposition is displayed to the left of the entry name  If the current entry is a program  you ll  see the current keyboard  MIDI  channel displayed to the right of the entry   s name  If it   s a  setup  you ll see the word Setup     The entries on the Quick Access page are arranged to correspond to the layout of the numeric  buttons on the alphanumeric pad  
388. ss Edit     There are a few conventions shared by all of the Song editor pages  Displayed at the top of each  Song editor page is the name of the page and the currently selected track  1 16  or all tracks   All  of the values for the parameters found in any of the Song editor pages are saved in the song    object     Song Editor  The COMMON Page    Press the Edit button on the front panel of the PC3LE to display the COMMON page and begin  editing a song  This is where you will find parameters common to all tracks  such as tempo and  time signature  control parameters for effects  and soft buttons for switching to other Song editor    pages     IEEE 500  e IA 1050 E  FR     Teme  Time S13  Fe Track    Drumbrk  1   Midilst  L      Rec  Play I     d  1       4    2 3  4 5   Sp  Los Les Les       6  7      asbes le    EVENT  Save                        Parameter Range of Values Default   Tempo 0  external   20 00 to 400 00 BPM 120   Time Signature  Numerator  1to 99 4   Denominator  1  2  4  8  16  32  and 64 4   FX Track 1to16 1   Drum Track  D      MIDI Destination      L  M  U L          The currently selected track is displayed on the top line  though on the COMMON page this  only applies to the DrumTrk and MidiDst parameters  see below   The rest of the parameters on  the COMMON page are global settings for the song and do not directly affect individual tracks        10 19    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  The COMMON Page    Tempo    This is another place w
389. st octaves  This  would allow you to play root note bass lines that change the key that Shift Key Number plays in   leaving the upper octaves of the keyboard open for use by other zones     If Shift Key is set to Last Note Played and no note is played  the default key is C  Each zone can  have a different Shift Key  so you can have zones preprogrammed with the keys you want to  use  or have them all in the same key  or just change the key in real time while you are playing     A Note About Octave Range     When using Shift Key Number  shift patterns with more than 12 steps begin triggering notes in  higher octaves  This is done because longer shift patterns use up more of a controller   s range   and limit the number of octaves that a single controller can trigger  Since the lowest octave of a  program is often too low to be musically useful  the PC3LE will automatically start triggering  notes from longer shift patterns in higher octaves  This saves room in the controller   s range of       7 23    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    values for triggering more useful octaves  See the table below for Shift Pattern step ranges and  their corresponding starting octave                 Default Octave Shifting  Total   of Shift Pattern Steps Starting Octave  1 12 Co C1  13 24 C1 C2  25 36 C2 C3  37 48 C3 C4       Selecting The Desired Octave Range     You adjust the starting octave manually  using the Offset parameter on the corresponding  controller   s setup page  In the Offset
390. st range of  pressure expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit  your playing style   MIDI  Sources    PC3LE Keyboard MIDI In via MIDI In port or USB Computer port        MIDI  Destinations             PC3LE Sound Engine    MIDI Out via MIDI Out port or USB Computer port    to  PC3LE audio outputs    The transmit Pressure Map affects the way the PC3LE sends MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values  to its USB or MIDI Out port  see the circled box above for its location in the MIDI signal flow    Different maps output different MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values for the same received MIDI  pressure  aftertouch  value  Each map applies a different curve to received MIDI pressure   aftertouch  values and remaps them to new values before transmitting them to the USB or  MIDI Out port  this parameter has no effect on MIDI data sent from Song mode or to the  PC3LE   s sound engine   The default map provides the widest range of pressure  aftertouch   expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default does not suit your playing  style  See the diagram above for the other pages that affect MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values  before reaching the transmit Pressure Map     The default map  Linear  allows MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values to pass unchanged  Maps 2 4  make it increasingly easier to produce MIDI pressure values for the same physical pressure  applied to a key  with 4    Easiest    being the easiest   Maps 4 7 make it incre
391. starts  and riff 1 stops  because it has  been waiting for riff 2 to start   In short  light and then unlight  a k a  trigger and release  pad 1 or 2 to start  riff 1 or 2  When you press the other pad  it will start the other riff when the playing riff reaches its loop  point  and stop that playing riff  This way  you can switch between the two riffs playing each song section   and the transition will always be in sync  When finished  press the front panel Stop button to stop any  playing riffs     13  To finish  press the Exit button to the right of the display to exit the Setup Editor and save your  changes to this setup under a new ID  if desired  See The Setup Editor section at the beginning  of this chapter for details on saving when you exit the Setup Editor        13 52    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    Riff Troubleshooting    When using riffs  you may run into a situation in which the riff isn t working the way you think  it should  Below are some common problems and solutions     Problem Solution    The riff wont trigger from anywhere    In the Setup Editor for the riff s zone  make sure the  SrcTrack parameter on the RIFF1 page is set to a track that  contains recorded MIDI data  from the song selected for the  Song field        In the Setup Editor for the riff s zone  if the BPM parameter  on the RIFF2 page is set to External  make sure an external  MIDI clock is being received by the PC3LE     The riff wont trigger from the   In the Setup Ed
392. switches        13 42    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    Riffs can also be triggered by the keyboard keys  Since keys can   t stay on  toggled  like switches  and pads can  it is common to have another key  usually right next to the trigger key  to release  the riff  Set the trigger and release keys for a riff by setting the Trigger and Release ranges on the  RIFF2 page to a range of one key each  You can also transpose riffs when triggering them from  the keys  See the next tutorial for details     Transposing A Riff As It Is Triggered    Riffs triggered from the PC3LE   s keyboard can be transposed as they are triggered  One  common use for this feature is to create a bass riff that can be triggered by the left hand  In this  tutorial we will look at a setup that is configured this way  and look at some settings we can  change to trigger the transposing riff in different ways     1  Press the Exit button until you reach the ProgramMode page  Next  press the Setup mode button   located with the mode buttons to the left of the display  This will bring you to the Setup mode main    page     2  Use the       buttons or Alpha Wheel to select the setup 64 Old School Jam or use the  alphanumeric pad to enter 64 and press Enter  see below   This setup splits the keyboard between  an electric bass riff on the lower notes of the keyboard and an electric piano on the higher notes of  the keyboard  There are also drum riffs that play from pads 1 and 2        Octau 
393. t pad  You can control either the current  zone  or all zones  See below for parameter explanations of each Pad control Type     Note  Chord    With Note or Chord selected in the Type field  you can assign the pad to play a single note or  chord of up to 8 notes     Chore    O EN    Key Number  KeyNum     Use the KeyNum field to select the note to be played  The note is displayed by MIDI note name   To select a note  select the KeyNum field with the cursor buttons  hold the Enter button on the  alphanumeric pad  then play the desired note on the keyboard  You can also change the note in  the field by using the Alpha Wheel or      buttons        Zone    Use the Zone field to set the desired zone that you wish to control with the current pad  A  setting of This Zone makes the pad control the currently selected zone  you can view the  currently selected zone in the upper right corner of the screen   while a setting of All Zones  makes the pad control all zones        7 15    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Velocity   Use the Velocity field to select a MIDI attack velocity  0 127  for the note s  designated in the  KeyNum field s   Alternatively  set the Velocity field to Auto and the note   s velocity will change  each time it is triggered dependent on how hard the pad is hit each time     MIDI Continuous Controller Destination or Program Parameter  Switch  SW  Momentary  or  SW  Toggled      With Switch selected in the Type field  the selected pad will function just like t
394. t to all  MIDI channels assigned to tracks that have data on them  and the internal clock is set to match  the setting of the Tempo parameter  When looking for a previously saved song  you can scroll  through songs while the sequencer is playing to quickly hear the beginning of each     Tempo    The Tempo parameter determines the initial tempo for the selected song  The song will always  start playback at the initial tempo  Whatever the tempo is set to when you record your first track  will be the song   s initial tempo  During playback  the current tempo is shown in this field   During recording  tempos dialed in here get recorded in the Tempo Track  The initial tempo and  other tempo changes can also be edited in the event list for the Tempo Track  The Tempo track  also allows you to program more precise fractional tempos with two decimal places     To quickly change a song   s initial tempo  press Record  the Song Status will change to REC  READY   set the tempo desired  then press Stop  The initial tempo can also be changed with the  Tempo parameter on the COMMON page in the Song Editor  or at the top of the event list for the  Tempo track on the EVENT page in the Song Editor     Note  You can also set the tempo using the Tap Tempo button  on the front panel  below the  Mode buttons   Tap the Tap Tempo button on beat for a measure or two at the desired tempo to  set a tempo  This also brings up the Tap Tempo page  see Tap Tempo Button on page 6 4      You can also set the
395. t want to do that  you can select a  different ID  You can also press the       buttons simultaneously to toggle between the ID that the  PC3LE suggested and the original ID  Or press the Cancel soft button to cancel the operation     If you decide not to cancel or change the ID  and you press the Replace soft button  the PC3LE  will write your newly edited object over the existing ROM object  Actually  it only appears that  way  since you can   t truly write to ROM  The ROM object will reappear if you delete the newly  edited object  there are soft buttons in each editor for deleting objects      Memory Objects    If the original object was a memory object  the PC3LE will assume you want to replace it  and  will suggest the same ID as the original object   In all modes other than Song mode  a diamond  icon preceding an item   s ID indicates a memory object   As with ROM objects  you can cancel   replace  or change the ID and save to an unused ID  If you replace a memory object  however   it   s definitely gone        5 4    Editing Conventions       Keyboard Naming    The keyboard naming feature  makes naming objects  convenient  by letting you use  the keyboard  or your MIDI  controller  to enter the name of  the object you re modifying     When you re in a Rename  dialog  use either of the Chan     AO to C8    Saving and Naming     Standard 88 note Keyboard     Zone buttons to change between move cursor to start of name    the keyboard naming states  Off   disabled   On  a
396. takes in a performance  or to make notes adhere to a  strict timing grid as a stylistic choice  as in much modern electronic music   Quantized notes  have technically perfect timing but tend to sound less like a human performance  Quantization  can be applied automatically to each track as itis recorded  or it can be applied after recording to  only specific selections  For details see the Song mode chapter  The MISC Page  Quant  parameter  and Song mode chapter  Song Editor  Track Functions  Quantize     Creating Loops With The Big Time Page    On the Big Time page you can set the sequencer to loop a selection of bars  Set the Loop  parameter to Loop  and set a time for the Time In and Time Out parameters  Now  pressing  Play Pause on the front panel will cause your selection to play repeatedly and seamlessly  You  will most commonly want to set your Time In and Time Out points to equal an even number of  bars such as 2  4  8  etc  Recording into a looped section of bars is a common technique for  recording sequence based music  For example  with a drum program selected for a track  you  could record a drum part by playing one drum sound each time through a 2 bar loop  until the  entire 2 bar drum    beat    sounds complete  Next  you could turn off the Loop parameter and  duplicate your drum beat several times to create the drum track for a longer song  see below for  details on duplicating bars   Keep in mind that you can loop any length of a song  and record  into a loop 
397. ted in any  mode except Setup mode  and pitch bend messages in the current program  in Program mode  will result  in behavior as specified for the Pitch Bend Range parameters on the BASIC page in the Program Editor     BendRangeUp ct  and BendRangeDown ct  lets you fine tune the value for Bend Range   semitones   100 cents equals one semitone  or one half step  you can set this parameter  anywhere between 0 and 100 cents     BendRangeUp  in both semitones and cents  affects all controllers that are set to PitchUp  in the  default settings for the control setup  Setup 126 Internal Voices   the Pitchbend up parameter  for  the Pitch Wheel  on the Controllers page is assigned to PitchUp   BendRangeDown  in both  semitones and cents  affects all controllers that are set to PitchDwn  in the default settings for  the control setup  Setup 126 Internal Voices   the Pitchbend dn parameter  for the Pitch Wheel  on  the Controllers page is assigned to PitchDwn   Any physical controller that uses the Control  Destination list can be assigned to PitchUp or PitchDwn  To keep things simple though  you  will normally want to use PitchUp and PitchDwn  controller destinations 130 and 131  as a  Pitch Wheel destinations  see page 7 10 for details   and use MIDI 21 and MIDI 15  controller       7 34    Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       destinations 21 and 15  for other controllers  such as the Knobs and Expression pedals  see Aux  Bend 1 Up Down and Aux Bend 2 Range below      Keep in mind that
398. ted on  any GM instrument will playback with the correct instrumentation on any other GM  instrument  no matter the manufacturer  GM has many uses  for example it makes it easy for  musicians who use MIDI files to share ideas and collaborate while using different sets of  equipment  Also many instrumental versions of public domain songs can be found for free on  the internet as GM compatible MIDI files  These  like all MIDI files  offer certain advantages over  audio such as small file size  the ability to edit  orchestrate  or change tempo to easily learn from  the sequences  or even convert note information to standard notation with a third party  application        9 9    Master Mode       Master Mode Page 2  MAST 2     Overview of General MIDI Mode    Once enabled  Program mode will display the set of 128 standard GM program names on the  right side of the screen  see below   Aside from the different layout and program choice  Program  mode operates normally  see below for info on the left side of the screen   A default GM sequence will  be loaded which sets FX sends for reverb and chorus  which are part of the GM specification   Drum programs will also be remapped to the GM drum map  The standard PC3LE programs  will not be visible until GM mode is turned off     ror arm        pj  Program assigned  123 Gunshot  4096 GM Fiano 1       Oetau    AT    Replacing Default General MIDI Programs    The PC3LE   s GM sounds consist of PC3LE programs tailored to work well in all GM
399. termines the MIDI receiving capabilities of the PC3LE  When set  to Omni  the PC3LE responds to incoming MIDI events on all MIDI channels  and plays them  on the current channel  This is normally used for diagnostic purposes only     At a setting of Poly  the PC3LE responds only to events that are sent on the same channel as the  PC3LE   s current MIDI channel  the one displayed on the top line of the Program mode page   In  Poly mode  the currently selected channel is always the basic channel  so if you change channels   the basic channel changes accordingly     With a value of Multi  the default   the PC3LE responds to events on all active channels  This is  the mode you   ll use when you re driving the PC3LE with a sequencer  since you can play a  different program on each channel        9 16    Master Mode       MIDI Receive  RECV     Velocity Map  Receive     Change the receive Velocity Map setting if you are triggering the PC3LE with external MIDI  gear which is producing notes that are too loud or too quiet  The default map provides the  widest range of velocity expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the default    does not suit your playing style   MIDI In via MIDI In port or USB Computer port    MIDI    Sources  q VelMap Settings on MIDI Receive Page    KEY VEL page for current Control Setup  in Program Mode  or current Zone  in Setup Mode    VelMap Settings on Master Mode Page 1  PC3LE Song Mode VelMap Settings on MIDI Transmit Page    MIDI  Desti
400. tertouch  values for the same received MIDI  pressure  aftertouch  value  Each map applies a different curve to received MIDI pressure   aftertouch  values and remaps them to new values before letting them pass  this parameter has  no effect on MIDI data sent from the PC3LE   s keyboard   The default map provides the widest  range of pressure  aftertouch  expression  but you may want to choose a different map if the  default does not suit your playing style  See the diagram above for the other pages that affect  MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values before reaching the receive Pressure Map     The default map  Linear  allows MIDI pressure  aftertouch  values to pass unchanged  Maps 2 4  make it increasingly easier to produce MIDI pressure values for the same physical pressure  applied to a key  with 4    Easiest    being the easiest   Maps 4 7 make it increasingly harder to  produce MIDI pressure values for the same physical pressure applied to a key  with 7    Hardest     being the hardest         9 18    Master Mode       MIDI Receive  RECV     All Notes Off    If this parameter s value is set to Normal  the PC3LE responds to All Notes Off messages  received over MIDI  Ignore causes these messages to be ignored  If you re using a Roland  product as a MIDI controller for your PC3LE  you ll want to set the value of this parameter to  Ignore  This is because some older Roland products occasionally send an All Notes Off message  when no keys are held down   even if you re sustainin
401. th  RelSynTyp set to None  your riff will stop playing as soon as it is released  It will not sync to  anything  With RelSynTyp set to DownBeat  if there is already something playing to sync to  the  current riff will wait for the downbeat of the next measure before stopping when released  so   you can trigger the riff to stop ahead of time  and have it stop in sync at the downbeat of the next  measure  If Syncing to an arpeggiator  see Num Beats on page 7 46 for details on changing when an       7 57    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    arpeggiator s downbeat will occur  With RelSynTyp set to AnyBeat  if there is already a something  playing to sync to  the riff will wait only until the next beat before stopping when released   Depending on when you release the riff it will stop in sync with a beat  but it may be on an  upbeat or a downbeat     With RelSynTyp set to DownBeatWait  the riff will wait for the downbeat of the next measure to  stop when released  The difference from DownBeat is that if there is nothing playing to sync to   the riff wont stop when released  If another riff is already running  DownBeatWait behaves just  like DownBeat     With RelSynTyp set to AnyBeatWait  if there is already a something playing to sync to  the riff  will wait for the next beat before releasing  The difference from AnyBeat is that if there is  nothing playing to sync to  this riff will not stop when released  This can be useful if you want to  stop a riff in sync only when anothe
402. the Chan Zone buttons to the left of       13 22    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones    the display to select Zone 3  see below   You can view the number of the selected Zone in the top  right corner of screen                  SNe    Horne    Offset    Cl     T  a  iT        a  iT           9  On the Controllers page for Zone 3  Knob 1 will still be selected in the Controller field  If not   follow these steps  Use the cursor buttons to select the Controller field  Make sure the LED to the  left of the Timbre Knob is lit  if it is not  press the Shift button to the left of the Knobs until that  LED is lit  Next  hold the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and move the Knob labeled  Timbre  This will select Knob 1 for the Controller field  You can also set the desired controller in  the Controller field by using the Alpha Wheel or       buttons     10  With Knob 1 selected in the Controller field  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  then use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select Ctrl  see below         PANWOLIEEYUEL   more d    11  With Ctrl selected in the DestType field  use the cursor buttons to select the Dest field  In the Dest  field  press 7 and then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad to choose Volume  see below    You can also use the Alpha Wheel or       buttons to select a destination in the Dest field                 LO   HOMES   Knot ntriblalue   None  Scale   10661  
403. the bottom  right corner of the display to find the RIFF2 soft button  Press the RIFF2 soft button to move to the  RIFF2 page  On the RIFF2 page  use the cursor buttons to select the BPM field  in the left column   bottom of the display   With the BPM field selected  press the   button  below the Alpha Wheel  to  select Setup  see below   Now if you press pads 1 and 2 to start the riffs at the same time  their  tempo   s should be in sync  Now you can also use the Tap Tempo button  to the left of the display   below the mode buttons  to set a tempo for the riffs by tapping the button at the desired tempo  or  press the button once to view the Tap Tempo page  see Tap Tempo Button on page 6 4 for details              Anc one   1 SuncTWPe i i  Relsune  n   First Avail   RelSunTue   Hone  Iur  loos  Wel  1007    Vik                 13 40    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    16  We can make the riffs both play in perfect sync by always starting them at the exact same time  One  way to do this is by making the horn riff start only when the drum riff plays a down beat  To do this   go to the RIFF2 page for zone 6 and use the cursor buttons to select the SyncZone field in the top  right of the page  Select Riff 4 by pressing 4 then the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad  see  below   You can also use the       buttons or the Alpha Wheel to select Riff 4           ANSLO  C 1 SYncTyPe  Relsundn              First Avail     RelSunTue   Hone  Iur  ieee Mel  1007     
404. the cursor to the value for the LoKey parameter  press  and hold  the Enter  button  then press the note you wish to be the lowest note for the currently displayed zone  The  note you triggered will appear as the value for the LoKey parameter  Repeat the process for the  HiKey parameter     You can find programs or setups by searching for a string of characters from the Program or  Setup mode main pages  or when selecting programs from with the Setup Editor   On these  pages  hold the Enter button and press any of the numeric Category buttons to display the  Search dialog     Type in the string of characters you want to find using the alphanumeric pad  For example  if  you re looking at the program list and you want to find all programs containing the word     Horn     you would type h o r n  This function is not case sensitive  it will find upper and lower  case characters regardless of what you type     When you ve typed the string of characters you want to find  press Enter  The PC3LE searches  through the current list of objects or values  finds all items that match the string of characters  you typed  and displays the first one it finds  Hold Enter and press one of the Plus Minus  buttons to move to the next higher  or lower numbered object that contains the string of  characters     The string you search for remains in memory  You can store and select a string of characters with  each of the numeric buttons  Hold Enter and press one of the numeric buttons at any time to
405. the linear curve at keystrike velocities above 64  In other  words  when you re playing softly  you 1l notice velocity differences less than with a linear  curve  while when you re playing hard  you ll notice velocity differences more     Setting Curv to Compress produces a velocity curve that is the opposite of the expanded  curve   that is  you ll notice velocity differences more when you re playing softly than when  you re playing hard     You can also create    reverse    versions of the three described curves  First  select your desired  curve  Then set the Scale parameter to  100   and set the Offset parameter to 127  This makes  the selected controller send a value of 127 when all the way down and a value of 0 when all the  way up     To get an idea of how these curves affect controller response  refer to the Velocity Curve charts   which begin on page 7 28     Offset    This adds or subtracts a constant to the controller  and at the same time sets minimum or  maximum values  there s no need for separate Max and Min parameters   If Offset is 25  the  minimum value of the controller will be 25  If it is  25  and scale is 100    the first one fifth of the  controller s movement  25 127   1 5  will send value of 0  and the maximum value of the  controller will be 102    127 25   As with velocity  Scale is a proportional change to the controller   while Offset is a linear change  The values for Offset range from  128 to 127     DestType    This field determines which type 
406. ther edit function  Keep in mind though  that if you choose to perform  more than one edit without saving  and you are not satisfied with one of the changes you make   you will have to exit the editor without saving and then redo each of the changes you made   That s why it s usually best to save after each successful edit     Common Parameters for Edit Song  Track Functions    Locate    This parameter is available for every function on the TRACK page  It appears at the lower left  hand corner of the page     The Locate bar  beat  and tick will change in real time during playback and recording to reflect  the song   s current position  It can be set to any bar  beat  and tick  including negative values   Playback begins at  and Stop resets the song to the Locate bar  beat  and tick     Region Criteria Box Parameters    From and To  From and To are available in most TRACK edit functions to define a range of time on the  selected track s      The From value defines the first bar  beat  and tick in a range of time selected for editing  The To  value defines the final bar  beat  and tick in a range of time selected for editing     Events    Any and all types of MIDI events are available for editing  selectable in this parameter  Some  events will provide you with settings for a range of values  or other MIDI event specific criteria   Available Values are  All  Notes  Controllers  MonoPress  PitchBend  ProgChange  PolyPress     When Events is set to ALL  all MIDI events on the tra
407. this setup  First  lets change the Stop time for riff 1 so that it doesn   t play the song  section that we will use for riff 2  On the RIFF  page for zone 1  use the cursor buttons to select the  left most Stop field  this is the Stop bars field   then press the minus button twice  below the Alpha  Wheel  to change this field to 3  see below   Now when you press and light pad 1  riff 1 will play all  tracks of the song 428 H Fact Sng  but now it is only a loop of the first 2 bars            Ores  ae ck Serra    a  H Src Track ALL  top  KB Rd 25 Re Channel   Off    eee Ltt  Amore EPL RP  RIFFI RIFF   more A       13 50    Tutorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs    9  Next  press the top Chan Zone button  to the left of the display  to move to the RIFF1 page for  zone 2  The currently selected zone number can be viewed in the top right corner of the display  Use  the cursor buttons to select the Sre Track field  then press the minus button twice  below the Alpha  Wheel  to select ALL  see below   Next  use the cursor buttons to select the left most Start field   this is the Start bars field   then press the plus button twice  below the Alpha Wheel  to change this  field to 3  see below   This will make riff 2 play a two bar loop of the song 428 H Fact Sng  but  unlike riff 1 it will play bars 3 and 4 instead of bars 1 and 2        E ER RS     CORP            10  Before this riff can be triggered  press the RIFF2 soft button to move to the RIFF2 page for zone 2   On t
408. tically moves and rounds to the next bar  so as to always be ahead of the  playhead  It is possible to move the Song End point to a location before other MIDI events  i e    in the middle of the current song    the sequencer will ignore  but not delete  events after this  point     Loop    With the Loop parameter set to Loop  the sequencer will loop the segment of the song between  Time In and Time Out     Punch    With the Punch parameter set to Punch  the sequencer  in RECORDING mode  will record  events only between Time In and Time Out     Metro    The Metro parameter determines the recording modes in which the metronome will play  With  Metro set to Rec  the metronome only plays while recording is in progress  With Metro set to  Always  the metronome plays during playback and recording  With Metro set to Off  the  metronome doesn t play at all     Song Mode  The FX Pages    The three Song mode FX pages   FX  AUXFX1  and AUXFX2   work the same way as the effects  pages in Setup Mode  See the Setup mode chapter effects section  The FX Pages  FX  AUXFX1   AUXFX2 on page 7 60 for information on using these pages        10 11    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MIXER Page    Song Mode  The MIXER Page    The MIXER page shows the current settings for the program number  panning  and volume of  each track  in groups of 8   The selected track number  as well as the range of tracks displayed on  the page  are displayed in the upper right hand corner of the screen
409. ting instrument volumes for only  specific sections of a song     1  On the Song mode MAIN page  make sure the Mode parameter is set to Merge  see below    Also  make sure the Punch parameter has been turned off  as in Part 5  step 9  above         12 11    Tutorial  Song Mode                 cures  1625   NY Sond TemFigs  RecTrki 1 Uol  SH Pant 64 Mod  Prog A Ara Grand Loc at     dica dia Geen cae    2  Press the Record button  then press Play Pause           3     Select the Vol parameter and adjust it with the alpha wheel while the sequencer is recording  Any  changes to the Vol parameter will be recorded as data in the current track         A AEREA E a a e r  CurSral 110425 4 Temo  166 4  RecTrk  1 dan  64 Mode  Merge  Prog 1 Stare   T Locat  1 il    oO    diia dia ala    4  When you are finished  press the Stop button  You will be able to review and save your changes just  as in Step 4 of Part 3  see above          Part 6 c  Erasing Volume Automation    If you ve saved a song with volume automation and you wish to change or remove it  afterwords  follow the steps below to erase a selection of volume automation  1     In Song mode  press the Edit button with anything except the Prog parameter selected  This brings  you to the current song   s EditSong  COMMON page           IEHOR E        TimeSi3  Fa Track   1  Drumtrke 1  2  3  de G  6  T  S   MidiDst  L   L   L   L   L   L   L   L      Stok TRACK  EVENT  Save      2  On the EditSong COMMON page  press the TRACK soft but
410. ting segment of recording tape          MAPAS A          Function   Location  Amount        Location  Bars   Beats   Ticks    The insertion point for the blank time being added is selected as a Bar and Beat Location value   Events that occurred at or after this Bar and Beat  before you insert time  are not erased when  you perform this function  rather they are offset by the length of the blank time being added to a  Bar and Beat later in the song     Amount  Bars   Beats   Ticks    The length of the blank time being added is defined as a number of Bars and Beats in the  Amount parameter     There are no Region Criteria parameters available for the Insert function     Delete    The Delete function is used to remove a region of time from the current song  This function is  different from the erase function because not only does it remove the events from the selected  time  it will delete the entire selected range of time from the song  modifying the song   s End  point appropriately  on all tracks   This is similar to cutting a section out of a tape and splicing  the ends         Es    Pe racket    Function  11 45    a  2 1116                  10 26    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Editor  Track Functions    Quantize    Use the Quantize function to adjust the timing of Note events  Keep in mind that only Note  events are quantized  other types of events  such as controllers  are not quantized         Function  Eee  Eluarit  Grid  Swing  Release       ALE re ea      
411. to choose specific programs and choose specific key ranges  You can follow  the same guides to make your own custom setups by choosing any combination of programs  and key ranges  In each tutorial  read the text for each step and look at the example display  screen shots as a guide for following each step  Important parameters that are mentioned in each  step will be circled on the example screen shots     The preset setups included with the PC3LE include split and layered setups  as well as some  setups that use more advanced features like riffs or assignable switches and knobs  To learn  more about these features see the Setup Mode chapter     A Note About Programs  Each Zone in a setup contains a program from the PC3LE s Program  mode  The PC3LE comes with over 1000 programs  and you can also edit these programs  When  choosing a program for a setup  many users will be satisfied using one of the included programs  as is  Some users may also wish to alter the properties of a program beyond the options given in  Setup mode  In these cases  it is necessary to edit the program from Program mode  See The  Program Editor on page 6 9 for more details        13 2    Tutorials  Setup Mode  The Setup Editor       The Setup Editor    In each of the following guides  you will be using the Setup Editor to make changes to the currently  selected setup  Open the Setup Editor from Setup mode by pressing the Edit button on the front panel   Use the soft buttons at the bottom of the display
412. to start playback or recording before the notes that you want to hear     About The Time Position Format    In this guide you will be instructed to select specific time positions in a song  In the PC3LE s  sequencer  time positions are measured from the beginning of the song in Bars  Beats  and Ticks   Dependent on the time signature  these units of measurements can have different values  In  these examples we will be using a 4 4 time signature in which a Bar contains 4 beats  and a  beat contains 960 ticks  from 0 to 959  see below for more about ticks   The Song mode MAIN  page displays song time in the Locat field as Bars and Beats  for example a Locat position of 1     3 would correspond to Bar 1  Beat 3  The Song mode Big Time page displays song time in large  numbers on the top half of the screen as Bars  Beats  and Ticks  For example a Big Time  position of 1  3  480 would correspond to Bar 1  Beat 3  Tick 480  in 4 4 Tick 480 would be the  second eighth note of the beat         12 1    Tutorial  Song Mode       Step 1  above    gt     Bars and beats should be familiar terms for musicians  but ticks are a term specific to MIDI  sequencers  Ticks provide fine resolution when recording and editing sequences  For example  if  you were to play along with the sequencer   s metronome to record one note on each beat of a bar   upon reviewing the sequence you would most likely find that each note was not recorded  exactly on each beat  but that each was recorded a different sm
413. to the event list of the  current RecTrk by changing the Prog parameter while recording  If a program change takes  place  the program will only return to the initial program if triggered by another program  change  or if the sequencer is stopped and restarted from the beginning of the sequence  One  exception to this is when using the Control Chase feature  you would only need to restart the  sequence before the first program change in order to return to the initial program  see Control  Chase on page 10 17      Prog changes to Trk   if RecTrk is set to None or Mult  This field indicates which track is  currently being triggered by the keyboard  and you can use this Trk   field to select a track     Track Number  Trk       This parameter is available only when RecTrk is set to None or Mult  replacing the Prog  parameter   It indicates which track is currently being triggered by the keyboard  and you can  use this field to select a track        10 3    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page    Volume  Vol     You can set a volume level for each track as a value between 0 and 127  If the channel of the  RecTrk  or the control channel  if RecTrk is set to Multi or None  contains any recorded volume  change  controller 7   the change will be reflected as the Vol parameter s value in real time  as  well as on the MIXER page  Also  changing the Vol value while recording will write volume  automation  controller 7 messages  to the current RecTrk s event list  
414. to the same channel  but with different controller assignments     Here s one example  if a receiving synth is using Controller 1 for modulation depth and  Controller  13 for modulation speed  you can increase both the depth and the speed with  Knob A  Start by assigning Knob A in Zone 1 to MWheel and in Zone 2 to MIDI 13  then assign  both zones to the same MIDI channel   You may want to make sure you aren t sending doubled  notes  Use the Note Map parameter on the KEY   VEL page to set one zone s Note Map to Linear  and the other zone s Note Map to Off      Another example  create two or more zones that are identical except for their transposition  settings  Now you can play parallel intervals  or chords  with single keystrikes     MidiBank    The PC3LE s programs are divided into 17 MIDI Banks  numbered 0 16  Program 46 in MIDI  Bank 3 for example  is 430 Lead Oboe  The MIDI Bank parameter displays which bank the  current program is assigned to  and automatically changes to match the Program value you set     You can send Bank Select messages to external MIDI devices as well  by setting the Destination  parameter to a destination including MIDI or USB_MIDI  then changing MidiBank  Some  instruments may have more banks than the PC3LE  Bank switching via MIDI makes it easy for  the PC3LE user to select sounds on external instruments  no matter how many banks they might  have     When you change the value of the Program parameter  the value of MidiBank automatically  changes 
415. ton  see below   This brings you to the       EditSong TRACK page     12 12       Tutorial  Song Mode       Et Sons CA ral    TemPo 1 1 O  Timesia  f zg   Track   1  Drumlirkil  z  3  de G  6  TT   amp    Midilst  L      L   L   L   L   L   L   L      Stor  TRACK PzWENT  Save    eT  3  On the EditSong TRACK page  set the Function parameter to Erase  see below      eS fat  From  1 8 1   To   1d 11   1  Events   All              Functio  Er ase           4  Use the Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to choose the track to erase volume  automation from  You can view the selected track number in the upper right corner of the screen     5  Set the Events parameter to Controllers  see below      Eqn Soros  RAL  Function  Erase            Lo i    ow 1   ls     n CR _ T  Events ii Conte aller  Control lene ell  Lollal   121    FromtolPlas Yotor e    6  Set the Controller parameter to Volume  You can do this quickly by selecting the Controller field   entering 7 on the alphanumeric pad  and pressing Enter  Make sure the LoVal parameter is set to 0  and the Hi parameter is set to 127  see below               12 13    Tutorial  Song Mode            Edita as  RHE  Function  Erase    7  Use the From and To parameters to set the range of time from which you want to remove your  volume automation  You can play the song and watch the Locate field to determine these times  For  this example  let s say that we want to erase volume automation from bar 3  see below      Edita as  RHE
416. top  Load files from your computer to your PC3LE by putting files on the PC3LE virtual  drive  then selecting USB PC Connection in Storage mode to load the files  Save files from the  PC3LE to your computer by using this configuration with the Storage modes Store function   Saved files will temporarily appear on the PC3LE virtual drive on your computers desktop  and  you then must copy your saved files to another location on your computer  You must copy data  from the PC3LE virtual drive to your computer   s drive or else the data will be lost     When you leave Storage Mode  there will be a prompt telling you that the PC3LE is turning back  into a USB MIDI device   which you have to acknowledge  If you haven   t copied the file s  to  your desktop  or other place on the computer  it won   t be on the virtual disk when you leave  storage mode     Depending on your computer   s operating system  you may sometimes see a scary device  removal warning on your desktop after using the PC3LE virtual drive  You may disregard such  a message without worries of damage to your PC3LE or computer     Caution  Do not remove a USB device while the display says Loading    or Saving     Removing a USB  device during a file transfer can cause data corruption     Formatting a USB Device  See Format on page 11 8        11 2    Storage Mode       Path    Path    When you choose the STORE  LOAD  or UTILS soft buttons on the Storage mode main page  at  some point you will have to choose exactly whe
417. ts           ccccccccscsseesesssseeseececeseseecenenesesesesneneneseeceeessseseenenenesesesenenes 13 8  Adjusting The Volume And Pan Of Zones A A AA o emanates 13 11  Assigning Multiple Knobs To Control Volume In Different Zones  oocononcooonononcnnnncnnnnnnncnnnennnnrarannnnncnrorarannananananos 13 13  Assigning A Single Knob To Control Relative Volume In Different Zones  onoconconcnonononcnnenennnracnnnnnnnrnrornrnecinananos 13 17  Assigning A Single Knob to Crossfade Between The Volume Of Different Zones          cccccseeeeeeeeeeeeeseenees 13 25  Switch Between Zones Based On Played Keyboard Velocity          ccscsssssssesesssessessessesessssssssssssssssssessssesseseesesees 13 30  Creating  A NeW Setup  as ccccseeeitesies cease irrita ds EA EE EE 13 33  Basics Of Using Ritts ss plis iii A a alta si 13 36  Adding A Riff Syne Ritts  ss  SN 13 36  Transposing A Riff As It Is Trig ered        c ccescscssessscssesescsssesesesesnenesesescecesescscenanssesesesuesesesceceesssnsnanenenesesenenesees 13 43  Using A Single Song For Multiple Riffs aisre eeen eierens roeier ieres E Er rar E REE A a EE 13 47  Chapter 14 Power User Tips  General TIPS intentos te sarres A ida 14 2  Set The Start up Program And MIDI Channel          ssssssssssssssssssstsesstttenssnteensntenenntesensntessnsntensnsnninssnntnessntrneesntet 14 2  Picking Favorite Programs For Each Cate iia 14 2  Easy Audition  Play A Demo Song For Each Program  A  14 3  Program Mode General Tips iesiri satra teser Ee ssi SR REE
418. ttons select Quick Access programs based on how programs are laid out  on the display  with no need to press the Shift button  In Master and Storage modes  as well as       3 9    User Interface Basics       Data Entry    the editors for Program  Setup  Song  and Quick Access modes  the Category buttons will  automatically enter letters or numbers into parameter fields when appropriate     When you re entering numeric values  press the corresponding numeric buttons  ignoring  decimal places if any  to enter 1 16  for example  press 1  1  6  Enter   The display will reflect  your entries  but the value won t actually change until you press Enter  Before pressing Enter   you can return to the original value by pressing Cancel  Pressing Clear is the same as pressing 0  without pressing Enter     When entering names  you can use the Left Right cursor buttons or the  lt  lt  lt     gt  gt  gt  soft buttons  to move the cursor to the character you want to change  Use the labels on the Category buttons  as a guide to character entry  Press the corresponding button one or more times to insert the  desired character above the cursor  The Enter button is equivalent to OK  The Clear button  replaces the currently selected character with a space  The     button toggles between uppercase  and lowercase letters     There s also a convenient feature called keyboard naming  which lets you use the keyboard to  enter characters in names  See page 5 5        3 10    User Interface Basics       
419. u replace a factory ROM song  you    can revert to the original song by deleting the song using the Object soft button in Master Mode   see the Master Mode chapter      Part 4  Record Additional Tracks    When you are happy with your first track and you have saved your song so far  move on to  adding other instrument parts on other tracks  You can record up to 16 tracks     1  On the Song mode MAIN page  use the Chan Zone buttons  to the left of the display  to Set  the RecTrk parameter to an unused track number  for example  track 2      MAI ff eventos Tas ye   STUFFED    CurSra  MY Sons TemPo  166 4  RecTrk ol  12r Pan  4 Mode  Merde  Frog  ano Stack Locat  1 il    O    Track F RF         re  ele Toa eara    AAA    2  Set the instrument sound for the current track  Use the cursor buttons to navigate to the Prog field  and choose a program with the plus minus buttons  alpha wheel  or by entering the desired program  number with the alphanumeric pad  This sets the instrument sound for the current track  For  example  choose program 105 P Bass to make the next track contain the bass part for this song  see    below   This would be useful to play a bass part that matches the root notes of your left hand piano  part from track 1              THI  events lara   STOPPED    Curro 1625   NY Sond TemPo  106 4  RecTrk J Mode  Merde  Prog Locat  1 il       Track  P Ra    e026 Seo Se ee a  Pare  BIG osa  save  Export   more 4  3  Follow the same steps in Part 3 above  starting on step 2
420. u use  nonstandard intonations  you ll want to set Int Key to the key you re playing in  If the Intonation  parameter is set to Equal  changing Int Key has no effect        Master Mode       Master Mode Page 2  MAST 2     Master Mode Page 2  MAST 2     On Master Mode page 2 you ll find settings for the PC3LE s digital output  FX Mode  and  default song  You can view the OS and Objects versions  remap drum programs  as well as  enable or disabling General MIDI mode  program demos  and buttons mode                   aci  139 0  A Pl    5    bject Wer             ode   Performance General MIDI  Wersion  4 26  12852 Demo Button     J TI    tol    a Te Drum Remake        On  21 41 55 Buttons Mode  Df       Dj  F  O  o                                   Parameter Range of Values Default  Clock Source Internal  External Internal  Digital Output Vol  Dig  out Variable  Fixed Variable  volume    FX Mode Performance  Multitrack Performance  OS Object Version Current OS Object Version Current OS Object Version  Default Song Song List 1 New Song  Output Clock Off  On Off   Drum Remap None  GM None  General MIDI Off  On Off   Demo Button On  Off On   Buttons Mode Off  On Off    Clock Source          With Clock Source set to Internal  the PC3LE generates its own tempo  With Clock Source set to  External  the PC3LE can sync up with the tempo from another device assuming the device is  sending MIDI clock data to the PC3LE via the PC3LE s MIDI in or USB ports  See Important Note  About Externa
421. ud Soft 87  Percussion Decay Fast Slow 88  Percussion Pitch High Low 89  KeyClick On Off 90       Table 6 2 KB3 MIDI Controller Assignments       6 8    Program Mode       The Program Editor    The Program Editor    You can use the Program Editor to further modify the PC3LE s factory preset ROM sounds  To  enter the Program Editor  start in Program mode by pressing the Program mode button on the  front panel  then press the Edit button on the front panel  The EditProg PARAMETERS page will    appear   Parameter MIDI Value Control Source                5  Por Hone   5    pre la Mone CCPedall  Pad Lr Brightness    Knob   Fiano En Release        Knobs  Fad Liar Eny Control knob    a i AE tibet    Press the PARAMS soft button to display the PARAMETERS page  see above   The  PARAMETERS page allows you to access all of the controlable parameters for the current  program  All programs have at least these five basic parameters  Pan  Expression  program  volume    Aux FX1 Wet Dry  Sustain  and Sostenuto  The parameters page will also display any  available VAST synthesis parameters for the current program and parameters for the current  program   s insert and aux effects  if effects are in use   All available parameters are listed  For  each parameter you can set a MIDI value as well as a control source        The PARAMETERS Page    The left column lists the available parameters  the center column shows the MIDI value for each  parameter  and the right column shows the control source  
422. uld set the bass riff SyncZone to Riff 1     You may want to have a little more freedom and not be tied to the drum riff as the main     timekeeper     Maybe you want to start with the bass riff and have the drum riff start later  In  this case you would set SyncZone to FirstRiff Av  With this setting  the riff will look for the first  available riff to sync to  So if both the drum riff and the bass riff have this parameter set to  FirstRiff Av   the riff that is started first will be the master  If the bass riff starts first  the drum riff  will see that as the first available riff to sync to and will do so  If the drum riff is started first  the  bass riff will see that as the first available riff to sync to and will do so  This can be very handy if  you have multiple riffs and want to do some live remixing  you could have the drums drop out   and   as long is there is a riff playing   they will sync back up when triggered again     You can also choose FirstArp Av   which behaves the same way as FirstRiff Av   but makes your  riff look for the first available arpeggiator to sync to  A setting of Main Seq  will sync the riff to  the song currently loaded in Song mode  You can select a song in Song mode  then play it from  setup mode with the front panel Play Pause button   Doing this temporarily replaces the programs  in your setup s zones with the program used for each channel in the song  so it s best to make a setup that  uses the same programs as your song on the same MI
423. ult  all factory ROM programs  have their Expression parameter set to a value of None  and Expression  program volume  by  default can be controlled by an expression pedal plugged into the CC Pedal jack  see The Control  Setup section on page 7 68 for more about default controller settings   With an expression pedal  plugged into the CC Pedal jack  you can control the volume of any factory ROM program  but  when you select another factory ROM program  it will have the same volume that you set with  the expression pedal in the last program  This way  the volume of your programs will stay  consistent  and can always be changed by the expression pedal  If you want a program to have a  default volume  you must set a MIDI Value other than None for the Expression parameter  For  all parameters with a MIDI Value of None  any values set with a physical control will not be  saved when saving the program  You must set the MIDI Value column for that parameter to  something other than None in order to set and save a value     Note About KB3 Programs  For KB3 Programs  the Drawbar parameters only accept MIDI  values from 0 8  representing the settings for Drawbar stops   as well as values of None     Control Source    In the Control Source  right  column  set one of the PC3LE   s physical controllers as a control  source by holding the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad and moving the desired controller   You can also use the Alpha Wheel or the     buttons to choose one of the PC3LE s p
424. ument     IMPORTANT  When connecting this product to accessories and or other  equipment use only high quality shielded cables     NOTE  This instrument has been tested and found to comply with the  limits for a Class B digital device  pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules   These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against  harmful interference in a residential installation  This instrument  generates  uses  and can radiate radio frequency energy and  if not  installed and used in accordance with the instructions  may cause  harmful interference to radio communications  However  there is no  guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation  If  this instrument does cause harmful interference to radio or television  reception  which can be determined by turning the instrument off and on   the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more  of the following measures       Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna     Increase the separation between the instrument and the receiver     e Connect the instrument into an outlet on a circuit other than the one  to which the receiver is connected       If necessary consult your dealer or an experienced radio television  technician for additional suggestions     NOTICE    This apparatus does not exceed the Class B limits for radio noise  emissions from digital apparatus set out in the Radio Interference  Regulations of the Canadian Department of Communications     AVIS    L
425. upbeat or a downbeat     With SyncType set to DownBeatWait  the riff will wait for the downbeat of the next measure to  start  The difference from DownBeat is that if there is nothing playing to sync to  the riff will not  start  This can be useful if you want to start multiple riffs synced to one riff  You could have a  bass riff set to DownBeatWait  for instance  and trigger the riff while no other riffs are running   As soon as you start another riff  the bass riff will start playing as well  provided that it is set to  sync to another riff or to the first available riff   If another riff is already running  DownBeatWait  behaves just like DownBeat        7 56    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    With SyncType set to AnyBeatWait  the riff will wait for the next beat to start  The difference  from AnyBeat is that if there is nothing playing to sync to  this riff will not start  This can be  useful if you want to start multiple riffs synced to one riff  You could have a bass riff set to  AnyBeatWait  for instance  and trigger the riff while no other riffs are running  As soon as you  start another riff  the bass riff will start playing as well  provided that it is set to sync to another  riff or the first available   If something is already playing to sync to  AnyBeatWait behaves just  like AnyBeat     With SyncType set to Loop  if there is already a riff or song playing to sync to  the current riff  will wait for the playing riff or song to restart its loop  if itis loop
426. use their functions change depending on the currently selected mode and page   Sometimes they perform specific functions  like changing MIDI transposition  In the Program  Editor and other editors  they re also used to move to different pages of programming  parameters  If a soft button   s label is in all capital letters  ARP1  for example   pressing the  corresponding soft button takes you to a page of parameters  If the soft button is labeled in  lower case or mixed case letters  Save  for example   the soft button performs some kind of  function     KURZWEIL    ES 15       The Cursor Buttons    To the right of the display are four buttons arranged around the Alpha Wheel  see below   These  are called the cursor buttons  They move the cursor around the currently selected page  in the  direction indicated by their labels  The cursor is a highlighted  reversed  rectangle  sometimes  it   s an underscore   It marks the value of the currently selected parameter     Ca    7    Programming the PC3LE involves selecting various parameters and changing their values   Select parameters by highlighting their values with the cursor  You can change the highlighted  value with any of the data entry methods described in the data entry section below        3 7    User Interface Basics       Navigation    The Chan Zone Buttons    To the left of the display are two buttons labeled Chan Zone  Their function depends on the  current mode  In Program mode  for example  they shift through the MI
427. used in combination with the controller  destinations Shift Key Note  Shift Key  and Key Velocity  These destinations can use a zone   s  Shift Pattern whether the arpeggiator is on or off without conflict  For more information on Shift  Patterns such as editing and saving  see Shift Pattern  ShiftPatt  on page 7 41   Note that the  ShiftPatt Up or Down options  as well as any of the arpeggiator parameters other than ShiftPatt do not  have an effect on Shift Key Number   You can also set controllers to destination 171  ShiftPatt  to  select a pattern from the current bank of 128 shift patterns  and destination 172  ShiftPBank  to  select a bank from banks of 128 shift patterns each     Selecting The Desired Velocity     In order to have a note sound when using Shift Key Number  you first need to send a Key  Velocity message  KeyVel  controller destination 135  with a non zero velocity  You must set a  controller to this destination  it   s useful to set a knob or other continuous controller in order to  control velocity while playing  The next notes to be triggered by Shift Key Number will be  played with the last received KeyVel velocity  One note triggered by these controllers sounds  until another note is triggered or until a KeyVel message with velocity 0 is sent        7 22    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Selecting The Desired Key  Root Note      Shift Key  ShiftKey  controller destination 177  allows the user to select the key  root note  of  the Shift Pattern t
428. ut saving  or press Cancel to return to the Setup Editor        When saving  you must choose an ID   An ID  gives you a way to locate a setup aside from its  name  you can store up to 2 560 unique ID s for each object type  setups  programs  songs  etc    though many ID s are already used for factory ROM objects   ID s also allow you to save  setups with the same name under different ID s  and rename them at a later time if desired   Choose an unused ID  to save a new setup  The next available unused ID  is automatically  selected when editing a factory ROM setup  When editing a setup that has been stored in user  memory  any originally unused ID    the edited setup   s ID  is automatically selected  This  assumes that you wish to replace the existing setup  but you can choose another ID  if desired  to save a new copy  Choose a used ID  to replace an existing saved setup  If you replace a  factory ROM setup  you can revert to the original setup by using the Delete soft button in the  Setup Editor  See the Editing Conventions chapter for more details on saving and naming        The setup has been edited       Save setup Zo Default Setup 7    Rename  No ves  Cancel          13 35    Tutorials  Setup Mode  Basics Of Using Riffs       Basics Of Using Riffs    Riffs are full songs or individual tracks of a song created in the PC3LE sequencer that you can  trigger in setup mode  Every zone in a setup can have it s own riff   a completely independent  sequence  Riffs can be used to
429. utorials  Setup Mode       Basics Of Using Riffs       13 54    Power User Tips       Chapter 14  Power User Tips    This chapter will discuss the PC3LE   s shortcuts and other features which are designed to make  the operation and editing of each mode more convenient  Though each of these features is  explained elsewhere in this guide  this chapter can be used as a reference as well as a quick  overview for power users who wish to operate the PC3LE more efficiently  General tips and  shortcuts will be discussed first  followed by more advanced tips that deal with editing and  operating each mode     In This Chapter   General Tips   eSet The Start up Program And MIDI Channel    oooooocccccncncncncncccccncccccnc cc 14 2  e Picking Favorite Programs For Each Category        0 0 00 ccc ccc ccc ccc cece eee ees 14 2  e Easy Audition  Play A Demo Song For Each Program       oooooccooccorrocccanrr rr mom    14 3  eSave The Current Knob And Switch Settings From The Program Mode Main Page              14 3  Advanced Tips  e Intuitive Controller Selection Data ENYA a at eh RN ot Nt eed ee fast Nek 14 4  e Search Function  Find A Program Or Setup By Name             000 ccc ccc ccc ccc ccc eee 14 4     Quick Song Recording And Playback  Record An Idea From Any Mode      ooooooooommmm     14 5  Program Mode     Change The Effects  CHAIM arser fede nace iach goed ote A Ree are Ree Sees 14 6  e Change Knob  Switches  and Other Controller Assignments and Control Non Default  POPAMCECTS 8 o
430. vely giving you access to 10 switches  Use  the Shift button to the left of these switches to toggle between accessing switches 1 5 or 6 10   Pressing this Shift button will light one of the LEDs of the two rows of labels below the  Assignable Switches  This lets you know which set of switches you are using  either SW1 SW5  or SW6 SW10   When using a KB3 program  the blue KB3 LED will light  below the LED for the  two rows of labels   and the Assignable Switches will control the KB3 organ functions labeled  below the switch names     Loo ASSIGNABLE SWITCHES      Oo SW1 SW2 SW3 SW4 SW5  Slow   Fast Brake On   Off Chor   Vib Depth       O SW6 SW7 SW8 SW9 SW10  On   Off Loud   Soft Decay F S Pitch H L On   Off    The Save Button    The Save button is located to the right of the display  While on the Program mode main page   the LED on the Save button will light when you have changed any of the control states of the  assignable knobs  switches  or other control sources  for example turning a switch on or off   changing a knob position  etc   When the LED on the Save button is lit  press the Save button  twice to quickly save your    tweaked    version of the current program  If you haven t previously  edited the program  this will save a new copy of the program under a new ID   If you have  previously edited the program  this will replace the current program by saving under the same  ID         3 3    User Interface Basics       Category Buttons    Category Buttons    Use the Cat
431. ween the ID and object type  of selected objects     Next Scroll to next entry  Same function as pressing the down cursor button or the    button  or turning the Alpha Wheel one click clockwise     Type Jump to next object type     Store Store the selected objects to the current storage device  Pressing this soft button calls  up the Select Directory dialog     Cancel Exits the Store Advanced page and returns you to the Store page        11 5    Storage Mode       The LOAD Page    Shortcuts when Storing Individual Objects    Selecting or deselecting all of the objects at once can be done with the following double presses   two front panel buttons simultaneously pressed        Left Right cursor double press  Select All Objects  e Up Down cursor double press  Clear All Selections    If you want to store most but not all of the items from a file  for example  if there are some songs  in RAM that you don   t want to be stored in the file   it may be fastest to first select all objects  using the Left   Right double press  and then manually deselect any unwanted items     Saving Master Table Files    Among your choices on the Store Advanced page are Master Table files  Master Table files  consist primarily of the items on the two Master mode pages  as well as settings for which  program is on each MIDI channel  Saving Master Table files is a good way to configure your  PC3LE  or another PC3LE  to your performance or sequencing needs  For example  you might  save different Master T
432. wing the program currently  assigned to that channel     If you change RecTrk to None or Multi  the display changes to show Trk    This field indicates  which track is currently being triggered by the keyboard  and you can use this Trk   field to  select a track     Program  Prog     Use this field to scroll through the programs in memory and select a program before initially  recording each track of your song  A program selected on the current RecTrk becomes the  track s initial program the first time that the track is recorded  An initial program is the program  that will be used for a track when it is played from the start of bar 1  or any other point if there  are no program changes and Control Chase is turned on  see Control Chase on page 10 17    Programs selected in Program or Quick Access Mode are selected as the program on the current  RecTrk when you return to Song mode     Follow these steps to change the current RecTrk   s initial program after recording has taken place  on that track  While the sequencer is stopped  press Record  select the program  press Stop  and  save the song  This preserves all changes you have made to any other track parameters  volume   pan  tempo  etc  You can also change the initial program at the top of a track   s EVENT list  see  Song Editor  The EVENT Page on page 10 31      Any MIDI program changes on the current RecTrk or Chan cause the ID and name of the track   s  program to change during playback  Program changes can be written 
433. with multiple layers of instruments on different tracks  This is also a common  method for recording sequence based music  in which you created each section of your song  from looped sequences  and then arrange the loops into the desired order for your song   s  structure  Afterwards you can make variations to each section if you want the song to have less  of a    looped    sound     Song Editing And Structure With Track Functions    In song mode you can easily copy part of a sequence to another time in the song  or from one  track to another  You can also copy a section of all tracks at once in order to duplicate or  structure entire sections of your song  such as verse and chorus sections  You can also choose  groups of notes to erase  or entire bars of time to delete  There are many basic and advanced  editing functions available  For details see the Song mode chapter  Song Editor  Track Functions     Program Changes    If your song requires more than 16 instrument parts  one method of achieving this is with  program changes  For example  let s say you ve used all 16 tracks but desire a new instrument  for the next section of the song  If there is a track whose instrument is not needed in the new  section  this track   s program could change to a new instrument sound for the section  and then  change back to the original instrument sound after the section  To do this  simply press Record  and Play Pause and then change the Prog parameter on the Song mode MAIN page to the 
434. wn  and therefore is useful when stepping through a list of  subdirectories from a single directory level     USB devices come formatted and ready to use with the PC3LE  If you ever need to format a  device  however  you can use any computer with USB device formatting capability  or format it  using the PC3LE     To format a USB device with the PC3LE  plug the USB device into the PC3LE   s USB Storage  port  then press the Storage button to enter Storage mode  Press the soft button labeled Format   The PC3LE will ask you if you want to format  Press the OK soft button to format the device  or  the Cancel soft button to return to the Storage mode main page     Caution  Formatting will erase all files on the USB device  make sure anything that you wish  to save is backed up on another device        11 8    Tutorial  Song Mode       Chapter 12  Tutorial  Song Mode    In Song mode  you can use the PC3LE s sequencer to record songs using multiple instrument  sounds  You can easily change your song   s tempo  fix mistakes  and adjust the volume of each  instrument     The following guide includes instructions to choose specific instrument sounds and track  numbers  simply as examples  When you are ready to make your own song  follow the same  methods and choose any instrument and track selection that you want     The steps below explain the simplest way to record  in a linear  track by track fashion  There are  many methods for recording songs  and there are recording options that 
435. would like certain tracks to not be stored with initial values   In this case  only set initial values for each desired parameter as described above  see Setting Initial Pan  Per Track         10 5    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page    Mode    Pan Sources When An Initial Pan Is Not Set    If an initial Pan is not stored with each track  the Pan for each track of your song will be set  depending on what mode you were in previous to loading the song  If you are in Song mode  and have played a song  and then you load a song without initial Pan settings  the Pan of each  track of the newly loaded song will be set by the previously played song  Pan settings are tied to  MIDI channels  so the Pan of each track will be dependent on which MIDI channel is assigned to  each track in each song  If you are in Song mode and you load a song that does not have initial  Pan settings without playing another song first  the Pan of the MIDI channel for each track is set  depending on which mode you enter Song mode from  If you enter Song mode from Program  mode or Quick Access mode  the Pan of each MIDI channel is set based on the pan for each  MIDI chamnel set in those modes  If you enter Song mode from Setup mode  the Pan of each  MIDI channel is set if a zone uses the same MIDI channel on the SetupMode CH PROG page   set with the Channel parameter   If a zone does use a MIDI channel that one of the tracks in  your song uses  the Pan of that track will be set by t
436. y pressing CANCEL  Caution  This will clear any existing knob or switch  assignments     For setups with KB3 and V A S T  programs  you can program a switch to toggle back and forth  between having the knobs and assignable switches function as they would with KB3 programs   or having the switches function as zone mute buttons  To do this  in the Setup editor  first use the  KB3CTL soft button as explained above  Next  go to the Controllers page  by pressing the  CTRLS soft button   On the Controllers page  select the Controllers field  hold the Enter button  on the alphanumeric pad and press the ArpLatch button  above the Mod Wheel  to choose Arp   latch sw for the controller field  alternatively the Arp Enable button  Arp  switch  can be used    On the Controllers page for Arp  latch sw  use the cursor buttons to select the DestType field and  set it to Ctrl  Next  select the OnControl field and set it to KB3Mutes by entering 169 and  pressing the Enter button on the alphanumeric pad  Do the same for the OffControl field  Leave  the other fields at their defaults  Type Toggled  On Value 127  Off Value 0  Make these  Controller page settings for all zones in the setup  Now when you press and light the ArpLatch  button the assignable switches work as zone mute buttons  see below   When you press and  unlight the ArpLatch button the assignable switches work as KB3 controls  Make sure to save  your setup to keep these changes  Caution  This will clear any existing knob or switch
437. y subtly to Offset and Scale  or not at all        7 30    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Velocity Curve  VelCurve     VelCurve lets you taper the velocity response  The default setting is Linear  which means that  the output velocity changes directly proportionally to the played velocity     Expand produces a curve that is less steep than the linear curve at keystrike velocities below 64   and steeper than the linear curve at keystrike velocities above 64  In other words  when you re  playing softly  you ll notice velocity differences less than with a linear curve  while when you re  playing hard  you ll notice velocity differences more     Compress produces a velocity curve that is the opposite of the expanded curve   that is  you ll  notice velocity differences more when you re playing softly than when you re playing hard     127 TA  Velocity Curve  Linear    as you hit the keys harder  increase the  velocity  MIDI velocity increases proportionally         7 i             Velocity Curve  Compress      N MIDI velocity is greater at  medium strike velocity than with Linear curve    64      mo Velocity Curve  Expand      E MIDI velocity is less at  medium strike velocity than with Linear curve    MIDI Velocity       0  64 127    Strike Velocity       7 31    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Crossfade is designed to be used in tandem with the Reverse Crossfade curve  enabling you to  perform smooth crossfades between different programs     Bump tapers velocity respon
438. y time  on the top line of the Master mode page    Press Delete  and you will be given a choice to Delete or Cancel  Press Delete again  and an    Are  You Sure     message will appear  Press Yes to delete the setup  or No to cancel     If you delete a user edited program  there is no way to recover it  If you delete an edited  program that has been saved over a factory ROM ID   the original factory ROM program will  re appear  Factory ROM programs can not be deleted        6 15    Program Mode       The Program Editor       6 16    Setup Mode       Chapter 7  Setup Mode    In Setup mode  the PC3LE can take on the identity of 16 distinct instruments and 16 distinct  MIDI transmitters  each of which can use the setup s physical controller assignments  or any  subset of those controller assignments   For example  you can create a setup that is split into 16  different keyboard regions  called zones   Each zone can play its own program  while also  transmitting on its own MIDI channel  Each zone can also have an independent arpeggiator and  one riff  You can also record the output of a setup to Song mode     Selecting setups in Setup mode is much like selecting programs in Program mode   just use one  of the normal data entry methods to scroll through the list of setups  There are  however  some  important differences between a program and a setup  A program plays on a single keyboard  zone and on a single MIDI channel  A setup enables you to use up to 16 keyboard  or MIDI  cont
439. yer page from Program mode  it acts the same as it does in  Setup mode  except that your result will be a new setup  instead of adding a new split or layer  zone to an existing setup as you would with when entering the Split  Layer page from Setup  mode  Also  when entering the Split Layer page from Program mode the currently selected  program will be assigned to zone 1 of a new setup  and the PC3LE   s physical controllers will be  assigned to zone 1   s program by default  though you can edit this later in setup Edit mode      Tap Tempo Button    You can use the Tap Tempo button to set the tempo of the Arpeggiator while in Program mode   Tap the Tap Tempo button on quarter note beats for a measure or two at the desired tempo to set  a tempo  You need to tap at least twice for a tempo to be calculated  though tapping several  times  like on each beat of one or more measures  works best  This also brings up the Tap Tempo  page which gives you more Tap Tempo options  The newly tapped tempo is displayed in the  tempo field  and LED on the Tap Tempo button blinks at that tempo  Press the Exit button or the  Done soft button to return to the Program mode main page        Tempo  120 00    TemForar    TAP controller   Tat       6 4    Program Mode       V A S T  and KB3 Programs    Alternatively  a temporary controller can be set for use in the Temporary TAP controller field  or  you can tap the Tap soft button  The Temporary TAP controller works only while on the Tap  Tempo screen
440. you let them go  until Latch turns off  Any notes that you  play after Latch is already on do not get arpeggiated  even if they re in the arpeggiation range     Arpeg is similar  any notes held when Latch goes on are latched and arpeggiated  and keep  going until Latch goes off  Any notes you play outside the arpeggiation range play normally   Notes that you play inside the arpeggiation range do not play normally  rather  if you hold them  on  they become part of the arpeggiation  They drop out of the arpeggiation as soon as you  release them     Like Overplay and Arpeggiation  Add means that all notes being held when Latch goes on get  latched  and keep playing until Latch goes off  even if you ve released the notes   Any notes you  play after Latch is already on also get latched        7 43    Setup Mode       The Setup Editor    Auto is independent of Latch  every note you play is automatically latched  and the Arpeggiator  runs as long as you hold at least one arpeggiated note  As long as you keep holding on at least  one note  it doesn t have to be the same note the whole time   every note you play in the  arpeggiation range gets latched     Pedals is sort of a combination of Keys  Add  and Overplay modes  It relies on both Latch  MIDI  157  and Latch2  MIDI 158   If neither latch controller is on  notes will arpeggiate only while you  are holding down keys  similar to Keys mode   If you activate Controller 158  the keys currently  held down will latch  and any additiona
441. you may wish to  change once you become familiar with the process  See the Song mode chapter for more options     Recording Overview    In this guide you will be instructed to record into tracks in a song  A track is like a layer in a song  containing the recorded part for one instrument program  You can record up to 16 tracks  and  each can be separately edited or adjusted in volume level  with many other options available as  well      About MIDI    In Song mode the PC3LE functions as a MIDI sequencer  MIDI  Musical Instrument Digital  Interface  is a standardized system that allows different electronic instruments to work together   among other musical uses  A MIDI sequencer doesn t record the sound of your performance   just messages that cause the instrument to play notes  When you play back a song  a k a  a MIDI  sequence  in Song mode  the PC3LE triggers each of the notes that you have recorded  sort of like  a player piano  MIDI is very useful for recording songs with electronic instruments such as the  PC3LE  because you can easily make changes to recorded sequences  For example  you can  change individual notes  transpose parts  or change the instrumentation of tracks that have  already been recorded  Since MIDI sequences only play back messages that trigger notes  if you  start recording or playing back from the middle of your song  you will not hear the result of  notes before that point  such as notes sustaining from the previous bar   In these cases  make  sure 
442. you set the Locate point  that location will be used as the return point when Stop is  pressed  Simply press Stop again to reset the song to the top  1   1      Mode Indicators    and x      Mode Indicators appear only for tracks that already contain data     A plus sign     appears above the Track Status Indicator of a track set to record  R  when the  Mode parameter is set to Merge     An  x  appears above the Track Status Indicator of a track set to Record  R  when the Mode  parameter is set to Erase     Activity Indicators    Asmall square above the Track Status Indicator of a track set to Play  P  or Mute  M  means the  track contains data        10 6    Song Mode and the Song Editor       Song Mode  The MAIN Page    During playback and recording  the indicators above tracks containing any MIDI data will flash  a small  filled in square when any MIDI activity is detected     Track Status Indicators    Using the Up  Down  Left  and Right cursor buttons to position the cursor onto a Track Status  Indicator  you can toggle an empty track     into Record  R  with the Alpha Wheel or Plus   Minus buttons     Once a track contains data  it will have a  P  as a Track Status Indicator  and it will be played  during playback  You now will be able to toggle between Play  P   Mute  M   and Record  R      The track selected as the RecTrk will display an  R   designating it as the recording track  If the  RecTrk is set to Mult  initially all empty tracks will have Record  R  as a Trac
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
  Modulation morphologique de la densité  GMA 200-MT Manual - GfG Instrumentation  Hampton Bay 17262 Installation Guide  Tascam DP-006 Handbuch  Samsung Индукционная варочная поверхность NZ63F3NM1AB Инструкция по использованию(User manual)  IAN 79839 - Lidl Service Website  manual de instalación - Trabajos de Grado  Libretto di istruzioni per la caldaia Delfis Monotermica  Switchboard User Manual - 8x8 - Packet8    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file